Use these links to rapidly review the document
TABLE OF CONTENTS

Table of Contents

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549



FORM 10-K

ý   ANNUAL REPORT UNDER SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008

or

o

 

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from            to            .

Commission File Number 001-32141

ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

Bermuda
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  98-0429991
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

30 Woodbourne Avenue
Hamilton HM 08 Bermuda
(441) 299-9375

(Address, including zip code, and telephone number,
including area code, of Registrant's principal executive office)

None
(Former name, former address and former fiscal year, if changed since last report)

         Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class   Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Stock, $0.01 per share   New York Stock Exchange, Inc.

         Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:    None

         Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ý    No o

         Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes o    No ý

         Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ý    No o

         Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. ý

         Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer," and "smaller reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer ý   Accelerated filer o   Non-accelerated filer o
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
  Smaller reporting company o

         Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes o    No ý

         The aggregate market value of Common Stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant as of the close of business on June 30, 2008 was $1,061,302,528 (based upon the closing price of the Registrant's shares of the New York Stock Exchange on that date, which was $17.99). For purposes of this information, the outstanding shares of Common Stock which were owned by all directors and executive officers of the Registrant and by ACE Limited were deemed to be shares of Common Stock held by affiliates.

         As of February 12, 2009, 91,097,894 shares of Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share, were outstanding.

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

         Certain portions of Registrant's definitive proxy statement relating to its 2008 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders are incorporated by reference to Part III of this report.


Table of Contents


FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

        Some of the statements under "Business," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and elsewhere in this Form 10-K may include forward-looking statements which reflect our current views with respect to future events and financial performance. These statements include forward looking statements both with respect to us specifically and the insurance and reinsurance industries in general. Statements which include the words "expect," "intend," "plan," "believe," "project," "anticipate," "may," "will," "continue," "further," "seek," and similar words or statements of a future or forward looking nature identify forward looking statements for purposes of the federal securities laws or otherwise.

        All forward-looking statements address matters that involve risks and uncertainties. Accordingly, there are or will be important factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from those indicated in these statements. We believe that these factors include the following:


Table of Contents

        The foregoing review of important factors should not be construed as exhaustive, and should be read in conjunction with the other cautionary statements that are included in this Form 10-K. We undertake no obligation to update publicly or review any forward looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise.

        If one or more of these or other risks or uncertainties materialize, or if our underlying assumptions prove to be incorrect, actual results may vary materially from what we projected. Any forward looking statements you read in this Form 10-K reflect our current views with respect to future events and are subject to these and other risks, uncertainties and assumptions relating to our operations, results of operations, growth strategy and liquidity.

        For these statements, we claim the protection of the safe harbor for forward-looking statements contained in Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.



TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
   
  Page

PART I

       

Item 1.

 

Business

  1

Item 1A.

 

Risk Factors

  50

Item 1B.

 

Unresolved Staff Comments

  70

Item 2.

 

Properties

  70

Item 3.

 

Legal Proceedings

  70

Item 4.

 

Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders

  71

PART II

       

Item 5.

 

Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

  72

Item 6.

 

Selected Financial Data

  75

Item 7.

 

Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

  78

Item 7A.

 

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

  150

Item 8.

 

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

  151

Item 9.

 

Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

  254

Item 9A.

 

Controls and Procedures

  254

Item 9B.

 

Other Information

  254

PART III

       

Item 10.

 

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

  254

Item 11.

 

Executive Compensation

  254

Item 12.

 

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

  255

Item 13.

 

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

  255

Item 14.

 

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

  255

PART IV

       

Item 15.

 

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

  256

Table of Contents


PART I

ITEM 1.    BUSINESS

Overview

        Assured Guaranty Ltd. (hereafter "Assured Guaranty," "we," "us," "our" or the "Company") is a Bermuda based holding company that provides, through its operating subsidiaries, credit enhancement products to the public finance, structured finance and mortgage markets. Credit enhancement products are financial guaranty or other types of financial support, including credit derivatives, that improve the credit of underlying debt obligations. A derivative is a financial instrument whose characteristics and value depend upon the characteristics and value of an underlying security or commodity. We apply our credit expertise, risk management skills and capital markets experience to develop insurance, reinsurance and derivative products that meet the credit enhancement needs of our customers. We market our products directly and through financial institutions, serving the U.S. and international markets.

        Assured Guaranty Ltd. was incorporated in Bermuda in August 2003. We operate through wholly owned subsidiaries including Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. ("AG Re"), and Assured Guaranty Finance Overseas Ltd. ("AGFOL"). Our principal operating subsidiaries are Assured Guaranty Corp. ("AGC") and AG Re.

Acquisition of Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd.

        On November 14, 2008, Assured Guaranty Ltd. announced that it had entered into a definitive agreement ("the Purchase Agreement") with Dexia Holdings, Inc. ("Dexia") to purchase Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd. ("FSAH") and, indirectly, all of its subsidiaries, including the financial guaranty insurance company, Financial Security Assurance, Inc. The definitive agreement provides that the Company will be indemnified against exposure to FSAH's Financial Products segment, which includes its guaranteed investment contract business. Pursuant to the Purchase Agreement, the Company agreed to buy 33,296,733 issued and outstanding shares of common stock of FSAH, representing as of the date thereof approximately 99.8524% of the issued and outstanding shares of

1


Table of Contents


common stock of FSAH. The remaining shares of FSAH are currently held by current or former directors of FSAH. Assured expects that it will acquire the remaining shares of FSAH common stock concurrent with the closing of the acquisition of shares of FSAH common stock from Dexia or shortly thereafter at the same price paid to Dexia. We expect to close this transaction in either the first or second quarter of 2009.

        The purchase price is $722 million (based upon the closing price of the Company's common shares on the NYSE on November 13, 2008 of $8.10), consisting of $361 million in cash and up to 44,567,901 of the Company's common shares. If, prior to the closing date under the stock purchase agreement, the Company issues new common shares (other than pursuant to an employee benefit plan) or other securities that are convertible into or exchangeable for or otherwise linked to the Company's common shares at a purchase price per share of less than $8.10, the Company has agreed to issue to Dexia on the closing date an additional number of the Company's common shares with an aggregate value as of the closing date (measured based on the average of the volume weighted average price per share for each day in the 20 NYSE trading day period ending three business days prior to the closing date) representing the amount of dilution as a result of such issuance. The amount of dilution is defined to mean (x) the number of the Company's common shares issued (or that upon conversion or exchange would be issuable) as a result of the dilutive issuance, multiplied by (y) the positive difference if any between $8.10 and the purchase (or reference, implied, conversion, exchange or comparable) price per share received by the Company in the dilutive issuance, multiplied by (z) the percentage of the issued and outstanding share capital of the Company represented by the Company common shares to be received by Dexia under the stock purchase agreement (without taking into account any additional Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s common shares issued or issuable as a result of the anti-dilution provision).

        Under the Purchase Agreement, the Company may elect to pay $8.10 per share in cash in lieu of up to 22,283,951 of the Company's common shares that it would otherwise deliver as part of the purchase price.

        The Company may finance the cash portion of the acquisition with the proceeds of a public equity offering. The Company has received a backstop commitment ("the WLR Backstop Commitment") from the WLR Funds, a related party, to fund the cash portion of the purchase price with the purchase of newly issued common shares. The Company entered into the WLR Backstop Commitment on November 13, 2008 with the WLR Funds. The WLR Backstop Commitment amended the Investment Agreement between the Company and the WLR Funds and provided to the Company the option to cause the WLR Funds to purchase from Assured Guaranty Ltd. or Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. a number of the Company's common shares equal to the quotient of (i) the aggregate dollar amount not to exceed $361 million specified by the Company divided by (ii) the volume weighted average price of the Company's common share on the NYSE for the 20 NYSE trading days ending with the last NYSE trading day immediately preceding the date of the closing under the stock purchase agreement, with a floor of $6.00 and a cap of $8.50.

        The WLR Funds have no obligation to purchase these common shares pursuant to the WLR Backstop Commitment until the closing under the stock purchase agreement occurs. The Company may use the proceeds from the sale of the Company's common shares pursuant to the WLR Backstop Commitment solely to pay a portion of the purchase price under the stock purchase agreement. The WLR Funds' obligations under the WLR Backstop Commitment have been secured by letters of credit issued for the benefit of the Company by Bank of America, N.A. and RBS Citizens Bank, N.A., each in the amount of $180.5 million.

        The Company has paid the WLR Funds a nonrefundable commitment fee of $10,830,000 in connection with the option granted by the WLR Backstop Commitment and has agreed to pay the WLR Funds' expenses in connection with the transactions contemplated thereby. The Company has

2


Table of Contents


agreed to reimburse the WLR Funds for the $4.1 million cost of obtaining the letters of credit referred to above.

Our Operating Segments

        Our financial results include four principal business segments: financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty reinsurance, mortgage guaranty and other. We primarily conduct our business in the United States, Bermuda and the European community. The following table sets forth our gross written premiums by segment for the periods presented:


Gross Written Premiums By Segment

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Financial guaranty direct:

                   
 

Structured finance

  $ 59.4   $ 45.0   $ 26.0  
 

Public finance

    425.3     122.1     98.8  
               
   

Total financial guaranty direct

    484.7     167.1     124.8  
               

Financial guaranty reinsurance:

                   
 

Structured finance

    38.0     43.2     31.7  
 

Public finance

    91.3     207.8     92.2  
               
   

Total financial guaranty reinsurance

    129.3     251.0     123.9  
               

Mortgage guaranty

    0.7     2.7     8.4  
               
   

Total financial guaranty gross written premiums

    614.7     421.0     257.2  

Other

    3.5     3.5     4.1  
               
   

Total

  $ 618.3   $ 424.5   $ 261.3  
               

Financial Guaranty Direct

        Financial guaranty direct insurance provides an unconditional and irrevocable guaranty that protects the holder of a financial obligation against non-payment of principal and interest when due. Financial guaranty insurance may be issued to the holders of the insured obligations at the time of issuance of those obligations, or may be issued in the secondary market to holders of public bonds and structured securities. Both issuers of and investors in financial instruments may benefit from financial guaranty insurance. Issuers benefit because the insurance may have the effect of lowering an issuer's cost of borrowing to the extent that the insurance premium is less than the value of the difference between the yield on the insured obligation (which carries the credit rating of the insurer) and the yield on the obligation if sold on the basis of its uninsured credit rating. Financial guaranty insurance also improves the marketability of obligations issued by infrequent or unknown issuers, as well as obligations with complex structures or backed by asset classes new to the market. Investors benefit from increased liquidity in the secondary market, added protection against loss in the event of the obligor's default on its obligation, and reduced exposure to price volatility caused by changes in the credit quality of the underlying issue.

        As an alternative to traditional financial guaranty insurance, credit protection relating to a particular security or issuer can be provided through a credit derivative, such as a credit default swap. Under the terms of a credit default swap, the seller of credit protection makes a specified payment to the buyer of credit protection upon the occurrence of one or more specified credit events with respect to a reference obligation or entity. Credit derivatives typically provide protection to a buyer rather than

3


Table of Contents


credit enhancement of an issue as in traditional financial guaranty insurance. Credit derivatives may be preferred by some customers because they generally offer ease of execution and standardized terms.

        Financial guaranty direct products are generally provided for structured finance and public finance obligations in the U.S. and international markets.

        Structured Finance—Structured finance obligations in both the U.S. and international markets are generally backed by pools of assets, such as residential mortgage loans, consumer or trade receivables, securities or other assets having an ascertainable cash flow or market value, which are generally held by a special purpose issuing entity. Structured finance obligations can be "funded" or "synthetic." Funded structured finance obligations generally have the benefit of one or more forms of credit enhancement, such as over-collateralization and excess cash flow, to cover credit risks associated with the related assets. Synthetic structured finance obligations generally take the form of credit derivatives or credit linked notes that reference a pool of securities or loans, with a defined deductible to cover credit risks associated with the referenced securities or loans.

        Public Finance—Public finance obligations in both the U.S. and international markets consist primarily of debt obligations issued by or on behalf of states or their political subdivisions (counties, cities, towns and villages, utility districts, public universities and hospitals, public housing and transportation authorities), other public and quasi public entities, private universities and hospitals, and investor owned utilities. These obligations generally are supported by the taxing authority of the issuer, the issuer's or underlying obligor's ability to collect fees or assessments for certain projects or public services or revenues from operations. This market also includes project finance obligations, as well as other structured obligations supporting infrastructure and other public works projects.

Financial Guaranty Reinsurance

        Financial guaranty reinsurance indemnifies a primary insurance company against part of a loss that the latter may sustain under a policy that it has issued. The reinsurer may itself purchase reinsurance protection ("retrocessions") from other reinsurers, thereby reducing its own exposure.

        Reinsurance agreements take two major forms: "treaty" and "facultative." Treaty reinsurance requires the reinsured to cede, and the reinsurer to assume, specific classes of risk underwritten by the ceding company over a specified period of time, typically one year. Facultative reinsurance is the reinsurance of part of one or more specified policies, and is subject to separate negotiation for each cession.

Financial Guaranty Portfolio

        The principal types of obligations covered on a global basis by our financial guaranty direct and our financial guaranty reinsurance businesses are structured finance and public finance obligations. Because both businesses involve similar risks, we analyze and monitor our financial guaranty direct portfolio and our financial guaranty reinsurance portfolio on a unified process and procedure basis. In the tables that follow, our reinsurance par outstanding on treaty business is reported on a one-quarter

4


Table of Contents


lag due to the timing of receipt of reports prepared by our ceding companies. The following table sets forth our financial guaranty net par outstanding by product line:


Net Par Outstanding By Product Line

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in billions)
 

U.S. Public Finance:

                   
 

Direct

  $ 37.5   $ 7.5   $ 3.5  
 

Reinsurance

    69.9     74.4     48.8  
               
   

Total U.S. public finance

    107.3     81.9     52.3  
               

U.S. Structured Finance:

                   
 

Direct

    65.6     65.0     44.5  
 

Reinsurance

    8.8     8.9     7.1  
               
   

Total U.S. structured finance

    74.4     73.8     51.6  
               

International:

                   
 

Direct

    29.0     30.6     19.9  
 

Reinsurance

    12.1     14.0     8.5  
               
   

Total international

    41.0     44.5     28.4  
               
   

Total net par outstanding(1)

  $ 222.7   $ 200.3   $ 132.3  
               

        U.S. Structured Finance Obligations—We insure and reinsure a number of different types of U.S. structured finance obligations. Credit support for the exposures written by us may come from a variety of sources, including some combination of subordinated tranches, excess spread, over-collateralization or cash reserves. Additional support also may be provided by transaction provisions intended to benefit noteholders or credit enhancers. The types of U.S. Structured Finance transactions we insure and reinsure include the following:

5


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth our U.S. structured finance direct and reinsurance gross par written by asset type (stated as a percentage of total U.S. structured finance direct and reinsurance gross par) for the periods presented:


U.S. Structured Finance Gross Par Written by Asset Type

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Pooled corporate obligations

    30.0 %   40.9 %   49.2 %

Residential mortgage-backed and home equity

    25.0 %   28.8 %   22.1 %

Structured credit

    22.4 %   2.9 %   4.2 %

Consumer receivables

    16.8 %   13.9 %   5.9 %

Commercial receivables

    5.6 %   6.8 %   2.1 %

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

        4.1 %   14.1 %

Insurance securitizations

        2.2 %   2.1 %

Other structured finance

    0.3 %   0.4 %   0.3 %
               
 

Total(1)

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
 

Total U.S. structured finance gross par written

  $ 12.7   $ 36.0   $ 28.2  
               

6


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth our U.S. structured finance direct and reinsurance net par outstanding by asset type (stated as a percentage of total U.S. structured finance direct and reinsurance net par outstanding) as of the dates indicated:


U.S. Structured Finance Net Par Outstanding by Asset Type

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Pooled corporate obligations

    46.6 %   45.8 %   49.6 %

Residential mortgage-backed and home equity

    24.7 %   24.7 %   21.8 %

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    7.9 %   8.1 %   10.5 %

Consumer receivables

    6.9 %   8.9 %   5.2 %

Commercial receivables

    6.6 %   7.1 %   4.7 %

Structured credit

    4.4 %   2.1 %   3.0 %

Insurance securitizations

    2.1 %   1.6 %   1.5 %

Other structured finance

    0.6 %   1.7 %   3.7 %
               
 

Total(1)

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
 

Total U.S. structured finance par outstanding

  $ 74.4   $ 73.8   $ 51.6  
               

        The table below shows our ten largest financial guaranty U.S. structured finance direct and reinsurance exposures by revenue source as a percentage of total financial guaranty net par outstanding as of December 31, 2008:


Ten Largest U.S. Structured Finance Exposures

 
  Net Par Outstanding   Percent of Total Net Par Outstanding   Rating(1)
 
  ($ in millions)

Fortress Credit Investments I & II

  $ 1,190     0.5 % AAA

Field Point III & IV, Limited

    1,178     0.5 % AA-

Ares Enhanced Credit Opportunities Fund

    1,152     0.5 % AAA

Deutsche Alt-A Securities Mortgage Loan 2007-2

    1,028     0.5 % BB

Discover Card Master Trust I Series A

    1,000     0.4 % AAA

Anchorage Crossover Credit Finance Ltd

    875     0.4 % AAA /Super senior

Prospect Funding I LLC

    797     0.4 % AAA

Park Avenue Receivables Company LLC

    731     0.3 % AAA

MortgageIt Securities Corp. Mortgage Loan 2007-2

    672     0.3 % AAA

280 Funding I—Class A-1 & A-2

    660     0.3 % AAA
             
 

Total of top ten U.S. structured finance exposures

  $ 9,283     4.1 %  
             

(1)
The Company's internal rating. The Company's scale is comparable to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies. The super senior category, which is not generally used by rating agencies, is used by the Company in instances where the Company's AAA-rated exposure has additional credit enhancement due to either (1) the existence of another security rated AAA that is subordinated to the Company's exposure or (2) the Company's exposure benefits from a different form of credit enhancement that would pay any claims first in the event that any of the

7


Table of Contents

        U.S. Public Finance Obligations—We insure and reinsure a number of different types of U.S. public obligations, including the following:

8


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth our U.S. public finance direct and reinsurance gross par written by bond type (stated as a percentage of total U.S. public finance direct and reinsurance gross par written) for the years presented:


U.S. Public Finance Gross Par Written by Asset Type

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Tax-backed

    25.5 %   22.9 %   28.3 %

General obligation

    24.5 %   25.1 %   28.3 %

Municipal utilities

    15.3 %   8.9 %   10.9 %

Healthcare

    12.2 %   13.1 %   20.1 %

Transportation

    11.9 %   10.4 %   5.3 %

Higher education

    4.9 %   7.3 %   3.0 %

Investor-owned utilities

    0.2 %   2.2 %   3.2 %

Housing

    0.1 %   3.1 %   0.4 %

Other public finance

    5.3 %   7.0 %   0.5 %
               
 

Total(1)

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
 

Total U.S. public finance gross par written

  $ 37.0   $ 34.8   $ 6.9  
               

        The following table sets forth our U.S. public finance direct and reinsurance net par outstanding by bond type (stated as a percentage of total U.S. public finance direct and reinsurance net par outstanding) as of the dates indicated:


U.S. Public Finance Net Par Outstanding by Asset Type

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in billions)
 

General obligation

    25.2 %   24.8 %   24.3 %

Tax-backed

    24.1 %   21.7 %   22.6 %

Municipal utilities

    14.5 %   14.2 %   18.5 %

Transportation

    11.8 %   12.2 %   12.0 %

Healthcare

    10.9 %   12.7 %   12.6 %

Higher education

    5.0 %   4.5 %   2.4 %

Investor-owned utilities

    2.0 %   2.8 %   3.0 %

Housing

    1.8 %   2.5 %   2.1 %

Other public finance

    4.7 %   4.6 %   2.5 %
               
 

Total

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
 

Total U.S. public finance net par outstanding

  $ 107.3   $ 81.9   $ 52.3  
               

9


Table of Contents

        The table below shows our ten largest financial guaranty U.S. public finance direct and reinsurance exposures by revenue source as a percentage of total financial guaranty net par outstanding as of December 31, 2008:


Ten Largest U.S. Public Finance Exposures

 
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Percent of Total
Net Par
Outstanding
  Rating(1)
 
   
  ($ in millions)
   

State of California General Obligation & Leases

  $ 1,546     0.7 % A+

State of New Jersey General Obligation & Leases

    1,151     0.5 % AA-

Commonwealth of Massachusetts General Obligation & Bay Transportation

    1,031     0.5 % A

Commonwealth of Puerto Rico General Obligation & Leases

    1,008     0.5 % BBB-

New York City General Obligation & Leases

    983     0.4 % A+

City of Chicago General Obligation & Leases

    934     0.4 % AA-

Los Angeles Unified School District

    897     0.4 % AA

State of New York General Obligation & Leases

    893     0.4 % A+

North Texas Toll Road Authority

    890     0.4 % A

Miami-Dade County Florida Aviation Authority

    883     0.4 % A
             

Total of top ten U.S. public finance exposures

  $ 10,216     4.6 %  
             

(1)
The Company's internal rating. The Company's scale is comparable to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies.

        International Obligations—We insure and reinsure a number of different types of international public and structured obligations. Credit support for the exposures written by us may come from a variety of sources, including some combination of subordinated tranches, excess spread, over-collateralization or cash reserves. Additional support also may be provided by transaction provisions intended to benefit noteholders or credit enhancers. The types of international transactions we insure and reinsure include the following:

10


Table of Contents

11


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth our international direct and reinsurance gross par written by bond type (stated as a percentage of total international direct and reinsurance gross par written) for the years presented:


International Gross Par Written by Asset Type

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Residential mortgage-backed and home equity

    48.8 %   15.9 %   17.5 %

Regulated utilities

    20.1 %   18.2 %   17.5 %

Pooled corporate obligations

    15.9 %   31.0 %   16.6 %

Infrastructure and pooled infrastructure

    7.8 %   19.3 %   34.1 %

Future flow

    3.9 %   1.5 %   1.8 %

Consumer receivables

    2.4 %   2.0 %    

Public finance

    1.1 %   4.3 %   2.6 %

Commercial receivables

    0.1 %   5.0 %   2.2 %

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

        1.8 %   4.2 %

Structured credit

        0.6 %    

Insurance securitizations

            3.2 %

Other international structured finance

        0.4 %   0.3 %
               
 

Total(1)

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
 

Total international gross par written

  $ 6.4   $ 17.3   $ 15.9  
               

        The following table sets forth our international direct and reinsurance net par outstanding by bond type (stated as a percentage of total international direct and reinsurance net par outstanding) as of the dates indicated:


International Net Par Outstanding by Asset Type

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Infrastructure and pooled infrastructure

    22.7 %   26.0 %   29.1 %

Pooled corporate obligations

    20.4 %   19.0 %   12.6 %

Residential mortgage-backed and home equity

    20.1 %   16.5 %   17.6 %

Regulated utilities

    18.3 %   18.7 %   16.8 %

Commercial receivables

    4.2 %   4.3 %   3.8 %

Public finance

    4.1 %   4.5 %   4.2 %

Future flow

    3.0 %   2.5 %   3.6 %

Insurance securitizations

    2.3 %   1.9 %   3.3 %

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    1.9 %   2.8 %   3.8 %

Structured credit

    1.1 %   1.3 %   2.1 %

Consumer receivables

    0.3 %   0.8 %   0.4 %

Other international structured finance

    1.6 %   1.7 %   2.7 %
               
 

Total

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
 

Total international net par outstanding

  $ 41.0   $ 44.5   $ 28.4  
               

12


Table of Contents

        The table below shows our ten largest financial guaranty international direct and reinsurance exposures by revenue source as a percentage of total financial guaranty net par outstanding as of December 31, 2008:


Ten Largest International Exposures

 
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Percent of Total
Net Par
Outstanding
  Rating(1)
 
   
  ($ in millions)
   

Prime European RMBS

  $ 1,306     0.6 % AAA

Permanent Master Issuer PLC

    1,261     0.6 % AAA

Arkle Master Issuer PLC

    1,245     0.6 % AAA

Gracechurch Mortgage Financing PLC

    1,237     0.6 % AAA

Essential Public Infrastructure Capital II

    961     0.4 % AAA

Granite Master Issuer PLC

    943     0.4 % AAA

Graphite Mortgages PLC Provide Graphite 2005-2

    941     0.4 % AAA

Essential Public Infrastructure Capital III

    850     0.4 % AAA

Paragon Mortgages (No.13) PLC

    657     0.3 % AAA

International Infrastructure Pool

    643     0.3 % AAA
             

Total of top ten international exposures

  $ 10,044     4.6 %  
             

        The following table sets forth our financial guaranty portfolio as of December 31, 2008 by internal rating:


Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Internal Rating

Rating Category(1)
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Percent of Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Super senior

  $ 32.4     14.5 %

AAA

    40.7     18.3 %

AA

    47.7     21.4 %

A

    66.0     29.6 %

BBB

    29.4     13.2 %

Below investment grade

    6.6     3.0 %
           
 

Total(2)

  $ 222.7     100.0 %
           

13


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth the geographic distribution of our financial guaranty portfolio as of December 31, 2008:


Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Geographic Area

 
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Percent of Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 
 
  ($ in billions)
 

United States:

             
 

California

  $ 16.2     7.3 %
 

New York

    9.5     4.3 %
 

Florida

    8.4     3.8 %
 

Texas

    7.3     3.3 %
 

Illinois

    5.9     2.7 %
 

Pennsylvania

    4.6     2.1 %
 

Massachusetts

    4.4     2.0 %
 

New Jersey

    4.2     1.9 %
 

Michigan

    3.1     1.4 %
 

Washington

    2.9     1.3 %
 

Other states

    40.8     18.3 %
 

Mortgage and structured (multiple states)

    74.4     33.4 %
           
   

Total U.S.(1)

    181.7     81.6 %
 

International

    41.0     18.4 %
           
     

Total

  $ 222.7     100.0 %
           

        We seek broad coverage of the market by insuring and reinsuring small and large issues alike. The following table sets forth the distribution of our portfolio as of December 31, 2008 by original size of our exposure:


Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Issue Size

Original Par Amount Per Issue
  Number of
Issues
  Percent of Total
Number of
Issues
  Net Par
Outstanding
  % of Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Less than $10.0 million

    5,555     64.4 % $ 7.9     3.5 %

$10.0 through $24.9 million

    1,023     11.9 %   11.0     4.9 %

$25.0 through $49.9 million

    730     8.5 %   18.3     8.2 %

$50.0 million and above

    1,314     15.2 %   185.6     83.3 %
                   
 

Total(1)

    8,622     100.0 % $ 222.7     100.0 %
                   

14


Table of Contents

        The following table sets forth our financial guaranty portfolio as of and for the year ended December 31, 2008 by source:


Financial Guaranty Portfolio by Source

 
  Gross Par
In Force
  Gross Par
Written
 
 
  ($ in billions)
 

Direct

  $ 136.3   $ 47.6  

Reinsurance:

             
 

Ambac Assurance Corporation

    34.6     0.2  
 

Financial Security Assurance Inc

    33.6     7.0  
 

Financial Guaranty Insurance Company

    12.1     0.9  
 

MBIA Insurance Corporation

    8.9      
 

Other ceding companies

    1.6     0.5  
           

Total Reinsurance

    90.8     8.6  
           
   

Total

  $ 227.2   $ 56.1  
           

Mortgage Guaranty Insurance/Reinsurance

        Mortgage guaranty insurance is a specialized class of credit insurance that provides protection to mortgage lending institutions against the default of borrowers on mortgage loans that, at the time of the advance, had a loan-to-value ("LTV") in excess of a specified ratio. In the United States, governmental agencies and private mortgage guaranty insurance compete in this market, while some lending institutions choose to self insure against the risk of loss on high LTV mortgage loans.

        Reinsurance in the mortgage guaranty insurance industry is used to increase the insurance capacity of the ceding company, to assist the ceding company in meeting applicable regulatory and rating agency requirements, to augment the financial strength of the ceding company, and to manage the ceding company's risk profile.

        The U.S. private mortgage guaranty insurance industry, composed of only monoline insurance companies as required by law, provides two basic types of coverage: primary insurance, which protects lenders against default on individual residential mortgage loans by covering losses on such loans to a stated percentage, and pool insurance, which protects lenders against loss on an underlying pool of individual mortgages by covering the full amount of the loss (less the proceeds from any applicable primary coverage) on individual residential mortgage loans in the pool, with an aggregate limit usually expressed as a percentage of the initial loan balances in the pool. Primary and pool insurance are used to facilitate the sale of mortgage loans in the secondary mortgage market, principally to the Federal National Mortgage Association ("Fannie Mae") and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation ("Freddie Mac"). Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac provide indirect funding for approximately half of all mortgage loans originated in the United States. Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac are prohibited by their charters from purchasing mortgage loans with LTV's of greater than 80% unless the loans are insured by a designated mortgage guaranty insurer or some other form of credit enhancement is provided. In addition, pool insurance is often used to provide credit support for mortgage-backed securities and other secondary mortgage market transactions.

        Mortgage guaranty reinsurance comprises the bulk of our in force mortgage business. We have provided reinsurance of primary mortgage insurance and pool insurance in the United States on a

15


Table of Contents


quota share and excess of loss basis. Quota share reinsurance describes all forms of reinsurance in which the reinsurer shares in a proportional part of the original premiums and losses of the business ceded by the primary company (subject to a ceding commission). Excess of loss reinsurance refers to reinsurance which indemnifies the ceding company for that portion of the loss that exceeds an agreed upon "retention." There has been a decrease in demand for our quota share mortgage guaranty reinsurance products over the last five years, as primary mortgage insurers have expanded their capital bases. We have not written a new mortgage guaranty deal since 2005.

        We have been a leading provider of excess of loss reinsurance to lender captives and third party insurers in the United Kingdom. There is not a consistent demand for mortgage insurance guaranty ("MIG") reinsurance in the United Kingdom although business opportunities may arise from time to time. We have entered into multi year reinsurance arrangements with several lenders and third party insurers.

        We have also participated in the mortgage reinsurance markets in Ireland, Hong Kong and Australia. We have participated in these markets on an excess of loss basis with high attachment points and believe that our risk of loss on these transactions is remote.

        The mortgage guaranty segment has a decreasing portfolio with limited possibilities for new business due to our change in business strategy and the overall market for mortgage insurance.

Mortgage Portfolio

        The following table sets forth our mortgage insurance and reinsurance risk in force by geographic region as of December 31, 2008:


Mortgage Guaranty Risk In Force By Geographic Region

 
  Risk In Force   Percent  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

United Kingdom

  $ 257.1     64.4 %

Ireland

    139.9     35.0 %

United States

    2.5     0.6 %
           
 

Total

  $ 399.5     100.0 %
           

        The following table sets forth our mortgage guaranty risk in force by treaty type as of December 31, 2008:


Mortgage Guaranty Risk In Force By Treaty Type

 
  Risk In Force   Percent  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Excess of loss

  $ 397.0     99.4 %

Quota share

    2.5     0.6 %
           
 

Total

  $ 399.5     100.0 %
           

        We have participated in several lines of business that are reflected in our historical financial statements, but that we exited, including equity layer credit protection, trade credit reinsurance, title reinsurance, and auto residual value reinsurance.

16


Table of Contents

Underwriting

        The underwriting, operations and risk management guidelines, policies and procedures of our insurance and reinsurance subsidiaries are tailored to their respective businesses, providing multiple levels of credit review and analysis.

        Exposure limits and underwriting criteria are established, as appropriate, for sectors, countries, single risks and in the case of structured finance obligations, servicers. Single risk limits are established in relation to the Company's capital base and are based on our assessment of potential severity of loss as well as other factors. Sector limits are based on our assessment of intra sector correlation, as well as other factors. Country limits are based on long term foreign currency ratings, history of political stability, size and stability of the economy and other factors.

        Critical risk factors for proposed public finance exposures include, for example, the credit quality of the issuer, the type of issue, the repayment source, security pledged, the presence of restrictive covenants, and the issue's maturity. Underwriting consideration for exposures include (1) class, reflecting economic and social factors affecting that bond type, including the importance of the proposed project, (2) the financial management of the project and of the issuer, and (3) various legal and administrative factors. In cases where the primary source of repayment is the taxing or rate setting authority of a public entity, such as general obligation bonds, transportation bonds and municipal utility bonds, emphasis is placed on the overall financial strength of the issuer, the economic and demographic characteristics of the taxpayer or ratepayer base and the strength of the legal obligation to repay the debt. In cases of not-for-profit institutions such as healthcare issuers and private higher education issuers, emphasis is placed on the financial stability of the institution, its competitive position and its management.

        Structured finance obligations generally present three distinct forms of risk: (1) asset risk, pertaining to the amount and quality of assets underlying an issue; (2) structural risk, pertaining to the extent to which an issue's legal structure provides protection from loss; and (3) execution risk, which is the risk that poor performance by a servicer contributes to a decline in the cash flow available to the transaction. Each risk is addressed in turn through our underwriting process. Generally, the amount and quality of asset coverage required with respect to a structured finance exposure is dependent upon the historic performance of the subject asset class, or those assets actually underlying the risk proposed to be insured or reinsured. Future performance expectations are developed from this history, taking into account economic, social and political factors affecting that asset class as well as, to the extent feasible, the subject assets themselves. Conclusions are then drawn about the amount of over-collateralization or other credit enhancement necessary in a particular transaction in order to protect investors (and therefore the insurer or reinsurer) against poor asset performance. In addition, structured securities usually are designed to protect investors (and therefore the guarantor) from the bankruptcy or insolvency of the entity which originated the underlying assets, as well as the bankruptcy or insolvency of the servicer of those assets.

        For international transactions, an analysis of the country or countries in which the risk resides is performed. Such analysis includes an assessment of the political risk as well as the economic and demographic characteristics of the country or countries. For each transaction, we perform an assessment of the legal regime governing the transaction and the laws affecting the underlying assets supporting the obligations.

        The Risk Oversight Committee of the Board of Directors oversees our credit underwriting process. Subject to limits established by the Risk Oversight Committee, the Portfolio Risk Management Committee implements specific underwriting procedures and limits for the Company. The Portfolio Risk Management Committee also allocates underwriting capacity among the Company's subsidiaries. The Portfolio Risk Management Committee focuses on the measurement and management of credit, market and liquidity risk for the overall company and its main operating subsidiaries. It has established

17


Table of Contents

and maintains underwriting limits, policies and procedures and meets at least quarterly to review and set policy.

        Each insurance, facultative reinsurance and credit derivative transaction, after passing an initial assessment intended to consider the desirability of the proposed exposure, is assigned to a team including relevant underwriting and legal personnel. Finance personnel review the proposed exposure for compliance with applicable accounting standards and investment guidelines. The team reviews the structure of the transaction, and the underwriter reviews credit issues pertinent to the particular line of business. In our structured financial guaranty and mortgage guaranty lines, underwriters generally apply computer models to stress cash flows in their assessment of the risk inherent in a particular transaction. For reinsurance transactions, stress model results may be provided by the primary insurer. Stress models may also be developed internally by our underwriters and reflect both empirical research as well as information gathered from third parties, such as rating agencies, investment banks or servicers. Where warranted to assess a particular credit risk properly, we may perform a due diligence review in connection with a transaction. A due diligence review may include, among other things, meetings with issuer management, review of underwriting and operational procedures, file reviews, and review of financial procedures and computer systems. The structure of a transaction is also scrutinized from a legal perspective by in house and, where appropriate, external counsel, and specialty legal expertise is consulted when our legal staff deems it appropriate.

        Upon completion of underwriting analysis, the underwriter prepares a formal credit report that is submitted to a credit committee for review. An oral presentation is usually made to the committee, followed by questions from committee members and discussion among the committee members and the underwriters. In some cases, additional information may be presented at the meeting or required to be submitted prior to approval. Signatures of committee members are received and any further requirements, such as specific terms or evidence of due diligence, is noted. U.S. direct business is submitted to AGC's Credit Committee, which consists of senior professionals including underwriting officers, the President, Chief Credit Officer and other senior officers of AGC. Certain public finance transactions that meet specific criteria with respect to size, rating and type of risk, may be eligible for an expedited approval process, in which the submission may be approved by certain designated officers of AGC. Transactions submitted by Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. must be approved by Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd.'s Underwriting Committee, consisting of senior officers of Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd., and by a Supervisory Underwriting Committee consisting of the AGC Credit Committee. Transactions submitted for execution in AGRO must be recommended by the AG Intermediary Credit Committee, consisting substantially of senior officers of AGC including the President and Chief Credit Officer, and approved by AGRO's underwriting managers in Bermuda. Transactions submitted for approval within AG Re must be approved by the AG Re Underwriting Committee, containing senior officers of AG Re, including the President and Chief Operating Officer. Certain transactions submitted for approval within AG Re that meet specific criteria with respect to size, rating and type of risk, require further approval of one of four designated officers of Assured Guaranty Ltd.

        The procedures for underwriting treaty business differ somewhat from those for facultative reinsurance, as we make a forward commitment to reinsure business from a ceding company for a specified period of time. Although we have the ability to exclude certain classes or categories of risk from a treaty, we have a limited ability to control the individual risks ceded pursuant to the terms of the treaty. As a result, we enter into reinsurance treaties only with ceding companies with proven track records and after extensive underwriting due diligence with respect to the proposed cedant. Prior to entering into a reinsurance treaty, we meet with senior management, underwriters, risk managers, and accounting and systems personnel of the proposed cedant. We evaluate the ceding company's underwriting expertise and experience, capital position, in-force book of business, reserves, cash flow, profitability and financial strength. We actively monitor ceded treaty exposures. Collected data is evaluated regularly to detect ceded risks that are inconsistent with our expectations. If appropriate and permitted under the terms of the treaty, we add exclusions in response to risks identified during our evaluations. Our surveillance department conducts periodic audits of each ceding company. The audits

18


Table of Contents


entail review of underwriting and surveillance files, as well as meetings with management. Information gathered during these audits is used to re-evaluate treaties at the time of renewal.

Risk Management

        The Risk Oversight and Audit Committees of the Board of Directors oversees our risk management policies and procedures. Within the limits established by the board committees, specific risk policies and limits are set by the Portfolio Risk Management Committee, which includes members of senior management and senior Credit and Surveillance officers. As part of its risk management strategy, the Company may seek to obtain third party reinsurance or retrocessions and may also periodically enter into other arrangements to alleviate all or a portion of this risk.

        Our Risk Management and Surveillance personnel are responsible for monitoring and reporting on all transactions in the insured portfolio, including exposures in both the Direct and Reinsurance segments. The primary objective of the surveillance process is to monitor trends and changes in transaction credit quality, detect any deterioration in credit quality, and take such remedial actions as may be necessary or appropriate. All transactions in the insured portfolio are risk rated, and surveillance personnel are responsible for adjusting those ratings to reflect changes in transaction credit quality. Surveillance personnel are also responsible for managing work-out and loss situations when necessary. For transactions where a loss is considered probable, surveillance personnel present analysis related to potential loss situations to a reserve committee. The reserve committee is made up of the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Surveillance Officer, General Counsel and Chief Accounting Officer. The reserve committee considers the information provided by the surveillance personnel when determining reserve recommendations of our operating subsidiaries.

Direct Businesses

        We conduct surveillance procedures to track risk aggregations and monitor performance of each risk. The review cycle and scope vary based upon transaction type and credit quality. In general, the review process includes the collection and analysis of information from various sources, including trustee and servicer reports, financial statements and reports, general industry or sector news and analyses, and rating agency reports. For Public Finance risks, the surveillance process includes monitoring general economic trends, developments with respect to state and municipal finances, and the financial situation of the issuers. For Structured Finance transactions, the surveillance process can include monitoring transaction performance data and cash flows, compliance with transaction terms and conditions, and evaluation of servicer or collateral manager performance and financial condition. Additionally, the Company uses various quantitative tools and models to assess transaction performance and identify situations where there may have been a change in credit quality. For all transactions, surveillance activities may include discussions with or site visits to issuers, servicers or other parties to a transaction.

Reinsurance Businesses

        For transactions in our Reinsurance segment, the primary insurers are responsible for conducting ongoing surveillance, and our surveillance personnel monitor the activities of the primary insurers through a variety of means, such as review of surveillance reports provided by the primary insurers, and meetings and discussions with their analysts. Our surveillance personnel take steps to ensure that the primary insurer is managing risk pursuant to the terms of the applicable reinsurance agreement. To this end, we conduct periodic reviews of ceding companies' surveillance activities and capabilities. That process may include the review of the primary insurer's underwriting, surveillance, and claim files for certain transactions. In the event of credit deterioration of a particular exposure, more frequent reviews of the ceding company's risk mitigation activities are conducted. Our surveillance personnel also monitor general news and information, industry trends, and rating agency reports to help focus surveillance activities on sectors or credits of particular concern. For certain exposures, we also will undertake an independent analysis and remodeling of the transaction.

19


Table of Contents

Closely Monitored Credits

        Our surveillance department is responsible for monitoring our portfolio of credits and maintains a list of closely monitored credits ("CMC"). The closely monitored credits are divided into four categories: Category 1 (low priority; fundamentally sound, greater than normal risk); Category 2 (medium priority; weakening credit profile, may result in loss); Category 3 (high priority; claim/default probable, case reserve established); Category 4 (claim paid, case reserve established for future payments). The closely monitored credits include all below investment grade ("BIG") exposures where there is a material amount of exposure (generally greater than $10.0 million) or a material risk of the Company incurring a loss greater than $0.5 million. The closely monitored credits also include investment grade ("IG") risks where credit quality is deteriorating and where, in the view of the Company, there is significant potential that the risk quality will fall below investment grade. As of December 31, 2008, the closely monitored credits include approximately 99% of our BIG exposure, and the remaining BIG exposure of $92.3 million is distributed across 89 different credits. Other than those excluded BIG credits, credits that are not included in the closely monitored credit list are categorized as fundamentally sound risks. The following table provides financial guaranty net par outstanding by credit monitoring category as of December 31, 2008 and 2007:

 
  As of December 31, 2008   As of December 31, 2007  
Description:
  Net Par Outstanding   % of Net Par Outstanding   # of Credits in Category   Net Par Outstanding   % of Net Par Outstanding   # of Credits in Category  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Fundamentally sound risk

  $ 215,987     97.0 %       $ 198,133     98.9 %      

Closely monitored credits:

                                     
 

Category 1

    2,967     1.3 %   51     1,288     0.6 %   36  
 

Category 2

    767     0.3 %   21     743     0.4 %   12  
 

Category 3

    2,889     1.3 %   54     71         16  
 

Category 4

    20         14     24         16  
                           
   

CMC total(1)

    6,643     3.0 %   140     2,126     1.1 %   80  
                               

Other below investment grade risk

    92         89     20         46  
                               

Total

  $ 222,722     100.0 %       $ 200,279     100.0 %      
                               

(1)
Percent total does not add due to rounding.

        The increase of $4,517 million in financial guaranty CMC net par outstanding during 2008 is mainly attributable to the downgrade of RMBS exposures.

Losses and Reserves

        Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses for non-derivative transactions in our financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty assumed reinsurance and mortgage guaranty business include case reserves and portfolio reserves. See the "Fair Value of Credit Derivatives" of the Critical Accounting Estimates section for more information on our derivative transactions. Case reserves are established when there is significant credit deterioration on specific insured obligations and the obligations are in default or default is probable, not necessarily upon non-payment of principal or interest by an insured. Case reserves represent the present value of expected future loss payments and loss adjustment expenses ("LAE"), net of estimated recoveries, but before considering ceded reinsurance. This reserving method is different from case reserves established by traditional property and casualty insurance companies, which establish case reserves upon notification of a claim and establish incurred but not reported ("IBNR") reserves for the difference between actuarially estimated ultimate losses and recorded case reserves. Financial guaranty insurance and assumed reinsurance case reserves and related salvage and subrogation, if any, are discounted at the taxable equivalent yield on our investment

20


Table of Contents


portfolio, which is approximately 6%, in all periods presented. When the Company becomes entitled to the underlying collateral of an insured credit under salvage and subrogation rights as a result of a claim payment, it records salvage and subrogation as an asset, based on the expected level of recovery. Such amounts have been recorded as a salvage recoverable asset in the Company's balance sheets.

        We record portfolio reserves in our financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty assumed reinsurance and mortgage guaranty business. Portfolio reserves are established with respect to the portion of our business for which case reserves have not been established.

        Portfolio reserves are not established based on a specific event, rather they are calculated by aggregating the portfolio reserve calculated for each individual transaction. Individual transaction reserves are calculated on a quarterly basis by multiplying the par in-force by the product of the ultimate loss and earning factors without regard to discounting. The ultimate loss factor is defined as the frequency of loss multiplied by the severity of loss, where the frequency is defined as the probability of default for each individual issue. The earning factor is inception to date earned premium divided by the estimated ultimate written premium for each transaction. The probability of default is estimated from rating agency data and is based on the transaction's credit rating, industry sector and time until maturity. The severity is defined as the complement of recovery/salvage rates gathered by the rating agencies of defaulting issues and is based on the industry sector.

        Portfolio reserves are recorded gross of reinsurance. We have not ceded any amounts under these reinsurance contracts, as our recorded portfolio reserves have not exceeded our contractual retentions, required by said contracts.

        The Company records an incurred loss that is reflected in the statement of operations upon the establishment of portfolio reserves. When we initially record a case reserve, we reclassify the corresponding portfolio reserve already recorded for that credit within the balance sheet. The difference between the initially recorded case reserve and the reclassified portfolio reserve is recorded as a charge in our statement of operations. Any subsequent change in portfolio reserves or the initial case reserves are recorded quarterly as a charge or credit in our statement of operations in the period such estimates change. Due to the inherent uncertainties of estimating loss and LAE reserves, actual experience may differ from the estimates reflected in our consolidated financial statements, and the differences may be material.

        At December 31, 2008 financial guaranty case reserves were $119.9 million. Case reserves may change from our original estimate due to changes in assumptions including, but not limited to, severity factors, credit deterioration of underlying obligations and salvage estimates.

        Our most significant case reserves during 2008 related to U.S. residential mortgage backed securities ("RMBS"), specifically HELOC transactions, Closed-End Second transactions and Alt-A transactions.

        As of December 31, 2008, we had net par outstanding of $1.7 billion related to HELOC securitizations, of which $1.5 billion are transactions with Countrywide and $1.1 billion were written in the Company's financial guaranty direct segment ("direct Countrywide transactions or "Countrywide 2005-J" and "Countrywide 2007-D").

        The performance of our HELOC exposures deteriorated during 2007 and 2008 and transactions, particularly those originated in the period from 2005 through 2007, continue to perform below our original underwriting expectations. In accordance with our standard practice, during the year ended December 31, 2008, we evaluated the most currently available information, including trends in delinquencies and charge-offs on the underlying loans, draw rates on the lines of credit, and the servicer's ability to fulfill its contractual obligations including its obligation to fund additional draws. In recent periods, CDR, CPR, Draw Rates and delinquency percentages have fluctuated within ranges that we believe make it appropriate to use rolling averages to project future performance. Accordingly, the Company is using modeling assumptions that are based upon or which approximate recent actual historical performance to project future performance and potential losses. During 2008, the Company extended the time frame during which it expects the Constant Default Rate (CDR) to remain elevated.

21


Table of Contents


The Company also revised its assumptions with respect to the overall shape of the default and loss curves. Among other things, these changes assume that a higher proportion of projected defaults will occur over the near term. This revision was based upon management's judgment that a variety of factors including the deterioration of U.S. economic conditions could lead to a longer period in which default rates remain high. The Company continues to model sensitivities around the results booked using a variety of CDR rates and stress periods as well as other modeling approaches including roll rates and hybrid roll rate/CDR methods. As a result of this modeling and analysis, the Company incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses of $111.0 million for its direct Countrywide transactions during 2008. The Company's cumulative incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses on the direct Countrywide transactions as of December 31, 2008 were $111.0 million ($87.2 million after-tax). During 2008, the Company paid losses and loss adjustment expenses for its direct Countrywide transactions of $170.0 million, of which we expect to recover $59.0 million from the receipt of excess spread from future cash flows as well as funding of future draws. This amount of $59.0 million is included in "salvage recoverable" on the balance sheet. There were no incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses or salvage recoverable amounts on these transactions in 2007.

        Credit support for HELOC these transactions comes primarily from two sources. In the first instance, excess spread is used to build a certain amount of credit enhancement and absorb losses. Over the past 12 months, excess spread (the difference between the interest collections on the collateral and the interest paid on the insured notes) has averaged approximately 270 basis points per annum. Additionally, for the transactions serviced by Countrywide, the servicer is required to fund additional draws on the HELOC loans following the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event. Among other things, such an event is triggered when claim payments by us exceed a certain threshold. Prior to the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event, during the transactions' revolving period, new draws on the HELOC loans are funded first from principal collections. As such, during the revolving period no additional credit enhancement is created by the additional draws, and the speed at which our exposure amortizes is reduced to the extent of such additional draws, since principal collections are used to fund those draws rather than pay down the insured notes. Subsequent to the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event, new draws are funded by Countrywide and all principal collections are used to pay down the insured notes. Any draws funded by Countrywide are subordinate to us in the cash flow waterfall and hence represent additional credit enhancement available to absorb losses before we have to make a claim payment. Additionally, since all principal collections are used to pay down the insured notes, rather than fund additional draws, our exposure begins to amortize more quickly. A Rapid Amortization Event occurred for Countrywide 2007-D in April 2008 and for Countrywide 2005-J in May 2008.

        We have modeled our HELOC exposures under a number of different scenarios, taking into account the multiple variables and structural features that materially affect transaction performance and potential losses to us. The key variables include the speed or rate at which borrowers make payments on their loans, as measured by the Constant Payment Rate (CPR)(1), the default rate, as measured by the CDR(2), excess spread, and the amount of loans that are already delinquent more than 30 days. We also take into account the pool factor (the percentage of the original principal balance that remains outstanding), and the timing of the remaining cash flows. Additionally, it should be noted that our contractual rights allow us to retroactively claim that loans included in the insured pool were inappropriately included in the pool by the seller, and to put these loans back to the seller such that we would not be responsible for losses related to these loans. Such actions would benefit us by reducing potential losses. We have included in our loss model an estimated benefit for loans we expect Countrywide will repurchase.


(1)
The CPR is the annualized rate at which the portfolio amortizes, so that a 15% CPR implies that 15% of the collateral will be retired over a one-year period.

(2)
The CDR is the annualized default rate, so that a 1.0% CDR implies that 1.0% of the remaining collateral will default each year.

22


Table of Contents

        The ultimate performance of the Company's HELOC transactions will depend on many factors, such as the level and timing of loan defaults, interest proceeds generated by the securitized loans, repayment speeds and changes in home prices, as well as the levels of credit support built into each transaction. Other factors also may have a material impact upon the ultimate performance of each transaction, including the ability of the seller and servicer to fulfill all of their contractual obligations including its obligation to fund future draws on lines of credit, as well as the amount of benefit received from repurchases of ineligible loans by Countrywide. The variables affecting transaction performance are interrelated, difficult to predict and subject to considerable volatility. If actual results differ materially from any of our assumptions, the losses incurred could be materially different from our estimate. We continue to update our evaluation of these exposures as new information becomes available.

        The key assumptions used in our case loss reserves on the direct Countrywide transactions is presented in the following table:

Key Variables
   

Constant payment rate (CPR)

  3-month average, currently 7-8%

Constant default rate (CDR)

 

6-month average CDR of approximately 19–21% during months 1–9, declining to 1.0% at the end of month 15. From months 16 onward, a 1.0% CDR is assumed.

Draw rate

 

3-month average, currently 1–2%

Excess spread

 

250 bps per annum

Repurchases of Ineligible loans by Countrywide

 

$49.3 million; or approximately 2.1% of original pool balance of $2.4 billion

Loss Severity

 

100%

        Another type of RMBS transaction is generally referred to as "Subprime RMBS". The collateral supporting such transactions is comprised of first-lien residential mortgage loans made to subprime borrowers. A "subprime borrower" is one considered to be a higher risk credit based on credit scores or other risk characteristics. As of December 31, 2008, we had net par outstanding of $6.6 billion related to Subprime RMBS securitizations, of which $483 million is classified by us as Below Investment Grade risk. Of the total U.S. Subprime RMBS exposure of $6.6 billion, $6.1 billion is from transactions issued in the period from 2005 through 2007 and written in our direct financial guaranty segment. As of December 31, 2008, we had portfolio reserves of $8.8 million and case reserves of $7.8 million related to our $6.6 billion U.S. Subprime RMBS exposure, of which $6.9 million were portfolio reserves related to our $6.1 billion exposure in the direct financial guaranty segment for transactions issued from 2005 through 2007.

        The problems affecting the subprime mortgage market have been widely reported, with rising delinquencies, defaults and foreclosures negatively impacting the performance of Subprime RMBS transactions. Those concerns relate primarily to Subprime RMBS issued in the period from 2005 through 2007. The $6.1 billion exposure that we have to such transactions in our direct financial guaranty segment benefits from various structural protections, including credit enhancement that on average currently equals approximately 54.3% of the remaining principal balance of the transactions.

23


Table of Contents

        We also have exposure of $433.1 million to Closed-End Second ("CES") RMBS transactions, of which $424.2 million is in the direct segment. As with other types of RMBS, we have seen significant deterioration in the performance of our CES transactions. On two transactions, which had exposure of $185.0 million, during 2008 we have seen a significant increase in delinquencies and collateral losses, which resulted in erosion of the Company's credit enhancement and the payment of claims totaling $16.2 million. Based on the Company's analysis of these transaction and their projected collateral losses, the Company had case reserves of $37.7 million as of December 31, 2008 in its direct segment. Additionally, as of December 31, 2008, the Company had portfolio reserves of $0.1 million in its financial guaranty direct segment and no case or portfolio reserves in its financial guaranty reinsurance segment related to its U.S. Closed-End Second RMBS exposure.

        Another type of RMBS transaction is generally referred to as "Alt-A RMBS". The collateral supporting such transactions is comprised of first-lien residential mortgage loans made to prime quality borrowers that lack certain ancillary characteristics that would make them prime. Included in this category is Alt-A Option ARMs, which include transactions where 66% or more of the collateral is comprised of mortgage loans that have the potential to negatively amortize. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had net par outstanding of $7.6 billion related to Alt-A RMBS securitizations. Of that amount, $7.5 billion is from transactions issued in the period from 2005 through 2007 and written in the Company's financial guaranty direct segment. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had portfolio reserves of $6.5 million and case reserves of $1.5 million related to its $7.6 billion Alt-A RMBS exposure, in the financial guaranty direct and reinsurance segments, respectively.

        The ultimate performance of the Company's RMBS transactions remains highly uncertain and may be subject to considerable volatility due to the influence of many factors, including the level and timing of loan defaults, changes in housing prices and other variables. The Company will continue to monitor the performance of its RMBS exposures and will adjust the risk ratings of those transactions based on actual performance and management's estimates of future performance.

        The Company has exposure on two life insurance reserve securitization transactions based on two discrete blocks of individual life insurance business reinsured by Scottish Re (U.S.) Inc. ("Scottish Re"). The two transactions relate to Ballantyne Re p.l.c. ("Ballantyne") (gross exposure of $500 million) and Orkney Re II, p.l.c. ("Orkney II") (gross exposure of $423 million). Under both transactions, monies raised through the issuance of the insured notes support present and future U.S. statutory life insurance reserve requirements. The monies were invested at inception of each transaction in accounts managed by a large, well-known investment manager. However, those investment accounts have incurred substantial mark-to-market losses since mid-year 2007, principally as a result of their exposure to subprime and Alt-A RMBS transactions. Largely as a result of these mark-to-market losses both we and the rating agencies have downgraded our exposure to both Ballantyne and Orkney II to below investment grade. As regards the Ballantyne transaction, the Company is working with the directing guarantor, who has insured exposure of $900 million, to remediate the risk. On the Orkney Re II transaction, the Company, as directing financial guarantor, is taking remedial action.

        Some credit losses have been realized on the securities in the Ballantyne and Orkney Re II portfolios and significant additional credit losses are expected to occur. Performance of the underlying blocks of life insurance business thus far generally has been in accordance with expectations. The combination of cash flows from the investment accounts and the treaty settlements currently is sufficient to cover interest payments due on the notes that we insure. Adverse treaty performance and/or a rise in credit losses on the invested assets are expected to lead to interest shortfalls. Additionally, the transactions also contain features linked to the market values of the invested assets, reserve funding requirements on the underlying blocks of life insurance business, and minimum capital requirements for the transactions themselves that may trigger a shut off of interest payments to the insured notes and thereby result in claim payments by the Company.

24


Table of Contents

        Another key risk is that the occurrence of certain events may result in a situation where either Ballantyne and/or Orkney Re II are required to sell assets and potentially realize substantial investment losses and for Assured Guaranty Ltd. to incur corresponding insured losses ahead of the scheduled final maturity date. For example, cedants to Scottish Re may have the right to recapture blocks of life insurance business which Scottish Re has ceded to Orkney Re II. Such recaptures could require Orkney Re II to sell assets and realize investment losses. In the Ballantyne transaction, further declines in the market value of the invested assets and/or an increase in the reserve funding requirements could lead to a similar mandatory realization of investment losses and for Assured Guaranty Ltd. to incur corresponding insured losses ahead of the scheduled final maturity date.

        In order for the Company to incur an ultimate net loss on these transactions, adverse experience on the underlying block of life insurance policies and/or credit losses in the investment portfolio would need to exceed the level of credit enhancement built into the transaction structures. Based on its analysis of the information currently available, including estimates of future investment performance, projected credit impairments on the invested assets and performance of the blocks of life insurance business, at December 31, 2008, the Company established a case reserve of $17.2 million for the Ballantyne transaction. The Company has not established a case loss reserve for the Orkney Re II transaction.

        On December 19, 2008, the Company sued J.P. Morgan Investment Management Inc. ("JPMIM"), the investment manager in the Orkney II transaction, in New York Supreme Court alleging that JPMIM engaged in breaches of fiduciary duty, gross negligence and breaches of contract based upon its handling of the investments of Orkney Re II. JPMIM requested and was given an extension of time to answer until the end of February.

        The Company has exposure to a public finance transaction for sewer service in Jefferson County, Alabama through several reinsurance treaties. The Company's total exposure to this transaction is approximately $456 million as of December 31, 2008. The Company has made debt service payments during the year and expects to make additional payments in the near term. Through our cedants, the Company is currently in discussions with the bond issuer to structure a solution, which may result in some or all of these payments being recoverable. A case reserve of $6.0 million has been established as of December 31, 2008.

        We also record IBNR reserves for our other segment. IBNR is an estimate of losses for which the insured event has occurred but the claim has not yet been reported to us. In establishing IBNR, we use traditional actuarial methods to estimate the reporting lag of such claims based on historical experience, claim reviews and information reported by ceding companies. We record IBNR for trade credit reinsurance within our other segment, which is 100% reinsured. The other segment represents lines of business that we exited or sold as part of our 2004 initial public offering ("IPO").

        For mortgage guaranty transactions we record portfolio reserves in a manner consistent with our financial guaranty business. While other mortgage guaranty insurance companies do not record portfolio reserves, rather just case and IBNR reserves, we record portfolio reserves because we write business on an excess of loss basis, while other industry participants write quota share or first layer loss business. We manage and underwrite this business in the same manner as our financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance business because they have similar characteristics as insured obligations of mortgage-backed securities.

        Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ("FAS") No. 60, "Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises" ("FAS 60") is the authoritative guidance for an insurance enterprise. FAS 60 prescribes differing reserving methodologies depending on whether a contract fits within its definition of a short-duration contract or a long-duration contract. Financial guaranty contracts have elements of long-duration insurance contracts in that they are irrevocable and extend over a period that may exceed 30 years or more, but for regulatory purposes are reported as property and liability insurance, which

25


Table of Contents


are normally considered short-duration contracts. The short-duration and long-duration classifications have different methods of accounting for premium revenue and contract liability recognition. Additionally, the accounting for deferred acquisition costs ("DAC") could be different under the two methods.

        We believe the guidance of FAS 60 does not expressly address the distinctive characteristics of financial guaranty insurance, so we also apply the analogous guidance of Emerging Issues Task Force ("EITF") Issue No. 85-20, "Recognition of Fees for Guaranteeing a Loan" ("EITF 85-20"), which provides guidance relating to the recognition of fees for guaranteeing a loan, which has similarities to financial guaranty insurance contracts. Under the guidance in EITF 85-20, the guarantor should assess the probability of loss on an ongoing basis to determine if a liability should be recognized under FAS No. 5, "Accounting for Contingencies" ("FAS 5"). FAS 5 requires that a loss be recognized where it is probable that one or more future events will occur confirming that a liability has been incurred at the date of the financial statements and the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated.

        The Company is aware that there are certain differences regarding the measurement of portfolio loss liabilities among companies in the financial guaranty industry. In January and February 2005, the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") staff had discussions concerning these differences with a number of industry participants. Based on those discussions, in June 2005 the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") staff decided additional guidance is necessary regarding financial guaranty contracts. In May 2008, the FASB issued FAS No. 163, "Accounting for Financial Guarantee Insurance Contracts—An Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 60" ("FAS 163"). FAS 163 requires that an insurance enterprise recognize a claim liability prior to an event of default (insured event) when there is evidence that credit deterioration has occurred in an insured financial obligation. FAS 163 also clarifies the methodology to be used for financial guaranty premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement as well as requiring expanded disclosures about the insurance enterprise's risk management activities. The provisions of FAS 163 related to premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement are effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and all interim periods within those fiscal years. Earlier application of these provisions is not permitted. The expanded risk management activity disclosure provisions of FAS 163 are effective for the third quarter of 2008 and are included in Note 11 "Significant Risk Management Activities" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K. FAS 163 will be applied to all existing and future financial guaranty insurance contracts written by us. The cumulative effect of initially applying FAS 163 will be recorded as an adjustment to retained earnings as of January 1, 2009. The adoption of FAS 163 is expected to have a material effect on our financial statements. We are in the process of estimating the impact of the adoption of FAS 163. We will continue to follow our existing accounting policies in regards to premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement until we complete our first quarter 2009 financial statements.

26


Table of Contents

        The following table provides a reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances of reserves for losses and LAE:

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Balance as of January 1

  $ 125,550   $ 115,857   $ 117,376  

Less reinsurance recoverable

    (8,849 )   (10,889 )   (12,350 )
               

Net balance as of January 1

    116,701     104,968     105,026  

Transfers to case reserves from portfolio reserves

    69,360     10,363     9  

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses pertaining to case and IBNR reserves:

                   
 

Current year

    163,197     8,056     (228 )
 

Prior years

    111,194     (17,716 )   3,248  
               

    274,391     (9,660 )   3,020  

Transfers to case reserves from portfolio reserves

    (69,360 )   (10,363 )   (9 )

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses pertaining to portfolio reserves

    (8,629 )   15,438     8,303  
               

Total losses and loss adjustment expenses

    265,762     5,778     11,323  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (paid) and recovered pertaining to:

                   
 

Current year

    (90,339 )   (2,637 )   (20 )
 

Prior years

    (169,061 )   7,330     (11,422 )
               

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (paid) recovered

    (259,400 )   4,693     (11,442 )

Change in salvage recoverable, net

    67,420     1,295     42  

Foreign exchange (gain) loss on reserves

    (213 )   (33 )   19  
               

Net balance as of December 31

    190,270     116,701     104,968  

Plus reinsurance recoverable

    6,528     8,849     10,889  
               

Balance as of December 31

  $ 196,798   $ 125,550   $ 115,857  
               

        The unfavorable current and prior year development in 2008 of is primarily due to incurred losses related to our U.S. RMBS exposures as well as other real estate related exposures. Additionally, during 2008 case reserves were established for two public finance transactions.

        The favorable prior year development in 2007 of $17.7 million is primarily due to $8.6 million of loss recoveries, $5.0 million reduction in case reserves and $4.3 million increase in salvage reserves for aircraft related transactions, reported to us by our cedant. These losses were incurred in 2002 and 2006.

        Losses and loss adjustment expenses paid (received), were $259.4 million, $(4.7) million and $11.4 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006. The loss payments of $259.4 million in 2008 are related to several HELOC and Closed-End Second transactions, as these transactions have experienced significant deterioration during the year. The loss recovery of $4.7 million in 2007 was mainly a result of loss recoveries of $8.6 million from two aircraft related transactions in which claims were paid in 2002 and 2006. These recoveries were partially offset by loss payments related to assumed U.S. home equity line of credit exposures. The loss payments of $11.4 million in 2006 were related to a U.S. Infrastructure transaction and a European Infrastructure transaction.

27


Table of Contents

Investments

        Our principal objectives in managing our investment portfolio are: (1) to preserve our subsidiaries' financial strength ratings; (2) to maximize total after-tax net investment income while generating a competitive total rate of return; (3) to maintain sufficient liquidity to cover unexpected stress in the insurance portfolio; (4) to manage investment risk within the context of the underlying portfolio of insurance risk; and (5) to meet applicable regulatory requirements.

        We have a formal review process for all securities in our investment portfolio, including a review for impairment losses. Factors considered when assessing impairment include: (1) a decline in the market value of a security by 20% or more below amortized cost for a continuous period of at least six months; (2) a decline in the market value of a security for a continuous period of 12 months; (3) recent credit downgrades of the applicable security or the issuer by rating agencies; (4) the financial condition of the applicable issuer; (5) whether scheduled interest payments are past due; and (6) whether we have the ability and intent to hold the security for a sufficient period of time to allow for anticipated recoveries in fair value. If we believe a decline in the value of a particular investment is temporary, we record the decline as an unrealized loss on our balance sheet in "accumulated other comprehensive income" in shareholders' equity. If we believe the decline is "other than temporary," we write down the carrying value of the investment and record a realized loss in our statement of operations. Our assessment of a decline in value includes management's current assessment of the factors noted above. If that assessment changes in the future, we may ultimately record a loss after having originally concluded that the decline in value was temporary.

        The Company recognized $71.3 million of other than temporary impairment losses primarily related to mortgage-backed and corporate securities for the year ended December 31, 2008. The Company continues to monitor the value of these investments. Future events may result in further impairment of the Company's investments. The Company had no write downs of investments for other than temporary impairment losses for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006. For additional information regarding our investments, see "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Investment Portfolio."

        As of December 31, 2008, other than the securities discussed above, the Company's gross unrealized loss position stood at $122.5 million compared to $8.9 million at December 31, 2007. The $113.6 million increase in gross unrealized losses was primarily attributable to mortgage and asset-backed securities, $54.3 million, municipal securities, $48.6 million, and corporate securities, $10.4 million. The increase in these unrealized losses during the year ended December 31, 2008 was related to the overall illiquidity in the financial markets, due in part to credit concerns across all sectors and also due to general illiquidity, which resulted in a sudden and severe depressed demand for non-cash investments.

        As of December 31, 2008, the Company had 58 securities in an unrealized loss position for greater than 12 months, representing a gross unrealized loss of $31.6 million. Of these securities, 20 securities had unrealized losses greater than 10% of book value. The total unrealized loss for these securities as of December 31, 2008 was $24.1 million. This unrealized loss is primarily attributable to the market illiquidity and volatility in the U.S. economy mentioned above and not specific to individual issuer credit. Except as noted below, the Company has recognized no other than temporary impairment losses and has the ability and intent to hold these securities until a recovery in value.

        As of January 1, 2005, we retained BlackRock Financial Management, Inc. to manage our investment portfolio. Our investment managers have discretionary authority over our investment portfolio within the limits of our investment guidelines approved by our Board of Directors. We compensate each of these managers based upon a fixed percentage of the market value of our portfolio. During the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, we paid aggregate investment management fees of $2.5 million, $1.9 million and $1.8 million, respectively, to these managers.

28


Table of Contents

Competition

        Our principal competitors in the financial guaranty direct market are Ambac Assurance Corporation ("Ambac"), Berkshire Hathaway Assurance Corporation ("BHAC"), Financial Security Assurance Inc. ("FSA") and MBIA Insurance Corporation ("MBIA"). On November 14, 2008, Assured entered into a definitive agreement to acquire Financial Security Assurance Holdings, Ltd, the parent company of FSA. We expect to close this transaction in either the first or second quarter of 2009, subject to the satisfaction or waiver of the closing conditions contained in the Purchase Agreement.

        There are companies that are entering or potentially may enter the market. Banks and multi-line insurers and reinsurers also participate in the broader credit enhancement market. The principal competitive factors are: (1) premium rates; (2) conditions precedent to the issuance of a policy related to the structure and security features of a proposed bond issue; (3) the financial strength ratings of the guarantor or credit ratings of the bank; (4) the quality of service and execution provided to issuers, investors and other clients of the issuer and (5) secondary market trading values of bonds insured by the financial guarantor. Financial guaranty insurance also competes domestically and internationally with other forms of credit enhancement, including the use of senior and subordinated tranches of a proposed structured finance obligation and/or overcollateralization or cash collateral accounts, as well as more traditional forms of credit support.

        The Company has no competitor devoted exclusively to financial guaranty reinsurance in the financial guaranty reinsurance market. The Company competes in the financial guaranty reinsurance market with multi-line insurers, which are able to reinsure financial guaranty insurance, and with the other primary financial guaranty insurers. Competition in the financial guaranty reinsurance business is based upon many factors including financial strength ratings from the major rating agencies, a financial enhancement rating from S&P, pricing, service, size and underwriting criteria.

Regulation

General

        The business of insurance and reinsurance is regulated in most countries, although the degree and type of regulation varies significantly from one jurisdiction to another. Reinsurers are generally subject to less direct regulation than primary insurers. We are subject to regulation under applicable statutes in the United States, the United Kingdom and Bermuda.

United States

        Assured Guaranty Ltd. has two operating insurance subsidiaries domiciled in the United States, which we refer to collectively as the "Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries."

        AGC is a Maryland domiciled insurance company licensed to write financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance (and in some states casualty, surety and other lines) in 50 U.S. states, the District of Columbia and Puerto Rico. AGC is also licensed as a Class 3 insurer in Bermuda. It is registered as a foreign company in Australia and operates through a representative office in Sydney. AGC currently intends for the representative office to conduct activities so that it does not have a permanent establishment in Australia.

        Assured Guaranty Mortgage, a wholly owned subsidiary of AGRO, is a New York corporation licensed as a mortgage guaranty insurer in the State of New York and in the District of Columbia and thereby is authorized solely to transact the business of mortgage guaranty insurance and reinsurance. Assured Guaranty Mortgage is an approved or accredited reinsurer in the States of California, Illinois and Wisconsin.

29


Table of Contents

        Assured Guaranty and the Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries are subject to the insurance holding company laws of Maryland and New York. These laws generally require each of the Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries to register with its respective domestic state insurance department and annually to furnish financial and other information about the operations of companies within their holding company system. Generally, all transactions among companies in the holding company system to which any of the Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries is a party (including sales, loans, reinsurance agreements and service agreements) must be fair and, if material or of a specified category, such as service agreements, require prior notice and approval or non-disapproval by the insurance department where the applicable subsidiary is domiciled.

        Before a person can acquire control of a U.S. domestic insurance company, prior written approval must be obtained from the insurance commissioner of the state where the domestic insurer is domiciled. Generally, state statutes provide that control over a domestic insurer is presumed to exist if any person, directly or indirectly, owns, controls, holds with the power to vote, or holds proxies representing, 10% or more of the voting securities of the domestic insurer. Prior to granting approval of an application to acquire control of a domestic insurer, the state insurance commissioner will consider such factors as the financial strength of the applicant, the integrity and management of the applicant's Board of Directors and executive officers, the acquirer's plans for the management of the applicant's Board of Directors and executive officers, the acquirer's plans for the future operations of the domestic insurer and any anti-competitive results that may arise from the consummation of the acquisition of control. These laws may discourage potential acquisition proposals and may delay, deter or prevent a change of control involving us that some or all of our stockholders might consider to be desirable, including in particular unsolicited transactions.

        State insurance authorities have broad regulatory powers with respect to various aspects of the business of U.S. insurance companies, including licensing these companies to transact business, accreditation of reinsurers, admittance of assets to statutory surplus, regulating unfair trade and claims practices, establishing reserve requirements and solvency standards, regulating investments and dividends, and, in certain instances, approving policy forms and related materials and approving premium rates. State insurance laws and regulations require the Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries to file financial statements with insurance departments everywhere they are licensed, authorized or accredited to conduct insurance business, and their operations are subject to examination by those departments at any time. The Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries prepare statutory financial statements in accordance with Statutory Accounting Practices, or SAP, and procedures prescribed or permitted by these departments. State insurance departments also conduct periodic examinations of the books and records, financial reporting, policy filings and market conduct of insurance companies domiciled in their states, generally once every three to five years. Market conduct examinations by regulators other than the domestic regulator are generally carried out in cooperation with the insurance departments of other states under guidelines promulgated by the National Association of Insurance Commissioners.

        The Maryland Insurance Administration conducts a periodic examination of insurance companies domiciled in Maryland every five years. The last such Report on Financial Examination, issued by the Maryland Insurance Administration on April 30, 2008 in connection with such examination, did not contain any materially adverse findings. The New York Insurance Department, the regulatory authority of the domiciliary jurisdiction of Assured Guaranty Mortgage, conducts a periodic examination of insurance companies domiciled in New York, also at five-year intervals. During 2008, the New York

30


Table of Contents


Insurance Department completed its field work in connection with its examination of Assured Guaranty Mortgage for the period from 2003 though 2007. We anticipate the report will be issued in 2009.

        The terms and conditions of reinsurance agreements generally are not subject to regulation by any U.S. state insurance department with respect to rates. As a practical matter, however, the rates charged by primary insurers do have an effect on the rates that can be charged by reinsurers.

        Maryland.    One of the primary sources of cash for the payment of debt service and dividends by Assured Guaranty is the receipt of dividends from AGC. If a dividend or distribution is an "extraordinary dividend," it must be reported to, and approved by, the Insurance Commissioner prior to payment. An "extraordinary dividend" is defined to be any dividend or distribution to stockholders, such as Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., which together with dividends paid during the preceding twelve months exceeds the lesser of 10% of an insurance company's policyholders' surplus at the preceding December 31 or 100% of AGC's adjusted net investment income during that period. Further, an insurer may not pay any dividend or make any distribution to its shareholders unless the insurer notifies the Insurance Commissioner of the proposed payment within five business days following declaration and at least ten days before payment. The Insurance Commissioner may declare that such dividend not be paid if the Commissioner finds that the insurer's policyholders' surplus would be inadequate after payment of the dividend or could lead the insurer to a hazardous financial condition. AGC declared and paid dividends of $16.5 million, $12.1 million and $13.8 million during 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, to Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. The maximum amount available during 2009 for the payment of dividends by AGC which would not be characterized as "extraordinary dividends" is approximately $37.8 million.

        New York.    Under the New York Insurance Law, Assured Guaranty Mortgage may declare or pay any dividend only out of "earned surplus," which is defined as that portion of the company's surplus that represents the net earnings, gains or profits (after deduction of all losses) that have not been distributed to shareholders as dividends or transferred to stated capital, capital surplus or contingency reserves, or applied to other purposes permitted by law, but does not include unrealized appreciation of assets. Additionally, no dividend may be declared or distributed in an amount which, together with all dividends declared or distributed by it during the preceding twelve months, exceeds the lesser of 10% of Assured Guaranty Mortgage's statutory surplus as shown on its latest statutory financial statement on file with the New York Superintendent of Insurance, or 100% of Assured Guaranty Mortgage's adjusted net investment income during that period, unless, upon prior application, the Superintendent approves a greater dividend or distribution after finding that the company will retain sufficient surplus to support its obligations and writings. Assured Guaranty Mortgage did not declare or pay dividends during 2008. As of December 31, 2008, Assured Guaranty Mortgage had negative unassigned funds and therefore cannot pay dividends during 2009.

        In accordance with Maryland insurance law and regulations, AGC maintains a statutory contingency reserve for the protection of policyholders against the effect of adverse economic cycles. The contingency reserve is maintained for each obligation and is equal to the greater of 50% of the premiums written or a percentage of principal guaranteed (which percentage varies from 0.55% to 2.5% depending on the nature of the asset). The contingency reserve is put up over a period of either 15 or 20 years, depending on the nature of the obligation, and then taken down over the same period of time. The contingency reserve may be maintained net of reinsurance. AGC's contingency reserve as of December 31, 2008 was in compliance with these insurance laws and regulations.

31


Table of Contents

        Under the New York Insurance Law, Assured Guaranty Mortgage must establish a contingency reserve to protect policyholders against the effect of adverse economic cycles. This reserve is established out of net premiums (gross premiums less premiums returned to policyholders) remaining after the statutory unearned premium reserve is established. Contributions to the contingency reserve must equal 50% of remaining earned premiums and, except as otherwise approved by the Superintendent of Insurance, must be maintained in the contingency reserve for a period of 120 months. Reinsurers are required to establish a contingency reserve equal to their proportionate share of the reserve established by the ceding company. Assured Guaranty Mortgage's contingency reserve as of December 31, 2008 was in compliance with these insurance laws and regulations.

        Under the New York Insurance Law, Assured Guaranty Mortgage's total liability, net of applicable reinsurance, under its aggregate insurance policies may not exceed 25 times its total policyholders' surplus, commonly known as the "risk-to-capital" requirement. As of December 31, 2008, the consolidated risk-to-capital ratio for Assured Guaranty Mortgage was below the limit.

        The Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries are subject to laws and regulations that require diversification of their investment portfolio and limit the amount of investments in certain asset categories, such as below investment grade fixed maturity securities, equity real estate, other equity investments, and derivatives. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations would cause investments exceeding regulatory limitations to be treated as non-admitted assets for purposes of measuring surplus, and, in some instances, would require divestiture of such non-qualifying investments. We believe that the investments made by the Assured Guaranty U.S. Subsidiaries complied with such regulations as of December 31, 2008. In addition, any investment must be approved by the insurance company's Board of Directors or a committee thereof that is responsible for supervising or making such investment.

        The insurance laws of each state of the United States and of many other countries regulate or prohibit the sale of insurance and reinsurance within their jurisdictions by unlicensed or non-accredited insurers and reinsurers. Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd., AG Re and AGRO are not admitted to do business in the United States. We do not intend that Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd., AG Re or AGRO will maintain offices or solicit, advertise, settle claims or conduct other insurance activities in any jurisdiction in the United States where the conduct of such activities would require it to be admitted or authorized.

        In addition to the regulatory requirements imposed by the jurisdictions in which they are licensed, reinsurers' business operations are affected by regulatory requirements in various states of the United States governing "credit for reinsurance" which are imposed on their ceding companies. In general, a ceding company which obtains reinsurance from a reinsurer that is licensed, accredited or approved by the ceding company's state of domicile is permitted to reflect in its statutory financial statements a credit in an aggregate amount equal to the ceding company's liability for unearned premiums (which are that portion of premiums written which applies to the unexpired portion of the policy period), loss reserves and loss expense reserves ceded to the reinsurer. The great majority of states, however, permit a credit on the statutory financial statement of a ceding insurer for reinsurance obtained from a non-licensed or non-accredited reinsurer to the extent that the reinsurer secures its reinsurance obligations to the ceding insurer by providing a letter of credit, trust fund or other acceptable security arrangement. A few states do not allow credit for reinsurance ceded to non-licensed reinsurers except in certain limited circumstances and others impose additional requirements that make it difficult to become accredited.

32


Table of Contents

Bermuda

        Each of AG Re and AGRO, our "Bermuda Subsidiaries," is an insurance company currently registered and licensed as a "Class 3 insurer" and a "long term insurer" under the Insurance Act 1978 of Bermuda. AGC is permitted under a revocable permit granted under the Companies Act 1981 of Bermuda (the "Companies Act") to engage in and carry on trade and business limited to engaging in certain non U.S. financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance outside Bermuda from a principal place of business in Bermuda, subject to compliance with the conditions attached to the permit and relevant provisions of the Companies Act (including having a Bermuda principal representative for the Companies Act purposes, restrictions on activities in Bermuda, publication and filing of prospectuses on public offerings of securities, registration of charges against its assets and certain winding up provisions). AGC is also licensed as a Class 3 insurer in Bermuda.

        The Insurance Act 1978 of Bermuda, amendments thereto and related regulations (collectively, the "Insurance Act") impose on insurance companies certain solvency and liquidity standards; certain restrictions on the declaration and payment of dividends and distributions; certain restrictions on the reduction of statutory capital; certain restrictions on the winding up of long term insurers; and certain auditing and reporting requirements and also the need to have a principal representative and a principal office (as understood under the Insurance Act) in Bermuda. The Insurance Act grants to the Bermuda Monetary Authority (the "Authority") the power to cancel insurance licenses, supervise, investigate and intervene in the affairs of insurance companies and in certain circumstances share information with foreign regulators. Class 3 insurers are authorized to carry on general insurance business (as understood under the Insurance Act), subject to conditions attached to the license and to compliance with minimum capital and surplus requirements, solvency margin, liquidity ratio and other requirements imposed by the Insurance Act. Long term insurers are permitted to carry on long term business (as understood under the Insurance Act) subject to conditions attached to the license and to similar compliance requirements and the requirement to maintain its long term business fund (a segregated fund). Each of AG Re and AGRO is required annually to file statutorily mandated financial statements and returns, audited by an auditor approved by the Authority (no approved auditor of an insurer may have an interest in that insurer, other than as an insured, and no officer, servant or agent of an insurer shall be eligible for appointment as an insurer's approved auditor), together with an annual loss reserve opinion of the Authority approved loss reserve specialist and the required actuary's certificate with respect to the long term business. AGC has an exemption from such filings, subject to certain conditions. On January 15, 2009 the Authority issued an On-site Assessment Final Management Report with respect to the 2007 review of AG Re. This report did not contain any adverse findings.

        In addition, pursuant to provisions under the Insurance Act, any person who becomes a holder of at least 10%, 20%, 33% or 50% of our common shares must notify the Authority in writing within 45 days of becoming such a holder or 30 days from the date they have knowledge of having become such a holder, whichever is later. The Authority has the power to object to a person holding 10% or more of our common shares if it appears to the Authority that the person is not fit and proper to be such a holder. In such a case, the Authority may require the holder to reduce their shareholding in us and may direct, among other things, that the voting rights attaching to their common shares shall not be exercisable. A person that does not comply with such a notice or direction from the Authority will be guilty of an offence.

        Under a condition to its permit granted under the Companies Act, AGC must inform the Minister of Finance of any change in its beneficial ownership within 14 days of the occurrence of such change.

33


Table of Contents

        The Insurance Act limits the declaration and payment of dividends and other distributions by AG Re, AGRO and AGC.

        Under the Insurance Act:

        The Insurance Act was amended in 2008 by the introduction of, amongst other things, a new classification system of the Class 3 insurance sector. Subject to certain exceptions, all Class 3 insurers have been required to submit a re-classification application to the Authority by December 31, 2008. Under the new classification criteria, all Class 3 companies are now classified as a Class 3 insurer, Class 3A (Small Commercial) insurer or Class 3B (Large Commercial) insurer. AG Re has applied to be reclassified as a Class 3B insurer and AGRO has applied to be reclassified as a Class 3A insurer. AGC is not currently required by the Authority to reclassify and will currently remain a Class 3 insurer.

34


Table of Contents


At present, Class 3A and 3B insurers are subject to the same regulation as Class 3 insurers, although we anticipate an increased level of supervision for Class 3A and 3B insurers in the future. In particular, we anticipate that the Authority will extend the risk-based capital model currently only applicable to Class 4 insurers to Class 3B insurers later in 2009 or 2010.

        Under the Companies Act, a Bermuda company (such as Assured Guaranty, AG Re and AGRO) may only declare and pay a dividend or make a distribution out of contributed surplus (as understood under the Companies Act) if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is and after the payment will be able to meet and pay its liabilities as they become due and the realizable value of the company's assets will not be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and its issued share capital and share premium accounts. The Companies Act also regulates and restricts the reduction and return of capital and paid in share premium, including the repurchase of shares and imposes minimum issued and outstanding share capital requirements.

        Although Assured Guaranty Ltd. is incorporated in Bermuda, it is classified as a non-resident of Bermuda for exchange control purposes by the Authority. Pursuant to its non-resident status, Assured Guaranty may engage in transactions in currencies other than Bermuda dollars and there are no restrictions on its ability to transfer funds (other than funds denominated in Bermuda dollars) in and out of Bermuda or to pay dividends to U.S. residents who are holders of its common shares.

        Under Bermuda law, "exempted" companies are companies formed for the purpose of conducting business outside Bermuda from a principal place of business in Bermuda. As an "exempted" company, Assured Guaranty (as well as each of AG Re and AGRO) may not, without the express authorization of the Bermuda legislature or under a license or consent granted by the Minister of Finance, participate in certain business and other transactions, including: (1) the acquisition or holding of land in Bermuda (except that held by way of lease or tenancy agreement which is required for its business and held for a term not exceeding 50 years, or which is used to provide accommodation or recreational facilities for its officers and employees and held with the consent of the Bermuda Minister of Finance, for a term not exceeding 21 years), (2) the taking of mortgages on land in Bermuda to secure a principal amount in excess of $50,000 unless the Minister of Finance consents to a higher amount, and (3) the carrying on of business of any kind or type for which it is not duly licensed in Bermuda, except in certain limited circumstances, such as doing business with another exempted undertaking in furtherance of Assured Guaranty's business carried on outside Bermuda.

        The Bermuda government actively encourages foreign investment in "exempted" entities like Assured Guaranty that are based in Bermuda, but which do not operate in competition with local businesses. Assured Guaranty is not currently subject to taxes computed on profits or income or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation. Bermuda companies and permit companies, such as AGC, pay, as applicable, annual government fees, business fees, payroll tax and other taxes and duties. See "Material Tax Considerations—Taxation of Assured Guaranty and Subsidiaries—Bermuda."

        Special considerations apply to our Bermuda operations. Under Bermuda law, non-Bermudians, other than spouses of Bermudians and individuals holding permanent resident certificates or working resident certificates, are not permitted to engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without a work permit issued by the Bermuda government. A work permit is only granted or extended if the employer can show that, after a proper public advertisement, no Bermudian, spouse of a Bermudian or individual holding a permanent resident certificate or working resident certificate is available who meets the minimum standards for the position. The Bermuda government has a policy that places a six-year term limit on individuals with work permits, subject to specified exemptions for persons deemed to be key employees. Currently, all of our Bermuda based professional employees who require work permits have been granted work permits by the Bermuda government. This includes the following key employees:

35


Table of Contents


Messrs. Frederico, Mills, Michener, Penchoff, Albert, Pickering and Bailenson and Ms. Purtill each of whom has received a work permit.

United Kingdom

        Since December 1, 2001, the regulation of the financial services industry in the United Kingdom has been consolidated under the Financial Services Authority ("FSA UK"). In addition, the regulatory regime in the United Kingdom must comply with certain European Union ("EU") directives binding on all EU member states and notably the Markets in Financial Instruments Directive ("MiFID") which came into effect on November 1, 2007, replacing the Investments Services Directive, largely for the purposes of harmonizing the regulatory regime for investment services and activities across the EEA (see definition of "EEA" under "Passporting" below).

        The FSA UK is the single statutory regulator responsible for regulating the financial services industry in the UK, having the authority to oversee the carrying on of "regulated activities" (including deposit taking, insurance and reinsurance, investment management and most other financial services), with the purpose of maintaining confidence in the UK financial system, providing public understanding of the system, securing the proper degree of protection for consumers and helping to reduce financial crime. It is a criminal offense for any person to carry on a regulated activity in the UK unless that person is authorized by the FSA UK and has been granted permission to carry on that regulated activity, or otherwise falls under an exemption to such regulation.

        Insurance business in the United Kingdom falls into two main categories: long-term insurance (which is primarily investment related) and general insurance. Subject to limited exceptions, it is not possible for a new insurance company to be authorized in both long-term and general insurance business unless the long-term insurance business is restricted to reinsurance business. These two categories are both divided into "classes" (for example: permanent health and pension fund management are two classes of long-term insurance; damage to property and motor vehicle liability are two classes of general insurance). Under the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 ("FSMA"), effecting or carrying out contracts of insurance, within a class of general or long-term insurance, by way of business in the UK, constitutes a "regulated activity" requiring authorization. An authorized insurance company must have permission for each class of insurance business it intends to write.

        Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. is authorized to effect and carry out certain classes of non-life insurance, specifically: classes 14 (credit), 15 (suretyship) and 16 (miscellaneous financial loss). This scope of permission is sufficient to enable Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. to effect and carry out financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance. The insurance and reinsurance businesses of Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. are subject to close supervision by the FSA UK. In addition to its requirements for senior management arrangements, systems and controls of insurance and reinsurance companies under its jurisdiction, the FSA UK now regards itself as a principles based regulator and is placing an increased emphasis on risk identification and management in relation to the prudential regulation of insurance and reinsurance business in the United Kingdom. In recent years, there have been a number of changes to the FSA UK's rules that affect insurance and reinsurance companies authorized in the UK. For example, the FSA UK introduced rules on the sale of general insurance, known as insurance mediation, and introduced the General Prudential Sourcebook (GENPRU); the Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers (INSPRU); and the Interim Prudential Sourcebook for Insurers (IPRU-INS), together the "Prudential Sourcebooks" which include measures such as risk-based capital adequacy rules, including individual capital assessments which are intended to align capital requirements with the risk profile of each insurance company and proposals aimed at ensuring adequate diversification of an insurer's or reinsurer's exposures to any credit risks of its reinsurers. Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. has calculated its

36


Table of Contents


minimum required capital according to the FSA's individual capital adequacy criteria and is in compliance.

        As a consequence of the new insurance mediation rules, Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. now also has permission to arrange and advise on deals in financial guaranties which it underwrites.

        Assured Guaranty Finance Overseas, Ltd. is not authorized as an insurer. It is authorized by the FSA UK as a "Category D" company to carry out designated investment business activities in that it may "advise on investments (except on pension transfers and pension opt outs)" relating to most investment instruments. In addition, it may arrange or bring about transactions in investments and make "arrangements with a view to transactions in investments." It should be noted that Assured Guaranty Finance Overseas, Ltd. does not itself take risk in the transactions it arranges or places, and may not hold funds on behalf of its customers.

        The FSA UK carries out the prudential supervision of insurance companies through a variety of methods, including the collection of information from statistical returns, review of accountants' reports, visits to insurance companies and regular formal interviews.

        The FSA UK has adopted a principles based and risk-based approach to the supervision of insurance companies. Under this approach, the FSA UK periodically performs a formal risk assessment of insurance companies or groups carrying on business in the UK which varies in scope according to the risk profile of the insurer. The FSA UK performs its risk assessment broadly, by analyzing information which it receives during the normal course of its supervision, such as regular prudential returns on the financial position of the insurance company, or which it acquires through a series of meetings with senior management of the insurance company and by making use of its thematic work. After each risk assessment, the FSA UK will inform the insurer of its views on the insurer's risk profile. This will include details of any remedial action that the FSA UK requires and the likely consequences if this action is not taken.

        GENPRU and INSPRU require that non-life insurance companies such as Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. maintain a margin of solvency at all times in respect of the liabilities of the insurance company, the calculation of which depends on the type and amount of insurance business a company writes. The method of calculation of the solvency margin (known as the minimum capital requirement) is set out in the Prudential Sourcebooks, and for these purposes, the insurer's assets and liabilities are subject to specified valuation rules. The Prudential Sourcebooks also requires that Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. calculates and shares with the FSA UK its "enhanced capital requirement" based on risk-weightings applied to assets held and lines of business written. This enhanced capital requirement is not yet a legally binding requirement but is required to form the basis of Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd.'s individual capital assessment which is then discussed with the FSA UK. Failure to maintain capital at least equal to the higher of the minimum capital requirement and the individual capital assessment is one of the grounds on which the wide powers of intervention conferred upon the FSA UK may be exercised.

        To the extent that the amount of premiums for such classes exceed certain specified minimum thresholds, each insurance company writing property, credit and other specified categories of insurance or reinsurance business is required by the Prudential Sourcebooks to maintain an equalization reserve calculated in accordance with the provisions of IPRU.

37


Table of Contents

        These solvency requirements came into force on January 1, 2005. They may need to be amended in order to implement the European Union's proposed "Solvency II" directive on risk-based capital but that is not expected to be implemented until 2012.

        In addition, an insurer [(which as of December 10, 2007 includes a company conducting only reinsurance business)] is required to perform and submit to the FSA UK a group capital adequacy return in respect of its ultimate parent and, if different, its ultimate EEA parent. The calculation at the level of the ultimate EEA parent is required to show a positive result from December 31, 2006. There is no such requirement in relation to the report at the level of the ultimate parent, although if the report at that level raises concerns the FSA may take regulatory action. Public disclosure of the EEA group calculation is also required. The purpose of this rule is to prevent leveraging of capital arising from involvements in other group insurance firms. Given the current structure of the Company, the main aspects of the Company's capital regime will not apply to Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd.'s ultimate parent, because it is incorporated in Bermuda, nor to the intermediate holding companies, because they are incorporated in the United States, but reporting will be required to the FSA UK up to the ultimate parent.

        Further, an insurer is required to report in its annual returns to the FSA UK all material related party transactions (e.g., intragroup reinsurance, whose value is more than 5% of the insurer's general insurance business amount).

        UK company law prohibits Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. from declaring a dividend to its shareholders unless it has "profits available for distribution." The determination of whether a company has profits available for distribution is based on its accumulated realized profits less its accumulated realized losses. While the UK insurance regulatory laws impose no statutory restrictions on a general insurer's ability to declare a dividend, the FSA UK's capital requirements may in practice act as a restriction on dividends.

        UK insurance companies must prepare their financial statements under the Companies Act of 1985 - 2006 (as amended), which requires the filing with Companies House of audited financial statements and related reports. In addition, UK insurance companies are required to file regulatory returns with the FSA UK, which include a revenue account, a profit and loss account and a balance sheet in prescribed forms. Under sections of IPRU-INS, audited regulatory returns must be filed with the FSA UK within two months and 15 days of the financial year end (or three months where the delivery of the return is made electronically).

        The FSA UK closely supervises the management of insurance companies through the approved persons regime, by which any appointment of persons to perform certain specified "controlled functions" within a regulated entity must be approved by the FSA UK.

        FSMA regulates the acquisition of "control" of any UK insurance company authorized under FSMA. Any company or individual that (together with its or his associates) directly or indirectly acquires 10% or more of the shares in a UK authorized insurance company or its parent company, or is entitled to exercise or control the exercise of 10% or more of the voting power in such authorized insurance company or its parent company, would be considered to have acquired "control" for the purposes of the relevant legislation, as would a person who had significant influence over the

38


Table of Contents

management of such authorized insurance company or its parent company by virtue of his shareholding or voting power in either.

        Under FSMA, any person proposing to acquire "control" of a UK authorized insurance company must give prior notification to the FSA UK of its intention to do so. The FSA UK then has three months to consider that person's application to acquire "control." In considering whether to approve such application, the FSA UK must be satisfied that both the acquirer is a "fit and proper" person to have "control" and that the interests of consumers would not be threatened by such acquisition of "control." "Consumers" in this context includes all persons who may use the services of the authorized insurance company. Failure to make the relevant prior application could result in action being taken by the FSA UK.

        The FSA UK has extensive powers to intervene in the affairs of an authorized person, culminating in the ultimate sanction of the removal of authorization to carry on a regulated activity. FSMA imposes on the FSA UK statutory obligations to monitor compliance with the requirements imposed by FSMA, and to investigate and enforce the provisions of FSMA related rules made by the FSA UK such as the Prudential Sourcebooks and breaches of the New Conduct of Business Sourcebook generally applicable to authorized persons as a result of the implementation of MiFID.

        The FSA UK also has the power to prosecute criminal offenses arising under FSMA, and to prosecute insider dealing under Part V of the Criminal Justice Act of 1993, and breaches of money laundering regulations. The FSA UK's stated policy is to pursue criminal prosecution in all appropriate cases.

        EU directives allow Assured Guaranty Finance Overseas, Ltd. and Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. to conduct business in EU states other than the United Kingdom in compliance with the scope of permission granted these companies by FSA UK without the necessity of additional licensing or authorization in other EU jurisdictions. This ability to operate in other jurisdictions of the EU on the basis of home state authorization and supervision is sometimes referred to as "passporting." Insurers may operate outside their home member state either on a "services" basis or on an "establishment" basis. Operating on a "services" basis means that the company conducts permitted businesses in the host state without having a physical presence there, while operating on an establishment basis means the company has a branch or physical presence in the host state. In both cases, a company remains subject to regulation by its home regulator although the company nonetheless may have to comply with certain local rules, such as where the company is operating on an "establishment" basis in which case, the local conduct of business (and other related) rules apply since the host state is regarded as better placed to detect and intervene in respect of suspected breaches relating to the branch within its territory. In such cases, the home state rules apply in respect of "organisational" and "prudential" obligations. In addition to EU member states, Norway, Iceland and Liechtenstein (members of the broader European Economic Area or "EEA") are jurisdictions in which this passporting framework applies. Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. is permitted to operate on a passport basis in various countries throughout the EEA; Assured Guaranty Finance Overseas, Ltd. is permitted to operate on a services basis in Austria, Belgium, Denmark, Finland, France, Germany, the Republic of Ireland, Italy, Luxembourg, the Netherlands, Norway, Portugal, Spain and Sweden.

        Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. is subject to FSA UK fees and levies based on Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd.'s gross written premiums. The FSA UK also requires authorized insurers to participate in an

39


Table of Contents

investors' protection fund, known as the Financial Services Compensation Scheme (the "FSCS"). The FSCS was established to compensate consumers of financial services, including the buyers of insurance, against failures in the financial services industry. Individual policyholders and small businesses may be compensated by the FSCS when an authorized insurer is unable, or likely to be unable, to satisfy policyholder claims. Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. does not expect to write any insurance business that is protected by the FSCS.

Tax Matters

Taxation of Assured Guaranty and Subsidiaries

Bermuda

        Under current Bermuda law, there is no Bermuda income, corporate or profits tax or withholding tax, capital gains tax or capital transfer tax payable by Assured Guaranty or our Bermuda Subsidiaries. Assured Guaranty, AGC, and the Bermuda Subsidiaries have each obtained from the Minister of Finance under the Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act 1966, as amended, an assurance that, in the event that Bermuda enacts legislation imposing tax computed on profits, income, any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance, then the imposition of any such tax shall not be applicable to Assured Guaranty, AGC or the Bermuda Subsidiaries or to any of their operations or their shares, debentures or other obligations, until March 28, 2016. This assurance is subject to the proviso that it is not to be construed so as to prevent the application of any tax or duty to such persons as are ordinarily resident in Bermuda, or to prevent the application of any tax payable in accordance with the provisions of the Land Tax Act 1967 or otherwise payable in relation to any land leased to Assured Guaranty, AGC or the Bermuda Subsidiaries. Assured Guaranty, AGC and the Bermuda Subsidiaries each pay annual Bermuda government fees, and the Bermuda Subsidiaries and AGC pay annual insurance license fees. In addition, all entities employing individuals in Bermuda are required to pay a payroll tax and there are other sundry taxes payable, directly or indirectly, to the Bermuda government.

United States

        We have conducted and intend to conduct substantially all of our foreign operations outside the United States and to limit the U.S. contacts of Assured Guaranty and its foreign subsidiaries (except AGRO, which has elected to be taxed as a U.S. corporation) so that they should not be engaged in a trade or business in the United States. A foreign corporation, such as AG Re deemed to be engaged in a trade or business in the United States would be subject to U.S. income tax at regular corporate rates, as well as the branch profits tax, on its income which is treated as effectively connected with the conduct of that trade or business, unless the corporation is entitled to relief under the permanent establishment provision of an applicable tax treaty, as discussed below. Such income tax, if imposed, would be based on effectively connected income computed in a manner generally analogous to that applied to the income of a U.S. corporation, except that a foreign corporation may generally be entitled to deductions and credits only if it timely files a U.S. federal income tax return. Assured Guaranty and AG Re have and will continue to file protective U.S. federal income tax returns on a timely basis in order to preserve the right to claim income tax deductions and credits if it is ever determined that they are subject to U.S. federal income tax. The highest marginal federal income tax rates currently are 35% for a corporation's effectively connected income and 30% for the "branch profits" tax.

        Under the income tax treaty between Bermuda and the United States (the "Bermuda Treaty"), a Bermuda insurance company would not be subject to U.S. income tax on income found to be effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business unless that trade or business is conducted through a

40


Table of Contents


permanent establishment in the United States. AG Re currently intends to conduct its activities so that it does not have a permanent establishment in the United States.

        An insurance enterprise resident in Bermuda generally will be entitled to the benefits of the Bermuda Treaty if (i) more than 50% of its shares are owned beneficially, directly or indirectly, by individual residents of the United States or Bermuda or U.S. citizens and (ii) its income is not used in substantial part, directly or indirectly, to make disproportionate distributions to, or to meet certain liabilities of, persons who are neither residents of either the United States or Bermuda nor U.S. citizens.

        Foreign insurance companies carrying on an insurance business within the United States have a certain minimum amount of effectively connected net investment income, determined in accordance with a formula that depends, in part, on the amount of U.S. risk insured or reinsured by such companies. If AG Re is considered to be engaged in the conduct of an insurance business in the United States and is not entitled to the benefits of the Bermuda Treaty in general (because it fails to satisfy one of the limitations on treaty benefits discussed above), the Internal Revenue of 1986, as amended (the "Code") could subject a significant portion of AG Re's investment income to U.S. income tax.

        Foreign corporations not engaged in a trade or business in the U.S., and those that are engaged in a U.S. trade or business with respect to their non-effectively connected income are nonetheless subject to U.S. income tax imposed by withholding on certain "fixed or determinable annual or periodic gains, profits and income" derived from sources within the U.S. (such as dividends and certain interest on investments), subject to exemption under the Code or reduction by applicable treaties. Generally under the U.S. income tax treaty with the United Kingdom the withholding rate is reduced (i) on dividends from less than 10% owned corporations to 15%; (ii) on dividends from 10% or more owned corporations to 5%; and (iii) on interest to 0%. The Bermuda Treaty does not reduce the U.S. withholding rate on U.S.-sourced investment income. The standard non-treaty rate of U.S. withholding tax is currently 30%. Accordingly, dividends paid, if any, by Assured Guaranty U.S. Holdings to Assured Guaranty or Assured Guaranty Overseas U.S. Holdings Inc. to AG Re should be subject to a 30% U.S. withholding tax.

        Assured Guaranty US Holdings, AGC, AG Financial Products Inc., Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings and Assured Guaranty Mortgage are each a U.S. domiciled corporation and AGRO has elected to be treated as a U.S. corporation for all U.S. federal tax purposes. As such, each corporation is subject to taxation in the United States at regular corporate rates.

Taxation of Shareholders

Bermuda Taxation

        Currently, there is no Bermuda capital gains tax, or withholding or other tax payable on principal, interests or dividends paid to the holders of the common shares of Assured Guaranty.

United States Taxation

        This discussion is based upon the Code, the regulations promulgated thereunder and any relevant administrative rulings or pronouncements or judicial decisions, all as in effect on the date hereof and as currently interpreted, and does not take into account possible changes in such tax laws or interpretations thereof, which may apply retroactively. This discussion does not include any description of the tax laws of any state or local governments within the United States or any foreign government.

        The following summary sets forth the material U.S. federal income tax considerations related to the purchase, ownership and disposition of our shares. Unless otherwise stated, this summary deals only with holders that are U.S. Persons (as defined below) who purchase their shares and who hold their

41


Table of Contents


shares as capital assets within the meaning of section 1221 of the Code. The following discussion is only a discussion of the material U.S. federal income tax matters as described herein and does not purport to address all of the U.S. federal income tax consequences that may be relevant to a particular shareholder in light of such shareholder's specific circumstances. For example, special rules apply to certain shareholders, such as partnerships, insurance companies, regulated investment companies, real estate investment trusts, financial asset securitization investment trusts, dealers or traders in securities, tax exempt organizations, expatriates, persons that do not hold their securities in the U.S. dollar, persons who are considered with respect to any of us as "United States shareholders" for purposes of the controlled foreign corporation ("CFC") rules of the Code (generally, a U.S. Person, as defined below, who owns or is deemed to own 10% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of Assured Guaranty or the stock of any of our foreign subsidiaries entitled to vote (i.e., 10% U.S. Shareholders)), or persons who hold the common shares as part of a hedging or conversion transaction or as part of a short-sale or straddle. Any such shareholder should consult their tax advisor.

        If a partnership holds our shares, the tax treatment of the partners will generally depend on the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. Partners of a partnership owning our shares should consult their tax advisers.

        For purposes of this discussion, the term "U.S. Person" means: (i) a citizen or resident of the United States, (ii) a partnership or corporation, created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, or organized under any political subdivision thereof, (iii) an estate the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source, (iv) a trust if either (x) a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of such trust and one or more U.S. Persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of such trust or (y) the trust has a valid election in effect to be treated as a U.S. Person for U.S. federal income tax purposes or (v) any other person or entity that is treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as if it were one of the foregoing.

        Taxation of Distributions.    Subject to the discussions below relating to the potential application of the CFC, related person insurance income ("RPII") and passive foreign investment company ("PFIC") rules, cash distributions, if any, made with respect to our shares will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent paid out of current or accumulated earnings and profits of Assured Guaranty (as computed using U.S. tax principles). Under current legislation, certain dividends paid to individual and certain other non-corporate shareholders before 2011 are eligible for reduced rates of tax. Dividends paid by Assured Guaranty to corporate shareholders will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction. To the extent such distributions exceed Assured Guaranty's earnings and profits, they will be treated first as a return of the shareholder's basis in the common shares to the extent thereof, and then as gain from the sale of a capital asset.

        We believe dividends paid by us on our common shares before 2011 to non-corporate holders will be eligible for reduced rates of tax up to a maximum of 15% as "qualified dividend income," provided that we are not a PFIC and certain other requirements, including stock holding period requirements, are satisfied. Qualified dividend income is subject to tax and capital gain rates.

        Classification of Assured Guaranty or its Foreign Subsidiaries as a Controlled Foreign Corporation.    Each 10% U.S. Shareholder (as defined below) of a foreign corporation that is a CFC for an uninterrupted period of 30 days or more during a taxable year, and who owns shares in the foreign corporation, directly or indirectly through foreign entities, on the last day of the foreign corporation's taxable year on which it is CFC, must include in its gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its pro rata share of the CFC's "subpart F income," even if the subpart F income is not distributed. "Subpart F income" of a foreign insurance corporation typically includes foreign personal holding company income (such as interest, dividends and other types of passive income), as well as insurance and reinsurance income (including underwriting and investment income). A foreign corporation is

42


Table of Contents


considered a CFC if 10% U.S. Shareholders own (directly, indirectly through foreign entities or by attribution by application of the constructive ownership rules of section 958(b) of the Code (i.e., "constructively")) more than 50% of the total combined voting power of all classes of voting stock of such foreign corporation, or more than 50% of the total value of all stock of such corporation on any day during the taxable year of such corporation. For purposes of taking into account insurance income, a CFC also includes a foreign insurance company in which more than 25% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock (or more than 25% of the total value of the stock) is owned by 10% U.S. Shareholders, on any day during the taxable year of such corporation. A "10% U.S. Shareholder" is a U.S. Person who owns (directly, indirectly through foreign entities or constructively) at least 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock entitled to vote of the foreign corporation. We believe that because of the dispersion of our share ownership, provisions in our organizational documents that limit voting power (these provisions are described in "Description of Share Capital") and other factors, no U.S. Person who owns shares of Assured Guaranty directly or indirectly through one or more foreign entities should be treated as owning (directly, indirectly through foreign entities, or constructively), 10% or more of the total voting power of all classes of shares of Assured Guaranty or any of its foreign subsidiaries. It is possible, however, that the Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") could challenge the effectiveness of these provisions and that a court could sustain such a challenge.

        The RPII CFC Provisions.    The following discussion generally is applicable only if the RPII of AG Re determined on a gross basis, is 20% or more of AG Re's gross insurance income for the taxable year and the 20% Ownership Exception (as defined below) is not met. The following discussion generally would not apply for any taxable year in which AG Re's gross RPII falls below the 20% threshold or the 20% Ownership Exception is met. Although we cannot be certain, Assured Guaranty believes that AG Re was in prior years of operations and will be for the foreseeable future below either the 20% threshold or 20% Ownership Exception for each tax year.

        RPII is any "insurance income" (as defined below) attributable to policies of insurance or reinsurance with respect to which the person (directly or indirectly) insured is a "RPII shareholder" (as defined below) or a "related person" (as defined below) to such RPII shareholder. In general, and subject to certain limitations, "insurance income" is income (including premium and investment income) attributable to the issuing of any insurance or reinsurance contract which would be taxed under the portions of the Code relating to insurance companies if the income were the income of a domestic insurance company. For purposes of inclusion of the RPII of AG Re in the income of RPII shareholders, unless an exception applies, the term "RPII shareholder" means any U.S. Person who owns (directly or indirectly through foreign entities) any amount of Assured Guaranty's common shares. Generally, the term "related person" for this purpose means someone who controls or is controlled by the RPII shareholder or someone who is controlled by the same person or persons which control the RPII shareholder. Control is measured by either more than 50% in value or more than 50% in voting power of stock applying certain constructive ownership principles. AG Re will be treated as a CFC under the RPII provisions if RPII shareholders are treated as owning (directly, indirectly through foreign entities or constructively) 25% or more of the shares of Assured Guaranty by vote or value.

        RPII Exceptions.    The special RPII rules do not apply if (i) at all times during the taxable year less than 20% of the voting power and less than 20% of the value of the stock of Assured Guaranty (the "20% Ownership Exception") is owned (directly or indirectly) by persons whose (directly or indirectly) insured under any policy of insurance or reinsurance issued by AG Re or related persons to any such person, (ii) RPII, determined on a gross basis, is less than 20% of AG Re's gross insurance income for the taxable year (the "20% Gross Income Exception), (iii) AG Re elects to be taxed on its RPII as if the RPII were effectively connected with the conduct of a U.S. trade or business, and to waive all treaty benefits with respect to RPII and meet certain other requirements or (iv) AG Re elects

43


Table of Contents


to be treated as a U.S. corporation and waive all treaty benefits and meet certain other requirements. AG Re does not intend to make either of these elections. Where none of these exceptions applies, each U.S. Person owning or treated as owning any shares in Assured Guaranty (and therefore, indirectly, in AG Re) on the last day of Assured Guaranty's taxable year will be required to include in its gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its share of the RPII for the portion of the taxable year during which AG Re was a CFC under the RPII provisions, determined as if all such RPII were distributed proportionately only to such U.S. Persons at that date, but limited by each such U.S. Person's share of AG Re's current-year earnings and profits as reduced by the U.S. Person's share, if any, of certain prior-year deficits in earnings and profits. AG Re intends to operate in a manner that is intended to ensure that it qualifies for either the 20% Gross Income Exception or 20% Ownership Exception.

        Computation of RPII.    For any year in which AG Re does not meet the 20% Ownership Exception or the 20% Gross Income Exception, Assured Guaranty may also seek information from its shareholders as to whether beneficial owners of shares at the end of the year are U.S. Persons so that the RPII may be determined and apportioned among such persons; to the extent Assured Guaranty is unable to determine whether a beneficial owner of shares is a U.S. Person, Assured Guaranty may assume that such owner is not a U.S. Person, thereby increasing the per share RPII amount for all known RPII shareholders. The amount of RPII includable in the income of a RPII shareholder is based upon the net RPII income for the year after deducting related expenses such as losses, loss reserves and operating expenses.

        If AG Re meets the 20% Ownership Exception or the 20% Gross Income Exception, RPII shareholders will not be required to include RPII in their taxable income. The amount of RPII includable in the income of a RPII shareholder is based upon the net RPII income for the year after deducting related expenses such as losses, loss reserves and operating expenses.

        Apportionment of RPII to U.S. Holders.    Every RPII shareholder who owns shares on the last day of any taxable year of Assured Guaranty in which AG Re does not meet the 20% Ownership Exception and the 20% Gross Income Exception should expect that for such year it will be required to include in gross income its share of AG Re's RPII for the portion of the taxable year during which AG Re was a CFC under the RPII provisions, whether or not distributed, even though it may not have owned the shares throughout such period. A RPII shareholder who owns shares during such taxable year but not on the last day of the taxable year is not required to include in gross income any part of AG Re's RPII.

        Uncertainty as to Application of RPII.    The RPII provisions are complex have never been interpreted by the courts or the Treasury Department in final regulations, and regulations interpreting the RPII provisions of the Code exist only in proposed form. It is not certain whether these regulations will be adopted in their proposed form or what changes or clarifications might ultimately be made thereto or whether any such changes, as well as any interpretation or application of RPII by the IRS, the courts or otherwise, might have retroactive effect. These provisions include the grant of authority to the Treasury Department to prescribe "such regulations as may be necessary to carry out the purpose of this subsection including regulations preventing the avoidance of this subsection through cross insurance arrangements or otherwise." Accordingly, the meaning of the RPII provisions and the application thereof to AG Re is uncertain. In addition, we cannot be certain that the amount of RPII or the amounts of the RPII inclusions for any particular RPII shareholder, if any, will not be subject to adjustment based upon subsequent IRS examination. Any prospective investor which does business with AG Re and is considering an investment in common shares should consult his tax advisor as to the effects of these uncertainties.

44


Table of Contents

        Information Reporting.    Under certain circumstances, U.S. Persons owning shares (directly, indirectly or constructively) in a foreign corporation are required to file IRS Form 5471 with their U.S. federal income tax returns. Generally, information reporting on IRS Form 5471 is required by (i) a person who is treated as a RPII shareholder, (ii) a 10% U.S. Shareholder of a foreign corporation that is a CFC for an uninterrupted period of 30 days or more during any tax year of the foreign corporation and who owned the stock on the last day of that year; and (iii) under certain circumstances, a U.S. Person who acquires stock in a foreign corporation and as a result thereof owns 10% or more of the voting power or value of such foreign corporation, whether or not such foreign corporation is a CFC. For any taxable year in which we determine that the 20% Gross Income Exception and the 20% Ownership Exception does not apply, we will provide to all U.S. Persons registered as shareholders of its shares a completed IRS Form 5471 or the relevant information necessary to complete the form. Failure to file IRS Form 5471 may result in penalties.

        Tax-Exempt Shareholders.    Tax-exempt entities will be required to treat certain subpart F insurance income, including RPII, that is includible in income by the tax-exempt entity as unrelated business taxable income. Prospective investors that are tax exempt entities are urged to consult their tax advisors as to the potential impact of the unrelated business taxable income provisions of the Code. A tax-exempt organization that is treated as a 10% U.S. Shareholder or a RPII Shareholder also must file IRS Form 5471 in certain circumstances.

        Dispositions of Our Shares.    Subject to the discussions below relating to the potential application of the Code section 1248 and PFIC rules, holders of shares generally should recognize capital gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes on the sale, exchange or other disposition of shares in the same manner as on the sale, exchange or other disposition of any other shares held as capital assets. If the holding period for these shares exceeds one year, any gain will be subject to tax at a current maximum marginal tax rate of 15% for individuals and 35% for corporations. Moreover, gain, if any, generally will be a U.S. source gain and generally will constitute "passive income" for foreign tax credit limitation purposes.

        Code section 1248 provides that if a U.S. Person sells or exchanges stock in a foreign corporation and such person owned, directly, indirectly through certain foreign entities or constructively, 10% or more of the voting power of the corporation at any time during the five-year period ending on the date of disposition when the corporation was a CFC, any gain from the sale or exchange of the shares will be treated as a dividend to the extent of the CFC's earnings and profits (determined under U.S. federal income tax principles) during the period that the shareholder held the shares and while the corporation was a CFC (with certain adjustments). We believe that because of the dispersion of our share ownership, provisions in our organizational documents that limit voting power and other factors that no U.S. shareholder of Assured Guaranty should be treated as owning (directly, indirectly through foreign entities or constructively) 10% of more of the total voting power of Assured Guaranty; to the extent this is the case this application of Code Section 1248 under the regular CFC rules should not apply to dispositions of our common shares. It is possible, however, that the IRS could challenge the effectiveness of these provisions and that a court could sustain such a challenge. A 10% U.S. Shareholder may in certain circumstances be required to report a disposition of shares of a CFC by attaching IRS Form 5471 to the U.S. federal income tax or information return that it would normally file for the taxable year in which the disposition occurs. In the event this is determined necessary, Assured Guaranty will provide a completed IRS Form 5471 or the relevant information necessary to complete the Form. Code section 1248 in conjunction with the RPII rules also applies to the sale or exchange of shares in a foreign corporation if the foreign corporation would be treated as a CFC for RPII purposes regardless of whether the shareholder is a 10% U.S. Shareholder or whether the 20% Ownership Exception or 20% Gross Income Exception applies. Existing proposed regulations do not address whether Code section 1248 would apply if a foreign corporation is not a CFC but the foreign corporation has a subsidiary that is a CFC and that would be taxed as an insurance company if it were a domestic corporation. We believe, however, that this application of Code section 1248 under the RPII

45


Table of Contents


rules should not apply to dispositions of our shares because Assured Guaranty will not be directly engaged in the insurance business. We cannot be certain, however, that the IRS will not interpret the proposed regulations in a contrary manner or that the Treasury Department will not amend the proposed regulations to provide that these rules will apply to dispositions of common shares. Prospective investors should consult their tax advisors regarding the effects of these rules on a disposition of common shares.

        Passive Foreign Investment Companies.    In general, a foreign corporation will be a PFIC during a given year if (i) 75% or more of its gross income constitutes "passive income" (the "75% test") or (ii) 50% or more of its assets produce passive income (the "50% test").

        If Assured Guaranty were characterized as a PFIC during a given year, each U.S. Person holding our shares would be subject to a penalty tax at the time of the sale at a gain of, or receipt of an "excess distribution" with respect to, their common shares, unless such person (i) is a 10% U.S. Shareholder and we are a CFC or (ii) made a "qualified electing fund election" or "mark-to-market" election. It is uncertain that Assured Guaranty would be able to provide its shareholders with the information necessary for a U.S. Person to make these elections. In addition, if Assured Guaranty were considered a PFIC, upon the death of any U.S. individual owning common shares, such individual's heirs or estate would not be entitled to a "step-up" in the basis of the common shares that might otherwise be available under U.S. federal income tax laws. In general, a shareholder receives an "excess distribution" if the amount of the distribution is more than 125% of the average distribution with respect to the common shares during the three preceding taxable years (or shorter period during which the taxpayer held common shares). In general, the penalty tax is equivalent to an interest charge on taxes that are deemed due during the period the shareholder owned the common shares, computed by assuming that the excess distribution or gain (in the case of a sale) with respect to the common shares was taken in equal portion at the highest applicable tax rate on ordinary income throughout the shareholder's period of ownership. The interest charge is equal to the applicable rate imposed on underpayments of U.S. federal income tax for such period. In addition, a distribution paid by Assured Guaranty to U.S. shareholders that is characterized as a dividend and is not characterized as an excess distribution would not be eligible for reduced rates of tax as qualified dividend income with respect to dividends paid before 2011.

        For the above purposes, passive income generally includes interest, dividends, annuities and other investment income. The PFIC rules provide that income "derived in the active conduct of an insurance business by a corporation which is predominantly engaged in an insurance business... is not treated as passive income." The PFIC provisions also contain a look-through rule under which a foreign corporation shall be treated as if it "received directly its proportionate share of the income..." and as if it "held its proportionate share of the assets..." of any other corporation in which it owns at least 25% of the value of the stock.

        The insurance income exception is intended to ensure that income derived by a bona fide insurance company is not treated as passive income, except to the extent such income is attributable to financial reserves in excess of the reasonable needs of the insurance business. We expect, for purposes of the PFIC rules, that each of our insurance subsidiaries will be predominantly engaged in an insurance business and is unlikely to have financial reserves in excess of the reasonable needs of its insurance business in each year of operations. Accordingly, none of the income or assets of our insurance subsidiaries should be treated as passive. Additionally, we expect that in each year of operations the passive income and assets of our non-insurance subsidiaries will not exceed the 75% test or 50% test amounts in each year of operations with respect to the overall income and assets of Assured Guaranty and its subsidiaries. Under the look-through rule Assured Guaranty should be deemed to own its proportionate share of the assets and to have received its proportionate share of the income of its direct and indirect subsidiaries for purposes of the 75% test and the 50% test. As a result, we believe that Assured Guaranty was not and should not be treated as a PFIC. We cannot be certain, however, as there are currently no regulations regarding the application of the PFIC provisions

46


Table of Contents


to an insurance company and new regulations or pronouncements interpreting or clarifying these rules may be forthcoming, that the IRS will not successfully challenge this position. Prospective investors should consult their tax advisor as to the effects of the PFIC rules.

        Foreign tax credit.    If U.S. Persons own a majority of our common shares, only a portion of the current income inclusions, if any, under the CFC, RPII and PFIC rules and of dividends paid by us (including any gain from the sale of common shares that is treated as a dividend under section 1248 of the Code) will be treated as foreign source income for purposes of computing a shareholder's U.S. foreign tax credit limitations. We will consider providing shareholders with information regarding the portion of such amounts constituting foreign source income to the extent such information is reasonably available. It is also likely that substantially all of the "subpart F income," RPII and dividends that are foreign source income will constitute either "passive" or "general" income. Thus, it may not be possible for most shareholders to utilize excess foreign tax credits to reduce U.S. tax on such income.

        Information Reporting and Backup Withholding on Distributions and Disposition Proceeds.    Information returns may be filed with the IRS in connection with distributions on our common shares and the proceeds from a sale or other disposition of our common shares unless the holder of our common shares establishes an exemption from the information reporting rules. A holder of common shares that does not establish such an exemption may be subject to U.S. backup withholding tax on these payments if the holder is not a corporation or non-U.S. Person or fails to provide its taxpayer identification number or otherwise comply with the backup withholding rules. The amount of any backup withholding from a payment to a U.S. Person will be allowed as a credit against the U.S. Person's U.S. federal income tax liability and may entitle the U.S. Person to a refund, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS.

        Changes in U.S. Federal Income Tax Law Could Materially Adversely Affect Us or Our Shareholders.    Legislation has been introduced in the U.S. Congress intended to eliminate certain perceived tax advantages of companies (including insurance companies) that have legal domiciles outside the United States but have certain U.S. connections. For example, legislation has been introduced in Congress to limit the deductibility of reinsurance premiums paid by U.S. companies to foreign affiliates. It is possible that this or similar legislation could be introduced in and enacted by the current Congress or future Congresses that could have an adverse impact on us or our shareholders.

        Additionally, The tax laws and interpretations regarding whether a company is engaged in a U.S. trade or business or whether a company is a CFC or a PFIC or has RPII are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis. There are currently no regulations regarding the application of the PFIC rules to an insurance company. Additionally, the regulations regarding related person insurance income are still in proposed form. New regulations or pronouncements interpreting or clarifying such rules may be forthcoming. We cannot be certain if, when or in what form such regulations or pronouncements may be provided and whether such guidance will have a retroactive effect.

Description of Share Capital

        The following summary of our share capital is qualified in its entirety by the provisions of Bermuda law, our memorandum of association and Bye-Laws, copies of which are incorporated by reference as exhibits to this Annual Report on Form 10-K. In this section, the "Company," "we," "us" and "our" refer to Assured Guaranty Ltd. and not to any of its subsidiaries.

General

        We have an authorized share capital of $5,000,000 divided into 500,000,000 shares, par value U.S. $0.01 per share, of which 91,097,894 common shares were issued and outstanding as of February 12, 2009. Except as described below, our common shares have no preemptive rights or other rights to subscribe for additional common shares, no rights of redemption, conversion or exchange and no

47


Table of Contents


sinking fund rights. In the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding-up, the holders of our common shares are entitled to share equally, in proportion to the number of common shares held by such holder, in our assets, if any remain after the payment of all our debts and liabilities and the liquidation preference of any outstanding preferred shares. Under certain circumstances, we have the right to purchase all or a portion of the shares held by a shareholder. See "—Acquisition of Common Shares by Us" below.

Voting Rights and Adjustments

        In general, and except as provided below, shareholders have one vote for each common share held by them and are entitled to vote with respect to their fully paid shares at all meetings of shareholders. However, if, and so long as, the common shares (and other of our shares) of a shareholder are treated as "controlled shares" (as determined pursuant to section 958 of the Code) of any "United States person" as defined in the Code (a "U.S. Person") and such controlled shares constitute 9.5% or more of the votes conferred by our issued and outstanding shares, the voting rights with respect to the controlled shares owned by such U.S. Person shall be limited, in the aggregate, to a voting power of less than 9.5% of the voting power of all issued and outstanding shares, under a formula specified in our Bye-laws. The formula is applied repeatedly until there is no U.S. Person whose controlled shares constitute 9.5% or more of the voting power of all issued and outstanding shares and who generally would be required to recognize income with respect to us under the Code if we were a controlled foreign corporation as defined in the Code and if the ownership threshold under the Code were 9.5% (as defined in our Bye-Laws as a "9.5% U.S. Shareholder"). In addition, our Board of Directors may determine that shares held carry different voting rights when it deems it appropriate to do so to (i) avoid the existence of any 9.5% U.S. Shareholder; and (ii) avoid adverse tax, legal or regulatory consequences to the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any direct or indirect holder of shares or its affiliates. "Controlled shares" includes, among other things, all shares of Assured Guaranty that such U.S. Person is deemed to own directly, indirectly or constructively (within the meaning of section 958 of the Code). The foregoing provision does not apply to ACE because it is not a U.S. Shareholder. Further, these provisions do not apply in the event one shareholder owns greater than 75% of the voting power of all issued and outstanding shares.

        Under these provisions, certain shareholders may have their voting rights limited to less than one vote per share, while other shareholders may have voting rights in excess of one vote per share. Moreover, these provisions could have the effect of reducing the votes of certain shareholders who would not otherwise be subject to the 9.5% limitation by virtue of their direct share ownership. Our Bye-laws provide that we will use our best efforts to notify shareholders of their voting interests prior to any vote to be taken by them.

        Our Board of Directors is authorized to require any shareholder to provide information for purposes of determining whether any holder's voting rights are to be adjusted, which may be information on beneficial share ownership, the names of persons having beneficial ownership of the shareholder's shares, relationships with other shareholders or any other facts our Board of Directors may deem relevant. If any holder fails to respond to this request or submits incomplete or inaccurate information, our Board of Directors may eliminate the shareholder's voting rights. All information provided by the shareholder will be treated by us as confidential information and shall be used by us solely for the purpose of establishing whether any 9.5% U.S. Shareholder exists and applying the adjustments to voting power (except as otherwise required by applicable law or regulation).

Restrictions on Transfer of Common Shares

        Our Board of Directors may decline to register a transfer of any common shares under certain circumstances, including if they have reason to believe that any adverse tax, regulatory or legal consequences to us, any of our subsidiaries or any of our shareholders or indirect holders of shares or its Affiliates may occur as a result of such transfer (other than such as our Board of Directors

48


Table of Contents


considers de minimis). Transfers must be by instrument unless otherwise permitted by the Companies Act.

        The restrictions on transfer and voting restrictions described above may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of Assured Guaranty.

Acquisition of Common Shares by Us

        Under our Bye-Laws and subject to Bermuda law, if our Board of Directors determines that any ownership of our shares may result in adverse tax, legal or regulatory consequences to us, any of our subsidiaries or any of our shareholders or indirect holders of shares or its Affiliates (other than such as our Board of Directors considers de minimis), we have the option, but not the obligation, to require such shareholder to sell to us or to a third party to whom we assign the repurchase right the minimum number of common shares necessary to avoid or cure any such adverse consequences at a price determined in the discretion of the Board of Directors to represent the shares' fair market value (as defined in our Bye-Laws).

Other Provisions of Our Bye-Laws

        Our Board of Directors and Corporate Action.    Our Bye-Laws provide that our Board of Directors shall consist of not less than three and not more than 21 directors, the exact number as determined by the Board of Directors. Our Board of Directors consists of ten persons, and is divided into three classes. Each elected director generally will serve a three year term, with termination staggered according to class. Shareholders may only remove a director for cause (as defined in our Bye-Laws) at a general meeting, provided that the notice of any such meeting convened for the purpose of removing a director shall contain a statement of the intention to do so and shall be provided to that director at least two weeks before the meeting. Vacancies on the Board of Directors can be filled by the Board of Directors if the vacancy occurs in those events set out in our Bye-Laws as a result of death, disability, disqualification or resignation of a director, or from an increase in the size of the Board of Directors.

        Generally under our Bye-Laws, the affirmative votes of a majority of the votes cast at any meeting at which a quorum is present is required to authorize a resolution put to vote at a meeting of the Board of Directors. Corporate action may also be taken by a unanimous written resolution of the Board of Directors without a meeting. A quorum shall be at least one-half of directors then in office present in person or represented by a duly authorized representative, provided that at least two directors are present in person.

        Shareholder Action.    At the commencement of any general meeting, two or more persons present in person and representing, in person or by proxy, more than 50% of the issued and outstanding shares entitled to vote at the meeting shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business. In general, any questions proposed for the consideration of the shareholders at any general meeting shall be decided by the affirmative votes of a majority of the votes cast in accordance with the Bye-Laws.

        The Bye-Laws contain advance notice requirements for shareholder proposals and nominations for directors, including when proposals and nominations must be received and the information to be included.

        Amendment.    The Bye-Laws may be amended only by a resolution adopted by the Board of Directors and by resolution of the shareholders.

        Voting of Non-U.S. Subsidiary Shares.    If we are required or entitled to vote at a general meeting of any of AG Re, AGFOL or any other directly held non-U.S. subsidiary of ours, our Board of Directors shall refer the subject matter of the vote to our shareholders and seek direction from such shareholders as to how they should vote on the resolution proposed by the non-U.S. subsidiary. Our Board of Directors in its discretion shall require substantially similar provisions are or will be contained

49


Table of Contents


in the bye-laws (or equivalent governing documents) of any direct or indirect non-U.S. subsidiaries other than UK and AGRO.

Employees

        As of December 31, 2008, we had 160 employees. None of our employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe that employee relations are satisfactory.

Available Information

        We maintain an Internet web site at www.assuredguaranty.com. We make available, free of charge, on our web site (under Investor Information/SEC Filings) our annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13 (a) or 15 (d) of the Exchange Act (15 U.S.C. 78m (a) or 78o(d)) as soon as reasonably practicable after we file such material with, or furnish it to, the Securities and Exchange Commission.

        We also make available free of charge through our web site (under Investor Information / Corporate Governance) links to our Corporate Governance Guidelines, our Code of Conduct and Charters for our Board Committees. These documents are also available in print to any shareholder who requests them from our secretary by:

Nothing on our website should be considered incorporated by reference in this report.

ITEM 1A.    RISK FACTORS

        You should carefully consider the following information, together with the other information contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the only ones we face. However, these are the risks our management believes are material. Additional risks not presently known to us or that we currently deem immaterial may also impair our business or results of operations. Any of the risks described below could result in a significant or material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition.


Risks Related to Our Company

A downgrade of the financial strength or financial enhancement ratings of any of our insurance subsidiaries would adversely affect our business and prospects and, consequently, our results of operations and financial condition.

        Financial strength ratings are an important factor in establishing the competitive position of financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance companies. The objective of these ratings is to provide an opinion of an insurer's financial strength and ability to meet ongoing obligations to its policyholders. Ratings reflect the rating agencies' opinions of our financial strength, and are neither evaluations directed to investors in our common shares nor recommendations to buy, sell or hold our common shares.

50


Table of Contents

        As of the date of this Form 10-K, our insurance company subsidiaries have been assigned the following insurance financial strength ratings:

 
  Moody's   S&P   Fitch

Assured Guaranty Corp

    Aa2(Excellent)     AAA(Extremely Strong)     AAA(Extremely Strong)

Assured Guaranty Re Ltd

    Aa3(Excellent)     AA(Very Strong)     AA(Very Strong)

Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd

    Aa3(Excellent)     AA(Very Strong)     AA(Very Strong)

Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company

    Aa3(Excellent)     AA(Very Strong)     AA(Very Strong)

Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd

    Aa2(Excellent)     AAA(Extremely Strong)     AAA(Extremely Strong)

        "Aa2" (Excellent) is the third highest ranking and "Aa3" (Excellent) is the fourth highest ranking of 21 ratings categories used by Moody's Investors Service ("Moody's"). A "AAA" (Extremely Strong) rating is the highest ranking and "AA" (Very Strong) is the third highest ranking of the 21 ratings categories used by Standard & Poor's Inc. ("S&P"). "AAA" (Extremely Strong) is the highest ranking and "AA" (Very Strong) is the third highest ranking of the 24 ratings categories used by Fitch Ratings ("Fitch"). An insurance financial strength rating is an opinion with respect to an insurer's ability to pay under its insurance policies and contracts in accordance with their terms. The opinion is not specific to any particular policy or contract. Insurance financial strength ratings do not refer to an insurer's ability to meet non-insurance obligations and are not a recommendation to purchase or discontinue any policy or contract issued by an insurer or to buy, hold, or sell any security issued by an insurer, including our common shares.

        The major rating agencies have developed and published rating guidelines for rating financial guaranty and mortgage guaranty insurers and reinsurers. The insurance financial strength ratings assigned by S&P, Moody's and Fitch are based upon factors relevant to policyholders and are not directed toward the protection of investors in our common shares. The rating criteria used by the rating agencies in establishing these ratings include consideration of the sufficiency of capital resources to meet projected growth (as well as access to such additional capital as may be necessary to continue to meet applicable capital adequacy standards), the company's overall financial strength, and demonstrated management expertise in financial guaranty and traditional reinsurance, credit analysis, systems development, marketing, capital markets and investment operations. Obligations insured by AGC generally are rated Aa2, AAA and AAA by Moody's, S&P and Fitch, respectively, by virtue of such insurance. These ratings reflect only the views of the respective rating agencies and are subject to revision or withdrawal at any time.

        The rating agencies grant credit to primary companies in their calculations of required capital and single risk limits for reinsurance ceded. The amount of credit is a function of the financial strength rating of the reinsurer. For example, S&P has established the following reinsurance credit for business ceded to a monoline reinsurer, including AG Re and AGRO:

 
  Monoline Reinsurer Rating  
Ceding Company Rating
  AAA   AA   A   BBB  
AAA     100 %   70 %   50 %   n/a  
AA     100 %   75 %   70 %   50 %
A     100 %   80 %   75 %   70 %

        For reinsurance ceded to a multiline reinsurer, S&P has re-examined its methodology for the determination of reinsurance credit. In the course of its examination, S&P considered the effect of having both monoline and multiline companies in the industry, determining that multiline reinsurers had not demonstrated sufficient commitment to participation in the industry and occasionally had handled claims for financial guaranty reinsurance as they handle claims in their other business lines. S&P therefore determined that no rating agency reinsurance credit would be accorded cessions to multiline reinsurance companies that had not demonstrated their willingness and ability to make timely

51


Table of Contents

payment, which willingness and ability is measured by a financial enhancement rating ("FER") from S&P. A financial enhancement rating reflects not only an insurer's perceived ability to pay claims, but also its perceived willingness to pay claims. FERs are assigned by S&P to multiline insurers requesting the rating who meet stringent criteria identifying the company's capacity and willingness to pay claims on a timely basis. S&P has established the following reinsurance credit for business ceded to a multiline reinsurer carrying an FER:

 
  Multiline Reinsurer Rating  
Ceding Company Rating
  AAA   AA   A   BBB  
AAA     95 %   65 %   45 %   n/a  
AA     95 %   70 %   65 %   45 %
A     95 %   75 %   70 %   65 %

        The ratings of AGRO, Assured Guaranty Mortgage and Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. are dependent upon support in the form of keepwell agreements. AG Re provides a keepwell to its subsidiary, AGRO. AGRO provides a keepwell to its subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Mortgage. AGC provides a keepwell to its subsidiary, Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. Pursuant to the terms of these agreements, each of AG Re, AGRO and AGC agrees to provide funds to their respective subsidiaries sufficient for those subsidiaries to meet their obligations.

        The ratings assigned by S&P, Moody's and Fitch to our insurance subsidiaries are subject to periodic review and may be downgraded by one or more of the rating agencies as a result of changes in the views of the rating agencies or adverse developments in our subsidiaries' financial conditions or results of operations due to underwriting or investment losses or other factors. As a result, the ratings assigned to our insurance subsidiaries by any of the rating agencies may change at any time. If the ratings of any of our insurance subsidiaries were reduced below current levels by any of the rating agencies, it could have an adverse effect on the affected subsidiary's competitive position and its prospects for future business opportunities. A downgrade may also reduce the value of the reinsurance we offer, which may no longer be of sufficient economic value for our customers to continue to cede to our subsidiaries at economically viable rates.

        On November 21, 2008, Moody's downgraded the insurance financial strength ratings of AGC and its wholly owned subsidiary, AGUK, to Aa2 from Aaa and also downgraded the insurance financial strength ratings of AG Re and its affiliated insurance operating companies to Aa3 from Aa2. In the same rating action, Moody's downgraded the senior unsecured rating of AGUS and the issuer rating of the ultimate holding company, Assured Guaranty Ltd to A2 from Aa3. Commensurate with these downgrades, Moody's also announced that its ratings outlook for all of Assured's ratings was "stable." As of the date of this filing, the Company's rating outlook is categorized as stable from Moody's, Standard & Poor's Rating Service, a division of McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. ("S&P") and Fitch Ratings ("Fitch").

        If the ratings of any of our insurance subsidiaries were reduced below current levels, we expect it would have an adverse effect on our subsidiary's prospects for future business opportunities. A downgrade may also reduce the value of the reinsurance we offer, which may no longer be of sufficient economic value for our customers to continue to cede to our subsidiaries at economically viable rates.

        With respect to a significant portion of our in-force financial guaranty reinsurance business, in the event that AG Re were downgraded from Aa3 to A1, subject to the terms of each reinsurance agreement, the ceding company may have the right to recapture business ceded to AG Re and assets representing substantially all of the statutory unearned premium and loss reserves (if any) associated with that business. As of December 31, 2008, the statutory unearned premium, which represents deferred revenue to the Company, subject to recapture is approximately $188 million. If this entire amount were recaptured, it would result in a corresponding one-time reduction to net income of

52


Table of Contents


approximately $4 million. With respect to FSA, the right to recapture business can only be exercised if AG Re were downgraded to the A category by more than one rating agency, or below A2/A by any one rating agency. As of December 31, 2008, the statutory unearned premium subject to recapture by this ceding company is approximately $390 million. If this entire amount were recaptured, it would result in a corresponding one-time reduction to net income of approximately $43 million. Alternatively, the ceding company can increase the commissions it charges AG Re for cessions. Any such increase may be retroactive to the date of the cession. As of December 31, 2008, the potential increase in ceding commissions would result in a one-time reduction to net income of approximately $42 million and a higher ceding commission rate going forward which would reduce future earnings. The effect on net income under these scenarios is exclusive of any capital gains or losses that may be realized.

        If a credit derivative is terminated, the Company could be required to make a mark-to-market payment as determined under the ISDA documentation. For example, if AGC's rating were downgraded to A+, under market conditions at December 31, 2008, if the counterparties exercised their right to terminate their credit derivatives, AGC would have been required to make payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $261 million. Further, if AGC's rating was downgraded to a level below BBB- it would have been required to make additional payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $620 million at December 31, 2008. The Company's mark-to-market methodology is, however, not the basis on which any such payment amount would be determined. The process for determining the amount of such payment is set forth in the credit derivative documentation and generally follows market practice for derivative contracts. The actual amounts could be materially larger than the Company's estimate.

        Under a limited number of credit derivative contracts, the Company may be required to post eligible securities as collateral, generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities. The need to post collateral under these transactions is generally based on mark-to-market valuation in excess of contractual thresholds. The particular thresholds decline if the Company's ratings decline. As of December 31, 2008 the Company had pre-IPO transactions with approximately $1.9 billion of par subject to collateral posting due to changes in market value. Of this amount, as of December 31, 2008, the Company posted collateral totaling approximately $157.7 million (including $134.2 million for AGC) based on the unrealized mark-to-market loss position for transactions with two of its counterparties. Any amounts required to be posted as collateral in the future will depend on changes in the market values of these transactions. Additionally, in the event AGC were downgraded below A-, contractual thresholds would be eliminated and the amount of par that could be subject to collateral posting requirements would be $2.4 billion. Based on market values as of December 31, 2008, such a downgrade would have resulted in AGC posting an additional $88.7 million of collateral. Currently no additional collateral posting is required or anticipated for any other transactions.

        The Company's financial strength ratings assigned by S&P and Fitch were affirmed on June 18, 2008 and December 12, 2007, respectively. Management is uncertain what, if any, impact Moody's ratings actions will have on the Company's financial strength ratings from S&P and Fitch.

        A downgrade may also negatively impact the affected company's ability to write new business or negotiate favorable terms on new business.

If the current difficult conditions in the national and world-wide financial markets continue for an extended period or intensify, our business, liquidity, financial condition and stock price may be adversely affected.

        The volatility and disruption in the global financial markets have reached unprecedented levels. The availability and cost of credit has been materially affected. These factors, combined with volatile oil prices, depressed home prices and increasing foreclosures, falling equity market values, declining business and consumer confidence and the risks of increased inflation and unemployment, have precipitated an economic slowdown and fears of a severe recession. These conditions may adversely affect our profitability, financial position, investment portfolio, cash flow, statutory capital and stock price.

53


Table of Contents

        Issuers or borrowers whose securities or loans we hold and counterparties under swaps and other derivative contracts may default on their obligations to us due to bankruptcy, insolvency, lack of liquidity, adverse economic conditions, operational failure, fraud or other reasons. Additionally, the underlying assets supporting our structured securities may deteriorate causing these securities to incur losses. These losses could be significantly more than we expect and could materially adversely impact the Company's financial strength, ratings and prospects for future business.

        The Company's access to funds under its credit facilities is dependent on the ability of the banks that are parties to the facilities to meet their funding commitments. Those banks may not be able to meet their funding commitments to the Company if they experience shortages of capital and liquidity or if they experience excessive volumes of borrowing requests from the Company and other borrowers within a short period of time. In addition, consolidation of financial institutions could lead to an increased credit risk.

We may require additional capital in the future, including soft capital and liquidity, which may not be available or may be available only on unfavorable terms.

        Our capital requirements depend on many factors, including our in force book of business and rating agency capital requirements. To the extent that our existing capital is insufficient to meet these requirements and/or cover losses, we may need to raise additional funds through financings or curtail our growth and reduce our assets. The Company's access to external sources of financing, as well as the cost of such financing, is dependent on various factors, including market supply of such financing, the long term debt ratings of the Company and the insurance financial strength ratings and the perceptions of the financial strength of the Company and its insurance subsidiaries. Our debt ratings are influenced by numerous factors, either in absolute terms or relative to our peer group, such as financial leverage, balance sheet strength, capital structure and earnings trends. The current adverse conditions in the credit markets have generally restricted the supply of external sources of financing and increased the cost of such financing when it is available. Equity financings could result in dilution to our shareholders and the securities may have rights, preferences and privileges that are senior to those of our common shares. If our need for capital arises because of significant losses, the occurrence of these losses may make it more difficult for us to raise the necessary capital.

        Financial guaranty insurers and reinsurers typically rely on providers of lines of credit, credit swap facilities and similar capital support mechanisms (often referred to as "soft capital") to supplement their "hard capital." The ratings of soft capital providers directly affect the level of capital credit which the rating agencies attribute to the financial guaranty insurer or reinsurer when rating its financial strength. We intend to maintain soft capital facilities with providers having ratings adequate to provide the desired capital credit, although no assurance can be given that one or more of the rating agencies will not downgrade or withdraw the applicable ratings of such providers in the future. In addition, we cannot assure you that an acceptable replacement provider would be available in that event.

        We require liquidity in order to pay our operating expenses, interest on our debt and dividends on our common shares, and to make capital investments in our operating subsidiaries. We anticipate that our need for liquidity will be met by (1) the ability of our operating subsidiaries to pay dividends or to make other payments to us, (2) external financings and (3) investment income from our invested assets. Some of our subsidiaries are subject to legal and rating agency restrictions on their ability to pay dividends and make other permitted payments, and external financing may or may not be available to us in the future on satisfactory terms. Our other subsidiaries are subject to legal restrictions on their ability to pay dividends and distributions. See "Business—Regulation." While we believe that we will have sufficient liquidity to satisfy our needs over the next 12 months, there can be no assurance that adverse market conditions, changes in insurance regulatory law or changes in general economic condition that adversely affect our liquidity will not occur. Similarly, there can be no assurance that adequate liquidity will be available to us on favorable terms in the future.

        Liquidity at our operating subsidiaries is used to pay operating expenses, claims, payment obligations with respect to credit derivatives, reinsurance premiums and dividends to Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. for debt service and dividends to us, as well as, where appropriate, to make capital investments in their own subsidiaries. While we believe that the operating cash flows of our subsidiaries will be sufficient to meet their needs, we cannot assure you that this will be the case, nor can we assure you that existing liquidity facilities will prove adequate to their needs, or be available to them on favorable terms in the future.

54


Table of Contents

An increase in our subsidiaries' risk-to-capital ratio or leverage ratio may prevent them from writing new insurance.

        Rating agencies and insurance regulatory authorities impose capital requirements on our insurance subsidiaries. These capital requirements, which include risk-to-capital ratios, leverage ratios and surplus requirements, limit the amount of insurance that our subsidiaries may write. Our insurance subsidiaries have several alternatives available to control their risk-to-capital ratios and leverage ratios, including obtaining capital contributions from us, purchasing reinsurance or entering into other loss mitigation agreements, or reducing the amount of new business written. However, a material reduction in the statutory capital and surplus of a subsidiary, whether resulting from underwriting or investment losses or otherwise, or a disproportionate increase in the amount of risk in force, could increase a subsidiary's risk-to-capital ratio or leverage ratio. This in turn could require that subsidiary to obtain reinsurance for existing business (which may not be available, or may be available on terms that we consider unfavorable), or add to its capital base to maintain its financial strength ratings. Failure to maintain such ratings could limit that subsidiary's ability to write new business.

Our reinsurance business is primarily dependent on facultative cessions and portfolio opportunities which may not be available to us in the future.

        In prior years we have derived a substantial portion of our revenues from financial guaranty reinsurance premiums. During 2008, there has been a reduction of direct financial guaranty business underwritten by our principal ceding companies and a reduction in the amount of reinsurance they utilize. As a result, reinsurance treaty business has declined and we are more dependent on facultative cessions and opportunities to assume financial guaranty portfolios. These facultative cessions and portfolio opportunities may decline or may not be available to us in the future, which would have an adverse effect on our reinsurance business.

        Additionally, our ability to receive profitable pricing for our reinsurance depends largely on prices charged by the primary insurers for their insurance coverage and the amount of ceding commissions paid by us to these primary insurers.

Recent adverse developments in the credit and financial guaranty markets have substantially increased uncertainty in our business and may materially and adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and future business.

        Since mid-2007 there have been adverse developments in the credit and financial guaranty markets. U.S. RMBS transactions issued in recent years are now expected to absorb mortgage losses far higher than originally expected by purchasers of these securities and financial guarantors which guaranteed such securities. This poor performance has led to price declines for RMBS securities and the rating agencies downgrading thousands of such transactions. The recent credit crisis has substantially reduced the demand for our structured finance guaranties. These market conditions may also adversely affect the Company in a number of ways, including requiring us to raise and hold more capital, reduce the demand for our direct guaranties or reinsurance, limit the types of guaranties we offer, encourage new competitors, make losses harder to estimate, make our results more volatile and make it harder to raise new capital.

Actions taken by the rating agencies with respect to capital models and rating methodology of our business or transactions within our insured portfolio may adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

        Changes in the rating agencies' capital models and rating methodology with respect to financial guaranty insurers and the risks in our investment portfolio and insured portfolio could require us to hold more capital against specified credit risks in the insured portfolio. For example, the rating agencies have recently made changes to their capital models and rating methodology in response to the

55


Table of Contents


deterioration in the performance of certain securities. There can be no assurance that capital will be available to us on favorable terms and conditions or at all, and the failure to raise such capital could have an adverse impact on our business, results of operations and financial condition. The rating agencies may also decide to change their rating scale for financial guaranty insurers or for the obligations that we insure. A change in the ratings methodology for financial guaranty insurers could mean that AGC and AG Re could have lower ratings even if there was no adverse change in their financial conditions. A change in the ratings methodology for the credits that we insure could result in us requiring more capital to maintain our current ratings levels.

        Individual credits in our insured portfolio (including potential new credits) are assessed a rating agency "capital charge" based on a variety of factors, including the nature of the credits, their underlying ratings, their tenor and their expected and actual performance. Factors influencing rating agencies' actions are beyond management's control and are not always known to us. In the event of an actual or perceived deterioration in creditworthiness, a reduction in the underlying rating or a change in the rating agency capital methodology, the rating agencies may require us to increase the amount of capital allocated to support the affected credits, regardless of whether losses actually occur, or against potential new business. Significant reductions in underlying ratings of credits in our insured portfolio can produce significant increases in assessed "capital charges", which may require us to seek additional capital. There can be no assurance that our capital position will be adequate to meet such increased reserve requirements or that we will be able to secure additional capital, especially at a time of actual or perceived deterioration in creditworthiness of new or existing credits. Unless we are able to increase its amount of available capital, an increase in capital charges could reduce the amount of capital available to support our ratings and could have an adverse effect on our ability to write new business.

        In recent months Fitch, Moody's and S&P have announced the downgrade of, or other negative ratings actions with respect to, a large number of structured finance transactions, including certain transactions that we insure. There can be no assurance that additional securities in our insured portfolio will not be reviewed and downgraded in the future. Moreover, we do not know what portion of the securities in our insured portfolio already have been reviewed by the rating agencies and if, and when, the rating agencies might review additional securities in our insured portfolio or review again securities that have already been reviewed and/or downgraded. Downgrades of credits that we insure will result in higher capital charges to us under the relevant rating agency model or models. If the additional amount of capital required to support such exposures is significant, we could be required to raise additional capital, if available, on terms and conditions that may not be favorable to us, curtail current business writings, or pay to transfer a portion of our in-force business to generate capital for ratings purposes with the goal of maintaining our ratings or suffer ratings downgrades. Such events or actions could adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition, ability to write new business or competitive positioning.

Loss reserve estimates are subject to uncertainties and loss reserves may not be adequate to cover potential paid claims.

        The financial guaranties issued by us insure the financial performance of the obligations guaranteed over an extended period of time, in some cases over 30 years, under policies that we have, in most circumstances, no right to cancel. As a result of the lack of statistical paid loss data due to the low level of paid claims in our financial guaranty business and in the financial guaranty industry in general, particularly, until recently, in the structured asset-backed area, we do not use traditional actuarial approaches to determine loss reserves. The establishment of the appropriate level of loss reserves is an inherently subjective process involving numerous estimates, assumptions and judgments by management, using both internal and external data sources with regard to frequency and severity of loss. Actual losses will ultimately depend on events or transaction performance that will occur in the future. Therefore, there can be no assurance that actual paid claims in our insured portfolio will not exceed our loss reserves. This uncertainty has substantially increased in recent months, especially for

56


Table of Contents


RMBS transactions. Current expected losses in subprime, Alt-A, Closed-End Second and HELOC RMBS transactions, as well as other real-estate related transactions, are far worse than originally expected and in many cases far worse than the worst historical losses. As a result, historical loss data may have limited value in predicting future RMBS losses. There can be no assurance that current estimates of probable and estimable losses reflect the actual losses that we may ultimately incur. Actual paid claims could exceed our estimate and could significantly exceed our loss reserves, which may result in adverse effects on our financial condition, ratings and ability to raise needed capital.

Our financial guaranty products may subject us to significant risks from individual or correlated credits.

        We could be exposed to corporate credit risk if the credit's securities are contained in a portfolio of collateralized debt obligations ("CDOs") we insure, or if it is the originator or servicer of loans or other assets backing structured securities that we have insured. A CDO is a debt security backed by a pool of debt obligations. While we track our aggregate exposure to single names in our various lines of business and have established underwriting criteria to manage risk aggregations, there can be no assurance that our ultimate exposure to a single name will not exceed our underwriting guidelines, or that an event with respect to a single name will not cause a significant loss. In addition, because we insure or reinsure municipal bonds, we can have significant exposures to single municipal risks. While the risk of a complete loss, where we pay the entire principal amount of an issue of bonds and interest thereon with no recovery, is generally lower than for corporate credits as most municipal bonds are backed by tax or other revenues, there can be no assurance that a single default by a municipality would not have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition.

        We are exposed to correlation risk across the various assets we insure. During strong periods of macro economic performance, stress in an individual transaction generally occurs in a single asset class or for idiosyncratic reason. During a broad economic downturn, a broader range of our insured portfolio could be exposed to stress at the same time. This stress may manifest itself in downgrades, which may require more capital, or in actual losses.

Some of our direct financial guaranty products may be riskier than traditional financial guaranty insurance.

        A substantial portion of our financial guaranty direct exposures have been assumed as credit derivatives. Traditional financial guaranty insurance provides an unconditional and irrevocable guaranty that protects the holder of a municipal finance or structured finance obligation against non payment of principal and interest, while credit derivatives provide protection from the occurrence of specified credit events, including non payment of principal and interest. In general, the Company structures credit derivative transactions such that circumstances giving rise to our obligation to make payments is similar to that for financial guaranty policies and generally occurs as losses are realized on the underlying reference obligation. Nonetheless, credit derivative transactions are governed by International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. ("ISDA") documentation and operate differently from financial guaranty insurance policies. For example, the Company's control rights with respect to a reference obligation under a credit derivative may be more limited than when the Company issues a financial guaranty insurance policy on a direct primary basis. In addition, while the Company's exposure under credit derivatives, like the Company's exposure under financial guaranty insurance policies, has been generally for as long as the reference obligation remains outstanding, unlike financial guaranty insurance policies, a credit derivative may be terminated for a breach of the ISDA documentation or other specific events. In some older credit derivative transactions, one such specified event is the failure of AGC to maintain specified financial strength ratings ranging from AA- to BBB-. If a credit derivative is terminated, the Company could be required to make a mark-to-market payment as determined under the ISDA documentation. For example, if AGC's rating were downgraded to A+, under market conditions at December 31, 2008, if the counterparties exercised their right to terminate their credit derivatives, AGC would have been required to make payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $261 million. Further, if AGC's rating was downgraded to a level below BBB- it

57


Table of Contents


would have been required to make additional payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $620 million at December 31, 2008. The Company's mark-to-market methodology is, however, not the basis on which any such payment amount would be determined. The process for determining the amount of such payment is set forth in the credit derivative documentation and generally follows market practice for derivative contracts. The actual amounts could be materially larger than the Company's estimate.

        Under a limited number of credit derivative contracts, the Company is required to post eligible securities as collateral, generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities. The need to post collateral under these transactions is generally based on mark-to-market valuation in excess of contractual thresholds. The particular thresholds decline if the Company's ratings decline. As of December 31, 2008 the Company had pre-IPO transactions with approximately $1.9 billion of par subject to collateral posting due to changes in market value. Of this amount, as of December 31, 2008, the Company posted collateral totaling approximately $157.7 million (including $134.2 million for AGC) based on the unrealized mark-to-market loss position for transactions with two of its counterparties. Any amounts required to be posted as collateral in the future will depend on changes in the market values of these transactions. Additionally, in the event AGC were downgraded below A-, contractual thresholds would be eliminated and the amount of par that could be subject to collateral posting requirements would be $2.4 billion. Based on market values as of December 31, 2008, such a downgrade would have resulted in AGC posting an additional $88.7 million of collateral. Currently no additional collateral posting is required or anticipated for any other transactions.

Competition in our industry may adversely affect our revenues.

        The principal sources of direct and indirect competition are other financial guaranty insurance companies and other forms of credit enhancement, which include structural enhancement, letters of credit, and credit derivatives provided by foreign and domestic banks and other financial institutions, some of which are governmental enterprises.

        Our financial guaranty reinsurance business is vulnerable to a decline in demand by other financial guaranty insurance companies.

New entrants into the financial guaranty industry could have an adverse effect on our prospects either by furthering price competition or by reducing the aggregate demand for our reinsurance as a result of additional insurance capacity.

        Recently a new financial guaranty insurer has been licensed to operate in New York and the New York State Insurance Superintendent is encouraging other insurance regulators to rapidly license this new financial guaranty insurer. Increased competition, either in terms of price, alternative structures, or the emergence of new providers of credit enhancement, could have an adverse effect on our business.

We are dependent on key executives and the loss of any of these executives, or our inability to retain other key personnel, could adversely affect our business.

        Our success substantially depends upon our ability to attract and retain qualified employees and upon the ability of our senior management and other key employees to implement our business strategy. We believe there are only a limited number of available qualified executives in the business lines in which we compete. Although we are not aware of any planned departures, we rely substantially upon the services of Dominic J. Frederico, our President and Chief Executive Officer, and other executives. Although Mr. Frederico and certain other executives have employment agreements with us, we cannot assure you that we will be able to retain their services. The loss of the services of any of these individuals or other key members of our management team could adversely affect the implementation of our business strategy.

58


Table of Contents


Our business could be adversely affected by Bermuda employment restrictions.

        Our location in Bermuda may serve as an impediment to attracting and retaining experienced personnel. Under Bermuda law, non Bermudians, other than spouses of Bermudians and individuals holding permanent resident certificates or working resident certificates, are not permitted to engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without a work permit issued by the Bermuda government. A work permit is only granted or extended if the employer can show that, after a proper public advertisement, no Bermudian, spouse of a Bermudian or individual holding a permanent resident certificate or working resident certificates is available who meets the minimum standards for the position. The Bermuda government's policy places a six year term limit on individuals with work permits, subject to specified exemptions for persons deemed to be key employees. All of our Bermuda based employees who require work permits have been granted permits by the Bermuda government, including our President and Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, General Counsel and Secretary, Chief Accounting Officer, Chief Credit Officer, Chief Surveillance Officer and President of AG Re. It is possible that we could lose the services of one or more of our key employees if we are unable to obtain or renew their work permits.

We may be adversely affected by interest rate changes affecting the performance of our investment portfolio.

        Our operating results are affected, in part, by the performance of our investment portfolio. Changes in interest rates could also have an adverse effect on our investment income. For example, if interest rates decline, funds reinvested will earn less than expected. Our investment portfolio contains interest rate-sensitive instruments, such as bonds, which may be adversely affected by changes in interest rates. Increases in interest rates will reduce the value of these securities, resulting in unrealized losses that we are required to include in shareholder's equity as a change in accumulated other comprehensive income. Accordingly, interest rate increases could reduce our shareholder's equity. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Critical Accounting Policies—Valuation of Investments."

        In addition, our investment portfolio includes mortgage-backed securities. As of December 31, 2008, mortgage-backed securities constituted approximately 29% of our invested assets. As with other fixed maturity investments, the fair market value of these securities fluctuates depending on market and other general economic conditions and the interest rate environment. Changes in interest rates can expose us to significant prepayment risks on these investments. In periods of declining interest rates, mortgage prepayments generally increase and mortgage-backed securities are prepaid more quickly, requiring us to reinvest the proceeds at then-current market rates. During periods of rising interest rates, the frequency of prepayments generally decreases. Mortgage-backed securities having an amortized value less than par (i.e., purchased at a discount) may incur a decrease in yield or a loss as a result of slower prepayment.

        Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors, including monetary policies, domestic and international economic and political conditions and other factors beyond our control. We do not engage in active management, or hedging, of interest rate risk, and may not be able to mitigate interest rate sensitivity effectively.

The performance of our invested assets affects our results of operations and cash flows.

        Income from our investment portfolio is one of the primary sources of cash flows supporting our operations and claim payments. For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, our net investment income was $162.6 million, $128.1 million and $111.5 million, respectively, in each case exclusive of net realized gains (losses) and unrealized gains (losses) on investments. If our calculations with respect to our policy liabilities are incorrect, or if we improperly structure our investments to meet these liabilities, we could have unexpected losses, including losses resulting from forced liquidation of investments before their maturity. The investment policies of our insurance subsidiaries are subject to

59


Table of Contents


insurance law requirements, and may change depending upon regulatory, economic and market conditions and the existing or anticipated financial condition and operating requirements, including the tax position, of our businesses.

        We have retained BlackRock Financial Management ("BlackRock") to manage our investment portfolio. The performance of our invested assets is subject to their performance in selecting and managing appropriate investments. BlackRock has discretionary authority over our investment portfolio within the limits of our investment guidelines.

Our net income may be volatile because a portion of the credit risk we assume is in the form of credit derivatives that are accounted for under FAS 133/149/155, which requires that these instruments be marked-to-market quarterly.

        Any event causing credit spreads (i.e., the difference in interest rates between comparable securities having different credit risk) on an underlying security referenced in a credit derivative in our portfolio either to widen or to tighten will affect the fair value of the credit derivative and may increase the volatility of our earnings. Derivatives must be accounted for either as assets or liabilities on the balance sheet and measured at fair market value. Although there is no cash flow effect from this "marking to market," net changes in the fair market value of the derivative are reported in our statement of operations and therefore will affect our reported earnings. If the derivative is held to maturity and no credit loss is incurred, any gains or losses previously reported would be offset by corresponding gains or losses at maturity. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Critical Accounting Policies—Fair Value of Credit Derivatives ." Due to the complexity of fair value accounting and the application of FAS 133/149/155, future amendments or interpretations of these accounting standards may cause us to modify our accounting methodology in a manner which may have an adverse impact on our financial results.

        Common events that may cause credit spreads on an underlying municipal or corporate security referenced in a credit derivative to fluctuate include changes in the state of national or regional economic conditions, industry cyclicality, changes to a company's competitive position within an industry, management changes, changes in the ratings of the underlying security, movements in interest rates, default or failure to pay interest, or any other factor leading investors to revise expectations about the issuer's ability to pay principal and interest on its debt obligations. Similarly, common events that may cause credit spreads on an underlying structured security referenced in a credit derivative to fluctuate may include the occurrence and severity of collateral defaults, changes in demographic trends and their impact on the levels of credit enhancement, rating changes, changes in interest rates or prepayment speeds, or any other factor leading investors to revise expectations about the risk of the collateral or the ability of the servicer to collect payments on the underlying assets sufficient to pay principal and interest.

Changes in tax laws could reduce the demand or profitability of financial guaranty insurance, or negatively impact our investment portfolio.

        Any material change in the U.S. tax treatment of municipal securities, the imposition of a national sales tax in lieu of the current federal income tax structure in the United States, or changes in the treatment of dividends, could adversely affect the market for municipal obligations and, consequently, reduce the demand for financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance of such obligations.

        Changes in U.S. federal, state or local laws that materially adversely affect the tax treatment of municipal securities or the market for those securities, or other changes negatively affecting the municipal securities market, also may adversely impact our investment portfolio, a significant portion of which is invested in tax-exempt instruments. These adverse changes may adversely affect the value of our tax-exempt portfolio, or its liquidity.

60


Table of Contents


Regulatory change could adversely affect our ability to enter into future business.

        Future legislative, regulatory or judicial changes in the jurisdictions regulating our Company may adversely affect our ability to pursue our current mix of business, materially impacting our financial results.

        The perceived decline in the financial strength of many financial guaranty insurers has caused a number of government officials to question the breadth and complexity of some of the securities guaranteed by financial guaranty insurers. For example, the New York State Insurance Department has announced that it is working to develop new rules and regulations for the financial guaranty industry. On September 22, 2008, the New York State Insurance Department (the "Department") issued Circular Letter No. 19 (2008) (the "Circular Letter"), which establishes best practices guidelines for financial guaranty insurers effective January 1, 2009. The Department plans to propose legislation and regulations to formalize these guidelines. These guidelines and the related legislation and regulations may limit the amount of new structured finance business that AGC is able to write in future periods. At this time it is not possible to predict if any such new rules will be implemented or, if implemented, the content of the new rules.

        In addition, perceived problems in the credit derivative markets have led to calls for further regulation of credit derivatives at the state or federal level. Changes in the regulation of credit derivatives could materially impact the market demand for derivatives and/or our ability to enter into derivative transactions.

        Actions taken at the federal level in response to the current recession could materially affect the Company's business. Such risks include:

Our ability to meet our obligations may be constrained by our holding company structure.

        Assured Guaranty is a holding company and, as such, has no direct operations of its own. We do not expect to have any significant operations or assets other than our ownership of the shares of our subsidiaries. Dividends and other permitted payments from our operating subsidiaries are expected to be our primary source of funds to meet ongoing cash requirements, including any future debt service payments and other expenses, and to pay dividends to our shareholders. Our insurance subsidiaries are subject to regulatory and rating agency restrictions limiting their ability to declare and to pay dividends and make other payments to us. In addition, to the extent that dividends are paid from our U.S. subsidiaries, they presently would be subject to U.S. withholding tax at a rate of 30%. The inability of our insurance subsidiaries to pay sufficient dividends and make other permitted payments to us would have an adverse effect on our ability to satisfy our ongoing cash requirements and on our ability to pay dividends to our shareholders. If we do not pay dividends, the only return on your investment in our Company, if at all, would come from any appreciation in the price of our common shares. For more information regarding these limitations, see "Business—Regulation."

Our ability to pay dividends may be constrained by certain regulatory requirements and restrictions.

        We are subject to Bermuda regulatory constraints that will affect our ability to pay dividends on our common shares and to make other payments. Under the Bermuda Companies Act 1981, as amended (the "Companies Act"), we may declare or pay a dividend out of distributable reserves only (1) if we have reasonable grounds for believing that we are, and after the payment would be, able to

61


Table of Contents


pay our liabilities as they become due and (2) if the realizable value of our assets would not be less than the aggregate of our liabilities and issued share capital and share premium accounts. While we currently intend to pay dividends, if you require dividend income you should carefully consider these risks before investing in our company. For more information regarding restrictions on our ability to pay dividends, see "Business—Regulation."

There are provisions in our Bye-Laws that may reduce or increase the voting rights of our common shares.

        If, and so long as, the common shares of a shareholder are treated as "controlled shares" (as determined under section 958 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code")) of any U.S. Person (as defined in "Tax Matters—Taxation of Shareholders") and such controlled shares constitute 9.5% or more of the votes conferred by our issued shares, the voting rights with respect to the controlled shares of such U.S. Person (a "9.5% U.S. Shareholder") shall be limited, in the aggregate, to a voting power of less than 9.5%, under a formula specified in our Bye-Laws. The formula is applied repeatedly until the voting power of all 9.5% U.S. Shareholders has been reduced to less than 9.5%. In addition, our Board of Directors may limit a shareholder's voting rights where it deems appropriate to do so to (1) avoid the existence of any 9.5% U.S. Shareholders, and (2) avoid certain material adverse tax, legal or regulatory consequences to us or any of our subsidiaries or any shareholder or its affiliates. "Controlled shares" include, among other things, all shares of Assured Guaranty that such U.S. Person is deemed to own directly, indirectly or constructively (within the meaning of section 958 of the Code).

        Under these provisions, certain shareholders may have their voting rights limited to less than one vote per share, while other shareholders may have voting rights in excess of one vote per share. Moreover, these provisions could have the effect of reducing the votes of certain shareholders who would not otherwise be subject to the 9.5% limitation by virtue of their direct share ownership. Our Bye-Laws provide that shareholders will be notified of their voting interests prior to any vote taken by them.

        As a result of any reallocation of votes, your voting rights might increase above 5% of the aggregate voting power of the outstanding common shares, thereby possibly resulting in your becoming a reporting person subject to Schedule 13D or 13G filing requirements under the Exchange Act of 1934 (the "Exchange Act"). In addition, the reallocation of your votes could result in your becoming subject to the short swing profit recovery and filing requirements under Section 16 of the Exchange Act.

        We also have the authority under our Bye-Laws to request information from any shareholder for the purpose of determining whether a shareholder's voting rights are to be reallocated under the Bye-Laws. If a shareholder fails to respond to our request for information or submits incomplete or inaccurate information in response to a request by us, we may, in our sole discretion, eliminate such shareholder's voting rights.

There are provisions in our Bye-Laws that may restrict the ability to transfer common shares, and that may require shareholders to sell their common shares.

        Our Board of Directors may decline to approve or register a transfer of any common shares (1) if it appears to the Board of Directors, after taking into account the limitations on voting rights contained in our Bye-Laws, that any adverse tax, regulatory or legal consequences to us, any of our subsidiaries or any of our shareholders may occur as a result of such transfer (other than such as the Board of Directors considers to be de minimis), or (2) subject to any applicable requirements of or commitments to the New York Stock Exchange, if a written opinion from counsel supporting the legality of the transaction under U.S. securities laws has not been provided or if any required governmental approvals have not been obtained.

        Our Bye-Laws also provide that if our Board of Directors determines that share ownership by a person may result in adverse tax, legal or regulatory consequences to us, any of our subsidiaries or any

62


Table of Contents


of our shareholders (other than such as the Board of Directors considers to be de minimis), then we have the option, but not the obligation, to require that shareholder to sell to us or to third parties to whom we assign the repurchase right for fair market value the minimum number of common shares held by such person which is necessary to eliminate such adverse tax, legal or regulatory consequences. See "Description of Share Capital."

Applicable insurance laws may make it difficult to effect a change of control of the Company.

        Before a person can acquire control of a U.S. insurance company, prior written approval must be obtained from the insurance commissioner of the state where the domestic insurer is domiciled. See "Regulation—Change of Control." Because a person acquiring 10% or more of our common shares would indirectly control the same percentage of the stock of our U.S. insurance company subsidiaries, the insurance change of control laws of Maryland and New York would likely apply to such a transaction.

        These laws may discourage potential acquisition proposals and may delay, deter or prevent a change of control of our company, including through transactions, and in particular unsolicited transactions, that some or all of our shareholders might consider to be desirable.

        While our Bye-Laws limit the voting power of any shareholder (other than ACE) to less than 10%, there can be no assurance that the applicable regulatory body would agree that a shareholder who owned 10% or more of our common shares did not, notwithstanding the limitation on the voting power of such shares, control the applicable insurance company subsidiary.

Some reinsurance agreement terms may make it difficult to effect a change of control of the Company

        Some of our reinsurance agreements have change of control provisions that are triggered if a third party acquires a designated percentage of our shares. If these change of control provisions are triggered, the ceding company may recapture some or all of the reinsurance business ceded to us in the past. Any such recapture could adversely affect our future income or ratings. These provisions may discourage potential acquisition proposals and may delay, deter or prevent a change of control of our Company, including through transactions that some or all of our shareholders might consider to be desirable.

Anti-takeover provisions in our Bye-Laws could impede an attempt to replace or remove our directors, which could diminish the value of our common shares.

        Our Bye-Laws contain provisions that may make it more difficult for shareholders to replace directors even if the shareholders consider it beneficial to do so. In addition, these provisions could delay or prevent a change of control that a shareholder might consider favorable. For example, these provisions may prevent a shareholder from receiving the benefit from any premium over the market price of our common shares offered by a bidder in a potential takeover. Even in the absence of an attempt to effect a change in management or a takeover attempt, these provisions may adversely affect the prevailing market price of our common shares if they are viewed as discouraging takeover attempts in the future.

Our foreign companies other than AGRO may be subject to U.S. tax.

        We intend to manage our business so that Assured Guaranty, AG Re, AGFOL, and Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. will operate in such a manner that none of them should be subject to U.S. federal tax (other than U.S. excise tax on insurance and reinsurance premium income attributable to insuring or reinsuring U.S. risks, and U.S. withholding tax on certain U.S. source investment income). However, because there is considerable uncertainty as to the activities which constitute being engaged in a trade or business within the United States, we cannot be certain that the IRS will not contend successfully that Assured Guaranty or any of our foreign subsidiaries is/are engaged in a trade or business in the

63


Table of Contents


United States. If Assured Guaranty , AG Re, AGFOL, or Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. were considered to be engaged in a trade or business in the United States, each such company could be subject to U.S. corporate income and branch profits taxes on the portion of its earnings effectively connected to such U.S. business. See "Tax Matters—Taxation of Assured Guaranty and Subsidiaries—United States."

We may become subject to taxes in Bermuda after 2016, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and on your investment.

        The Bermuda Minister of Finance, under Bermuda's Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act 1966, as amended, has given Assured Guaranty, AGC, AG Re and AGRO an assurance that if any legislation is enacted in Bermuda that would impose tax computed on profits or income, or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax, then subject to certain limitations the imposition of any such tax will not be applicable to Assured Guaranty, AGC or our Bermuda Subsidiaries, or any of our or their operations, shares, debentures or other obligations until 2016. See "Tax Matters—Taxation of Assured Guaranty and Subsidiaries—Bermuda." Given the limited duration of the Minister of Finance's assurance, we cannot be certain that we will not be subject to Bermuda tax after 2016.

U.S. Persons who hold 10% or more of our shares directly or through foreign entities may be subject to taxation under the CFC rules.

        Each 10% U.S. Shareholder of a foreign corporation that is a CFC for an uninterrupted period of 30 days or more during a taxable year, and who owns shares in the foreign corporation directly or indirectly through foreign entities on the last day of the foreign corporation's taxable year on which it is a CFC, must include in its gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its pro rata share of the CFC's "subpart F income," even if the subpart F income is not distributed. See "Tax Matters—Taxation of Shareholders—United States Taxation."

        We believe that because of the dispersion of our share ownership, provisions in our Bye-Laws that limit voting power and other factors, no U.S. Person who owns our common shares directly or indirectly through foreign entities should be treated as a 10% U.S. Shareholder of us or of any of our foreign subsidiaries. It is possible, however, that the IRS could challenge the effectiveness of these provisions and that a court could sustain such a challenge.

U.S. Persons who hold shares may be subject to U.S. income taxation at ordinary income rates on their proportionate share of our RPII.

        If the gross RPII of AG Re was to equal or exceed 20% of AG Re's gross insurance income in any taxable year and direct or indirect insureds (and persons related to such insureds) own (or are treated as owning directly or indirectly through entities) 20% or more of the voting power or value of our shares, then a U.S. Person who owns our shares (directly or indirectly through foreign entities) on the last day of the taxable year would be required to include in its income for U.S. federal income tax purposes such person's pro rata share of AG Re's RPII for the entire taxable year, determined as if such RPII were distributed proportionately only to U.S. Persons at that date, regardless of whether such income is distributed. In addition, any RPII that is includible in the income of a U.S. tax-exempt organization may be treated as unrelated business taxable income. The amount of RPII earned by AG Re (generally, premium and related investment income from the direct or indirect insurance or reinsurance of any direct or indirect U.S. holder of shares or any person related to such holder) will depend on a number of factors, including the geographic distribution of AG Re's business and the identity of persons directly or indirectly insured or reinsured by AG Re. We believe AG Re did not in prior years of operation and should not in the foreseeable future have either RPII income which equals or exceeds 20% of gross insurance income or have direct or indirect insureds, as provided for by RPII rules, of AG Re (and related persons) directly or indirectly own 20% or more of either the voting

64


Table of Contents


power or value of our shares. However, we cannot be certain that this will be the case because some of the factors which determine the extent of RPII may be beyond our control.

U.S. Persons who dispose of our shares may be subject to U.S. income taxation at ordinary income tax rates in a portion of their gain, if any.

        The RPII rules provide that if a U.S. Person disposes of shares in a foreign insurance corporation in which U.S. Persons own 25% or more of the shares (even if the amount of gross RPII is less than 20% of the corporation's gross insurance income and the ownership of its shares by direct or indirect insureds and related persons is less than the 20% threshold), any gain from the disposition will generally be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the holder's share of the corporation's undistributed earnings and profits that were accumulated during the period that the holder owned the shares (whether or not such earnings and profits are attributable to RPII). In addition, such a holder will be required to comply with certain reporting requirements, regardless of the amount of shares owned by the holder. These RPII rules should not apply to dispositions of our shares because we will not ourselves be directly engaged in the insurance business; however, the RPII provisions have never been interpreted by the courts or the U.S. Treasury Department in final regulations, and regulations interpreting the RPII provisions of the Code exist only in proposed form. It is not certain whether these regulations will be adopted in their proposed form, what changes or clarifications might ultimately be made thereto, or whether any such changes, as well as any interpretation or application of RPII by the IRS, the courts, or otherwise, might have retroactive effect. The U.S. Treasury Department has authority to impose, among other things, additional reporting requirements with respect to RPII. Accordingly, the meaning of the RPII provisions and the application thereof to Assured Guaranty and AG Re is uncertain.

U.S. Persons who hold common shares will be subject to adverse tax consequences if we are considered to be a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

        If Assured Guaranty is considered a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes, a U.S. person who owns any shares of Assured Guaranty will be subject to adverse tax consequences, including subjecting the investor to greater tax liability than might otherwise apply and subjecting the investor to tax on amounts in advance of when tax would otherwise be imposed, which could materially adversely affect your investment. We believe that Assured Guaranty is not, and we currently do not expect Assured Guaranty to become, a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes; however, we cannot assure you that Assured Guaranty will not be deemed a PFIC by the IRS. There are currently no regulations regarding the application of the PFIC provisions to an insurance company. New regulations or pronouncements interpreting or clarifying these rules may be forthcoming. We cannot predict what impact, if any, such guidance would have on an investor that is subject to U.S. federal income taxation.

65


Table of Contents

Changes in U.S. federal income tax law could materially adversely affect an investment in our common shares.

        Legislation has been introduced in the U.S. Congress intended to eliminate certain perceived tax advantages of companies (including insurance companies) that have legal domiciles outside the United States but have certain U.S. connections. For example, legislation has been introduced in Congress to limit the deductibility of reinsurance premiums paid by U.S. companies to foreign affiliates. It is possible that this or similar legislation could be introduced in and enacted by the current Congress or future Congresses that could have an adverse impact on us or our shareholders.

        U.S. federal income tax laws and interpretations regarding whether a company is engaged in a trade or business within the United States, is a PFIC, or whether U.S. Persons would be required to include in their gross income the "subpart F income" of a CFC or RPII are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis. There currently are no regulations regarding the application of the PFIC rules to insurance companies, and the regulations regarding RPII are still in proposed form. New regulations or pronouncements interpreting or clarifying such rules may be forthcoming. We cannot be certain if, when, or in what form such regulations or pronouncements may be implemented or made, or whether such guidance will have a retroactive effect.

The Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development and the European Union are considering measures that might increase our taxes and reduce our net income.

        The Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development (the "OECD") has published reports and launched a global dialogue among member and non-member countries on measures to limit harmful tax competition. These measures are largely directed at counteracting the effects of tax havens and preferential tax regimes in countries around the world. In the OECD's report dated April 18, 2002 and periodically updated Bermuda was not listed as an uncooperative tax haven jurisdiction because it had previously committed to eliminate harmful tax practices and to embrace international tax standards for transparency, exchange of information and the elimination of any aspects of the regimes for financial and other services that attract business with no substantial domestic activity. We are not able to predict what changes will arise from the commitment or whether such changes will subject us to additional taxes.


Risk Factors Related to the Pending Acquisition of Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd.

Loss reserve estimates are subject to uncertainties and loss reserves may not be adequate to cover potential paid claims.

        The financial guarantees issued by Assured and FSA insure the financial performance of the obligations guaranteed over an extended period of time, in some cases over 30 years, under policies that Assured and FSA have, in most circumstances, no right to cancel. The acquisition of FSAH will increase our net par outstanding from approximately $227.3 billion to approximately $651.3 billion. As a result of the lack of statistical paid loss data due to the low level of paid claims in our financial guaranty business and in the financial guaranty industry in general, particularly, until recently, in the structured asset-backed area, we do not use traditional actuarial approaches to determine loss reserves. The establishment of the appropriate level of loss reserves is an inherently subjective process involving numerous estimates, assumptions and judgments by management, using both internal and external data sources with regard to frequency and severity of loss. Actual losses will ultimately depend on events or transaction performance that will occur in the future. Therefore, we cannot assure you that current estimates of probable and estimable losses reflect the actual losses that we may ultimately incur. Actual paid claims could exceed our estimate and could significantly exceed our loss reserves, which may result in adverse effects on our financial condition, ratings and ability to raise needed capital.

66


Table of Contents


We may have exposure through financial guaranty insurance policies to FSAH's financial products business which we are not acquiring.

        FSAH, through its financial products subsidiaries, offers FSA-insured GICs and other investment agreements, including Medium Term Notes ("MTNs"). In connection with the acquisition, FSAH is expected to transfer to Dexia Holdings the ownership interests in certain of its financial products subsidiaries. Even if FSAH no longer owns such financial products subsidiaries, FSA's guarantees of the GICs and MTNs will remain in place. While Dexia Holdings and FSAH have entered into and are entering into a number of agreements pursuant to which Dexia Holdings or other Dexia affiliates will guarantee the assets and liabilities of the GIC subsidiaries for the benefit of FSA (and, if FSAH continues to own Financial Security Asset Management ("FSAM") and the GIC subsidiaries; indemnify Assured for losses arising after the closing of the acquisition from the assets, liabilities, operations and business of the financial products business); FSA may still be subject to certain risks, including credit and liquidity risks, associated with FSAH's financial products business. To the extent FSA is required to pay any amounts on financial products written by FSAH's financial products subsidiaries, FSA will be subject to the risk that it will not receive the guarantee payment from Dexia Holdings or its affiliates before it is required to make the payment under its financial guarantee policies or that it will not receive the guarantee payment at all. See "The Stock Purchase Agreement and Ancillary Agreements—Financial Products Agreements."

We will have substantial credit and liquidity exposure to Dexia.

        Dexia Holdings and its affiliates have entered into and are entering into a number of agreements pursuant to which Dexia Holdings or other Dexia affiliates will guarantee certain amounts, lend certain amounts or lend securities to or in respect of FSAH's financial products business. In addition, Dexia Holdings has agreed (directly or through an affiliate) to provide a liquidity facility to FSAH in respect of the leveraged tax lease debt defeasance business FSAH is retaining. As a result of these various agreements, Assured will be subject to the risk that Dexia Holdings or its various affiliates may not make such amounts or securities available on a timely basis, which is referred to as "liquidity risk," if the beneficiary of the agreement would be required to fund the necessary amounts, or at all, which is referred to as "credit risk," because of the risk of default. Even if Dexia Holdings and its affiliates have sufficient assets to pay all amounts when due, concerns regarding Dexia's financial condition could cause one or more rating agencies to view negatively the ability of Dexia Holdings and its affiliates to perform under their various agreements and could negatively affect FSA's ratings.

        Dexia Holdings and FSAH have entered into and are entering into a number of agreements pursuant to which Dexia Holdings or other Dexia affiliates will guarantee the assets and liabilities of the GIC subsidiaries for the benefit of FSA (and, if FSAH continues to own FSAM and the GIC subsidiaries, indemnify Assured for losses arising after the closing of the acquisition from the assets, liabilities, operations and business of FSAH's financial products business). Dexia has also agreed to post from time to time eligible collateral (other than any assets of FSAM owned as of the closing date) having an aggregate value (subject to customary "haircuts") equal to the excess of (i) the aggregate principal amount of all outstanding GICs over (ii) the aggregate mark-to-market value of FSAM's assets. Under specified circumstances, including issuance of the sovereign guarantees, Dexia will be relieved, in whole or in part, of its obligation to post collateral. See "The Stock Purchase Agreement and Ancillary Agreements—Financial Product Agreements." As of September 30, 2008, the liabilities of FSAH's financial products business exceeded their assets by approximately $4.3 billion (before any tax effects). To the extent FSA is required to pay any amounts in respect of liabilities of FSAH's financial products subsidiaries, FSA will be subject to the risk that it will not receive the guarantee payment from Dexia Holdings or its affiliate before it is required to make the payment under its financial guarantee policy or that it will not receive the guarantee payment at all.

67


Table of Contents

        Dexia Holdings and/or it affiliates have also entered into agreements to:

        All of these agreements are described under "The Stock Purchase Agreement and Ancillary Agreements—Financial Product Agreements—Pre-Existing Agreements."

        Dexia Holdings has agreed to (or cause an affiliate to) provide a liquidity facility for the purpose of covering the liquidity risk arising out of claims payable in respect of "strip coverages" included in FSAH's leveraged tax lease debt defeasance business. The initial commitment under this facility will not exceed $2 billion, subject to adjustment to $1 billion under specified conditions. See "The Stock Purchase Agreement and Ancillary Agreements—Financial Product Agreements—Strip Coverage Liquidity Facility."

Restrictions on the conduct of FSA's business after the closing will limit Assured's operating and financial flexibility.

        Under the stock purchase agreement, Assured has agreed to conduct its business, including the business it acquires from FSAH, subject to certain restraints described under "The Stock Purchase Agreement and Ancillary Agreements—Post-Closing Conduct of Business." These restrictions will generally continue for three years after the closing of the acquisition. Among other things, Assured has agreed that unless FSA is rated below A+, FSA will not write any business except municipal bond and infrastructure bond insurance, whether written directly, assumed, reinsured or occurring through any merger transaction. Assured has also agreed that FSA will not repurchase, redeem or pay any dividends in relation to any class of equity interests unless (i) (A) at such time FSA is rated at least AA- by S&P, AA- by Fitch and Aa3 by Moody's (if such rating agencies still rate financial guaranty insurers generally) and (B) the aggregate amount of such dividends in any year does not exceed $25 million or (ii) FSA receives prior rating agency confirmation that such action would not cause any rating currently assigned to FSA to be downgraded immediately following such action. These agreements will limit Assured's operating and financial flexibility.

Although we expect that the acquisition of FSAH will result in benefits to Assured, we may not realize those benefits because of integration difficulties.

        Integrating the operations of Assured and FSAH successfully or otherwise realizing any of the anticipated benefits of the acquisition of FSAH, including anticipated cost savings and additional revenue opportunities, involve a number of potential challenges. The failure to meet these integration challenges could seriously harm our results of operations and the market price of the Assured common shares may decline as a result.

        Realizing the benefits of the acquisition will depend in part on the integration of information technology, operations and personnel. These integration activities are complex and time-consuming and we may encounter unexpected difficulties or incur unexpected costs, including:

68


Table of Contents

        We may not successfully integrate the operations of Assured and FSAH in a timely manner and we may not realize the anticipated net reductions in costs and expenses and other benefits and synergies of the acquisition of FSAH to the extent, or in the time frame, anticipated. In addition to the integration risks discussed above, our ability to realize these net reductions in costs and expenses and other benefits and synergies could be adversely impacted by practical or legal constraints on our ability to combine operations.

The acquisition of FSAH is subject to the receipt of consents and approvals from government entities that may not be received or that may impose conditions that could have an adverse effect on Assured following the completion of the acquisition.

        We cannot complete the acquisition unless we receive various consents, orders, approvals and clearances from certain regulatory authorities in the United States and elsewhere. While we believe that we will receive the requisite regulatory approvals from these authorities, we cannot assure you of this. In addition, these authorities may impose conditions on the completion of the acquisition of FSAH or require changes to the terms of the acquisition. For example, the authorities may require divestiture of certain assets as a condition to the closing of the acquisition. We are not obligated to agree to divest assets in order to obtain regulatory approval of the proposed acquisition if such divestiture would have a material adverse effect on Assured and its subsidiaries (including FSAH and its subsidiaries (other than the financial products subsidiaries)) taken as a whole after the acquisition. While we do not currently expect that any such conditions or changes would be imposed, we cannot assure you that they will not be, and such conditions or changes could have the effect of delaying completion of the acquisition or imposing additional costs on or limiting the revenues of Assured following the acquisition, any of which may have an adverse effect on us following the acquisition. See "The Transaction—Regulatory Approvals Required for the Transaction" and "The Stock Purchase Agreement—Closing Conditions" for a more detailed discussion.

Subject to certain limitations, Dexia Holdings may sell Assured common shares at any time following the one year anniversary of the acquisition, which could cause our stock price to decrease.

        Dexia Holdings has agreed not to transfer any of the Assured common shares received in connection with the acquisition at any time prior to the one year anniversary of the stock purchase agreement. Assured has agreed to register all of such Assured common shares under the Securities Act. The sale of a substantial number of Assured common shares by Dexia Holdings or our other stockholders within a short period of time could cause Assured's stock price to decrease, make it more difficult for us to raise funds through future offerings of Assured common shares or acquire other businesses using Assured common shares as consideration.

You will experience a reduction in percentage ownership and voting power with respect to Assured common shares as a result of the acquisition.

        In connection with the transaction, we will issue to Dexia Holdings up to 44,567,901 Assured common shares. In order to finance the cash portion of the purchase price under the stock purchase agreement, we expect to issue additional Assured common shares having a value of approximately $361 million, or approximately 48.9 million Assured common shares based upon the closing price of the Assured common shares on the NYSE on February 12, 2009. Therefore, following the completion of the acquisition, holders of Assured common shares will experience a substantial reduction in their respective percentage ownership interests and effective voting power relative to their respective

69


Table of Contents


percentage ownership interests in Assured common shares and effective voting power prior to the acquisition.

ITEM 1B.    UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

        None.

ITEM 2.    PROPERTIES

        We and our subsidiaries currently occupy approximately over 142,000 square feet of leased office space in Bermuda, New York, London and Sydney. Included in that amount are 45,000 square feet for New York office space for the lease that will expire in March 2009. In June 2008, the Company's subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Corp., entered into a new five-year lease agreement for New York office space. Management believes that the office space is adequate for its current and anticipated needs.

ITEM 3.    LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

Litigation

        Lawsuits arise in the ordinary course of the Company's business. It is the opinion of the Company's management, based upon the information available, that the expected outcome of these matters, individually or in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial position, results of operations or liquidity, although an adverse resolution of a number of these items could have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations or liquidity in a particular quarter or fiscal year.

        Effective January 1, 2004, Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company ("AGMIC") reinsured a private mortgage insurer (the "Reinsured") under a Mortgage Insurance Stop Loss Excess of Loss Reinsurance Agreement (the "Agreement"). Under the Agreement, AGMIC agreed to cover the Reinsured's aggregate mortgage guaranty insurance losses in excess of a $25 million retention and subject to a $95 million limit. Coverage under the Agreement was triggered only when the Reinsured's: (1) combined loss ratio exceeded 100%; and (2) risk to capital ratio exceeded 25 to 1, according to insurance statutory accounting. In April 2008, AGMIC notified the Reinsured it was terminating the Agreement because of the Reinsured's breach of the terms of the Agreement. The Reinsured notified AGMIC that it considers the Agreement to remain in effect and that the two coverage triggers under the Agreement apply as of April 1, 2008. By letter dated May 5, 2008, the Reinsured demanded arbitration against AGMIC seeking a declaration that the Agreement remains in effect and alleged compensatory and other damages. The arbitration hearing took place before a three person panel in December 2008 and January 2009. Post hearing briefing and oral arguments will be completed on February 26, 2009, and the arbitration panel could render its decision at any time thereafter.

        It is the opinion of the Company's management, based upon the information available, that the expected outcome of litigation against the Company, individually or in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial position or liquidity, although an adverse resolution of litigation against the Company could have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations in a particular quarter or fiscal year.

        During 2007, the Company's wholly owned subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. ("AGRO"), and a number of other parties, completed various settlements with defendants in the In re: National Century Financial Enterprises Inc. Investment Litigation now pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of Ohio—Eastern District. AGRO received approximately $0.4 million (pre-tax) in 2008, $1.3 million (pre-tax) in 2007 and $13.5 million (pre-tax) in 2006 from the settlements. AGRO originally paid claims in 2003 of approximately $41.7 million (pre-tax) related to National Century Financial Enterprises Inc. To date, including the settlements described above, the

70


Table of Contents


Company has recovered $20.5 million (pre-tax). These are a partial settlement of the litigation, and the litigation will continue against other parties.

        In the ordinary course of their respective businesses, certain of the Company's subsidiaries assert claims in legal proceedings against third parties to recover losses paid in prior periods. The amounts, if any, the Company will recover in these proceedings are uncertain, although recoveries in any one or more of these proceedings during any quarter or fiscal year could be material to the Company's results of operations in that particular quarter or fiscal year.

ITEM 4.    SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

        No matters were submitted to a vote of stockholders during the fourth quarter of the fiscal year covered by this report.

        On February 6, 2009, a Proxy statement was distributed to Company's stockholders asking for their vote "FOR" 1) the approval of the issuance of Assured common shares to Dexia Holdings or its designated affiliate in connection with Assured's acquisition of FSAH and 2) the approval of the issuance of Assured common shares to the WLR Funds pursuant to the WLR Backstop Commitment. The votes for this Proxy statement will be tallied at a Special General Meeting of the Company on March 16, 2009. .See Item 1. Business, "Acquisition of Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd." for further details.

Executive Officers of the Company

        The table below sets forth the names, ages, positions and business experience of the executive officers of Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Name
  Age   Position(s)

Dominic J. Frederico

    56   President and Chief Executive Officer; Deputy Chairman

Michael J. Schozer

    51   President of Assured Guaranty Corp.

Robert B. Mills

    59   Chief Financial Officer

James M. Michener

    56   General Counsel and Secretary

Robert A. Bailenson

    42   Chief Accounting Officer

        Dominic J. Frederico has been President and Chief Executive Officer of Assured Guaranty since December 2003. Mr. Frederico served as Vice Chairman of ACE from June 2003 until April 2004 and served as President and Chief Operating Officer of ACE and Chairman of ACE INA Holdings, Inc. ("ACE INA") from November 1999 to June 2003. Mr. Frederico was a director of ACE since 2001, but retired from that board when his term expired on May 26, 2005. Mr. Frederico has also served as Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of ACE INA from May 1999 through November 1999. Mr. Frederico previously served as President of ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. ("ACE Bermuda") from July 1997 to May 1999, Executive Vice President, Underwriting from December 1996 to July 1997, and as Executive Vice President, Financial Lines from January 1995 to December 1996. Prior to joining ACE, Mr. Frederico spent 13 years working for various subsidiaries of American International Group ("AIG"). Mr. Frederico completed his employment at AIG after serving as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of AIG Risk Management. Before that, Mr. Frederico was Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of UNAT, a wholly owned subsidiary of AIG headquartered in Paris, France.

        Michael J. Schozer has been President of Assured Guaranty Corp. since December 2003. Mr. Schozer was Managing Director—Structured Finance and Credit Derivatives of Ambac Assurance Corporation from 1996 to December 2003 where he was also a member of Ambac's senior credit committee.

71


Table of Contents

        Robert B. Mills has been Chief Financial Officer of Assured Guaranty since January 2004. Mr. Mills was Managing Director and Chief Financial Officer—Americas of UBS AG and UBS Investment Bank from April 1994 to January 2004 where he was also a member of the Investment Bank Board of Directors. Previously, Mr. Mills was with KPMG from 1971 to 1994 where his responsibilities included being partner-in-charge of the Investment Banking and Capital Markets practice.

        James M. Michener has been General Counsel and Secretary of Assured Guaranty since February 2004. Mr. Michener was General Counsel and Secretary of Travelers Property Casualty Corp. from January 2002 to February 2004. From April 2001 to January 2002, Mr. Michener served as general counsel of Citigroup's Emerging Markets business. Prior to joining Citigroup's Emerging Markets business, Mr. Michener was General Counsel of Travelers Insurance from April 2000 to April 2001 and General Counsel of Travelers Property Casualty Corp. from May 1996 to April 2000.

        Robert A. Bailenson has been Chief Accounting Officer of Assured Guaranty since May 2005 and has been with Assured Guaranty and its predecessor companies since 1990. In addition to this position, Mr. Bailenson serves as the Chief Accounting Officer of the Company's subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Corp; a position he has held since 2003. He was Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer of Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. from 1999 until 2003 and was previously the Assistant Controller of Capital Re Corp., which was acquired by ACE Limited in 1999.

        Information pertaining to this item is incorporated by reference to the sections entitled "Proposal No. 1:Election of Directors", "Corporate Governance—Did our Officers and Directors Comply with Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting in 2008?", "Corporate Governance—How are Directors Nominated?", "Corporate Governance—The Committees of the Board—The Audit Committee" of the definitive proxy statement for the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, which involves the election of directors and will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to regulation 14A.


PART II

ITEM 5.    MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

        Our Common Stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under symbol "AGO." The table below sets forth, for the calendar quarters indicated, the reported high and low sales prices and amount of any cash dividends declared:

 
  2008   2007  
 
  Sales Price    
  Sales Price    
 
 
  Cash
Dividends
  Cash
Dividends
 
 
  High   Low   High   Low  

First Quarter

  $ 26.98   $ 16.53   $ 0.045   $ 28.40   $ 25.90   $ 0.04  

Second Quarter

    27.58     17.94     0.045     31.99     26.65     0.04  

Third Quarter

    20.64     7.95     0.045     30.22     21.32     0.04  

Fourth Quarter

    16.65     5.49     0.045     29.46     13.34     0.04  

        On February 12, 2009, the closing price for our common stock on NYSE was $7.38, and the approximate number of shareholders of record at the close of business on that date was 14,743.

        The Company is a holding company whose principal source of income is net investment income and dividends from its operating subsidiaries. The ability of the operating subsidiaries to pay dividends to us and our ability to pay dividends to our shareholders, are each subject to legal and regulatory restrictions. The declaration and payment of future dividends will be at the discretion of the Board of Directors and will be dependent upon the profits and financial requirements of Assured Guaranty Ltd. and other factors, including legal restrictions on the payment of dividends and such other factors as the Board of Directors deems relevant. For more information concerning our dividends, please refer to

72


Table of Contents


Item 7 under caption "Liquidity and Capital Resources" and Note 14 "Insurance Regulations" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

        On May 4, 2006, the Company's Board of Directors approved a share repurchase program for 1.0 million common shares. Share repurchases took place at management's discretion depending on market conditions. In August 2007 the Company completed this share repurchase program. During 2007 and 2006 we repurchased 1.0 million common shares at an average price of $24.81.

        On November 8, 2007, the Company's Board of Directors approved a new share repurchase program for up to 2.0 million common shares. Share repurchases will take place at management's discretion depending on market conditions. During 2007 we repurchased 0.3 million common shares at an average price of $19.82. No repurchases were made during 2008.

        The following table reflects the Company share repurchase activity during the three months ended December 31, 2008. All shares repurchased were for the payment of employee withholding taxes due in connection with the vesting of restricted stock awards:

Period
  (a) Total
Number of
Shares Purchased
  (b) Average
Price Paid
Per Share
  (c) Total Number of
Shares Purchased as
Part of Publicly
Announced Program
  (d) Maximum Number
of Shares that
May Yet Be Purchased
Under the Program
 

October 1–October 31

    482   $ 14.61         1,717,400  

November 1–November 30

    626   $ 10.58         1,717,400  

December 1–December 31

    189   $ 12.91         1,717,400  
                       
 

Total

    1,297   $ 12.42            
                       

        Set forth below are a line graph and a table comparing the dollar change in the cumulative total shareholder return on the Company's Common Shares from April 22, 2004 through December 31, 2008 as compared to the cumulative total return of the Standard & Poor's 500 Stock Index and the cumulative total return of the Standard & Poor's 500 Financials Index. The chart and table depict the value on April 22, 2004, December 31, 2004, December 31, 2005, December 31, 2006, December 31,

73


Table of Contents


2007 and December 31, 2008 of a $100 investment made on April 22, 2004, with all dividends reinvested.

GRAPHIC

 
  Assured Guaranty   S&P 500 Index   S&P 500
Financial Index
 

04/22/04

  $ 100.00   $ 100.00   $ 100.00  

12/31/04

  $ 109.67   $ 107.65   $ 108.25  

12/31/05

  $ 142.36   $ 112.93   $ 115.29  

12/31/06

  $ 149.98   $ 130.77   $ 137.45  

12/31/07

  $ 150.57   $ 137.95   $ 111.99  

12/31/08

  $ 65.56   $ 86.91   $ 50.09  

74


Table of Contents

ITEM 6.    SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

        The following selected financial data should be read together with the other information contained in this Form 10-K, including "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and the consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this Form 10-K.

Reclassification

        Effective with the quarter ended March 31, 2008, the Company reclassified the revenues, expenses and balance sheet items associated with financial guaranty contracts that our financial guaranty subsidiaries write in the form of credit default swap ("CDS") contracts. The reclassification does not change our net income (loss) or shareholder's equity. This reclassification is being adopted by the Company after agreement with member companies of the Association of Financial Guaranty Insurers in consultation with the staffs of the Office of the Chief Accountant and the Division of Corporate Finance of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The reclassification is being implemented in order to increase comparability of our financial statements with other financial guaranty companies that have CDS contracts.

        In general, the Company structures credit derivative transactions such that the method for making loss payments is similar to that for financial guaranty policies and generally occurs as losses are realized on the underlying reference obligation. Nonetheless, credit derivative transactions are governed by International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. documentation and operates differently from financial guaranty insurance policies. Under GAAP CDS contracts are subject to derivative accounting rules and financial guaranty policies are subject to insurance accounting rules.

        In the Company's accompanying consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, the Company has reclassified CDS revenues from "net earned premiums" to "realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives." Loss and loss adjustment expenses and recoveries that were previously included in "loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)" have been reclassified to "realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives," as well. Portfolio and case loss and loss adjustment expenses have been reclassified from "loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)" and are included in "unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives," which previously included only unrealized mark to market gains or losses on the Company's contracts written in CDS form. In the consolidated balance sheet, the Company reclassified all CDS-related balances previously included in "unearned premium reserves," "reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses," "prepaid reinsurance premiums," "premiums receivable" and "reinsurance balances payable" to either "credit derivative liabilities" or "credit derivative assets," depending on the net position of the CDS contract at each balance sheet date.

75


Table of Contents

        These reclassifications had no impact on net income (loss), comprehensive income (loss), earnings (loss) per share, cash flows or total shareholders' equity.

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006   2005   2004  
 
  ($ in millions, except per share amounts)
 

Statement of operations data:*

                               
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 618.3   $ 424.5   $ 261.3   $ 192.1   $ 222.8  
 

Net written premiums

    604.6     408.0     255.8     159.1     114.6  
 

Net earned premiums

    261.4     159.3     144.8     139.4     98.7  
 

Net investment income

    162.6     128.1     111.5     96.8     94.8  
 

Net realized investment (losses) gains

    (69.8 )   (1.3 )   (2.0 )   2.2     12.0  
 

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

    117.6     74.0     73.9     57.1     (13.1 )
 

Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives

    38.0     (670.4 )   11.8     4.4     137.4  
 

Other income(1)

    43.4     8.8     0.4     0.2     0.8  
                       
 

Total revenues

    553.2     (301.6 )   340.4     300.3     330.5  
                       
 

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    265.8     5.8     11.3     (63.9 )   (48.2 )
 

Profit commission expense

    1.3     6.5     9.5     12.9     15.5  
 

Acquisition costs

    61.2     43.2     45.2     45.4     49.7  
 

Operating expenses

    83.5     79.9     68.0     59.0     67.8  
 

Interest expense

    23.3     23.5     13.8     13.5     10.7  
 

Other expense

    5.7     2.6     2.5     3.7     1.6  
                       
 

Total expenses

    440.9     161.4     150.4     70.7     97.2  
                       
 

Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes

    112.3     (463.0 )   190.0     229.6     233.3  
 

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

    43.4     (159.8 )   30.2     41.2     50.5  
                       
 

Net income (loss)

  $ 68.9   $ (303.3 ) $ 159.7   $ 188.4   $ 182.8  
                       
 

Earnings (loss) per share:

                               
   

Basic

  $ 0.78   $ (4.46 ) $ 2.18   $ 2.55   $ 2.44  
   

Diluted

  $ 0.77   $ (4.46 ) $ 2.15   $ 2.53   $ 2.44  
 

Dividends per share

  $ 0.18   $ 0.16   $ 0.14   $ 0.12   $ 0.06  

*
Some amounts may not add due to rounding.

76


Table of Contents

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006   2005   2004  
 
  ($ in millions, except per share amounts)
 

Balance sheet data (end of period):

                               
 

Investments and cash

  $ 3,643.6   $ 3,147.9   $ 2,469.9   $ 2,256.0   $ 2,157.9  
 

Prepaid reinsurance premiums

    18.9     13.5     4.5     9.5     11.8  
 

Total assets

    4,555.7     3,762.9     2,931.6     2,689.8     2,689.0  
 

Unearned premium reserves

    1,233.7     887.2     631.0     524.6     507.2  
 

Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses

    196.8     125.6     115.9     117.4     217.2  
 

Credit derivative liabilities (assets), net

    586.8     617.6     (49.0 )   (35.8 )   (31.3 )
 

Long-term debt

    347.2     347.1     347.1     197.3     197.4  
 

Total liabilities

    2,629.5     2,096.4     1,280.8     1,028.3     1,161.4  
 

Accumulated other comprehensive income

    2.9     56.6     41.9     45.8     79.0  
 

Shareholders' equity

    1,926.2     1,666.6     1,650.8     1,661.5     1,527.6  
 

Book value per share

    21.18     20.85     24.44     22.22     20.19  

Financial Ratios:

                               
 

Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio(2)

    81.4 %   3.4 %   (3.3 )%   (35.0 )%   (17.0 )%
 

Expense ratio(3)

    38.7 %   55.8 %   59.2 %   58.9 %   65.4 %
                       
 

Combined ratio(4)

    120.1 %   59.2 %   55.9 %   23.9 %   48.4 %
                       

Combined statutory financial information:

                               
 

Contingency reserve(5)

  $ 728.4   $ 598.5   $ 645.8   $ 572.9   $ 491.8  
 

Policyholders' surplus(6)

    1,578.4     1,489.9     1,010.0     977.3     906.2  

Additional financial guaranty information (end of period):

                               
 

Net in-force business (principal and interest)(7)

  $ 348,816   $ 302,413   $ 180,174   $ 145,694   $ 136,120  
 

Net in-force business (principal only)(7)

    222,722     200,279     132,296     102,465     95,592  

(1)
Other income for the year ended December 31, 2008 and 2007 included a change in fair value of $42.7 million and $8.3 million related to Assured Guaranty Corp.'s committed capital securities entered into in April 2005. The change in fair value was $0 in 2006 and 2005.

(2)
Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio, which is a non-GAAP financial measure, is defined as loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries) plus the Company's net estimate of credit derivative incurred case and portfolio loss and loss adjustment expense reserves, which is included in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives, plus net credit derivative losses (recoveries), which is included in realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives, divided by net earned premiums plus net credit derivative premiums received and receivable, which is included in realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives.

(3)
Expense ratio is calculated by dividing the sum of ceding commissions expense (income), profit commission expense, acquisition costs and operating expenses by net earned premiums plus net credit derivative premiums received and receivable, which is included in realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives.

(4)
Combined ratio, which is a non-GAAP financial measure, is the sum of the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio and the expense ratio.

(5)
Under U.S. statutory accounting principles, financial guaranty and mortgage guaranty insurers are required to establish contingency reserves based on a specified percentage of premiums. A contingency reserve is an additional liability established to protect policyholders against the effects of adverse economic developments or cycles or other unforeseen circumstances.

(6)
Combined policyholders' surplus represents the addition of our combined U.S. based statutory surplus and our Bermuda based statutory surplus.

(7)
The Company's 2008, 2007 and 2006 reinsurance par outstanding on facultative business are reported on a current quarter basis while 2005 and prior years are reported on a one-quarter lag.

77


Table of Contents

ITEM 7.    MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATION

        The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes which appear elsewhere in this Form 10-K. It contains forward looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Please see "Forward Looking Statements" for more information. Our actual results could differ materially from those anticipated in these forward looking statements as a result of various factors, including those discussed below and elsewhere in this Form 10-K, particularly under the headings "Risk Factors" and "Forward Looking Statements."

Executive Summary

        Assured Guaranty Ltd. is a Bermuda based holding company which provides, through its operating subsidiaries, credit enhancement products to the public finance, structured finance and mortgage markets. We apply our credit expertise, risk management skills and capital markets experience to develop insurance, reinsurance and credit derivative products that meet the credit enhancement needs of our customers. We market our products directly and through financial institutions. We serve the U.S. and international markets.

        Our insurance company subsidiaries have been assigned the following insurance financial strength ratings:

 
  Moody's   S&P   Fitch
Assured Guaranty Corp.    Aa2(Excellent)   AAA(Extremely Strong)   AAA(Extremely Strong)
Assured Guaranty Re Ltd.    Aa3(Excellent)   AA(Very Strong)   AA(Very Strong)
Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd.    Aa3(Excellent)   AA(Very Strong)   AA(Very Strong)
Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company   Aa3(Excellent)   AA(Very Strong)   AA(Very Strong)
Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd   Aa2(Excellent)   AAA(Extremely Strong)   AAA(Extremely Strong)

        "Aaa" (Exceptional) is the highest ranking, which Assured Guaranty Corp. ("AGC") and Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. achieved in July 2007, and "Aa2" (Excellent) is the third highest ranking of 21 ratings categories used by Moody's Investors Service ("Moody's"). A "AAA" (Extremely Strong) rating is the highest ranking and "AA" (Very Strong) is the third highest ranking of the 21 ratings categories used by Standard & Poor's Inc. ("S&P"). "AAA" (Extremely Strong) is the highest ranking and "AA" (Very Strong) is the third highest ranking of the 24 ratings categories used by Fitch Ratings ("Fitch"). An insurance financial strength rating is an opinion with respect to an insurer's ability to pay under its insurance policies and contracts in accordance with their terms. The opinion is not specific to any particular policy or contract. Insurance financial strength ratings do not refer to an insurer's ability to meet non insurance obligations and are not a recommendation to purchase or discontinue any policy or contract issued by an insurer or to buy, hold, or sell any security issued by an insurer, including our common shares.

        On July 21, 2008, Moody's placed under review for possible downgrade the Aaa insurance financial strength ratings of Assured Guaranty Corp. ("AGC") and its wholly owned subsidiary, Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd., as well as the Aa2 insurance financial strength ratings of Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. ("AG Re") and its affiliated insurance operating companies. Moody's has placed under review for possible downgrade the Aa3 senior unsecured rating of parent company, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. and the Aa3 issuer rating of the ultimate holding company, Assured Guaranty Ltd. Moody's revised assessment of stress-case loss estimates on our residential mortgage-backed securities portfolio did not change meaningfully from their prior estimates.

        On November 21, 2008, Moody's downgraded the insurance financial strength ratings of AGC and its wholly owned subsidiary, Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd., to Aa2 from Aaa and also downgraded the insurance financial strength ratings of AG Re and its affiliated insurance operating companies to Aa3 from Aa2. In the same rating action, Moody's downgraded the senior unsecured rating of Assured

78


Table of Contents


Guaranty US Holdings Inc. and the issuer rating of the ultimate holding company, Assured Guaranty Ltd. to A2 from Aa3.

        If the ratings of any of our insurance subsidiaries were reduced below current levels, we expect it would have an adverse effect on our subsidiary's competitive position and its prospects for future business opportunities. A downgrade may also reduce the value of the reinsurance we offer, which may no longer be of sufficient economic value for our customers to continue to cede to our subsidiaries at economically viable rates.

        With respect to a significant portion of our in-force financial guaranty reinsurance business, in the event that AG Re were downgraded from Aa3 to A1, subject to the terms of each reinsurance agreement, the ceding company may have the right to recapture business ceded to AG Re and assets representing substantially all of the statutory unearned premium and loss reserves (if any) associated with that business. As of December 31, 2008, the statutory unearned premium, which represents deferred revenue to the Company, subject to recapture is approximately $188 million. If this entire amount was recaptured, it would result in a corresponding one-time reduction to net income of approximately $4 million. With respect to one of AG Re's ceding companies, the right to recapture business can only be exercised if AG Re were downgraded to the A category by more than one rating agency, or below A2/A by any one rating agency. As of December 31, 2008, the statutory unearned premium subject to recapture by this ceding company is approximately $390 million. If this entire amount were recaptured, it would result in a corresponding one-time reduction to net income of approximately $43 million. Alternatively, the ceding company can increase the commissions it charges AG Re for cessions. Any such increase may be retroactive to the date of the cession. As of December 31, 2008, the potential increase in ceding commissions would result in a one-rime reduction to net income of approximately $42 million. The effect on net income under these scenarios is exclusive of any capital gains or losses that may be realized.

        If a credit derivative is terminated, the Company could be required to make a mark-to-market payment as determined under the ISDA documentation. For example, if AGC's rating were downgraded to A+, under market conditions at December 31, 2008, if the counterparties exercised their right to terminate their credit derivatives, AGC would have been required to make payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $261 million. Further, if AGC's rating was downgraded to a level below BBB- it would have been required to make additional payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $620 million at December 31, 2008. The Company's mark-to-market methodology is, however, not the basis on which any such payment amount would be determined. The process for determining the amount of such payment is set forth in the credit derivative documentation and generally follows market practice for derivative contracts. The actual amounts could be materially larger than the Company's estimate.

        Under a limited number of credit derivative contracts, the Company is required to post eligible securities as collateral, generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities. The need to post collateral under these transactions is generally based on mark-to-market valuation in excess of contractual thresholds. The particular thresholds decline if the Company's ratings decline. As of December 31, 2008 the Company had pre-IPO transactions with approximately $1.9 billion of par subject to collateral posting due to changes in market value. Of this amount, as of December 31, 2008, the Company posted collateral totaling approximately $157.7 million (including $134.2 million for AGC) based on the unrealized mark-to-market loss position for transactions with two of its counterparties. Any amounts required to be posted as collateral in the future will depend on changes in the market values of these transactions. Additionally, in the event AGC were downgraded below A-, contractual thresholds would be eliminated and the amount of par that could be subject to collateral posting requirements would be $2.4 billion. Based on market values as of December 31, 2008, such a downgrade would have resulted in AGC posting an additional $88.7 million of collateral. Currently no additional collateral posting is required or anticipated for any other transactions.

79


Table of Contents

        The Company's financial strength ratings assigned by S&P and Fitch were affirmed on June 18, 2008 and December 12, 2007, respectively. Management is uncertain what, if any, impact Moody's ratings actions will have on the Company's financial strength ratings from S&P and Fitch.

        On April 8, 2008, investment funds managed by WL Ross & Co. LLC ("WL Ross") purchased 10,651,896 shares of the Company's common equity at a price of $23.47 per share, resulting in proceeds to the Company of $250.0 million. The Company contributed $150.0 million of these proceeds to its subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. In addition, the Company contributed $100.0 million of these proceeds to its subsidiary, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., which in turn contributed the same amount to its subsidiary, AGC. The commitment to purchase these shares was previously announced on February 29, 2008. In addition, Wilbur L. Ross, Jr., President and Chief Executive Officer of WL Ross, has been appointed to the Board of Directors of the Company to serve a term expiring at the Company's 2009 annual general meeting of shareholders. Mr. Ross's appointment became effective immediately following the Company's 2008 annual general meeting of shareholders, which was held on May 8, 2008. WL Ross has a remaining commitment through April 8, 2009 to purchase up to $750.0 million of the Company's common equity, at the Company's option, subject to the terms and conditions of the investment agreement with the Company dated February 28, 2008. In accordance with the investment agreement, the Company may exercise this option in one or more drawdowns, subject to a minimum drawdown of $50 million, provided that the purchase price per common share for the subsequent shares is not greater than $27.57, or less than $19.37, the price per common share for the initial shares. The purchase price per common share for such shares will be equal to 97% of the volume weighted average price of a common share on the NYSE for the 15 NYSE trading days prior to the applicable drawdown notice. As of December 31, 2008, and as of the date of this filing, the purchase price per common share is outside of this range and therefore the Company may not, at this time, exercise its option for WL Ross to purchase additional shares.

        On September 16, 2008, the Company agreed to waive the standstill provisions of the investment agreement to permit investment funds managed by WL Ross (the "WLR Funds") to purchase up to 5,000,000 additional common shares of the Company in open market transactions from time to time. The timing and amount of any such purchases are in the sole discretion of WL Ross and they are not obligated to purchase any such shares. The additional shares purchased by the WLR Funds, if any, will be purchased from current shareholders and therefore will not result in an increase in shareholders' equity at the Company or its subsidiaries. If all 5,000,000 additional shares were purchased, the WLR Funds would beneficially own 17,166,396 shares or approximately 18.9% of the Company's outstanding common shares based on shares outstanding as of December 31, 2008. As of the date of this filing the Company has not been notified that WLR Funds purchased any additional shares of the Company.

        On December 21, 2007, the Company completed the sale of 12,483,960 of its common shares at a price of $25.50 per share. The net proceeds of the sale totaled approximately $303.8 million. The Company has contributed the net proceeds of the offering to its reinsurance subsidiary, AG Re. AG Re has used the proceeds to provide capital support in the form of a reinsurance portfolio transaction with Ambac Assurance Corp. ("Ambac") for approximately $29 billion of net par outstanding, as well as to support the growth of AGC, the Company's principal direct financial guaranty subsidiary, by providing reinsurance. AG Re is AGC's principal financial guaranty reinsurer.

        We regularly evaluate potential acquisitions of other companies, lines of business and portfolios of risks and hold discussions with potential third parties regarding such transactions. As a general rule, we publicly announce such transactions only after a definitive agreement has been reached.

        On November 14, 2008, Assured Guaranty Ltd. announced that it had entered into a definitive agreement ("the Purchase Agreement") with Dexia Holdings, Inc. ("Dexia") to purchase Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd. ("FSAH") and, indirectly, all of its subsidiaries, including the financial guaranty insurance company, Financial Security Assurance, Inc. The definitive agreement provides that the Company will be indemnified against exposure to FSAH's Financial Products segment,

80


Table of Contents


which includes its guaranteed investment contract business. Pursuant to the Purchase Agreement, the Company agreed to buy 33,296,733 issued and outstanding shares of common stock of FSAH, representing as of the date thereof approximately 99.8524% of the issued and outstanding shares of common stock of FSAH. The remaining shares of FSAH are currently held by current or former directors of FSAH. Assured expects that it will acquire the remaining shares of FSAH common stock concurrent with the closing of the acquisition of shares of FSAH common stock from Dexia or shortly thereafter at the same price paid to Dexia. We expect to close this transaction is expected to occur in either the first or second quarter of 2009.

        The purchase price is $722 million (based upon the closing price of the Company's common shares on the NYSE on November 13, 2008 of $8.10), consisting of $361 million in cash and up to 44,567,901 of the Company's common shares. If, prior to the closing date under the stock purchase agreement, the Company issues new common shares (other than pursuant to an employee benefit plan) or other securities that are convertible into or exchangeable for or otherwise linked to the Company's common shares at a purchase price per share of less than $8.10, the Company has agreed to issue to Dexia on the closing date an additional number of the Company's common shares with an aggregate value as of the closing date (measured based on the average of the volume weighted average price per share for each day in the 20 NYSE trading day period ending three business days prior to the closing date) representing the amount of dilution as a result of such issuance. The amount of dilution is defined to mean (x) the number of the Company's common shares issued (or that upon conversion or exchange would be issuable) as a result of the dilutive issuance, multiplied by (y) the positive difference if any between $8.10 and the purchase (or reference, implied, conversion, exchange or comparable) price per share received by the Company in the dilutive issuance, multiplied by (z) the percentage of the issued and outstanding share capital of the Company represented by the Company common shares to be received by Dexia under the stock purchase agreement (without taking into account any additional Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s common shares issued or issuable as a result of the anti-dilution provision).

        Under the Purchase Agreement, the Company may elect to pay $8.10 per share in cash in lieu of up to 22,283,951 of the Company's common shares that it would otherwise deliver as part of the purchase price.

        The Company expects to finance the cash portion of the acquisition with the proceeds of a public equity offering. The Company has received a backstop commitment ("the WLR Backstop Commitment") from the WLR Funds, a related party, to fund the cash portion of the purchase price with the purchase of newly issued common shares. The Company entered into the WLR Backstop Commitment on November 13, 2008 with the WLR Funds. The WLR Backstop Commitment amended the Investment Agreement between the Company and the WLR Funds and provided to the Company the option to cause the WLR Funds to purchase from Assured Guaranty Ltd. or Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. a number of the Company's common shares equal to the quotient of (i) the aggregate dollar amount not to exceed $361 million specified by the Company divided by (ii) the volume weighted average price of the Company's common share on the NYSE for the 20 NYSE trading days ending with the last NYSE trading day immediately preceding the date of the closing under the stock purchase agreement, with a floor of $6.00 and a cap of $8.50.

        The WLR Funds have no obligation to purchase these common shares pursuant to the WLR Backstop Commitment until the closing under the stock purchase agreement occurs. The Company may use the proceeds from the sale of the Company's common shares pursuant to the WLR Backstop Commitment solely to pay a portion of the purchase price under the stock purchase agreement. The WLR Funds' obligations under the WLR Backstop Commitment have been secured by letters of credit issued for the benefit of the Company by Bank of America, N.A. and RBS Citizens Bank, N.A., each in the amount of $180.5 million.

        The Company has paid the WLR Funds a nonrefundable commitment fee of $10,830,000 in connection with the option granted by the WLR Backstop Commitment and has agreed to pay the

81


Table of Contents


WLR Funds' expenses in connection with the transactions contemplated thereby. The Company has agreed to reimburse the WLR Funds for the $4.1 million cost of obtaining the letters of credit referred to above.

        In January 2009, AGC finalized an agreement with CIFG Assurance North America, Inc. ("CIFG") to assume a diversified portfolio of financial guaranty contracts totaling approximately $13.3 billion of net par outstanding. AGC received $75.6 million, which included $85.7 million of upfront premiums net of ceding commissions and approximately $12.2 million of future installments related to this transaction.

        The financial guaranty industry, along with many other financial institutions, continues to be threatened by deterioration of the credit performance of securities collateralized by U.S. residential mortgages. There is significant uncertainty surrounding general economic factors, including interest rates and housing prices, which may adversely affect our loss experience on these securities. The Company continues to monitor these exposures and update our loss estimates as new information is received. Additionally, scrutiny from state and federal regulatory agencies could result in changes that limit our business.

        Our financial results include four principal business segments: financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty reinsurance, mortgage guaranty and other. The other segment represents lines of business that we exited or sold as part of our 2004 initial public offering ("IPO").

        We derive our revenues principally from premiums from our insurance and reinsurance businesses, unrealized gains and losses and realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives, net investment income, and net realized gains and losses from our investment portfolio. Our premiums and realized gains and other settlement on credit derivatives are a function of the amount and type of contracts we write as well as prevailing market prices. We receive payments on an upfront basis when the policy is issued or the contract is executed and/or on an installment basis over the life of the applicable transaction.

        Investment income is a function of invested assets and the yield that we earn on those assets. The investment yield is a function of market interest rates at the time of investment as well as the type, credit quality and maturity of our invested assets. In addition, we could realize capital losses on securities in our investment portfolio from other than temporary declines in market value as a result of changing market conditions, including changes in market interest rates, and changes in the credit quality of our invested assets.

        Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives include credit derivative premiums received and receivable for credit protection the Company has sold under its credit default swaps ("CDS"), any contractual claim losses paid and payable related to insured credit events under these contracts, realized gains or losses related to their early termination and ceding commissions (expense) income. The Company generally holds credit derivative contracts to maturity. However, in certain circumstances such as for risk management purposes or as a result of a decision to exit a line of business, the Company may decide to terminate a derivative contract prior to maturity.

        Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives represent the adjustments for changes in fair value that are recorded in each reporting period under FAS No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" ("FAS 133"). Changes in unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives are reflected in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives. Cumulative unrealized gains (losses), determined on a contract by contract basis, are reflected as either net assets or net liabilities in the Company's balance sheets. Unrealized gains and losses resulting from changes in the fair value of credit derivatives occur because of changes in interest rates, credit spreads, the credit ratings of the referenced entities, the Company's credit rating and other market factors. The unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives will reduce to zero as the exposure approaches its maturity date, unless there is a payment default on the exposure.

82


Table of Contents


Changes in the fair value of the Company's credit derivatives do not reflect actual claims or credit losses, and have no impact on the Company's claims paying resources, rating agency capital or regulatory capital positions.

        In 2008 and 2007 the Company also recorded a fair value gain of $42.7 million and $8.3 million, pre-tax, respectively, related to Assured Guaranty Corp.'s committed capital securities.

        Our expenses consist primarily of losses and loss adjustment expenses ("LAE"), profit commission expense, acquisition costs, operating expenses, interest expense, put-option premium expense associated with our committed capital securities (the "CCS Securities") and income taxes. Losses and LAE are a function of the amount and types of business we write. Losses and LAE are based upon estimates of the ultimate aggregate losses inherent in the portfolio. The risks we take have a low expected frequency of loss and are investment grade at the time we accept the risk. Profit commission expense represents payments made to ceding companies generally based on the profitability of the business reinsured by us. Acquisition costs are related to the production of new business. Certain acquisition costs that vary with and are directly attributable to the production of new business are deferred and recognized over the period in which the related premiums are earned. Operating expenses consist primarily of salaries and other employee-related costs, including share-based compensation, various outside service providers, rent and related costs and other expenses related to maintaining a holding company structure. These costs do not vary with the amount of premiums written. Interest expense is a function of outstanding debt and the contractual interest rate related to that debt. Put-option premium expense, which is included in "other expenses" on the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income, is a function of the outstanding amount of the CCS Securities and the applicable distribution rate. Income taxes are a function of our profitability and the applicable tax rate in the various jurisdictions in which we do business.

Critical Accounting Estimates

        Our consolidated financial statements include amounts that, either by their nature or due to requirements of accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("GAAP"), are determined using estimates and assumptions. The actual amounts realized could ultimately be materially different from the amounts currently provided for in our consolidated financial statements. We believe the items requiring the most inherently subjective and complex estimates to be reserves for losses and LAE, fair value of credit derivatives, fair value of committed capital securities, valuation of investments, other than temporary impairments of investments, premium revenue recognition, deferred acquisition costs, deferred income taxes and accounting for share-based compensation. An understanding of our accounting policies for these items is of critical importance to understanding our consolidated financial statements. The following discussion provides more information regarding the estimates and assumptions used for these items and should be read in conjunction with the notes to our consolidated financial statements.

Reserves for Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses

        Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses for non-derivative transactions in our financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty assumed reinsurance and mortgage guaranty business include case reserves and portfolio reserves. See the "Fair Value of Credit Derivatives" of the Critical Accounting Estimates section for more information on our derivative transactions. Case reserves are established when there is significant credit deterioration on specific insured obligations and the obligations are in default or default is probable, not necessarily upon non-payment of principal or interest by an insured. Case reserves represent the present value of expected future loss payments and LAE, net of estimated recoveries, but before considering ceded reinsurance. This reserving method is different from case reserves established by traditional property and casualty insurance companies, which establish case reserves upon notification of a claim and establish incurred but not reported ("IBNR") reserves for the

83


Table of Contents


difference between actuarially estimated ultimate losses and recorded case reserves. Financial guaranty insurance and assumed reinsurance case reserves and related salvage and subrogation, if any, are discounted at the taxable equivalent yield on our investment portfolio, which is approximately 6%, in all periods presented. When the Company becomes entitled to the underlying collateral of an insured credit under salvage and subrogation rights as a result of a claim payment, it records salvage and subrogation as an asset, based on the expected level of recovery. Such amounts have been recorded as a salvage recoverable asset in the Company's balance sheets.

        We record portfolio reserves in our financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty assumed reinsurance and mortgage guaranty business. Portfolio reserves are established with respect to the portion of our business for which case reserves have not been established.

        Portfolio reserves are not established based on a specific event, rather they are calculated by aggregating the portfolio reserve calculated for each individual transaction. Individual transaction reserves are calculated on a quarterly basis by multiplying the par in-force by the product of the ultimate loss and earning factors without regard to discounting. The ultimate loss factor is defined as the frequency of loss multiplied by the severity of loss, where the frequency is defined as the probability of default for each individual issue. The earning factor is inception to date earned premium divided by the estimated ultimate written premium for each transaction. The probability of default is estimated from rating agency data and is based on the transaction's credit rating, industry sector and time until maturity. The severity is defined as the complement of recovery/salvage rates gathered by the rating agencies of defaulting issues and is based on the industry sector.

        Portfolio reserves are recorded gross of reinsurance. We have not ceded any amounts under these reinsurance contracts, as our recorded portfolio reserves have not exceeded our contractual retentions, required by said contracts.

        The Company records an incurred loss that is reflected in the statement of operations upon the establishment of portfolio reserves. When we initially record a case reserve, we reclassify the corresponding portfolio reserve already recorded for that credit within the balance sheet. The difference between the initially recorded case reserve and the reclassified portfolio reserve is recorded as a charge in our statement of operations. Any subsequent change in portfolio reserves or the initial case reserves are recorded quarterly as a charge or credit in our statement of operations in the period such estimates change. Due to the inherent uncertainties of estimating loss and LAE reserves, actual experience may differ from the estimates reflected in our consolidated financial statements, and the differences may be material.

        The weighted average default frequencies and severities as of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 are as follows:

 
  Average Default
Frequency
  Average Default
Severity
 

December 31, 2008

    1.08 %   23.87 %

December 31, 2007

    0.58 %   26.53 %

        The Company incorporates default frequency and severity by asset class into its portfolio loss reserve models. Average default frequency and severity are based on information published by rating agencies. The increase in average default frequency shown in 2008 is reflective of downgrades within the Company's direct insured portfolio, including HELOC exposures. Rating agencies update default frequency and severity information on a periodic basis, as warranted by changes in observable data.

        The chart below demonstrates the portfolio reserve's sensitivity to frequency and severity assumptions. The change in these estimates represent management's estimate of reasonably possible material changes and are based upon our analysis of historical experience. Portfolio reserves were recalculated with changes made to the default and severity assumptions. In all scenarios, the starting point used to test the portfolio reserve's sensitivity to the changes in the frequency and severity

84


Table of Contents


assumptions was the weighted average frequency and severity by rating and asset class of our insured portfolio. Overall the weighted average default frequency was 1.08% and the weighted average severity was 23.87% at December 31, 2008. For example, in the first scenario where the frequency was increased by 5.0%, each transaction's contribution to the portfolio reserve was recalculated by adding 0.05% (i.e. 5.0% multiplied by 1.08%) to the individual transaction's default frequency.

(in thousands of U.S. dollars)
  Portfolio
Reserve
  Reserve
Increase
  Percentage
Change
 

Portfolio reserve(1) as of December 31, 2008

  $ 111,419   $      

5% Frequency Increase

    116,673     5,254     4.72 %

10% Frequency Increase

    123,104     11,685     10.49 %

5% Severity Increase

    116,276     4,857     4.36 %

10% Severity Increase

    122,310     10,891     9.77 %

5% Frequency and Severity Increase

    123,020     11,601     10.41 %

        In addition to analyzing the sensitivity of our portfolio reserves to possible changes in frequency and severity, we have also considered the effect of changes in assumptions on our financial guaranty and mortgage guaranty case reserves. At December 31, 2008 case reserves were $119.9 million. Case reserves may change from our original estimate due to changes in assumptions including, but not limited to, severity factors, credit deterioration of underlying obligations and salvage estimates. We discuss below the asset classes and credit for which we have recorded expected case losses and which are the most significant credits in our insured portfolio.

        Specifically with respect to reserves related to our U.S. home equity line of credit ("HELOC") and other U.S. residential mortgage exposures, there exists significant uncertainty as to the ultimate performance of these transactions. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had net par outstanding of $1.7 billion related to HELOC securitizations, of which $1.5 billion are transactions with Countrywide and $1.1 billion were written in the Company's financial guaranty direct segment ("direct Countrywide transactions" or "Countrywide 2005-J" and "Countrywide 2007-D").

        The performance of our HELOC exposures deteriorated during 2007 and 2008 and transactions, particularly those originated in the period from 2005 through 2007, continue to perform below our original underwriting expectations. In accordance with our standard practice, during the year ended December 31, 2008, we evaluated the most currently available information, including trends in delinquencies and charge-offs on the underlying loans, draw rates on the lines of credit, and the servicer's ability to fulfill its contractual obligations including its obligation to fund additional draws. In recent periods, Constant Default Rate (CDR), Constant Payment Rate (CPR), Draw Rates and delinquency percentages have fluctuated within ranges that we believe make it appropriate to use rolling averages to project future performance. Accordingly, the Company is using modeling assumptions that are based upon or which approximate recent actual historical performance to project future performance and potential losses. During 2008, the Company extended the time frame during which it expects the CDR to remain elevated. The Company also revised its assumptions with respect to the overall shape of the default and loss curves. Among other things, these changes assume that a higher proportion of projected defaults will occur over the near term. This revision was based upon management's judgment that a variety of factors including the deterioration of U.S. economic conditions could lead to a longer period in which default rates remain high. The Company continues to model sensitivities around the results booked using a variety of CDR rates and stress periods as well as other modeling approaches including roll rates and hybrid roll rate/CDR methods. As a result of this modeling and analysis, the Company incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses of $111.0 million for

85


Table of Contents


its direct Countrywide transactions during 2008. The Company's cumulative incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses on the direct Countrywide transactions as of December 31, 2008 were $111.0 million ($87.2 million after-tax). During 2008, the Company paid losses and loss adjustment expenses for its direct Countrywide transactions of $170.0 million, of which we expect to recover $59.0 million from the receipt of excess spread from future cash flows as well as funding of future draws. This amount of $59.0 million is included in "salvage recoverable" on the balance sheet. There were no incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses or salvage recoverable amounts on these transactions in 2007.

        Credit support for HELOC transactions comes primarily from two sources. In the first instance, excess spread is used to build a certain amount of credit enhancement and absorb losses. Over the past 12 months, excess spread (the difference between the interest collections on the collateral and the interest paid on the insured notes) has averaged approximately 270 basis points per annum. Additionally, for the transactions serviced by Countrywide, the servicer is required to fund additional draws on the HELOC loans following the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event. Among other things, such an event is triggered when claim payments by us exceed a certain threshold. Prior to the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event, during the transactions' revolving period, new draws on the HELOC loans are funded first from principal collections. As such, during the revolving period no additional credit enhancement is created by the additional draws, and the speed at which our exposure amortizes is reduced to the extent of such additional draws, since principal collections are used to fund those draws rather than pay down the insured notes. Subsequent to the occurrence of a Rapid Amortization Event, new draws are funded by Countrywide and all principal collections are used to pay down the insured notes. Any draws funded by Countrywide are subordinate to us in the cash flow waterfall and hence represent additional credit enhancement available to absorb losses before we have to make a claim payment. Additionally, since all principal collections are used to pay down the insured notes, rather than fund additional draws, our exposure begins to amortize more quickly. A Rapid Amortization Event occurred for Countrywide 2007-D in April 2008 and for Countrywide 2005-J in May 2008.

        We have modeled our HELOC exposures under a number of different scenarios, taking into account the multiple variables and structural features that materially affect transaction performance and potential losses to us. The key variables include the speed or rate at which borrowers make payments on their loans, as measured by the CPR(3), the default rate, as measured by the CDR(4), excess spread, and the amount of loans that are already delinquent more than 30 days. We also take into account the pool factor (the percentage of the original principal balance that remains outstanding), and the timing of the remaining cash flows. Additionally, it should be noted that our contractual rights allow us to retroactively claim that loans included in the insured pool were inappropriately included in the pool by the seller, and to put these loans back to the seller such that we would not be responsible for losses related to these loans. Such actions would benefit us by reducing potential losses. We have included in our loss model an estimated benefit for loans we expect Countrywide will repurchase.


(3)
The CPR is the annualized rate at which the portfolio amortizes, so that a 15% CPR implies that 15% of the collateral will be retired over a one-year period.

(4)
The CDR is the annualized default rate, so that a 1.0% CDR implies that 1.0% of the remaining collateral will default each year.

86


Table of Contents

        The ultimate performance of the Company's HELOC transactions will depend on many factors, such as the level and timing of loan defaults, interest proceeds generated by the securitized loans, repayment speeds and changes in home prices, as well as the levels of credit support built into each transaction. Other factors also may have a material impact upon the ultimate performance of each transaction, including the ability of the seller and servicer to fulfill all of their contractual obligations including its obligation to fund future draws on lines of credit, as well as the amount of benefit received from repurchases of ineligible loans by Countrywide. The variables affecting transaction performance are interrelated, difficult to predict and subject to considerable volatility. If actual results differ materially from any of our assumptions, the losses incurred could be materially different from our estimate. We continue to update our evaluation of these exposures as new information becomes available.

        The key assumptions used in our case loss reserves on the direct Countrywide transactions is presented in the following table:

Key Variables
   

Constant payment rate (CPR)

  3-month average, currently 7–8%

Constant default rate (CDR)

 

6-month average CDR of approximately 19–21% during months 1–9, declining to 1.0% at the end of month 15. From months 16 onward, a 1.0% CDR is assumed.

Draw rate

 

3-month average, currently 1–2%

Excess spread

 

250 bps per annum

Repurchases of Ineligible loans by Countrywide

 

$49.3 million; or approximately 2.1% of original pool balance of $2.4 billion

Loss Severity

 

100%

        Another type of RMBS transaction is generally referred to as "Subprime RMBS". The collateral supporting such transactions is comprised of first-lien residential mortgage loans made to subprime borrowers. A "subprime borrower" is one considered to be a higher risk credit based on credit scores or other risk characteristics. As of December 31, 2008, we had net par outstanding of $6.6 billion related to Subprime RMBS securitizations, of which $483 million is classified by us as Below Investment Grade risk. Of the total U.S. Subprime RMBS exposure of $6.6 billion, $6.1 billion is from transactions issued in the period from 2005 through 2007 and written in our direct financial guaranty segment. As of December 31, 2008, we had portfolio reserves of $8.8 million and case reserves of $7.8 million related to our $6.6 billion U.S. Subprime RMBS exposure, of which $6.9 million were portfolio reserves related to our $6.1 billion exposure in the direct financial guaranty segment for transactions issued from 2005 through 2007.

        The problems affecting the subprime mortgage market have been widely reported, with rising delinquencies, defaults and foreclosures negatively impacting the performance of Subprime RMBS transactions. Those concerns relate primarily to Subprime RMBS issued in the period from 2005 through 2007. The $6.1 billion exposure that we have to such transactions in our direct financial guaranty segment benefits from various structural protections, including credit enhancement that on average currently equals approximately 54.3% of the remaining principal balance of the transactions.

87


Table of Contents

        We also have exposure of $433.1 million to Closed-End Second ("CES") RMBS transactions, of which $424.2 million is in the direct segment. As with other types of RMBS, we have seen significant deterioration in the performance of our CES transactions. On two transactions, which had exposure of $185.0 million, during 2008 we have seen a significant increase in delinquencies and collateral losses, which resulted in erosion of the Company's credit enhancement and the payment of claims totaling $16.2 million. Based on the Company's analysis of these transaction and their projected collateral losses, the Company had case reserves of $37.7 million as of December 31, 2008 in its direct segment. Additionally, as of December 31, 2008, the Company had portfolio reserves of $0.1 million in its financial guaranty direct segment and no case or portfolio reserves in its financial guaranty reinsurance segment related to its U.S. Closed-End Second RMBS exposure.

        Another type of RMBS transaction is generally referred to as "Alt-A RMBS". The collateral supporting such transactions is comprised of first-lien residential mortgage loans made to prime quality borrowers that lack certain ancillary characteristics that would make them prime. Included in this category is Alt-A Option ARMs, which include transactions where 66% or more of the collateral is comprised of mortgage loans that have the potential to negatively amortize. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had net par outstanding of $7.6 billion related to Alt-A RMBS securitizations. Of that amount, $7.5 billion is from transactions issued in the period from 2005 through 2007 and written in the Company's financial guaranty direct segment. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had portfolio reserves of $6.5 million and case reserves of $1.5 million related to its $7.6 billion Alt-A RMBS exposure, in the financial guaranty direct and reinsurance segments, respectively.

        The ultimate performance of the Company's RMBS transactions remains highly uncertain and may be subject to considerable volatility due to the influence of many factors, including the level and timing of loan defaults, changes in housing prices and other variables. The Company will continue to monitor the performance of its RMBS exposures and will adjust the risk ratings of those transactions based on actual performance and management's estimates of future performance.

        The Company has exposure on two life insurance reserve securitization transactions based on two discrete blocks of individual life insurance business reinsured by Scottish Re (U.S.) Inc. ("Scottish Re"). The two transactions relate to Ballantyne Re p.l.c. ("Ballantyne") (gross exposure of $500 million) and Orkney Re II, p.l.c. ("Orkney II") (gross exposure of $423 million). Under both transactions, monies raised through the issuance of the insured notes support present and future U.S. statutory life insurance reserve requirements. The monies were invested at inception of each transaction in accounts managed by a large, well-known investment manager. However, those investment accounts have incurred substantial mark-to-market losses since mid-year 2007, principally as a result of their exposure to subprime and Alt-A RMBS transactions. Largely as a result of these mark-to-market losses both we and the rating agencies have downgraded our exposure to both Ballantyne and Orkney II to below investment grade. As regards the Ballantyne transaction, the Company is working with the directing guarantor, who has insured exposure of $900 million, to remediate the risk. On the Orkney Re II transaction, the Company, as directing financial guarantor, is taking remedial action.

        Some credit losses have been realized on the securities in the Ballantyne and Orkney Re II portfolios and significant additional credit losses are expected to occur. Performance of the underlying blocks of life insurance business thus far generally has been in accordance with expectations. The combination of cash flows from the investment accounts and the treaty settlements currently is sufficient to cover interest payments due on the notes that we insure. Adverse treaty performance and/or a rise in credit losses on the invested assets are expected to lead to interest shortfalls. Additionally, the transactions also contain features linked to the market values of the invested assets, reserve funding requirements on the underlying blocks of life insurance business, and minimum capital

88


Table of Contents

requirements for the transactions themselves that may trigger a shut off of interest payments to the insured notes and thereby result in claim payments by the Company.

        Another key risk is that the occurrence of certain events may result in a situation where either Ballantyne and/or Orkney Re II are required to sell assets and potentially realize substantial investment losses and for Assured Guaranty Ltd. to incur corresponding insured losses ahead of the scheduled final maturity date. For example, cedants to Scottish Re may have the right to recapture blocks of life insurance business which Scottish Re has ceded to Orkney Re II. Such recaptures could require Orkney Re II to sell assets and realize investment losses. In the Ballantyne transaction, further declines in the market value of the invested assets and/or an increase in the reserve funding requirements could lead to a similar mandatory realization of investment losses and for Assured Guaranty Ltd. to incur corresponding insured losses ahead of the scheduled final maturity date.

        In order for the Company to incur an ultimate net loss on these transactions, adverse experience on the underlying block of life insurance policies and/or credit losses in the investment portfolio would need to exceed the level of credit enhancement built into the transaction structures. Based on its analysis of the information currently available, including estimates of future investment performance, projected credit impairments on the invested assets and performance of the blocks of life insurance business, at December 31, 2008, the Company established a case reserve of $17.2 million for the Ballantyne transaction. This case reserve reflects expected losses resulting primarily from the deterioration in the investment portfolio as discussed above. At this time we do not expect the shut off triggers or recaptures by cedants discussed above to occur. Should these events occur our losses could be significantly greater than our case reserve. The Company has not established a case loss reserve for the Orkney Re II transaction.

        On December 19, 2008, the Company sued J.P. Morgan Investment Management Inc. ("JPMIM"), the investment manager in the Orkney II transaction, in New York Supreme Court alleging that JPMIM engaged in breaches of fiduciary duty, gross negligence and breaches of contract based upon its handling of the investments of Orkney Re II. JPMIM requested and was given an extension of time to answer until the end of February.

        The Company has exposure to a public finance transaction for sewer service in Jefferson County, Alabama through several reinsurance treaties. The Company's total exposure to this transaction is approximately $456 million as of December 31, 2008. The Company has made debt service payments during the year and expects to make additional payments in the near term. Through our cedants, the Company is currently in discussions with the bond issuer to structure a solution, which may result in some or all of these payments being recoverable. A case reserve of $6.0 million has been established as of December 31, 2008.

        A sensitivity analysis is not appropriate for our other segment reserves since the amounts are 100% reinsured.

        We also record IBNR reserves for our other segment. IBNR is an estimate of losses for which the insured event has occurred but the claim has not yet been reported to us. In establishing IBNR, we use traditional actuarial methods to estimate the reporting lag of such claims based on historical experience, claim reviews and information reported by ceding companies. We record IBNR for trade credit reinsurance within our other segment, which is 100% reinsured. The other segment represents lines of business that we exited or sold as part of our 2004 IPO.

        For mortgage guaranty transactions we record portfolio reserves in a manner consistent with our financial guaranty business. While other mortgage guaranty insurance companies do not record portfolio reserves, rather just case and IBNR reserves, we record portfolio reserves because we write business on an excess of loss basis, while other industry participants write quota share or first layer loss business. We manage and underwrite this business in the same manner as our financial guaranty

89


Table of Contents


insurance and reinsurance business because they have similar characteristics as insured obligations of mortgage-backed securities.

        Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ("FAS") No. 60, "Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises" ("FAS 60") is the authoritative guidance for an insurance enterprise. FAS 60 prescribes differing reserving methodologies depending on whether a contract fits within its definition of a short-duration contract or a long-duration contract. Financial guaranty contracts have elements of long-duration insurance contracts in that they are irrevocable and extend over a period that may exceed 30 years or more, but for regulatory purposes are reported as property and liability insurance, which are normally considered short-duration contracts. The short-duration and long-duration classifications have different methods of accounting for premium revenue and contract liability recognition. Additionally, the accounting for deferred acquisition costs ("DAC") could be different under the two methods.

        We believe the guidance of FAS 60 does not expressly address the distinctive characteristics of financial guaranty insurance, so we also apply the analogous guidance of Emerging Issues Task Force ("EITF") Issue No. 85-20, "Recognition of Fees for Guaranteeing a Loan" ("EITF 85-20"), which provides guidance relating to the recognition of fees for guaranteeing a loan, which has similarities to financial guaranty insurance contracts. Under the guidance in EITF 85-20, the guarantor should assess the probability of loss on an ongoing basis to determine if a liability should be recognized under FAS No. 5, "Accounting for Contingencies" ("FAS 5"). FAS 5 requires that a loss be recognized where it is probable that one or more future events will occur confirming that a liability has been incurred at the date of the financial statements and the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated.

        The following tables summarize our reserves for losses and LAE by segment and type of reserve as of the dates presented. For an explanation of changes in these reserves see "—Consolidated Results of Operations."

 
  As of December 31, 2008  
 
  Financial Guaranty Direct   Financial Guaranty Reinsurance   Mortgage Guaranty   Other   Total  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

Financial Guaranty Insurance Reserves by segment and type(1):

                               

Case

  $ 64.2   $ 55.7   $ 0.1   $ 1.5   $ 121.5  

IBNR

                3.0     3.0  

Portfolio reserves associated with fundamentally sound credits

    11.8     35.5     2.5         49.8  

Portfolio reserves associated with CMC credits

    15.8     6.7             22.5  
                       
 

Total financial guaranty insurance loss and LAE reserves

    91.8     97.9     2.6     4.5     196.8  

Credit Derivative Reserves by segment and type(2):

                               

Case

    7.2     5.5             12.7  

Credit derivative portfolio reserves associated with fundamentally sound credits

    15.7                 15.7  

Credit derivative portfolio reserves associated with CMC credits

    23.4                 23.4  
                       
 

Total credit derivative loss and LAE reserves

    46.3     5.5             51.8  
                       
 

Total loss and LAE reserves, including credit derivatives(3)

  $ 138.1   $ 103.4   $ 2.6   $ 4.5   $ 248.6  
                       

90


Table of Contents

 

 
  As of December 31, 2007  
 
  Financial Guaranty Direct   Financial Guaranty Reinsurance   Mortgage Guaranty   Other   Total  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

Financial Guaranty Insurance Reserves by segment and type of reserve(1):

                               

Case

  $   $ 35.6   $ 0.1   $ 2.4   $ 38.1  

IBNR

                6.4     6.4  

Portfolio reserves associated with fundamentally sound credits

    17.0     33.0     2.8         52.8  

Portfolio reserves associated with CMC credits

    16.5     11.7             28.2  
                       
 

Total financial guaranty insurance loss and LAE reserves

    33.5     80.3     2.9     8.8     125.6  

Credit Derivative Reserves by segment and type(2):

                               

Case

    3.2                 3.2  

Credit derivative portfolio reserves associated with fundamentally sound credits

    3.9                 3.9  

Credit derivative portfolio reserves associated with CMC credits

    1.2                 1.2  
                       
 

Total credit derivative loss and LAE reserves

    8.3                 8.3  
                       
 

Total loss and LAE reserves, including credit derivatives(3)

  $ 41.8   $ 80.3   $ 2.9   $ 8.8   $ 133.8  
                       

(1)
Included in Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses on the Balance Sheet.

(2)
Included in Credit derivative liabilities/assets on the Balance Sheet.

(3)
Total does not add due to rounding.

        The following table sets forth the financial guaranty in-force portfolio by underlying rating:

 
  As of December 31, 2008   As of December 31, 2007  
Ratings(1)
  Net par outstanding   % of Net par outstanding   Net par outstanding   % of Net par outstanding  
 
  (in billions of U.S. dollars)
 

Super senior

  $ 32.4     14.5 % $ 36.4     18.2 %

AAA

    40.7     18.3 %   47.3     23.6 %

AA

    47.7     21.4 %   38.4     19.2 %

A

    66.0     29.6 %   49.2     24.6 %

BBB

    29.4     13.2 %   26.9     13.4 %

Below investment grade

    6.6     3.0 %   2.1     1.1 %
                   
 

Total exposures(2)

  $ 222.7     100.0 % $ 200.3     100.0 %
                   

(1)
The Company's internal rating. The Company's scale is comparable to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies. The super senior category, which is not generally used by rating agencies, is used by the Company in instances where the Company's AAA-rated exposure has additional credit enhancement due to either (1) the existence of another security rated AAA that is subordinated to the Company's exposure or (2) the Company's exposure benefits from a different form of credit enhancement that would pay any claims first in the event that any of the

91


Table of Contents

(2)
Total does not add due to rounding.

        The change in ratings above is mainly related to the Company's U.S. RMBS exposures.

        Our surveillance department is responsible for monitoring our portfolio of credits and maintains a list of closely monitored credits ("CMC"). The closely monitored credits are divided into four categories: Category 1 (low priority; fundamentally sound, greater than normal risk); Category 2 (medium priority; weakening credit profile, may result in loss); Category 3 (high priority; claim/default probable, case reserve established); Category 4 (claim paid, case reserve established for future payments). The closely monitored credits include all below investment grade ("BIG") exposures where there is a material amount of exposure (generally greater than $10.0 million) or a material risk of the Company incurring a loss greater than $0.5 million. The closely monitored credits also include investment grade ("IG") risks where credit quality is deteriorating and where, in the view of the Company, there is significant potential that the risk quality will fall below investment grade. As of December 31, 2008, the closely monitored credits include approximately 99% of our BIG exposure, and the remaining BIG exposure of $92.3 million was distributed across 89 different credits. As of December 31, 2007, the closely monitored credits include approximately 99% of our BIG exposure, and the remaining BIG exposure of $19.8 million was distributed across 46 different credits. Other than those excluded BIG credits, credits that are not included in the closely monitored credit list are categorized as fundamentally sound risks.

        The following table provides financial guaranty insurance policy and credit derivative contract net par outstanding by credit monitoring category as of December 31, 2008 and 2007:

 
  As of December 31, 2008  
Description:
  Net Par Outstanding   % of Net Par Outstanding   # of Credits in Category   Case Reserves(2)  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Fundamentally sound risk

  $ 215,987     97.0 %            

Closely monitored credits:

                         
 

Category 1

    2,967     1.3 %   51   $  
 

Category 2

    767     0.3 %   21     1  
 

Category 3

    2,889     1.3 %   54     111  
 

Category 4

    20         14     20  
                   
   

CMC total(1)

    6,643     3.0 %   140     133  
                     

Other below investment grade risk

    92         89      
                     

Total(1)

  $ 222,722     100.0 %       $ 133  
                     

92


Table of Contents

 

 
  As of December 31, 2007  
Description:
  Net Par Outstanding   % of Net Par Outstanding   # of Credits in Category   Case Reserves(2)  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Fundamentally sound risk

  $ 198,133     98.9 %            

Closely monitored credits:

                         
 

Category 1

    1,288     0.6 %   36   $  
 

Category 2

    743     0.4 %   12      
 

Category 3

    71         16     17  
 

Category 4

    24         16     22  
                   
   

CMC total(1)

    2,126     1.1 %   80     39  
                     

Other below investment grade risk

    20         46      
                     

Total

  $ 200,279     100.0 %       $ 39  
                     

(1)
Total does not add due to rounding.

(2)
Includes case reserves on credit derivatives of $12.7 million at December 31, 2008 and $3.2 million at December 31, 2007, which balances are included in credit derivative liabilities in the Company's consolidated balance sheets.

        The following table summarizes movements in CMC exposure by risk category:

Net Par Outstanding
  Category 1   Category 2   Category 3   Category 4   Total CMC  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Balance, December 31, 2007

  $ 1,288   $ 743   $ 71   $ 24   $ 2,126  

Less: amortization

    66     395     211     1     673  

Additions from first time on CMC

    4,171     1,022     225         5,418  

Deletions—Upgraded and removed

    195         30     3     228  

Category movement

    (2,231 )   (603 )   2,834          
                       

Net change

    1,679     24     2,818     (4 )   4,517  
                       

Balance, December 31, 2008

  $ 2,967   $ 767   $ 2,889   $ 20   $ 6,643  
                       

93


Table of Contents

        The increase of $4,517 million in financial guaranty CMC net par outstanding during 2008 is mainly attributable to the downgrade of RMBS or RMBS related exposures.

Industry Methodology

        The Company is aware that there are certain differences regarding the measurement of portfolio loss liabilities among companies in the financial guaranty industry. In January and February 2005, the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") staff had discussions concerning these differences with a number of industry participants. Based on those discussions, in June 2005, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") staff decided additional guidance is necessary regarding financial guaranty contracts. In May 2008, the FASB issued FAS No. 163, "Accounting for Financial Guarantee Insurance Contracts—An Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 60" ("FAS 163"). FAS 163 requires that an insurance enterprise recognize a claim liability prior to an event of default (insured event) when there is evidence that credit deterioration has occurred in an insured financial obligation. FAS 163 also clarifies the methodology to be used for financial guaranty premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement as well as requiring expanded disclosures about the insurance enterprise's risk management activities. The provisions of FAS 163 related to premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement are effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and all interim periods within those fiscal years. Earlier application of these provisions is not permitted. The expanded risk management activity disclosure provisions of FAS 163 are effective for the third quarter of 2008 and are included in Note 11 "Significant Risk Management Activities" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K. FAS 163 will be applied to all existing and future financial guaranty insurance contracts written by us. The cumulative effect of initially applying FAS 163 will be recorded as an adjustment to retained earnings as of January 1, 2009. The adoption of FAS 163 is expected to have a material effect on our financial statements. We are in the process of estimating the impact of the adoption of FAS 163. We will continue to follow our existing accounting policies in regards to premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement until we complete our first quarter 2009 financial statements.

Reclassification

        Effective with the quarter ended March 31, 2008, we reclassified the revenues, expenses and balance sheet items associated with financial guaranty contracts that our financial guaranty subsidiaries write in the form of CDS contracts. The reclassification does not change our net income (loss) or shareholder's equity. This reclassification is being adopted by us after agreement with member companies of the Association of Financial Guaranty Insurers in consultation with the staffs of the Office of the Chief Accountant and the Division of Corporate Finance of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The reclassification is being implemented in order to increase comparability of our financial statements with other financial guaranty companies that have CDS contracts.

        Our CDS contracts provide for credit protection against payment default and have substantially the same terms and conditions as its financial guaranty insurance contracts. Under United States Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, however, CDS contracts are subject to derivative accounting rules and financial guaranty policies are subject to insurance accounting rules.

        In our accompanying consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, we have reclassified CDS revenues from "net earned premiums" to "realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives." Loss and loss adjustment expenses and recoveries that were previously included in "loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)" will be reclassified to "realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives," as well. Portfolio and case loss and loss adjustment expenses will be reclassified from "loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)" and will be included in "unrealized

94


Table of Contents


gains (losses) on credit derivatives," which previously included only unrealized mark to market gains or losses on our contracts written in CDS form. In the consolidated balance sheet, we reclassified all CDS-related balances previously included in "unearned premium reserves," "reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses," "prepaid reinsurance premiums," "premiums receivable" and "reinsurance balances payable" to either "credit derivative liabilities" or "credit derivative assets," depending on the net position of the CDS contract at each balance sheet date.

Fair Value of Credit Derivatives

        The Company follows FAS 133, FAS No. 149, "Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" ("FAS 149") and FAS No. 155, "Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments" ("FAS 155"), which establishes accounting and reporting standards for derivative instruments and FAS No. 157 "Fair Value Measurements" ("FAS 157"), which establishes a comprehensive framework for measuring fair value. FAS 133 and FAS 149 require recognition of all derivatives on the balance sheet at fair value. FAS 157 defines fair value as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. FAS 157 also requires an entity maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value. The standard describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value. The price shall represent that available in the principal market for the asset or liability. If there is no principal market, then the price is based on the market that maximizes the value received for an asset or minimizes the amount paid for a liability (i.e. the most advantageous market).

        FAS 157 specifies a fair value hierarchy based on whether the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect Company-based market assumptions. In accordance with FAS 157, the fair value hierarchy prioritizes model inputs into three broad levels as follows:

        An asset or liability's categorization within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of significant input to its valuation.

        We issue credit derivatives that we view as an extension of our financial guaranty business but that do not qualify for the financial guaranty insurance scope exception under FAS 133 and FAS 149 and therefore are reported at fair value, with changes in fair value included in our earnings.

        Our realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives include credit derivative premiums received and receivable, credit derivative losses paid and payable and realized gains or losses due to early terminations and ceding commissions (expense) income. Credit derivative premiums and ceding commissions (expense) income are earned over the life of the transaction. Claim payments or recoveries are related to credit events requiring payment by or to us under the credit derivative

95


Table of Contents


contract. Realized gains or losses are recorded related to the early termination of credit derivative contracts.

        Our unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives represent changes in fair value of these instruments that are required to be recorded under FAS 133. The unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives will reduce to zero as the exposure approaches its maturity date, unless there is a payment default on the exposure. However, in the event that we terminate a credit derivative contract prior to maturity the unrealized gain or loss will be realized through realized gains or losses and other settlements on credit derivatives. Changes in the fair value of our credit derivative contracts do not reflect actual claims or credit losses, and have no impact on the Company's claims-paying resources, rating agency capital or regulatory capital positions or debt covenants.

        We do not typically exit our credit derivative contracts and there are not quoted prices for our instruments or similar instruments. Observable inputs other than quoted market prices exist, however, these inputs reflect contracts that do not contain terms and conditions similar to the credit derivatives issued by us. Therefore, the valuation of our credit derivative contracts requires the use of models that contain significant, unobservable inputs. Thus, we believe that our credit derivative contract valuations are in Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy of FAS 157.

        The fair value of these instruments represents the difference between the present value of remaining contractual premiums charged for the credit protection and the estimated present value of premiums that a comparable financial guarantor would hypothetically charge for the same protection at the balance sheet date. The fair value of these contracts depends on a number of factors including notional amount of the contract, expected term, credit spreads, changes in interest rates, the credit ratings of the referenced entities, our own credit risk and remaining contractual flows.

        Remaining contractual cash flows, which are included in the realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives component of credit derivatives, are the most readily observable variables since they are based on the CDS contractual terms. These variables include i) net premiums received and receivable on written credit derivative contracts, ii) net premiums paid and payable on purchased contracts, iii) losses paid and payable to credit derivative contract counterparties and iv) losses recovered and recoverable on purchased contracts. The remaining key variables described above impact unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives.

        Market conditions at December 31, 2008 were such that market prices for our CDS contracts were generally not available. Where market prices were not available, we used a combination of observable market data and valuation models, including various market indexes, credit spreads, our own credit risk and estimated contractual payments to estimate the fair value of the Company's credit derivatives. These models are primarily developed internally based on market conventions for similar transactions. Management considers the non-standard terms of its credit derivative contracts in determining the fair value of these contracts. These terms differ from credit derivatives sold by companies outside of the financial guaranty industry. The non-standard terms include the absence of collateral support agreements or immediate settlement provisions, relatively high attachment points and the fact that the Company does not exit derivatives it sells for credit protection purposes, except under specific circumstances such as exiting a line of business. Because of these terms and conditions, the fair value of the Company's credit derivatives may not reflect the same prices observed in an actively traded market of credit default swaps that do not contain terms and conditions similar to those observed in the financial guaranty market. These models and the related assumptions are continuously reevaluated by management and enhanced, as appropriate, based upon improvements in modeling techniques and availability of more timely market information

96


Table of Contents

        Valuation models include the use of management estimates and current market information. Management is also required to make assumptions on how the fair value of credit derivative instruments is affected by current market conditions. Management considers factors such as current prices charged for similar agreements, performance of underlying assets, life of the instrument, and the extent of credit default swaps exposure the Company ceded under reinsurance agreements, and the nature and extent of activity in the financial guaranty credit derivative marketplace. The assumptions that management uses to determine its fair value may change in the future due to market conditions. Due to the inherent uncertainties of the assumptions used in the valuation models to determine the fair value of these credit derivative products, actual experience may differ from the estimates reflected in the Company's consolidated financial statements, and the differences may be material.

        The fair value adjustment excluding incurred losses on credit derivatives recognized in our statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2008 was a $81.7 million gain compared with a $666.9 million loss for the year ended December 31, 2007 and a $5.5 million loss for the year ended December 31, 2006. The 2008 gain includes a gain of $4,147.6 million associated with the change in AGC's credit spread, which widened substantially from 180 basis points at December 31, 2007 to 1,775 basis points at December 31, 2008. Management believes that the widening of AGC's credit spread is due to the correlation between AGC's risk profile and that experienced currently by the broader financial markets and increased demand for credit protection against AGC as the result of its increased business volume. Offsetting the gain attributable to the significant increase in AGC's credit spread were declines in fixed income security market prices primarily attributable to widening spreads in certain markets as a result of the continued deterioration in credit markets and some credit rating downgrades, rather than from delinquencies or defaults on securities guaranteed by the Company. The higher credit spreads in the fixed income security market are due to the recent lack of liquidity in the high yield collateralized debt obligation and collateralized loan obligation markets as well as continuing market concerns over the most recent vintages of subprime residential mortgage backed securities and commercial mortgage backed securities. The 2007 loss is primarily related to spreads widening and includes no credit losses. For the year ended 2007, approximately 45% of the Company's unrealized loss on credit derivatives was due to a decline in the market value of high yield and investment grade corporate collateralized loan obligation transactions, with the balance generated by lower market values principally in the residential and commercial mortgage-backed securities markets. The 2006 loss of $5.5 million is primarily related to the run-off of transactions and changes in credit spreads. With considerable volatility continuing in the market, the fair value adjustment amount will fluctuate significantly in future periods.

Fair Value of Committed Capital Securities ("CCS")

        The fair value of CCS Securities represents the present value of remaining expected put option premium payments under the CCS Securities agreements and the value of such estimated payments based upon the quoted price for such premium payments as of December 31, 2008 and 2007. The $51.1 million and $8.3 million fair value asset for CCS Securities as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, is included in the consolidated balance sheets. Changes in fair value of this asset are included in other income in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. In 2008 and 2007 the Company recorded a fair value gain of $42.7 million and $8.3 million, pre-tax, respectively, related to Assured Guaranty Corp.'s CCS Securities.

Valuation of Investments

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, we had total investments of $3.6 billion and $3.1 billion, respectively. The fair values of all of our investments are calculated from independent market valuations. The fair values of the Company's U.S. Treasury securities are primarily determined based

97


Table of Contents


upon broker dealer quotes obtained from several independent active market makers. The fair values of the Company's portfolio other than U.S. Treasury securities are determined primarily using matrix pricing models. The matrix pricing models incorporate factors such as tranche type, collateral coupons, average life, payment speeds, and spreads, in order to calculate the fair values of specific securities owned by the Company. As of December 31, 2008, under FAS 157, all of our fixed maturity securities were classified as Level 2 and our short-term investments were classified as either Level 1 or Level 2.

        As of December 31, 2008, approximately 87% of our investments were long-term fixed maturity securities, and our portfolio had an average duration of 4.1 years, compared with 82% and 3.9 years as of December 31, 2007. Changes in interest rates affect the value of our fixed maturity portfolio. As interest rates fall, the fair value of fixed maturity securities increases and as interest rates rise, the fair value of fixed maturity securities decreases. The Company's portfolio is comprised primarily of high-quality, liquid instruments. We continue to receive sufficient information to value our investments and have not had to modify our approach due to the current market conditions.

        The following table summarizes the estimated change in fair value on our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2008 based upon an assumed parallel shift in interest rates across the entire yield curve:

Change in Interest Rates
  Estimated Increase (Decrease) in Fair Value  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

300 basis point rise

  $ (484.1 )

200 basis point rise

    (329.2 )

100 basis point rise

    (166.3 )

100 basis point decline

    161.6  

200 basis point decline

    304.2  

300 basis point decline

    420.6  

        See Item 7A, "Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk" for more information.

Other Than Temporary Impairments

        We have a formal review process for all securities in our investment portfolio, including a review for impairment losses. Factors considered when assessing impairment include:

        If we believe a decline in the value of a particular investment is temporary, we record the decline as an unrealized loss on our balance sheet in "accumulated other comprehensive income" in

98


Table of Contents


shareholders' equity. If we believe the decline is "other than temporary," we write down the carrying value of the investment and record a realized loss in our statement of operations. In periods subsequent to the recognition of an other-than-temporary impairment, the impaired security is accounted for as if it had been purchased on the measurement date of the impairment. Accordingly, the discount (or reduced premium) based on the new cost basis is accreted into net investment income in future periods based upon the amount and timing of expected future cash flows of the security, if the recoverable value of the investment based upon those cash flows is greater than the carrying value of the investment after the impairment.

        Our assessment of a decline in value includes management's current assessment of the factors noted above. If that assessment changes in the future, we may ultimately record a loss after having originally concluded that the decline in value was temporary.

        As part of our other than temporary impairment review process, we consider the nature of the investment, the cause for the impairment (interest or credit related), the severity (both as a percentage of book value and absolute dollars) and duration of the impairment and any other available evidence, such as discussions with investment advisors, volatility of the securities fair value, recent news reports, etc., when performing our assessment.

        The Company recognized $71.3 million of other than temporary impairment losses substantially related to mortgage-backed and corporate securities for the year ended December 31, 2008 primarily due to the fact that it does not have the intent to hold these securities until there is a recovery in their value. The Company continues to monitor the value of these investments. Future events may result in further impairment of the Company's investments. The Company had no write downs of investments for other than temporary impairment losses for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006.

        As of December 31, 2008, excluding the securities described above, the Company's gross unrealized loss position stood at $122.5 million compared to $8.9 million at December 31, 2007. The $113.6 million increase in gross unrealized losses was primarily attributable to mortgage and asset-backed securities, $54.3 million, municipal securities, $48.6 million, and corporate securities, $10.4 million. The increase in these unrealized losses during the year ended December 31, 2008 was related to the overall illiquidity in the financial markets and resulted in a sudden and severe depressed demand for non-cash investments.

        As of December 31, 2008, the Company had 58 securities in an unrealized loss position for greater than 12 months, representing a gross unrealized loss of $31.6 million. Of these securities, 20 securities had unrealized losses greater than 10% of book value. The total unrealized loss for these securities as of December 31, 2008 was $24.1 million. This unrealized loss is primarily attributable to the market illiquidity and volatility in the U.S. economy mentioned above and not specific to individual issuer credit. Except as noted below, the Company has recognized no other than temporary impairment losses and has the ability and intent to hold these securities until a recovery in value.

99


Table of Contents

        The following table summarizes the unrealized losses in our investment portfolio by type of security and the length of time such securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position as of the dates indicated:

 
  As of December 31, 2008   As of December 31, 2007  
Length of Time in Continuous Unrealized Loss Position
  Estimated Fair Value   Gross Unrealized Losses   Estimated Fair Value   Gross Unrealized Losses  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Municipal securities

                         

0–6 months

  $ 168.8   $ (5.8 ) $ 67.2   $ (0.6 )

7–12 months

    310.6     (22.9 )   123.0     (1.9 )

Greater than 12 months

    137.9     (22.7 )   8.6     (0.3 )
                   

    617.3     (51.4 )   198.8     (2.8 )

Corporate and foreign government securities

                         

0–6 months

    23.7     (1.7 )   13.6     (0.3 )

7–12 months

    81.9     (8.5 )   22.2     (0.8 )

Greater than 12 months

    14.2     (1.6 )   12.8     (0.3 )
                   

    119.8     (11.8 )   48.6     (1.4 )

U.S. Government obligations

                         

0–6 months

            25.4      

7–12 months

    8.0              

Greater than 12 months

                 
                   

    8.0         25.4      

Mortgage and asset-backed securities

                         

0–6 months

    143.6     (15.5 )   37.7     (0.4 )

7–12 months

    111.0     (36.2 )   32.0     (0.3 )

Greater than 12 months

    74.4     (7.3 )   254.4     (4.0 )
                   

    329.0     (59.0 )   324.1     (4.7 )

Preferred stock

                         

0–6 months

    12.4     (0.3 )        

7–12 months

                 

Greater than 12 months

                 
                   

    12.4     (0.3 )        
                   

Total

  $ 1,086.5   $ (122.5 ) $ 596.9   $ (8.9 )
                   

100


Table of Contents

        The following table summarizes the unrealized losses in our investment portfolio by type of security and remaining time to maturity as of the dates indicated:

 
  As of December 31, 2008   As of December 31, 2007  
Remaining Time to Maturity
  Estimated
Fair
Value
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Estimated
Fair
Value
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
 
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Municipal securities

                         

Due in one year or less

  $   $   $   $  

Due after one year through five years

    5.4              

Due after five years through ten years

    42.4     (2.6 )   1.9     (0.1 )

Due after ten years

    569.5     (48.8 )   196.9     (2.7 )
                   

    617.3     (51.4 )   198.8     (2.8 )

Corporate and foreign government securities

                         

Due in one year or less

    0.8         7.2      

Due after one year through five years

    23.9     (1.2 )   16.1     (0.3 )

Due after five years through ten years

    72.6     (6.6 )   12.0     (0.2 )

Due after ten years

    22.5     (4.0 )   13.3     (0.9 )
                   

    119.8     (11.8 )   48.6     (1.4 )

U.S. Government obligations

                         

Due in one year or less

    8.0              

Due after one year through five years

            25.4      

Due after five years through ten years

                 

Due after ten years

                 
                   

    8.0         25.4      

Mortgage and asset-backed securities

   
329.0
   
(59.0

)
 
324.1
   
(4.7

)

Preferred stock

   
12.4
   
(0.3

)
 
   
 
                   
 

Total

  $ 1,086.5   $ (122.5 ) $ 596.9   $ (8.9 )
                   

101


Table of Contents

        The following table summarizes, for all realized losses through December 31, 2008 and 2007, the fair value and realized loss by length of time such securities were in a continuous unrealized loss position prior to the date of sale of the security or the recognition of an other than temporary loss:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007  
Length of Time in Continuous Unrealized Loss Position Prior to Sale
  Estimated
Fair
Value
  Gross
Realized
Losses(1)
  Estimated
Fair
Value
  Gross
Realized
Losses
 
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Municipal securities

                         

0–6 months

  $ 2.5   $ (0.3 ) $ 45.6   $ (0.2 )

7–12 months

                 

Greater than 12 months

    3.6     (1.5 )        
                   

    6.1     (1.8 )   45.6     (0.2 )

Corporate and foreign government securities

                         

0–6 months

    6.4     (6.1 )   12.6      

7–12 months

    3.6     (7.5 )   12.6     (0.1 )

Greater than 12 months

    2.9     (7.5 )   16.4     (0.3 )
                   

    12.9     (21.1 )   41.6     (0.4 )

U.S. Government securities

                         

0–6 months

            25.0     (0.4 )

7–12 months

            0.8      

Greater than 12 months

            17.8     (0.2 )
                   

            43.6     (0.6 )

Mortgage and asset-backed securities

                         

0–6 months

    82.0     (13.5 )   92.1     (0.6 )

7–12 months

    35.1     (20.9 )   0.3      

Greater than 12 months

    51.4     (15.0 )   105.8     (1.5 )
                   

    168.5     (49.4 )   198.2     (2.1 )

Preferred stock

                         

0–6 months

    4.8     (3.1 )        

7–12 months

                 

Greater than 12 months

                 
                   

    4.8     (3.1 )        
                   
 

Total

  $ 192.3   $ (75.4 ) $ 329.0   $ (3.3 )
                   

(1)
Includes $71.3 million of other than temporary realized losses in 2008. There were no other than temporary realized losses in 2007.

Premium Revenue Recognition

        Premiums are received either upfront or in installments. Upfront premiums are earned in proportion to the expiration of the amount at risk. Each installment premium is earned ratably over its installment period, generally one year or less. Premium earnings under both the upfront and installment revenue recognition methods are based upon and are in proportion to the principal amount guaranteed and therefore result in higher premium earnings during periods where guaranteed principal is higher. For insured bonds for which the par value outstanding is declining during the insurance

102


Table of Contents


period, upfront premium earnings are greater in the earlier periods thus matching revenue recognition with the underlying risk. For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, approximately 81%, 78% and 72%, respectively, of our gross written premiums were received upfront, and 19%, 22% and 28%, respectively, were received in installments. The premiums are allocated in accordance with the principal amortization schedule of the related bond issue and are earned ratably over the amortization period. When an insured issue is retired early, is called by the issuer, or is in substance paid in advance through a refunding accomplished by placing U.S. Government securities in escrow, the remaining unearned premium reserves are earned at that time. Unearned premium reserves represent the portion of premiums written that is applicable to the unexpired amount at risk of insured bonds.

        In our reinsurance businesses, we estimate the ultimate written and earned premiums to be received from a ceding company at the end of each quarter and the end of each year because some of our ceding companies report premium data anywhere from 30 to 90 days after the end of the relevant period. Written premiums reported in our statement of operations are based upon reports received from ceding companies supplemented by our own estimates of premium for which ceding company reports have not yet been received. As of December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 the assumed premium estimate and related ceding commissions included in our consolidated financial statements are $5.4 million and $1.0 million, $8.8 million and $2.0 million and $25.1 million and $7.9 million, respectively. Key assumptions used to arrive at management's best estimate of assumed premiums are premium amounts reported historically and informal communications with ceding companies. Differences between such estimates and actual amounts are recorded in the period in which the actual amounts are determined. Historically, the differences have not been material. We do not record a provision for doubtful accounts related to our assumed premium estimate. Historically there have not been any material issues related to the collectibility of assumed premium. No provision for doubtful accounts related to our premium receivable was recorded for 2008, 2007 or 2006.

Deferred Acquisition Costs

        Acquisition costs incurred, other than those associated with credit derivative products, that vary with and are directly related to the production of new business are deferred and amortized in relation to earned premiums. These costs include direct and indirect expenses such as ceding commissions, brokerage expenses and the cost of underwriting and marketing personnel. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, we had deferred acquisition costs of $288.6 million and $259.3 million, respectively. Ceding commissions paid to primary insurers are the largest component of deferred acquisition costs, constituting 59% and 68% of total deferred acquisition costs as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Management uses its judgment in determining what types of costs should be deferred, as well as what percentage of these costs should be deferred. We annually conduct a study to determine which operating costs vary with, and are directly related to, the acquisition of new business and qualify for deferral. Ceding commissions received on premiums we cede to other reinsurers reduce acquisition costs. Anticipated losses, LAE and the remaining costs of servicing the insured or reinsured business are considered in determining the recoverability of acquisition costs. Acquisition costs associated with credit derivative products are expensed as incurred. When an insured issue is retired early, as discussed in the Premium Revenue Recognition section of these Critical Accounting Estimates, the remaining related deferred acquisition cost is expensed at that time.

Deferred Income Taxes

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, we had a net deferred income tax asset of $129.1 million and a net deferred income tax asset of $147.6 million, respectively. Certain of our subsidiaries are subject to U.S. income tax. Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are established for the temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities using enacted rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. Such temporary differences

103


Table of Contents


relate principally to unrealized gains and losses on investments and credit derivatives, deferred acquisition costs, reserves for losses and LAE, unearned premium reserves, net operating loss carryforwards ("NOLs") and statutory contingency reserves. A valuation allowance is recorded to reduce a deferred tax asset to the amount that in management's opinion is more likely than not to be realized.

        As of December 31, 2008, Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. ("AGRO") had a stand alone NOL of $47.9 million, compared with $54.8 million as of December, 31, 2007, which is available to offset its future U.S. taxable income. The Company has $27.2 million of this NOL available through 2017 and $20.7 million available through 2023. AGRO's stand alone NOL is not permitted to offset the income of any other members of AGRO's consolidated group due to certain tax regulations.

        Under applicable accounting rules, we are required to establish a valuation allowance for NOLs that we believe are more likely than not to expire before being utilized. Management has assessed the likelihood of realization of all of its deferred tax assets. Based on this analysis, management believes it is more likely than not that $20.0 million of AGRO's $47.9 million NOL will not be utilized before it expires and has established a $7.0 million valuation allowance related to the NOL deferred tax asset. Management believes that all other deferred income taxes are more-likely-than-not to be realized. The valuation allowance is subject to considerable judgment, is reviewed quarterly and will be adjusted to the extent actual taxable income differs from estimates of future taxable income that may be used to realize NOLs or capital losses.

Taxation of Subsidiaries

        The Company's Bermuda subsidiaries are not subject to any income, withholding or capital gains taxes under current Bermuda law. The Company's U.S. and U.K. subsidiaries are subject to income taxes imposed by U.S. and U.K. authorities and file applicable tax returns. In addition, AGRO, a Bermuda domiciled company, has elected under Section 953(d) of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code to be taxed as a U.S. domestic corporation.

        The U.S. Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") has completed audits of all of the Company's U.S. subsidiaries' federal income tax returns for taxable years through 2001. In September 2007, the IRS completed its audit of tax years 2002 through 2004 for Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries, which includes Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc., AGRO, Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company and AG Intermediary Inc. As a result of the audit there were no significant findings and no cash settlements with the IRS. In addition the IRS is reviewing Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries ("AGUS") for tax years 2002 through the date of the IPO. AGUS includes Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., AGC and AG Financial Products and were part of the consolidated tax return of a subsidiary of ACE Limited ("ACE"), our former Parent, for years prior to the IPO. The Company is indemnified by ACE for any potential tax liability associated with the tax examination of AGUS as it relates to years prior to the IPO. In addition, tax years 2005 and subsequent remain open.

Uncertain Tax Positions

        The Company adopted the provisions of FASB Interpretation No. 48, "Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes—an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109" ("FIN 48"), on January 1, 2007. As a result of the adoption of FIN 48, the Company reduced its liability for unrecognized tax benefits and increased retained earnings by $2.6 million. The total liability for unrecognized tax benefits as of January 1, 2007 was $12.9 million. This entire amount, if recognized, would affect the effective tax rate.

        Subsequent to the adoption of FIN 48, the IRS published final regulations on the treatment of consolidated losses. As a result of these regulations the utilization of certain capital losses is no longer at a level that would require recording an associated liability for an uncertain tax position. As such, the

104


Table of Contents


Company decreased its liability for unrecognized tax benefits and its provision for income taxes $4.1 million during the period ended March 31, 2007. In September 2007, upon completion of the IRS audit of Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries, the liability for unrecognized tax benefits was reduced by approximately $6.0 million.

        The total liability for unrecognized tax benefits as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 was $5.1 million and $2.8 million, respectively, and is included in other liabilities on the balance sheets. During the year ended December 31, 2008 the net liability increased by approximately $2.3 million due to a position management intends to take on the Company's 2008 tax return. The Company does not believe it is reasonably possible that this amount will change significantly in the next twelve months.

        The Company's policy is to recognize interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in income tax expense. As of the date of adoption, the Company has accrued $0.9 million in interest and penalties.

Liability For Tax Basis Step-Up Adjustment

        In connection with the IPO, the Company and ACE Financial Services Inc. ("AFS"), a subsidiary of ACE, entered into a tax allocation agreement, whereby the Company and AFS made a "Section 338 (h)(10)" election that has the effect of increasing the tax basis of certain affected subsidiaries' tangible and intangible assets to fair value. Future tax benefits that the Company derives from the election will be payable to AFS when realized by the Company.

        As a result of the election, the Company has adjusted its net deferred tax liability to reflect the new tax basis of the Company's affected assets. The additional basis is expected to result in increased future income tax deductions and, accordingly, may reduce income taxes otherwise payable by the Company. Any tax benefit realized by the Company will be paid to AFS. Such tax benefits will generally be calculated by comparing the Company's affected subsidiaries' actual taxes to the taxes that would have been owed by those subsidiaries had the increase in basis not occurred. After a 15 year period, to the extent there remains an unrealized tax benefit, the Company and AFS will negotiate a settlement of the unrealized benefit based on the expected realization at that time.

        The Company initially recorded a $49.0 million reduction of its existing deferred tax liability, based on an estimate of the ultimate resolution of the Section 338(h)(10) election. Under the tax allocation agreement, the Company estimated that, as of the IPO date, it was obligated to pay $20.9 million to AFS and accordingly established this amount as a liability. The initial difference, which is attributable to the change in the tax basis of certain liabilities for which there is no associated step-up in the tax basis of its assets and no amounts due to AFS, resulted in an increase to additional paid-in capital of $28.1 million. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the liability for tax basis step-up adjustment, which is included in the Company's balance sheets in "Other liabilities," was $9.1 million and $9.9 million, respectively. The Company has paid ACE and correspondingly reduced its liability by $0.7 million and $5.1 million in 2008 and 2007, respectively.

Accounting for Share-Based Compensation

        Prior to January 1, 2006, we accounted for our share-based employee compensation plans under the measurement and recognition provisions of Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees" ("APB 25") and related Interpretations, as permitted by FAS No. 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" ("FAS 123").

        Effective January 1, 2006, we adopted the fair value recognition provisions of FAS No. 123 (revised), "Share-Based Payment" ("FAS 123R") using the modified prospective transition method. Under that transition method, compensation expense includes: (a) compensation expense for all share-based payments granted prior to, but not yet vested as of January 1, 2006, based on the grant date fair

105


Table of Contents


value estimated in accordance with the original provisions of FAS 123, and (b) compensation expense for all share-based payments granted on or after January 1, 2006, based on the grant date fair value estimated in accordance with the provisions of FAS 123R. Because we elected to use the modified prospective transition method, results for prior periods have not been restated.

        The following table presents pre-DAC and pre-tax, share-based compensation cost by share-based expense type:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)
  2008   2007   2006  

Share-Based Employee Cost

                   

Restricted Stock

                   
 

Recurring amortization

  $ 6,075   $ 9,371   $ 7,676  
 

Accelerated amortization for retirement eligible employees

    125     4,074     1,534  
               
   

Subtotal

    6,200     13,445     9,210  
               

Restricted Stock Units

                   
 

Recurring amortization

    1,174          
 

Accelerated amortization for retirement eligible employees

    1,632          
               
   

Subtotal

    2,806          
               

Stock Options

                   
 

Recurring amortization

    3,373     3,632     3,581  
 

Accelerated amortization for retirement eligible employees

    1,498     1,782     655  
               
   

Subtotal

    4,871     5,414     4,236  
               

ESPP

    125     154     125  
               

Total Share-Based Employee Cost

    14,002     19,013     13,571  
               

Share-Based Directors Cost

                   

Restricted Stock

    441     219     289  

Restricted Stock Units

    677     804     843  
               

Total Share-Based Directors Cost

    1,118     1,023     1,132  
               

Total Share-Based Cost

  $ 15,120   $ 20,036   $ 14,703  
               

        At December 31, 2008, there was $12.3 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested share-based compensation arrangements granted under all equity compensation plans. Total unrecognized compensation cost will be adjusted for future changes in estimated forfeitures. We expect to recognize that cost over a weighted average period of 1.5 years. As a result of the adoption of FAS 123R, the income tax effects of compensatory stock options are included in the computation of the income tax expense (benefit), and deferred tax assets and liabilities, subject to certain prospective adjustments to shareholders' equity for the differences between the income tax effects of expenses recognized in the results of operations and the related amounts deducted for income tax purposes. Prior to the adoption of FAS 123R, the tax benefits relating to the income tax deductions for compensatory stock options were recorded directly to shareholders' equity.

        The weighted-average grant-date fair value of options granted were $7.59, $6.83 and $6.71 for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The fair value of options issued is

106


Table of Contents


estimated on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model, with the following weighted-average assumptions used for grants in 2008, 2007 and 2006:

 
  2008   2007   2006  

Dividend yield

    0.8%     0.6%     0.5%  

Expected volatility

    35.10%     19.03%     20.43%  

Risk free interest rate

    2.8%     4.7%     4.6%  

Expected life

    5 years     5 years     5 years  

Forfeiture rate

    6.0%     6.0%     6.0%  

        These assumptions were based on the following:

        For options granted before January 1, 2006, the Company amortizes the fair value on an accelerated basis. For options granted on or after January 1, 2006, the Company amortizes the fair value on a straight-line basis. All options are amortized over the requisite service periods of the awards, which are generally the vesting periods, with the exception of retirement-eligible employees. Stock options are generally granted once a year with exercise prices equal to the closing price on the date of grant. The Company may elect to use different assumptions under the Black-Scholes option valuation model in the future, which could materially affect the Company's net income or earnings per share.

Accounting for Cash-Based Compensation

        In February 2006, the Company established the Assured Guaranty Ltd. Performance Retention Plan. This plan permits the award of cash based awards to selected employees which vest after four years of continued employment (or earlier, if the employee's termination occurs as a result of death, disability, or retirement). The plan was revised in 2008 giving the Compensation Committee greater flexibility in establishing the terms of performance retention awards, including the ability to establish different performance periods and performance objectives. See Note 20 "Employee Benefit Plans" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K for greater detail about the Performance Retention Plan.

        The Company's compensation expense for the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2007 was in the form of performance retention awards and the awards that were made in 2008 (which vest over a four year period) and 2007 (which cliff vest after 4 years). The Company recognized approximately $5.7 million ($4.5 million after tax) and $0.2 million ($0.1 million after tax) of expense for performance retention awards in 2008 and 2007, respectively. Included in the 2008 amount was $3.3 million of accelerated expense related to retirement-eligible employees.

107


Table of Contents

Goodwill

        In connection with FAS No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets", the Company does not amortize goodwill, but instead is required to perform an impairment test annually or more frequently should circumstances warrant. The impairment test evaluates goodwill for recoverability by comparing the fair value of the Company's direct and reinsurance lines of business to their carrying value. If fair value is greater than carrying value then goodwill is deemed to be recoverable and there is no impairment. If fair value is less than carrying value then goodwill is deemed to be impaired and written down by an amount such that the fair value of the reporting unit is equal to the carrying value, but not less than $0. No such impairment to goodwill was recognized in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 or 2006.

        As part of the impairment test of goodwill, there are inherent assumptions and estimates used by management in developing discounted future cash flows related to our direct and reinsurance lines of business that are subject to change based on future events. Management's estimates include projecting earned premium, incurred losses, expenses, interest rates, cost of capital and tax rates. Many of the factors used in assessing fair value are outside the control of management and it is reasonably likely that assumptions and estimates will change in future periods. These changes can result in future impairments.

        The Company has concluded that it is reasonably likely that the goodwill associated with our reinsurance line of business could become impaired in future periods if the volume of new business in the financial guaranty reinsurance market does not return to historical levels experienced prior to 2008 or if the Company is not able to continue to execute portfolio based reinsurance contracts on blocks of business for other financial guarantors in financial distress. Also, the pending FSAH transaction may cause a triggering event that will cause management to reassess its goodwill amounts related to its reinsurance line of business. See Note 22. "Goodwill", to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this 10-K for greater detail about Goodwill.

        Information on Residential Mortgage Backed Securities ("RMBS"), Subprime RMBS, Collateralized Debt Obligations of Asset Backed Securities ("CDOs of ABS") and Prime RMBS Exposures

        Our Risk Management and Surveillance personnel are responsible for monitoring and reporting on all transactions in the insured portfolio. The primary objective of the surveillance process is to monitor trends and changes in transaction credit quality, detect any deterioration in credit quality and take such remedial actions as may be necessary or appropriate. All transactions in the insured portfolio are risk rated, and surveillance personnel are responsible for adjusting these ratings to reflect changes in transaction credit quality. In assessing the credit quality of our insured portfolio, we take into consideration a variety of factors. For RMBS exposures such factors include the amount of credit support or subordination benefiting our exposure, delinquency and loss trends on the underlying collateral, the extent to which the exposure has amortized and the year in which it was insured.

        The tables below provide information on the risk ratings and certain other risk characteristics of the Company's RMBS, subprime RMBS, CDOs of ABS and Prime exposures as of December 31, 2008 (dollars in millions):

108


Table of Contents


Distribution of U.S. RMBS by Rating(1) and by Segment as of December 31, 2008

Ratings(1):
  Direct
Net Par
Outstanding
  %   Reinsurance
Net Par
Outstanding
  %   Total
Net Par
Outstanding
  %  

Super senior

  $ 6,384     36.9 % $       $ 6,384     34.7 %

AAA

    1,471     8.5 %   201     18.7 %   1,672     9.1 %

AA

    1,461     8.4 %   101     9.4 %   1,561     8.5 %

A

    2,360     13.6 %   98     9.1 %   2,458     13.4 %

BBB

    1,724     10.0 %   185     17.2 %   1,909     10.4 %

Below investment grade

    3,918     22.6 %   489     45.6 %   4,408     24.0 %
                           

  $ 17,319     100.0 % $ 1,074     100.0 % $ 18,393     100.0 %
                           


Distribution of U.S. RMBS by Rating(1) and Type of Exposure as of December 31, 2008

Ratings(1):
  Prime First
Lien
  Prime
Closed End
Seconds
  Prime
HELOC
  Alt-A First
Lien
  Alt-A
Option
ARMs
  Subprime
First Lien
  Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 

Super senior

  $ 672   $ 47   $   $ 2,746   $   $ 2,920   $ 6,384  

AAA

    335     60     13     738     195     331     1,672  

AA

    171     135     13     514     82     645     1,561  

A

    74         8     886     333     1,157     2,458  

BBB

    681     5     102     24         1,097     1,909  

Below investment grade

    26     185     1,602     1,310     801     483     4,408  
                               
 

Total exposures

  $ 1,959   $ 433   $ 1,738   $ 6,218   $ 1,411   $ 6,633   $ 18,393  
                               


Distribution of U.S. RMBS by Year Insured and Type of Exposure as of December 31, 2008

Year Insured:
  Prime First
Lien
  Prime
Closed End
Seconds
  Prime
HELOC
  Alt-A First
Lien
  Alt-A
Option
ARMs
  Subprime
First Lien
  Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 

2004 and prior

  $ 224   $   $ 140   $ 57   $ 71   $ 493   $ 984  

2005

    214         739     383     43     97     1,476  

2006

    431     5     146         57     4,477     5,117  

2007

    1,090     428     713     3,249     1,090     1,536     8,106  

2008

                2,529     151     30     2,710  
                               
 

Total exposures

  $ 1,959   $ 433   $ 1,738   $ 6,218   $ 1,411   $ 6,633   $ 18,393  
                               

(1)
Assured's internal rating. Assured's scale is comparable to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies. The super senior category, which is not generally used by rating agencies, is used by the Company in instances where Assured's AAA-rated exposure has additional credit enhancement due to either (1) the existence of another security rated AAA that is subordinated to Assured's exposure or (2) Assured's exposure benefits from a different form of credit enhancement that would pay any claims first in the event that any of the exposures incurs a loss and such credit enhancement, in management's opinion, causes Assured's attachment point to be materially above the AAA attachment point.

109


Table of Contents


Distribution of U.S. RMBS by Rating(1) and Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year insured:
  Super
Senior
  AAA
Rated
  AA
Rated
  A
Rated
  BBB
Rated
  BIG
Rated
  Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $ 253   $ 159   $ 136   $ 166   $ 270   $ 984  

2005

        346     125     136     31     838     1,476  

2006

    2,920     184     541     400     845     227     5,117  

2007

    1,314     344     736     1,785     869     3,058     8,106  

2008

    2,150     545                 15     2,710  
                               

  $ 6,384   $ 1,672   $ 1,561   $ 2,458   $ 1,909   $ 4,408   $ 18,393  
                               

% of total

   
34.7

%
 
9.1

%
 
8.5

%
 
13.4

%
 
10.4

%
 
24.0

%
 
100.0

%


Distribution of U.S. Prime HELOC RMBS by Rating(1) and Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year insured:
  Super
Senior
  AAA
Rated
  AA
Rated
  A
Rated
  BBB
Rated
  BIG
Rated
  Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $ 2   $ 12   $ 5   $ 79   $ 42   $ 140  

2005

                2     21     715     739  

2006

                    1     146     146  

2007

        11     2         1     700     713  

2008

                             
                               

  $   $ 13   $ 13   $ 8   $ 102   $ 1,602   $ 1,738  
                               

% of total

   
0.0

%
 
0.8

%
 
0.8

%
 
0.4

%
 
5.9

%
 
92.2

%
 
100.0

%


Distribution of U.S. Closed End Seconds RMBS by Rating(1) and Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year insured:
  Super
Senior
  AAA
Rated
  AA
Rated
  A
Rated
  BBB
Rated
  BIG
Rated
  Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $   $   $   $   $   $  

2005

                             

2006

                    5         5  

2007

    47     60     135             185     428  

2008

                             
                               

  $ 47   $ 60   $ 135   $   $ 5   $ 185   $ 433  
                               

% of total

   
10.9

%
 
14.0

%
 
31.2

%
 
0.0

%
 
1.3

%
 
42.7

%
 
100.0

%

110


Table of Contents


Distribution of U.S. Alt-A RMBS by Rating(1) and Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year insured:
  Super
Senior
  AAA
Rated
  AA
Rated
  A
Rated
  BBB
Rated
  BIG
Rated
  Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $ 19   $ 16   $   $ 21   $   $ 57  

2005

        228     42             114     383  

2006

                             

2007

    595     113     456     886     2     1,197     3,249  

2008

    2,150     378                     2,529  
                               

  $ 2,746   $ 738   $ 514   $ 886   $ 24   $ 1,310   $ 6,218  
                               

% of total

   
44.2

%
 
11.9

%
 
8.3

%
 
14.3

%
 
0.4

%
 
21.1

%
 
100.0

%


Distribution of U.S. Alt-A Option ARM RMBS by Rating(1) and Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year insured:
  Super
Senior
  AAA
Rated
  AA
Rated
  A
Rated
  BBB
Rated
  BIG
Rated
  Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $ 39   $ 14   $ 17   $   $   $ 71  

2005

                43             43  

2006

                        57     57  

2007

        5     68     272         744     1,090  

2008

        151                     151  
                               

  $   $ 195   $ 82   $ 333   $   $ 801   $ 1,411  
                               

% of total

   
0.0

%
 
13.8

%
 
5.8

%
 
23.6

%
 
0.0

%
 
56.8

%
 
100.0

%


Distribution of U.S. Subprime RMBS by Rating(1) and Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year insured:
  Super
Senior
  AAA
Rated
  AA
Rated
  A
Rated
  BBB
Rated
  BIG
Rated
  Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $ 173   $ 38   $ 41   $ 13   $ 228   $ 493  

2005

        5         90     2     0     97  

2006

    2,920     125     532     400     488     13     4,477  

2007

        12     75     627     594     227     1,536  

2008

        16                 15     30  
                               

  $ 2,920   $ 331   $ 645   $ 1,157   $ 1,097   $ 483   $ 6,633  
                               

% of total

   
44.0

%
 
5.0

%
 
9.7

%
 
17.4

%
 
16.5

%
 
7.3

%
 
100.0

%

(1)
Assured's internal rating. Assured's scale is comparable to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies. The super senior category, which is not generally used by rating agencies, is used by the Company in instances where Assured's AAA-rated exposure has additional credit enhancement due to either (1) the existence of another security rated AAA that is subordinated to Assured's exposure or (2) Assured's exposure benefits from a different form of credit enhancement that would pay any claims first in the event that any of the exposures incurs a loss and such credit enhancement, in management's opinion, causes Assured's attachment point to be materially above the AAA attachment point.

111


Table of Contents


Distribution of Financial Guaranty Direct U.S. RMBS by Rating(1) and Type of Exposure as of December 31, 2008

Ratings(1):
  Prime First
Lien
  Prime
Closed End
Seconds
  Prime
HELOC
  Alt-A
First Lien
  Alt-A
Option
ARMs
  Subprime
First Lien
  Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 

Super senior

  $ 672   $ 47   $   $ 2,746   $   $ 2,920   $ 6,384  

AAA

    252     58         736     195     232     1,471  

AA

    83     134     6     512     82     644     1,461  

A

                886     332     1,142     2,360  

BBB

    613         17     20         1,074     1,724  

Below investment grade

        185     1,220     1,294     801     418     3,918  
                               
 

Total exposures

  $ 1,620   $ 424   $ 1,242   $ 6,193   $ 1,410   $ 6,430   $ 17,319  
                               


Distribution of Financial Guaranty Direct U.S. RMBS Net Par Outstanding by Rating(1) and Year Issued as of December 31, 2008

Year issued:
  Super
Senior
  AAA
Rated
  AA
Rated
  A
Rated
  BBB
Rated
  BIG
Rated
  Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $ 163   $ 71   $ 50   $ 37   $ 193   $ 514  

2005

    2,020     461     656     530     480     719     4,866  

2006

    1,189         75     150     892     371     2,678  

2007

    3,175     847     658     1,630     315     2,635     9,260  

2008

                             
                               

  $ 6,384   $ 1,471   $ 1,461   $ 2,360   $ 1,724   $ 3,918   $ 17,319  
                               

% of total

   
36.9

%
 
8.5

%
 
8.4

%
 
13.6

%
 
10.0

%
 
22.6

%
 
100.0

%


Distribution of Financial Guaranty Direct U.S. RMBS Net Par Outstanding by Rating(1) and Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year issued:
  Super Senior   AAA Rated   AA Rated   A Rated   BBB Rated   BIG Rated   Total  

2004 and prior

  $   $ 163   $ 71   $ 50   $ 37   $ 193   $ 514  

2005

        337     124     130         719     1,311  

2006

    2,920     124     532     400     822     57     4,855  

2007

    1,314     318     733     1,780     865     2,949     7,960  

2008

    2,150     529                     2,679  
                               

  $ 6,384   $ 1,471   $ 1,461   $ 2,360   $ 1,724   $ 3,918   $ 17,319  
                               

% of total

   
36.9

%
 
8.5

%
 
8.4

%
 
13.6

%
 
10.0

%
 
22.6

%
 
100.0

%

(1)
Assured's internal rating. Assured's scale is comparable to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies. The super senior category, which is not generally used by rating agencies, is used by the Company in instances where Assured's AAA-rated exposure has additional credit enhancement due to either (1) the existence of another security rated AAA that is subordinated to Assured's exposure or (2) Assured's exposure benefits from a different form of credit enhancement that would pay any claims first in the event that any of the exposures incurs a loss, and such credit enhancement, in management's opinion, causes Assured's attachment point to be materially above the AAA attachment point.

112


Table of Contents


Distribution of Financial Guaranty Direct U.S. RMBS by Year Insured as of December 31, 2008

Year insured:
  Prime First
Lien
  Prime
Closed End
Seconds
  Prime
HELOC
  Alt-A First
Lien
  Alt-A
Option
ARMs
  Subprime
First Lien
  Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 

2004 and prior

  $   $   $ 22   $ 51   $ 71   $ 370   $ 514  

2005

    192         605     383     42     88     1,311  

2006

    342                 57     4,455     4,855  

2007

    1,085     424     614     3,230     1,090     1,516     7,960  

2008

                2,529     151         2,679  
                               

  $ 1,620   $ 424   $ 1,242   $ 6,193   $ 1,410   $ 6,430   $ 17,319  
                               


Distribution of Financial Guaranty Direct U.S. RMBS by Year Issued as of December 31, 2008

Year issued:
  Prime First
Lien
  Prime
Closed End
Seconds
  Prime
HELOC
  Alt-A First
Lien
  Alt-A
Option
ARMs
  Subprime
First Lien
  Total
Net Par
Outstanding
 

2004 and prior

  $   $   $ 22   $ 51   $ 71   $ 370   $ 514  

2005

    192         605     383     42     3,643     4,866  

2006

    342             379     57     1,900     2,678  

2007

    1,085     424     614     5,380     1,240     516     9,260  

2008

                             
                               

  $ 1,620   $ 424   $ 1,242   $ 6,193   $ 1,410   $ 6,430   $ 17,319  
                               

113


Table of Contents

Distribution of Financial Guaranty Direct U.S. Mortgage-Backed Securities Issued January 1, 2005 or Later by Exposure Type, Average Pool Factor, Subordination, Cumulative Losses and 60+ Day Delinquencies as of December 31, 2008(1)

U.S. Prime First Lien

Year issued:
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Pool Factor(2)   Subordination(3)   Cumulative
Losses(4)
  60+ Day
Delinquencies(5)
  Number of
transactions
 

2005

  $ 192     75.8%     5.4%     0.1%     2.7%     6  

2006

    342     69.1%     5.3%     0.0%     0.6%     2  

2007

    1,085     87.6%     10.5%     0.2%     4.5%     3  

2008

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

  $ 1,620     82.3%     8.8%     0.1%     3.5%     11  
                           

U.S. Prime CES

Year issued:
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Pool Factor(2)   Subordination(3)   Cumulative
Losses(4)
  60+ Day
Delinquencies(5)
  Number of
transactions
 

2005

  $     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  

2006

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  

2007

    424     67.5%     25.7%     24.5%     17.2%     5  

2008

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

  $ 424     67.5%     25.7%     24.5%     17.2%     5  
                           

U.S. Prime HELOC

Year issued:
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Pool Factor(2)   Subordination(3)   Cumulative
Losses(4)
  60+ Day
Delinquencies(5)
  Number of
transactions
 

2005

  $ 605     33.5%     0.0%     10.5%     12.6%     2  

2006

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  

2007

    614     68.8%     0.0%     14.0%     9.8%     2  

2008

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

  $ 1,220     51.3%     0.0%     12.3%     11.2%     4  
                           

U.S. Alt-A First Lien

Year issued:
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Pool Factor(2)   Subordination(3)   Cumulative
Losses(4)
  60+ Day
Delinquencies(5)
  Number of
transactions
 

2005

  $ 383     61.9%     11.6%     0.7%     7.4%     13  

2006

    379     76.6%     39.5%     1.8%     24.3%     2  

2007

    5,380     79.4%     20.7%     0.8%     17.3%     11  

2008

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

  $ 6,142     78.1%     21.3%     0.9%     17.1%     26  
                           

114


Table of Contents

U.S. Alt-A Option ARMs

Year issued:
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Pool Factor(2)   Subordination(3)   Cumulative
Losses(4)
  60+ Day
Delinquencies(5)
  Number of
transactions
 

2005

  $ 42     34.1%     27.9%     0.5%     18.3%     1  

2006

    57     57.0%     19.3%     0.7%     23.0%     1  

2007

    1,240     79.1%     21.8%     0.6%     18.1%     6  

2008

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

  $ 1,339     76.7%     21.9%     0.6%     18.3%     8  
                           

U.S. Subprime First Lien

Year issued:
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Pool Factor(2)   Subordination(3)   Cumulative
Losses(4)
  60+ Day
Delinquencies(5)
  Number of
transactions
 

2005

  $ 3,643     34.1%     62.6%     5.7%     42.4%     42  

2006

    1,900     50.5%     41.8%     7.4%     43.2%     49  

2007

    516     51.9%     42.1%     7.5%     45.1%     2  

2008

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

  $ 6,059     40.8%     54.3%     6.4%     42.9%     93  
                           

U.S. CMBS

Year issued:
  Net Par
Outstanding
  Pool Factor(2)   Subordination(3)   Cumulative
Losses(4)
  60+ Day
Delinquencies(5)
  Number of
transactions
 

2005

  $ 3,429     96.8%     28.9%     0.0%     0.1%     158  

2006

    1,418     98.5%     30.1%     0.0%     0.2%     57  

2007

    533     90.6%     20.0%     0.0%     0.0%     13  

2008

        N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

  $ 5,380     96.6%     28.3%     0.0%     0.1%     228  
                           

(1)
Net par outstanding is based on values as of December 2008. With the exception of the US Prime First Lien, US Prime HELOC, US Prime CES and US CMBS portfolios which are as of December 2008, the pool factor, subordination, cumulative losses and delinquency data is based on November 2008 information obtained from Intex, Bloomberg, and/or provided by the trustee and may be subject to restatement or correction.

(2)
Pool factor is the percentage of net par outstanding divided by the original net par outstanding of the transactions at inception.

(3)
Represents the sum of subordinate tranches and over-collateralization, expressed as a percentage of total transaction size and does not include any benefit from excess interest collections that may be used to absorb losses.

(4)
Cumulative losses are defined as net charge-offs on the underlying loan collateral divided by the original pool balance.

(5)
60+ day delinquencies are defined as loans that are greater than 60 days delinquent and all loans that are in foreclosure, bankruptcy or REO divided by net par outstanding.

115


Table of Contents

Financial Guaranty Direct Collateralized Debt Obligations of Asset-Backed Securities (CDOs of ABS)(1) Net Par Outstanding by Type of CDO, by Year Insured and by Collateral:

 
   
   
  Type of Collateral as a Percent of Total Pool   Ratings as of
December 31, 2008
   
   
   
Year
Insured
  Legal
Final
Maturity(2)
  Net Par
Outstanding
  ABS   RMBS
(Includes
Subprime)
  Comm.
MBS
(CMBS)(3)
  CDOs of
Investment
Grade
Corporate
  CDOs of
ABS
  Total
Collateral
Pool
  U.S.
Subprime
First Lien
RMBS
  S&P   Moody's   Original AAA
Subordination(6)
  Original
Subordination
Below
Assured
  Current
Subordination
Below
Assured
CDOs of Mezzanine ABS(3):
2001   2017   $   113.5     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   25.1%   25.1%   30.3%
2001   2016         59.7     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   28.1%   28.1%   40.1%
2002   2017       102.1     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   24.6%   24.6%   39.6%
2002   2017         92.9     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   22.1%   22.1%   31.6%
2002   2017         88.7     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   35.0%   35.0%   48.0%
2002   2017         64.8     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   24.0%   24.0%   34.3%
2003   2018       118.6     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aa3   20.0%   20.0%   26.6%
2003   2038         74.5     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aa2   23.0%   38.0%   49.7%
2003   2018         46.5     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   63.0%   63.0%   66.9%
                                                         
                         Subtotal:   $   761.3     0%     0%   100%     0%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aa1   27.3%   28.7%   38.4%
                                                         

CDOs of High Grade ABS(4):
No CDO of ABS business written

CDOs of Pooled AAA ABS(5):
2003   2010       636.2   35%   34%   26%   5%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa     0.0%   12.5%   12.5%
                                                         
                         Subtotal:   $   636.2   35%   34%   26%     5%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa     0.0%   12.5%   12.5%
                                                         
Total:   $1,397.5   16%   15%   66%     2%     0%   100%     0%   AAA   Aaa   14.9%   21.4%   26.6%
                                                         

(1)
A "CDO of ABS" is a collateralized debt obligation (CDO) transaction whose collateral pool consists primarily of asset-backed securities (ABS), including mortgage-backed securities (MBS). ABS transactions securities generally represent an ownership interest in a trust that contains collateral supporting the notes. Those interests are divided into several tranches that can have varying levels of subordination, credit protection triggers and credit ratings.

(2)
"Legal Final Maturity" represents the final date for payment specified in the transaction documents and does not take into account prepayments that shorten the expected maturity and weighted average life.

(3)
"CDOs of Mezzanine ABS" is a market term that refers to transactions where the underlying collateral at issuance is comprised primarily of mezzanine tranches rated BBB or lower. The collateral underlying Assured's exposure to CDOs of Mezzanine ABS is comprised of mezzanine tranches of CMBS transactions and senior unsecured debt issued by commercial property REITs. The transactions to which Assured has exposure are static pools rather than actively managed transactions, and the collateral in these static pools was originated primarily in the period from 1997-2003. The collateral underlying Assured's exposure to CDOs of Mezzanine ABS had weighted average ratings, based on rating information as of December 31, 2008, as follows: 16% AAA, 8% AA, 13% A, 45% BBB and 18% below investment grade (BIG).

(4)
"CDOs of High Grade ABS" is a market term that refers to transactions where the underlying collateral at issuance is comprised of mezzanine tranches rated single-A or higher.

(5)
"CDOs of Pooled AAA ABS" is a market term that refers to transactions where the underlying collateral at issuance is comprised of the senior-most AAA rated securities. Assured's exposure to CDOs of Pooled AAA ABS was rated, based on rating information as of December 31, 2008: 100% AAA.

(6)
Represents the sum of subordinate tranches and over-collateralization and does not include any benefit from excess interest collections that may be used to absorb losses.

116


Table of Contents

Consolidated Results of Operations

        The following table presents summary consolidated results of operations data for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006.

 
  Year Ended December 31,(1)  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Revenues:

                   

Gross written premiums

  $ 618.3   $ 424.5   $ 261.3  

Net written premiums

    604.6     408.0     255.8  

Net earned premiums

    261.4     159.3     144.8  

Net investment income

    162.6     128.1     111.5  

Net realized investment losses

    (69.8 )   (1.3 )   (2.0 )

Change in fair value of credit derivatives

                   
 

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

    117.6     74.0     73.9  
 

Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives

    38.0     (670.4 )   11.8  
               

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

    155.6     (596.4 )   85.7  

Other income

    43.4     8.8     0.4  
               
 

Total revenues

    553.2     (301.6 )   340.4  
               

Expenses:

                   

Loss and loss adjustment expenses

    265.8     5.8     11.3  

Profit commission expense

    1.3     6.5     9.5  

Acquisition costs

    61.2     43.2     45.2  

Operating expenses

    83.5     79.9     68.0  

Interest expense

    23.3     23.5     13.8  

Other expense

    5.7     2.6     2.5  
               
 

Total expenses

    440.9     161.4     150.4  
               

Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes

    112.3     (463.0 )   190.0  

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

    43.4     (159.8 )   30.2  
               
 

Net income (loss)

  $ 68.9   $ (303.3 ) $ 159.7  
               

Underwriting (loss) gain by segment:

                   

Financial guaranty direct

  $ (106.8 ) $ 22.1   $ 30.8  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    28.1     61.6     30.0  

Mortgage guaranty

    0.6     9.4     16.7  

Other

    1.9     1.3     13.5  
               

Total

  $ (76.4 ) $ 94.5   $ 91.0  
               

(1)
Some amounts may not add due to rounding.

        We organize our business around four principal business segments: financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty reinsurance, mortgage guaranty and other. There are a number of lines of business that we exited as part of our April 2004 IPO, which are included in the other segment. However, the results of these businesses are reflected in the above numbers.

117


Table of Contents

Net Income (Loss)

        Net income (loss) was $68.9 million, $(303.3) million and $159.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase of $372.2 million in 2008 compared with 2007 was primarily due to the following factors:

        Partially offsetting these positive factors were:

118


Table of Contents

        Partially offsetting these negative factors were:

Gross Written Premiums

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Gross Written Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Financial guaranty direct

  $ 484.7   $ 167.1   $ 124.8  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    129.3     251.0     123.9  

Mortgage guaranty

    0.7     2.7     8.4  
               

Total financial guaranty gross written premiums

    614.7     421.0     257.2  

Other

    3.5     3.5     4.1  
               
 

Total gross written premiums

  $ 618.3   $ 424.5   $ 261.3  
               

        Gross written premiums for the year ended December 31, 2008 were $618.3 million, compared with $424.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2007, an increase of $193.8 million, or 46%. Gross written premiums in our financial guaranty direct operations increased $317.6 million for 2008 compared with 2007 primarily due to a $371.8 million increase in U.S. generated business, of which

119


Table of Contents


$355.8 million was from our upfront U.S. public finance business, as we continue to increase our market share. Partially offsetting this increase was a reduction of our international business to $16.9 million in 2008, compared with $71.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 due to market conditions. Gross written premiums in our financial guaranty reinsurance segment decreased $121.7 million primarily due to a large portfolio assumed from one of our cedants in December 2007, which contributed $143.2 million to gross written premiums in the fourth quarter of 2007. The decrease in gross written premiums in mortgage guaranty segment is primarily related to the run-off of our quota share treaty business as well as commutations executed in the latter part of 2007.

        Gross written premiums for the year ended December 31, 2007 were $424.5 million compared with $261.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2006, an increase of $163.2 million, or 62%. Our 2007 financial guaranty direct segment increased $42.3 million due to an increase of $24.7 million in our U.S. public finance business and $18.1 million in our U.S. structured finance business, while our international infrastructure business remained flat. Our financial guaranty reinsurance segment increased $127.1 million in 2007 compared with 2006 primarily due to execution of a reinsurance transaction with Ambac Assurance Corporation ("Ambac") whereby we assumed a diversified portfolio of financial guaranty transactions, which resulted in gross written premiums of $143.2 million. Gross written premiums for 2007 in our mortgage guaranty segment decreased $5.7 million compared with 2006, primarily attributable to run-off of our quota share contracts and commutations executed in the latter part of 2006.

Net Earned Premiums

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Net Earned Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Financial guaranty direct

  $ 90.0   $ 52.8   $ 27.8  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    165.9     88.9     94.4  

Mortgage guaranty

    5.7     17.5     22.7  
               

Total financial guaranty net earned premiums

    261.4     159.3     144.8  

Other

             
               
 

Total net earned premiums

  $ 261.4   $ 159.3   $ 144.8  
               

        Net earned premiums for the year ended December 31, 2008 increased $102.1 million, or 64%, compared with the year ended December 31, 2007. Financial guaranty direct net earned premiums increased $37.2 million in 2008, compared with 2007. This increase is attributable to the continued growth of our in-force book of business, resulting in increased net earned premiums. The year ended December 31, 2008 had $1.3 million of earned premiums from public finance refundings in the financial guaranty direct segment compared to $2.8 million in 2007. Public finance refunding premiums reflect the unscheduled pre-payment or refundings of underlying municipal bonds. The increase in financial guaranty reinsurance segment was due to the increase in public finance refundings of $45.8 million to $60.6 million in 2008. This increase is primarily a result of greater refundings of municipal auction rate and variable rate debt as reported by our ceding companies. Excluding refundings, our financial guaranty reinsurance segment increased $31.2 million in 2008 compared with 2007 due mainly to the portfolio assumed from Ambac in December 2007, which contributed $56.9 million to net premiums earned in 2008. The $11.8 million decrease in net earned premiums in our mortgage guaranty segment in 2008 compared with 2007 reflects the run-off of our quota share treaty business as well as commutations executed in the latter part of 2007.

120


Table of Contents

        Net earned premiums for the year ended December 31, 2007 increased $14.5 million, or 10%, compared with the year ended December 31, 2006. Net earned premiums from our financial guaranty direct operations increased to $52.8 million in 2007 compared with $27.8 million in 2006 due to the continued growth of our in-force book of business, resulting in increased net earned premiums, and to public finance refundings which were $2.8 million in 2007. The year ended December 31, 2006 amounts had no earned premiums from public finance refundings in the financial guaranty direct segment. The decreases in net earned premiums in the financial guaranty reinsurance and mortgage guaranty segments in 2007 compared to 2006 were primarily related to the non-renewal and expiration of certain treaties.

Net Investment Income

        Net investment income was $162.6 million, $128.1 million and $111.5 million and had pre-tax yields to maturity of 4.6%, 5.0% and 5.1% for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The $34.5 million increase in investment income in 2008 compared with 2007 was attributable to increased invested assets due to positive operating cash flows as well as increased capital from equity offerings in April 2008 and December 2007. The increase in net investment income in 2007 compared with 2006 was mainly due to increased invested assets due to positive operating cash flows.

Net Realized Investment Losses

        Realized investment gains and losses are determined using the specific identification method and are credited or charged to income. Net realized investment losses, principally from the sale of fixed maturity securities, were $(69.8) million, $(1.3) million and $(2.0) million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The Company recognized $71.3 million of other than temporary impairment losses substantially related to mortgage-backed and corporate securities for the year ended December 31, 2008 primarily due to the fact that it does not have the intent to hold these securities until there is a recovery in their value. The Company had no write downs of investments for other than temporary impairment losses in 2007 and 2006. Net realized investment losses, net of related income taxes, were $(62.7) million, $(1.3) million and $(1.5) million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

Realized Gains and Other Settlements on Credit Derivatives

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable:

                   

Direct segment

  $ 113.2   $ 72.7   $ 61.9  

Reinsurance segment

    4.9          
               
 

Total net credit derivative premiums received and receivable

    118.1     72.7     61.9  

Net credit derivative losses recovered and recoverable

    0.4     1.4     11.8  

Ceding commissions (paid/payable) received/receivable, net

    (0.9 )   (0.1 )   0.2  
               
 

Total realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

  $ 117.6   $ 74.0   $ 73.9  
               

        Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives, were $117.6 million, $74.0 million and $73.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Total net credit derivative premiums received and receivable, which represents premium income recognized attributable to insured CDS contracts, was $118.1 million, $72.7 million and $61.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. This increase is attributable to growth in our direct segment business written in credit derivative form. Net credit derivative losses recovered and recoverable of $0.4 million, $1.4 million and $11.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007

121


Table of Contents


and 2006, respectively, relates to recoveries received by us in those years for claim payments made in prior years. We did not have any losses paid or payable under these contracts in either 2008, 2007 or 2006.

Unrealized Gains (Losses) on Credit Derivatives

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Pre-tax:

                   

Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives, excluding incurred losses on credit derivatives

  $ 81.7   $ (666.9 ) $ 5.5  

Incurred (losses) gains on credit derivatives

    (43.7 )   (3.6 )   6.3  
               
 

Total unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives

  $ 38.0   $ (670.4 ) $ 11.8  
               

After-tax:

                   

Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives, excluding incurred losses on credit derivatives

  $ 29.3   $ (485.4 ) $ 4.0  

Incurred (losses) gains on credit derivatives

    (33.4 )   (2.5 )   4.8  
               
 

Total unrealized (losses) gains on credit derivatives

  $ (4.1 ) $ (487.9 ) $ 8.8  
               

        Credit derivatives are recorded at fair value as required by FAS 133, FAS 149 and FAS 155. The change in fair value for the year ended December 31, 2008 was a $38.0 million gain compared with a $670.4 million loss for the year ended December 31, 2007 and a $11.8 million gain for the same period in 2006. The change in fair value for 2008 was attributable to the widening of credit default spreads traded on AGC, which increased from 180 basis points at December 31, 2007 to 1,775 basis points at December 31, 2008. For the year ended December 31, 2008, approximately 50% of our unrealized gain on credit derivatives is attributable to the fair value of high yield and investment grade corporate collateralized loan obligation transactions, with the balance of the change in fair values principally in the residential and commercial mortgage backed securities markets. The change in fair value for 2007 was attributable to spreads widening and includes no credit losses. For the year ended 2007, approximately 45% of the Company's unrealized loss on credit derivatives was due to a decline in the market value of high yield and investment grade corporate collateralized loan obligation transactions, with the balance generated by lower market values principally in the residential and commercial mortgage-backed securities markets. Changes in the fair value of our derivative contracts do not reflect actual claims or credit losses, and have no impact on the Company's claims-paying resources, rating agency capital or regulatory capital positions. With considerable volatility continuing in the market, the fair value adjustment amount will fluctuate significantly in future periods. The change in fair value of $11.8 million for 2006 was related to many factors but primarily due to run-off of transactions and tightening in credit spreads. Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives, excluding incurred losses on credit derivatives, net of related income taxes, were $29.3 million, $(485.4) million and $4.0 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

        The gain or loss created by the estimated fair value adjustment will rise or fall based on estimated market pricing and may not be an indication of ultimate claims. Fair value is defined as the amount at which an asset or liability could be bought or sold in a current transaction between willing parties. We enter into credit derivative contracts which require us to make payments upon the occurrence of certain defined credit events relating to an underlying obligation (generally a fixed income obligation). The Company's credit derivative exposures are substantially similar to its financial guaranty insurance contracts and provide for credit protection against payment default. They are contracts that are generally held to maturity. The unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives will reduce to zero as the exposure approaches its maturity date, unless there is a payment default on the exposure.

122


Table of Contents

        Management also calculates portfolio and case reserve expenses on our credit derivative contracts in the same manner as we do for our financial guaranty insurance contracts. Prior to the First Quarter 2008, incurred losses on credit derivatives were apportioned in our financial statements from unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives and included in loss and loss adjustment expenses. As a result of reclassifying our accounting activity related to credit derivative contracts commencing with the First Quarter 2008, we no longer make this apportionment in our financial statements, but believe it is an important metric in evaluating the credit quality of our credit derivative contracts. The incurred (losses) gains on credit derivatives were $(43.7) million ($(33.4) million loss after-tax), $(3.6) million ($(2.5) million loss after-tax) and $6.3 million ($4.8 million after-tax) for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase for 2008 as compared with 2007 is primarily due to an increase in portfolio reserves as a result of downgrades within our U.S. RMBS credit derivative book of business.

Other Income

        The years ended December 31, 2008 and 2007 included a fair value gain of $42.7 million and $8.3 million, pre-tax, respectively, related to Assured Guaranty Corp.'s committed capital securities. The increase was due to the widening of the Company's credit spreads. The Company recorded a fair value gain of $0 in the year ended December 31, 2006, as the fair value of CCS securities was $0 as of December 31, 2006 and December 31, 2005.

Loss and Loss Adjustment Expenses (Recoveries)

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Loss and Loss Adjustment Expenses (Recoveries)
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Financial guaranty direct

  $ 196.7   $ 29.2   $ 2.6  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    68.4     (24.1 )   13.1  

Mortgage guaranty

    2.0     0.6     (4.4 )
               

Total financial guaranty loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    267.1     5.8     11.3  

Other

    (1.5 )        
               
 

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

  $ 265.8   $ 5.8   $ 11.3  
               

        Loss and loss adjustment expenses for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $265.8 million, $5.8 million and $11.3 million, respectively. Loss and LAE for 2008 were $265.8 million. Results for the financial guaranty direct segment for 2008 included losses incurred of $119.7 million and $53.9 million related to HELOC and Closed-End Second exposures, respectively, driven by credit deterioration, primarily related to increases in delinquencies. The financial guaranty reinsurance segment included losses incurred of $48.5 million related primarily to our assumed HELOC exposures during 2008.

        In 2007, loss and LAE for the financial guaranty direct segment included a $2.4 million case reserve increase and a $30.2 million portfolio reserve increase, primarily attributable to downgrades of transactions in our CMC list related to the subprime mortgage market, particularly U.S. home equity line of credit ("HELOC") exposures. Portfolio reserves also increased as a result of growth in new business and revised rating agency default statistics used in the portfolio reserving model. The financial guaranty reinsurance segment had a $(24.1) million loss benefit principally due to the restructuring of a European infrastructure transaction, as well as loss recoveries and increases in salvage reserves for aircraft-related transactions.

        In 2006, the financial guaranty direct segment had loss and loss adjustment expenses of $2.6 million mainly due to an increase of $4.5 million associated with the increase in net earned premiums and downgrades of a sub-prime mortgage transaction, partially offset by a case loss reserves

123


Table of Contents


net recovery of $(1.6) million relating to the settlement of a sub-prime mortgage transaction. The financial guaranty reinsurance segment had loss and loss adjustment expenses of $13.1 million due to $6.8 million of net case loss and LAE reserve additions, primarily related to the ratings downgrade of a U.S. public infrastructure transaction as well as other asset backed securities and a $1.6 million write-down of expected litigation recoveries, reported from a cedant. These recoveries were established in 1998 from a bankruptcy estate. In addition, the Company increased portfolio reserves $6.2 million primarily due to the ratings downgrade of a European infrastructure transaction and management updating its rating agency default statistics, as part of our normal portfolio reserve process and due to the rating downgrade of various credits.

Profit Commission Expense

        Profit commissions, which are primarily related to our mortgage guaranty segment, allow the ceding company to share favorable experience on a reinsurance contract due to lower than expected losses. Expected or favorable loss development generates profit commission expense, while the inverse occurs on unfavorable loss development. Portfolio reserves are not a component of these profit commission calculations. For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 profit commissions were $1.3 million, $6.5 million and $9.5 million, respectively. The decreases in profit commission expense for both 2008, 2007 and 2006 were due to the run-off of mortgage guaranty experience rated quota share treaties, which have a large profit commission component. Also adding to the 2008 decrease were the increases in losses incurred for certain transactions ceded to us and subject to profit commission.

Acquisition Costs

        Acquisition costs primarily consist of ceding commissions, brokerage fees and operating expenses that are related to the acquisition of new business. Acquisition costs that vary with and are directly related to the acquisition of new business are deferred and amortized in relation to earned premium. For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, acquisition costs incurred were $61.2 million, $43.2 million and $45.2 million, respectively. These amounts are consistent with changes in net earned premium from non-derivative transactions. The increase of $18.0 million in 2008 compared with 2007 was primarily related to the increase in refunded earned premium, and the related deferred ceding commission which was amortized. The decrease of $2.0 million in 2007 compared with 2006 was primarily related to a greater portion of earned premium coming from our financial guaranty direct business, which has no ceding commission. There were no acquisition costs incurred in our other segment during 2008, 2007 and 2006.

Operating Expenses

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, operating expenses were $83.5 million, $79.9 million and $68.0 million, respectively. The increases for 2008 compared with 2007, and 2007 compared with 2006, were mainly due to higher salaries and related employee benefits, due to staffing additions and merit increases. Also contributing to the increases was the amortization of restricted stock and stock option awards, due to new stock awards and other performance retention programs each year and the related amortization as well as the accelerated vesting of these awards for retirement eligible employees as required by FAS 123R.

Interest Expense

        Interest expense was $23.3 million, $23.5 million and $13.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The 2008 and 2007 amounts were mainly comprised of $13.4 million of interest expense, net of amortization of our cash flow hedge, related to the issuance of our 7% Senior Notes ("Senior Notes") in May 2004 and $9.8 million of interest expense related to the issuance of our 6.40% Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures (the "Debentures") in

124


Table of Contents


December 2006. The coupon on the Senior Notes is 7.0%, however, the effective rate is approximately 6.4%, which reflects the effect of a cash flow hedge executed by the Company in March 2004, the term of which matches that of the Senior Notes. In addition, the 2007 amount included $0.2 million of interest expense on taxes owed. The 2006 amount included $13.4 million of interest expense, net of amortization of our cash flow hedge, on our Senior Notes and $0.3 million of interest expense on our Debentures.

Other Expense

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, other expenses were $5.7 million, $2.6 million and $2.5 million, respectively. For all years, the amounts reflect put option premiums associated with Assured Guaranty Corp.'s $200.0 million committed capital securities. The increase in 2008 compared to 2007 was due to the increase in annualized rates from One-Month LIBOR plus 110 basis points to One-Month LIBOR plus 250 basis points as a result of the failed auction process in April 2008.

Income Tax

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, income tax expense (benefit) was $43.4 million, $(159.8) million and $30.2 million and our effective tax rate was 38.7%, 34.5% and 15.9% for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Our effective tax rates reflect the proportion of income recognized by each of our operating subsidiaries, with U.S. subsidiaries taxed at the U.S. marginal corporate income tax rate of 35%, UK subsidiaries taxed at the UK marginal corporate tax rate of 30%, and no taxes for our Bermuda holding company and subsidiaries. Accordingly, our overall corporate effective tax rate fluctuates based on the distribution of taxable income across these jurisdictions. 2008 included $38.0 million of pre-tax unrealized gains on credit derivatives, the majority of which was associated with subsidiaries taxed in the U.S., compared with a $(670.4) million pre-tax unrealized loss on credit derivatives in 2007. Additionally, during 2007, the IRS completed its audit of Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries for the 2002 through 2004 tax years, resulting in a $6.0 million reduction of our FIN 48 tax liability. 2007 also included a $4.1 million reduction of the Company's FIN 48 liability, which was reduced subsequent to adoption of FIN 48, due to final regulations on the treatment of a tax uncertainty regarding the use of consolidated losses. Income tax expense in 2006 included $4.7 million related to the $13.5 million of loss recoveries from third party litigation settlements related to the equity layer credit protection business.

Segment Results of Operations

        Our financial results include four principal business segments: financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty reinsurance, mortgage guaranty and other. Management uses underwriting gains and losses as the primary measure of each segment's financial performance. Underwriting gain is calculated as net earned premiums plus realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives less the sum of loss and loss adjustment expenses including incurred losses on credit derivatives, profit commission expense, acquisition costs and other operating expenses that are directly related to the operations of our insurance businesses. This measure excludes certain revenue and expense items, such as net investment income, realized investment gains and losses, unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives, excluding loss reserves allocation , other income, and interest and other expenses, that are not directly related to the underwriting performance of our insurance operations, but are included in net income.

        Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio, which is a non-GAAP financial measure, is defined as loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries) plus the Company's net estimate of credit derivative incurred case and portfolio loss and loss adjustment expense reserves, which is included in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives, plus net credit derivative losses (recoveries), which is included in realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives, divided by net earned premiums plus net credit

125


Table of Contents


derivative premiums received and receivable, which is included in realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives. Expense ratio is calculated by dividing the sum of ceding commissions expense (income), profit commission expense, acquisition costs and operating expenses by net earned premiums plus net credit derivative premiums received and receivable, which is included in realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives. Combined ratio, which is a non-GAAP financial measure, is the sum of the loss and loss adjustment expense ratio and the expense ratio.

Financial Guaranty Direct Segment

        The financial guaranty direct segment consists of our primary financial guaranty insurance business and our credit derivative business. Financial guaranty insurance provides an unconditional and irrevocable guaranty that protects the holder of a financial obligation against non-payment of principal and interest when due. Financial guaranty insurance may be issued to the holders of the insured obligations at the time of issuance of those obligations, or may be issued in the secondary market to holders of public bonds and structured securities. As an alternative to traditional financial guaranty insurance, credit protection on a particular security or issuer can also be provided through a credit derivative, such as a credit default swap. Under a credit default swap, the seller of protection makes a specified payment to the buyer of protection upon the occurrence of one or more specified credit events with respect to a reference obligation or a particular reference entity. Credit derivatives typically provide protection to a buyer rather than credit enhancement of an issue as in traditional financial guaranty insurance.

        The table below summarizes the financial results of our financial guaranty direct segment for the periods presented:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 484.7   $ 167.1   $ 124.8  

Net written premiums

    474.7     154.5     124.1  

Net earned premiums

    90.0     52.8     27.8  

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives:

                   
 

Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable

    113.2     72.7     61.9  
 

Net credit derivative losses recovered and recoverable (paid and payable)

        0.1     (1.7 )
 

Ceding commissions income (expense), net

    0.6     (0.1 )   0.2  
               

Total realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

    113.8     72.7     60.4  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    196.7     29.2     2.6  

Incurred losses (gains) on credit derivatives

    38.4     3.6     (6.3 )
               

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    235.1     32.7     (3.7 )

Profit commission expense

             

Acquisition costs

    14.0     10.2     8.7  

Operating expenses

    61.5     60.5     52.3  
               

Underwriting (loss) gain

  $ (106.8 ) $ 22.1   $ 30.8  
               

Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio

    115.7 %   26.0 %   (2.2 )%

Expense ratio

    36.9 %   56.4 %   67.8 %
               

Combined ratio

    152.6 %   82.4 %   65.6 %
               

126


Table of Contents

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Gross Written Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Public finance

  $ 425.3   $ 122.1   $ 98.8  

Structured finance

    59.4     45.0     26.0  
               
 

Total

  $ 484.7   $ 167.1   $ 124.8  
               

        The financial guaranty direct segment contributed $484.7 million, $167.1 million and $124.8 million to overall gross written premiums, for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Gross written premiums in our financial guaranty direct operations increased $317.6 million in 2008 compared with 2007 primarily due to a $371.8 million increase in U.S. generated business, of which $355.8 million was from our upfront public finance business, as we continue to increase our book of business. Partially offsetting this increase was a reduction of our international infrastructure business to $16.9 million in 2008, compared with $71.3 million for 2007, as the prior included a few large infrastructure transactions. Gross written premiums in our financial guaranty direct operations increased $42.3 million in 2007 from 2006 primarily due to a $42.7 million increase in U.S. generated business, mainly from our upfront public finance and installment structured finance business, as we continue to execute our direct business strategy. Our international business was basically flat, and generated $71.3 million of gross written premiums in 2007 compared with $71.6 million in 2006.

        Generally, gross and net written premiums from the public finance market are received upfront, while the structured finance and credit derivatives markets have been received on an installment basis. The contribution of upfront premiums to gross written premiums were 87.7%, 72.4% and 79.2% of gross written premiums, or $425.0 million, $121.1 million and $98.9 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. In 2008, 2007 and 2006, installment premiums represented 12.3%, 27.6% and 20.8% of gross written premiums in this segment, or $59.7 million, $46.0 million and $25.9 million, respectively.

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Net Written Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Public finance

  $ 418.2   $ 111.7   $ 98.8  

Structured finance

    56.5     42.7     25.3  
               

Total

  $ 474.7   $ 154.5   $ 124.1  
               

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, net written premiums were $474.7 million, $154.5 million and $124.1 million, respectively. The variances in net written premiums are consistent with the variances in gross written premiums as we typically retain a substantial portion of this business.

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Net Earned Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Public finance

  $ 34.6   $ 13.0   $ 5.6  

Structured finance

    55.4     39.8     22.2  
               

Total

  $ 90.0   $ 52.8   $ 27.8  
               

Included in public finance direct net earned premiums are refundings of:

  $ 1.3   $ 2.8   $  

        Net earned premiums for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, were $90.0 million, $52.8 million and $27.8 million, respectively. The increase in net earned premiums reflects our increased market penetration, which has resulted in growth of our in-force book of business. Net earned premiums in 2008 increased $37.2 million compared with 2007 for the same reason. Net earned premiums increased $25.0 million in 2007 from 2006 due to the continued growth in our in-force book of business. Included in 2008 and 2007 financial guaranty direct net earned premiums were $1.3 million and $2.8 million, respectively, of public finance refundings, which reflect the unscheduled pre-payment or refundings of underlying municipal bonds. These unscheduled refundings are sensitive to market

127


Table of Contents


interest rates. There were no unscheduled refundings in 2006. We evaluate our net earned premiums both including and excluding these refundings.

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable

  $ 113.2   $ 72.7   $ 61.9  

Net credit derivative losses recovered and recoverable (paid and payable)

        0.1     (1.7 )

Ceding commissions received/receivable (paid/payable), net

    0.6     (0.1 )   0.2  
               
 

Total realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

  $ 113.8   $ 72.7   $ 60.4  
               

        Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives, were $113.8 million, $72.7 million and $60.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, and were comprised only of net credit derivative premiums received and receivable, which represents premium income recognized attributable to CDS contracts. The increases in both 2008 and 2007 are attributable to the increases in our direct business written in credit derivative form, as indicated by a 3% and 44% increase in par outstanding during the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, as well as pricing improvements during this time period. We did not have any losses paid or payable under these contracts in either 2008, 2007 or 2006.

        Loss and loss adjustment expenses were $196.7 million, $29.2 million and $2.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Our loss and loss adjustment expenses are affected by changes in the mix, size and credit trends in our book of business, and by changes in our reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses for prior periods. The loss ratios for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were 115.7%, 26.0% and (2.2)%, respectively. The 2008 year included an incurred loss and LAE of $53.9 million mainly attributable to two Closed-End Second transactions and loss and LAE of $119.7 million mainly related to our direct HELOC exposures driven by credit deterioration, primarily related to increases in delinquencies and decreases in credit enhancement. Additionally, 2008 included an incurred loss of $17.2 million due to establishment of a case reserve for a real estate related transaction. Included in 2007 was a $2.4 million case reserve increase and a $30.2 million portfolio reserve increase, primarily attributable to downgrades of transactions in our CMC list, including U.S. home equity line of credit exposures, as well as growth in new business and management's annual updating of rating agency default statistics used in the portfolio reserving model.

        Loss and LAE of $2.6 million in 2006 were due to an increase of $4.5 million associated with the increase in par in force and related net earned premiums and downgrades to sub-prime mortgage transactions, partially offset by a case loss reserve net recovery of $(1.6) million relating to the settlement of a sub-prime mortgage transaction.

        Incurred losses (gains) on credit derivatives were $38.4 million in 2008 compared with $3.6 million in 2007. The increase is primarily due to an increase in portfolio reserves as a result of downgrades within our U.S. RMBS credit derivative book of business.

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, acquisition costs incurred were $14.0 million, $10.2 million and $8.7 million, respectively. The changes in acquisition costs incurred over the periods are directly related to changes in net earned premiums from non-derivative transactions.

        Operating expenses for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $61.5 million, $60.5 million and $52.3 million, respectively. During 2006, the Company implemented a new operating expense allocation methodology to more closely allocate expenses to the individual operating segments. This new methodology was based on a comprehensive study which was based on departmental time estimates and headcount. The increases in operating expenses for both 2008 and 2007 were attributable to increased staff additions and merit increases as well as the increase in the amortization of restricted stock and stock option awards, due to new stock awards and other performance retention programs

128


Table of Contents


each year and the related amortization as well as the accelerated vesting of these awards for retirement eligible employees as required by FAS 123R.

Financial Guaranty Reinsurance Segment

        In our financial guaranty reinsurance business, we assume all or a portion of risk undertaken by other insurance companies that provide financial guaranty protection. The financial guaranty reinsurance business consists of public finance and structured finance reinsurance lines. Premiums on public finance are typically written upfront and earned over the life of the policy, and premiums on structured finance are typically written on an installment basis and earned ratably over the installment period.

        The table below summarizes the financial results of our financial guaranty reinsurance segment for the periods presented:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 129.3   $ 251.0   $ 123.9  

Net written premiums

    129.1     250.8     123.2  

Net earned premiums

    165.9     88.9     94.4  

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives:

                   
 

Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable

    4.9          
 

Net credit derivative losses recovered and recoverable

             
 

Ceding commissions (expense) income, net

    (1.5 )        
               

Total realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

    3.4          

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    68.4     (24.1 )   13.1  

Incurred losses on credit derivatives

    5.4          
               

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    73.8     (24.1 )   13.1  

Profit commission expense

    1.0     2.7     2.7  

Acquisition costs

    46.6     31.3     34.1  

Operating expenses

    19.7     17.3     14.5  
               

Underwriting gain

  $ 28.1   $ 61.6   $ 30.0  
               

Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio

   
43.2

%
 
(27.1

)%
 
13.9

%

Expense ratio

    40.3 %   57.7 %   54.3 %
               

Combined ratio

    83.5 %   30.6 %   68.2 %
               

 

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Gross Written Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Public finance

  $ 91.3   $ 207.8   $ 92.2  

Structured finance

    38.0     43.2     31.7  
               
 

Total

  $ 129.3   $ 251.0   $ 123.9  
               

        Gross written premiums for our financial guaranty reinsurance segment include upfront premiums on transactions underwritten during the period, plus installment premiums on business primarily underwritten in prior periods. Consequently, this amount is affected by changes in the business mix between public finance and structured finance. For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, 59%, 84% and 68%, respectively, of gross written premiums in this segment were upfront premiums and 41%, 16% and 32%, respectively, were installment premiums.

        Gross written premiums for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $129.3 million, $251.0 million and $123.9 million, respectively. The decrease of $121.7 million, or 48%, in gross written premiums for 2008, compared with 2007was mainly a result of a large portfolio assumed from Ambac in December 2007 which contributed $143.2 million of written premium. For 2007, gross written premiums increased $127.1 million, or 103%, compared with 2006 primarily due to the Ambac portfolio mentioned above.

129


Table of Contents

        The following table summarizes the Company's gross written premiums by type of contract:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Gross Written Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Treaty

  $ 37.9   $ 66.0   $ 82.4  

Facultative

    91.4     185.0     41.5  
               
 

Total

  $ 129.3   $ 251.0   $ 123.9  
               

        The following table summarizes the Company's reinsurance gross written premiums by significant client:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Gross Written Premiums by Client(1)
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Financial Security Assurance Inc.(1)

  $ 94.5   $ 58.6   $ 57.5  

Ambac Assurance Corporation(2)

    27.6     156.9     23.6  

Financial Guaranty Insurance Company

    21.2     17.5     21.1  

MBIA Insurance Corporation

    6.0     7.9     10.5  

XL Capital Assurance Ltd(3). 

    (20.3 )   10.0     10.4  
 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Net Written Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Public finance

  $ 91.1   $ 207.6   $ 91.5  

Structured finance

    38.0     43.2     31.7  
               

Total

  $ 129.1   $ 250.8   $ 123.2  
               

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, net written premiums were $129.1 million, $250.8 million and $123.2 million, respectively. The changes in all periods are consistent with the changes in gross written premiums because, to date, we have not retroceded a significant amount of premium to external reinsurers.

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Net Earned Premiums
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Public finance

  $ 123.1   $ 62.8   $ 61.2  

Structured finance

    42.8     26.1     33.2  
               

Total

  $ 165.9   $ 88.9   $ 94.4  
               

Included in public finance reinsurance net earned premiums are refundings of:

  $ 60.6   $ 14.8   $ 11.2  

130


Table of Contents

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, net earned premiums were $165.9 million, $88.9 million and $94.4 million, respectively. Net earned premiums increased $77.0 million, or 87%, in 2008 compared with 2007 and decreased $5.5 million, or 6%, in 2007 compared with 2006. Public finance transactions traditionally have a longer weighted average life than structured finance transactions. Public finance net earned premiums also include refundings, which reflect the unscheduled pre-payment or refundings of underlying municipal bonds. These unscheduled refundings, which were $60.6 million, $14.8 million and $11.2 million in 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, are sensitive to market interest rates and other market factors. Excluding refundings, net earned premiums increased $31.2 million, or 42%, in 2008 compared with 2007, due primarily to the portfolio assumed from Ambac in December 2007, which contributed $30.6 million to net earned premiums in 2008. Excluding these refundings, our financial guaranty reinsurance segment net earned premiums decreased by $9.1 million in 2007 when compared with 2006 due to the non-renewal of certain treaties in 2004 and 2006. Net earned premiums, excluding refundings, decreased $10.3 million, or 11%, in 2006 compared with 2005, due to the non-renewal of certain treaties and change in mix of business. We evaluate our net earned premiums both including and excluding these refundings.

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable

  $ 4.9   $   $  

Net credit derivative losses recovered and recoverable or payable

             

Ceding commissions (paid/payable) received/receivable, net

    (1.5 )        
               
 

Total realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

  $ 3.4   $   $  
               

        Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives, were $3.4 million, $0 million and $0 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable, which represents premium income recognized attributable to CDS contracts, and related ceding commission expense, increased based on amounts reported to us by our cedants. We did not have any losses paid or payable under these contracts in either 2008, 2007 or 2006.

        Loss and LAE were $68.4 million, $(24.1) million and $13.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Our loss and LAE ratios for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were 43.2%, (27.1)% and 13.9%, respectively. Loss and LAE in 2008 included $48.5 million of loss and LAE related to our assumed HELOC exposures. Additionally, 2008 loss and LAE included $14.6 million of incurred losses related to two public finance transactions. In 2007, the financial guaranty reinsurance segment had $(12.8) million of incurred losses due to the restructuring of a European infrastructure transaction, as well as losses incurred of $(17.7) million related to loss recoveries and increased salvage reserves for aircraft-related transactions. These benefits were partially offset by increases to case and portfolio reserves of $2.5 million and $2.4 million, respectively, for HELOC exposures. Portfolio reserves also increased $2.9 million as a result of management's annual updating of its rating agency default statistics. The 2006 loss and loss adjustment expenses included $6.8 million of net case loss and LAE reserve additions, primarily related to the rating downgrades of a U.S. public infrastructure transaction as well as other asset backed securities and a $1.6 million write-down of expected litigation recoveries, reported from a cedant. These recoveries were established in 1998 from a bankruptcy estate. In addition, the Company increased portfolio reserves $6.2 million primarily due to the ratings downgrade of a European infrastructure transaction and management updating its rating agency default statistics, as part of our normal portfolio reserve process and due to the rating downgrade of various credits.

        Profit commission expense was $1.0 million, $2.7 million and $2.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Not all of our treaties have a profit commission component, however the changes in profit commission expense correspond with the net earned

131


Table of Contents


premium from a treaty which has a profit commission component. The decrease in 2008, compared with 2007 is primarily related to amounts reported by our ceding companies, which reflects increases in reported loss and LAE for transactions subject to profit commission.

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, acquisition costs incurred were $46.6 million, $31.3 million and $34.1 million, respectively. The changes in acquisition costs incurred over the periods are directly related to the changes in net earned premiums from non-derivative transactions and also reflect a decrease in negotiated ceding commission rates for transactions executed in recent years.

        Operating expenses for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, were $19.7 million, $17.3 million and $14.5 million, respectively. During 2006, the Company implemented a new operating expense allocation methodology to more closely allocate expenses to the individual operating segments. This new methodology was based on a comprehensive study which was based on departmental time estimates and headcount. The increases in operating expenses for both 2008 and 2007 were attributable to increased staff additions and merit increases as well as the increase in the amortization of restricted stock and stock option awards, due to new stock awards and other performance retention programs each year and the related amortization as well as the accelerated vesting of these awards for retirement eligible employees as required by FAS 123R.

Mortgage Guaranty Segment

        Mortgage guaranty insurance provides protection to mortgage lending institutions against the default of borrowers on mortgage loans that, at the time of the advance, had a loan-to-value ratio in excess of a specified ratio. We primarily function as a reinsurer in this industry and assume all or a portion of the risks undertaken by primary mortgage insurers.

        The table below summarizes the financial results of our mortgage guaranty segment for the periods presented:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 0.7   $ 2.7   $ 8.4  

Net written premiums

    0.7     2.7     8.4  

Net earned premiums

    5.7     17.5     22.7  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    2.0     0.6     (4.4 )

Profit commission expense

    0.4     3.8     6.8  

Acquisition costs

    0.5     1.6     2.3  

Operating expenses

    2.2     2.0     1.3  
               

Underwriting gain

  $ 0.6   $ 9.4   $ 16.7  
               

Loss and loss adjustment expense ratio

    35.1 %   3.3 %   (19.4 )%

Expense ratio

    53.9 %   42.9 %   45.7 %
               

Combined ratio

    89.0 %   46.2 %   26.3 %
               

        Gross written premiums for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $0.7 million, $2.7 million and $8.4 million, respectively. The decrease in gross written premiums for 2007 compared with 2006 was primarily related to the run-off of our quota share treaty business as well as commutations executed in the latter part of 2007. The decrease in gross written premiums for 2007 compared with 2006 was primarily related to the run-off of our quota share treaty business as well as commutations executed in the latter part of 2006.

132


Table of Contents

        Net written premiums for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $0.7 million, $2.7 million and $8.4 million, respectively. This is consistent with gross written premiums, as we do not cede a significant amount of our mortgage guaranty business.

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, net earned premiums were $5.7 million, $17.5 million and $22.7 million, respectively. The decrease in net earned premiums for both periods reflects the run-off of our quota share treaty business as well as commutations executed in the latter parts of 2007 and 2006.

        Loss and loss adjustment expenses were $2.0 million, $0.6 million and $(4.4) million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The loss and loss adjustment expense ratios for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were 35.1%, 3.3% and (19.4)%, respectively. Loss and LAE for 2008 included $2.3 million of LAE related to one transaction in arbitration (refer to Note 16 "Commitments and Contingencies" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K for further discussion). The loss and loss adjustment expense for 2007 was due to an increase in portfolio reserves as a result of management's annual updating of rating agency default statistics used in its portfolio reserving process. The 2006 result was primarily due to the Company releasing $4.1 million of IBNR reserves related to the settlement of the 1997 quota share treaty year. This release however, was offset by a corresponding increase in profit commission expense, discussed below.

        Profit commission expense for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 was $0.4 million, $3.8 million and $6.8 million, respectively. The decrease in profit commission expense for 2008 compared with 2007 is primarily due to the run-off of mortgage guaranty experience rated quota share treaties, which have a large profit commission component. The 2007 profit commission expense is mainly related to the commutation of two transactions during the latter part of the year. The 2006 year included $4.1 million of profit commission expense due to the settlement of the 1997 quota share years, discussed above. Portfolio reserves are not a component of these profit commission calculations.

        Acquisition costs incurred for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $0.5 million, $1.6 million and $2.3 million, respectively. The changes in acquisition costs incurred are directly related to the changes in net earned premiums.

        Operating expenses for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were $2.2 million, $2.0 million and $1.3 million, respectively. During 2006, the Company implemented a new operating expense allocation methodology to more closely allocate expenses to the individual operating segments. This new methodology was based on a comprehensive study which was based on departmental time estimates and headcount. The increase in operating expenses for both 2008 and 2007 were attributable to increased salaries due to increased staff additions and merit increases as well as the increase in the amortization of restricted stock and stock option awards, due to new stock awards and other performance retention programs each year and the related amortization as well as the accelerated vesting of these awards for retirement eligible employees as required by FAS 123R.

Other Segment

        The other segment represents lines of businesses that we exited or sold as part of our IPO.

        The other segment had no earned premiums during 2008, 2007 or 2006. However, due to loss recoveries the other segment generated underwriting gains of $1.9 million, $1.3 million and $13.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The Company recorded net credit derivative loss recoveries of $0.4 million, $1.3 million and $13.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

133


Table of Contents

Liquidity and Capital Resources

        Our liquidity, both on a short-term basis (for the next twelve months) and a long-term basis (beyond the next twelve months), is largely dependent upon: (1) the ability of our operating subsidiaries to pay dividends or make other payments to us, (2) external financings and (3) net investment income from our invested assets. Our liquidity requirements include the payment of our operating expenses, interest on our debt, and dividends on our common shares. We may also require liquidity to make periodic capital investments in our operating subsidiaries. In the ordinary course of our business, we evaluate our liquidity needs and capital resources in light of holding company expenses, debt-related expenses and our dividend policy, as well as rating agency considerations. Based on the amount of dividends we expect to receive from our subsidiaries and the income we expect to receive from our invested assets, management believes that we will have sufficient liquidity to satisfy our needs over the next twelve months, including the ability to pay dividends on our common shares. Total cash paid in 2008, 2007 and 2006 for dividends to shareholders was $16.0 million, or $0.18 per common share, $11.0 million, or $0.16 per common share, and $10.5 million, or $0.14 per common share, respectively. Beyond the next twelve months, the ability of our operating subsidiaries to declare and pay dividends may be influenced by a variety of factors including market conditions, insurance and rating agencies regulations and general economic conditions. Consequently, although management believes that we will continue to have sufficient liquidity to meet our debt service and other obligations over the long term, it remains possible that we may be required to seek external debt or equity financing in order to meet our operating expenses, debt service obligations or pay dividends on our common shares. These external sources of financing may or may not be available to us, and if available, the costs of such financing may be higher than our current levels.

        We anticipate that a major source of our liquidity, for the next twelve months and for the longer term, will be amounts paid by our operating subsidiaries as dividends. Certain of our operating subsidiaries are subject to restrictions on their ability to pay dividends. See "Business—Regulation." The amount available at AGC to pay dividends in 2009 with notice to, but without the prior approval of, the Maryland Insurance Commissioner is approximately $37.8 million. Dividends paid by a U.S. company to a Bermuda holding company presently are subject to a 30% withholding tax. The amount available at AG Re to pay dividends or make a distribution of contributed surplus in 2009 in compliance with Bermuda law is $1,125.0 million. However, any distribution which results in a reduction of 15% or more of AG Re's total statutory capital, as set out in its previous year's financial statements, would require the prior approval of the Bermuda Monetary Authority.

        Liquidity at our operating subsidiaries is used to pay operating expenses, claims, payment obligations with respect to credit derivatives, including collateral postings, reinsurance premiums and dividends to AGUS for debt service and dividends to us, as well as, where appropriate, to make capital investments in their own subsidiaries. In addition, certain of our operating companies may be required to post additional collateral in connection with credit derivatives and reinsurance transactions. Management believes that these subsidiaries' operating needs generally can be met from operating cash flow, including gross written premium and investment income from their respective investment portfolios.

        Net cash flows provided by operating activities were $427.0 million, $385.9 million and $261.6 million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The increase in cash flows provided by operating activities in 2008, compared with 2007 was due to the large proportion of upfront premiums received in our financial guaranty direct segment due to growth in our U.S. public finance business.

        The increase in cash flows provided by operating activities in 2007 was due to significant amount of upfront premiums received in both our financial guaranty direct and financial guaranty reinsurance segments, partially offset by payments for income taxes.

134


Table of Contents

        2006 operating cash flows were primarily due to upfront premium received in both our financial guaranty direct and financial guaranty reinsurance segments during 2006 and $13.5 million of loss recoveries from third party litigation settlements from business, which was exited in connection with the IPO.

        Net cash flows used in investing activities were $(649.6) million, $(664.4) million and $(228.5) million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. These investing activities were primarily net purchases of fixed maturity investment securities during 2008, 2007 and 2006. The increase in 2008 was due to purchases of fixed maturity securities with the cash generated from positive cash flows from operating activities and capital received from the equity offerings in April 2008 and December 2007. The increase in 2007 was due to purchases of fixed maturity securities with the cash proceeds from the December 2007 public offering, as discussed below.

        Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities were $229.3 million, $281.4 million and $(35.1) million during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

        On December 21, 2007, the Company completed the sale of 12,483,960 of its common shares at a price of $25.50 per share. The net proceeds of the sale totaled approximately $303.8 million. The Company has contributed the net proceeds of the offering to its reinsurance subsidiary, AG Re. AG Re has used the proceeds to provide capital support in the form of a reinsurance portfolio transaction with Ambac Assurance Corp. for approximately $29 billion of net par outstanding, as well as to support the growth of AGC, the Company's direct financial guaranty subsidiary, by providing reinsurance. AG Re is AGC's principal financial guaranty reinsurer.

        On April 8, 2008, investment funds managed by WL Ross & Co. LLC ("WL Ross") purchased 10,651,896 shares of the Company's common equity at a price of $23.47 per share, resulting in proceeds to the Company of $250.0 million. The Company contributed $150.0 million of these proceeds to its subsidiary, AG Re. In addition, the Company contributed $100.0 million of these proceeds to its subsidiary, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., which in turn contributed the same amount to its subsidiary, AGC. The commitment to purchase these shares was previously announced on February 29, 2008. WL Ross has a remaining commitment through April 8, 2009 to purchase up to $750.0 million of the Company's common equity, at the Company's option, subject to the terms and conditions of the investment agreement with the Company dated February 28, 2008. In accordance with the investment agreement, the Company may exercise this option in one or more drawdowns, subject to a minimum drawdown of $50 million, provided that the purchase price per common share for the subsequent shares is not greater than $27.57, or less than $19.37, the price per common share for the initial shares. The purchase price per common share for such shares will be equal to 97% of the volume weighted average price of a common share on the NYSE for the 15 NYSE trading days prior to the applicable drawdown notice. As of December 31, 2008, and as of the date of this filing, the purchase price per common share is outside of this range and therefore the Company may not, at this time, exercise its option for WL Ross to purchase additional shares.

        During 2008 we paid $16.0 million in dividends, $3.6 million, net, under our option and incentive plans and $1.0 million for offering costs incurred in connection with the December 2007 equity offering and issuance of common shares to WL Ross.

        In addition, during 2007 we paid $11.0 million in dividends, $9.3 million for share repurchases, $2.0 million, net, under our option and incentive plans and $0.4 million in debt issue costs related to $150.0 million of Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures issued in December 2006.

        On May 4, 2006, the Company's Board of Directors approved a share repurchase program for 1.0 million common shares. Share repurchases took place at management's discretion depending on market conditions. In August 2007 the Company completed this share repurchase program. During

135


Table of Contents


2007 and 2006, we paid $3.7 million and $21.1 million to repurchase 0.2 million shares and 0.8 million shares of our Common Stock, respectively.

        On November 8, 2007, the Company's Board of Directors approved a new share repurchase program for up to 2.0 million common shares. Share repurchases will take place at management's discretion depending on market conditions. During 2007 we paid $5.6 million to repurchase 0.3 million shares of our Common Stock.

        During 2006 we paid $21.1 million for share repurchases, $10.5 million in dividends and $2.1 million of notes outstanding, which were issued in connection with the IPO, and related interest to subsidiaries of ACE.

        In December 2006, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. ("AGUS"), a subsidiary of the Company, issued $150.0 million Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures (the "Debentures") due in 2066. The Debentures pay a fixed 6.40% rate of interest until December 15, 2016 and pay a floating rate based on three-month LIBOR plus a margin of 2.38% with quarterly resets thereafter. Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. used the proceeds to repurchase 5,692,599 of the Company's common shares from ACE Bermuda.

        The following table summarizes our contractual obligations as of December 31, 2008:

 
  As of December 31, 2008  
 
  Total   Less Than 1 Year   1-3 Years   3-5 Years   After 5 Years  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Senior Notes(1)

  $ 554.3   $ 14.0   $ 28.0   $ 28.0   $ 484.3  

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures(1)

    226.5     9.6     19.2     19.2     178.5  

Operating lease obligations(2)

    31.9     7.1     12.4     11.2     1.1  

Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses(3)

    156.9     224.0     6.2     (26.2 )   (47.1 )
                       

Total(4)

  $ 969.6   $ 254.7   $ 65.8   $ 32.2   $ 616.8  
                       

(1)
Principal and interest. See also Note 18 "Long-Term Debt" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this 10-K.

(2)
Lease payments are subject to escalations in building operating costs and real estate taxes.

(3)
We have estimated the timing of these payments based on our historical experience and our expectation of future payment patterns. However, the timing of these payments may vary significantly from the amounts shown above, especially for our portfolio reserves. Amounts include payments for derivative reserves of $48.7 million and mortgage reserves of $1.5 million. These amounts are not discounted.

(4)
Totals may not add due to rounding.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

        In June 2008, the Company's subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Corp., entered into a new five-year lease agreement for New York office space. Future minimum annual payments of $5.3 million for the first twelve month period and $5.7 million for subsequent twelve month periods will commence October 1, 2008 and are subject to escalation in building operating costs and real estate taxes.

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the Company did not have any significant off-balance-sheet arrangements that were not accounted for or disclosed in the consolidated financial statements.

136


Table of Contents

Credit Facilities

        On November 6, 2006, Assured Guaranty Ltd. and certain of its subsidiaries entered into a $300.0 million five-year unsecured revolving credit facility (the "2006 credit facility") with a syndicate of banks, for which ABN AMRO Incorporated and Bank of America Securities LLC acted as lead arrangers. Under the 2006 credit facility, each of AGC, Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. ("AG (UK)"), AG Re, AGRO and Assured Guaranty Ltd. are entitled to request the banks to make loans to such borrower or to request that letters of credit be issued for the account of such borrower.

        Of the $300.0 million available to be borrowed, no more than $100.0 million may be borrowed by Assured Guaranty Ltd., AG Re or AGRO, individually or in the aggregate, and no more than $20.0 million may be borrowed by AG (UK). The stated amount of all outstanding letters of credit and the amount of all unpaid drawings in respect of all letters of credit cannot, in the aggregate, exceed $100.0 million.

        The 2006 credit facility also provides that Assured Guaranty Ltd. may request that the commitment of the banks be increased an additional $100.0 million up to a maximum aggregate amount of $400.0 million. Any such incremental commitment increase is subject to certain conditions provided in the agreement and must be for at least $25.0 million.

        The proceeds of the loans and letters of credit are to be used for the working capital and other general corporate purposes of the borrowers and to support reinsurance transactions.

        At the closing of the 2006 credit facility, (i) AGC guaranteed the obligations of AG (UK) under such facility, (ii) Assured Guaranty Ltd. guaranteed the obligations of AG Re and AGRO under such facility and agreed that, if the Company Consolidated Assets (as defined in the related credit agreement) of AGC and its subsidiaries were to fall below $1.2 billion, it would, within 15 days, guarantee the obligations of AGC and AG (UK) under such facility, (iii) Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. guaranteed the obligations of Assured Guaranty Ltd., AG Re and AGRO under such facility and (iv) Each of AG Re and AGRO guarantees the other as well as Assured Guaranty Ltd.

        The 2006 credit facility's financial covenants require that Assured Guaranty Ltd. (a) maintain a minimum net worth of seventy-five percent (75%) of the Consolidated Net Worth of Assured Guaranty Ltd. as of the most recent fiscal quarter of Assured Guaranty Ltd. prior to November 6, 2006 and (b) maintain a maximum debt-to-capital ratio of 30%. In addition, the 2006 credit facility requires that AGC maintain qualified statutory capital of at least 75% of its statutory capital as of the fiscal quarter prior to November 6, 2006. Furthermore, the 2006 credit facility contains restrictions on Assured Guaranty Ltd. and its subsidiaries, including, among other things, in respect of their ability to incur debt, permit liens, become liable in respect of guaranties, make loans or investments, pay dividends or make distributions, dissolve or become party to a merger, consolidation or acquisition, dispose of assets or enter into affiliate transactions. Most of these restrictions are subject to certain minimum thresholds and exceptions. The 2006 credit facility has customary events of default, including (subject to certain materiality thresholds and grace periods) payment default, failure to comply with covenants, material inaccuracy of representation or warranty, bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings, change of control and cross-default to other debt agreements. A default by one borrower will give rise to a right of the lenders to terminate the facility and accelerate all amounts then outstanding. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, Assured Guaranty was in compliance with all of those financial covenants.

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, no amounts were outstanding under this facility nor have there been any borrowings under this facility.

137


Table of Contents

        The 2006 credit facility replaced a $300.0 million three-year credit facility. Letters of credit totaling approximately $2.9 million remained outstanding as of December 31, 2008 related to the Real Estate Lease agreement discussed above. No letters of credit were outstanding as of December 31, 2007.

        On July 31, 2007 AG Re entered into a non-recourse credit facility ("AG Re Credit Facility") with a syndicate of banks which provides up to $200.0 million to satisfy certain reinsurance agreements and obligations. The AG Re Credit Facility expires in July 2014.

        The AG Re Credit Facility does not contain any financial covenants. The AG Re Credit Facility has customary events of default , including (subject to certain materiality thresholds and grace periods) payment default, failure to comply with covenants, material inaccuracy of representation or warranty, bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings, change of control and cross-default to other debt agreements. If any such event of default were triggered, AG Re could be required to repay potential outstanding borrowings in an accelerated manner.

        AG Re's obligations to make payments of principal and interest on loans under the AG Re Credit Facility, whether at maturity, upon acceleration or otherwise, are limited recourse obligations of AG Re and are payable solely from the collateral securing the AG Re Credit Facility, including recoveries with respect to certain insured obligations in a designated portfolio, premiums with respect to defaulted insured obligations in that portfolio, certain designated reserves and other designated collateral.

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, no amounts were outstanding under this facility nor have there been any borrowings under the life of this facility.

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

        On December 20, 2006, AGUS issued $150.0 million of Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures (the "Debentures") due 2066 for net proceeds of $149.7 million. The Debentures are guaranteed on a junior subordinated basis by Assured Guaranty Ltd. The proceeds of the offering were used to repurchase 5,692,599 of Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s common shares from ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd., a subsidiary of ACE. The Debentures pay a fixed 6.40% rate of interest until December 15, 2016, and thereafter pay a floating rate of interest, reset quarterly, at a rate equal to 3 month LIBOR plus a margin equal to 2.38%. AGUS may elect at one or more times to defer payment of interest for one or more consecutive periods for up to ten years. Any unpaid interest bears interest at the then applicable rate. AGUS may not defer interest past the maturity date.

        On any date on which accrued interest through the most recent interest payment date has not been paid in full, whether because of an optional deferral or otherwise, AGUS and Assured Guaranty Ltd. will not, and will not permit any subsidiary to, declare or pay any dividends or any distributions on, or make any payments of interest, principal or premium, or any guarantee payments on, or redeem, repurchase, purchase, acquire or make a liquidation payment on, any of AGUS's or Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s capital stock, debt securities that rank equal or junior to the Debentures or the subordinated guarantees or guarantees that rank equal or junior to the Debentures or the subordinated guarantees, other than pro rata payments on debt securities that rank equally with the Debentures and the subordinated guarantees with certain exceptions.

        If AGUS has optionally deferred interest payments otherwise due on the Debentures, then following the earlier of (i) the fifth anniversary of the commencement of a deferral period or (ii) a payment, during a deferral period, of current interest on the Debentures, AGUS and Assured Guaranty Ltd. must make commercially reasonable efforts to sell qualifying warrants and non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock. If such efforts are successful, AGUS must pay optionally

138


Table of Contents


deferred interest out of the net proceeds from the sale of such securities. AGUS cannot pay optionally deferred interest from sources other than the net proceeds from the sale of such securities. AGUS's and Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s obligation to make commercially reasonable efforts to sell qualifying warrants and non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock to satisfy AGUS's obligation to pay interest is subject to market disruption events and subject to certain caps, and does not apply if an event of default with respect to the Debentures has occurred and is continuing.

        In connection with the issuance of the Debentures, Assured Guaranty Ltd. and AGUS entered into a replacement capital covenant (the "Replacement Capital Covenant") in which Assured Guaranty Ltd. and AGUS covenanted that (i) AGUS will not redeem or repurchase the Debentures and (ii) Assured Guaranty Ltd. will not purchase the Debentures, in each case on or before December 15, 2046, except, subject to certain limitations, to the extent that the applicable redemption, repurchase or purchase price does not exceed a specified amount of proceeds from the sale, during the 180 days prior to the date of that redemption, repurchase or purchase, of common shares, rights to acquire common shares, and qualifying capital securities.

        Subject to the Replacement Capital Covenant, the Debentures may be redeemed in whole or in part, subject to minimum amounts outstanding, at any time, on or after December 15, 2016, at the cash redemption price of 100% of the principal amount of the Debentures to be redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, together with any compounded interest, on such Debentures to the date of redemption (the "par redemption amount"). AGUS may redeem the Debentures prior to December 15, 2016, in whole but not in part, at a price equal to the greater of (i) the par redemption amount and (ii) the applicable make-whole redemption amount.

        The junior subordinated indenture governing the Debentures provides that only the following constitute events of default with respect to the Debentures that give a right to accelerate the amounts due under the Debentures: (i) default for 30 calendar days in the payment of any interest on the Debentures when such interest becomes due and payable (whether or not such payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions); however, a default under this provision will not arise if AGUS has properly deferred the interest in connection with an optional deferral period, (ii) any non-payment of interest, whether due to an optional deferral or otherwise, that continues for 10 consecutive years without all accrued and unpaid interest (including compounded interest thereon) having been paid in full, such non-payment continues for 30 days and Assured Guaranty Ltd. fails to make guarantee payments with respect thereto, (iii) default in the payment of the principal of, and premium, if any, on the Debentures when due, or (iv) certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency, or receivership, whether voluntary or not. Failure to comply with covenants is not an event of default under the junior subordinated indenture for purposes of declaring an acceleration of payment of the Debentures.

Committed Capital Securities

        On April 8, 2005, AGC entered into separate agreements (the "Put Agreements") with each of Woodbourne Capital Trust I, Woodbourne Capital Trust II, Woodbourne Capital Trust III and Woodbourne Capital Trust IV (each, a "Custodial Trust") pursuant to which AGC may, at its option, cause each of the Custodial Trusts to purchase up to $50,000,000 of perpetual preferred stock of AGC (the "AGC Preferred Stock").

Structure

        Each of the Custodial Trusts is a newly organized Delaware statutory trust formed for the purpose of (i) issuing a series of flex committed capital securities (the "CCS Securities") representing undivided beneficial interests in the assets of such Custodial Trust; (ii) investing the proceeds from the issuance of the CCS Securities or any redemption in full of AGC Preferred Stock in a portfolio of high-grade

139


Table of Contents


commercial paper and (in limited cases) U.S. Treasury Securities (the "Eligible Assets"), (iii) entering into the Put Agreement with AGC; and (iv) entering into related agreements.

        Initially, all of the CCS Securities were issued to a special purpose pass-through trust (the "Pass-Through Trust"). The Pass-Through Trust was dissolved in April 2008 and the committed capital securities were distributed to the holders of the Pass-Through Trust's securities. Neither the Pass-Through Trust nor the Custodial Trusts are consolidated in Assured Guaranty's financial statements.

        Income distributions on the Pass-Through Trust Securities and CCS Securities were equal to an annualized rate of One-Month LIBOR plus 110 basis points for all periods ending on or prior to April 8, 2008. Following dissolution of the Pass-Through Trust, distributions on the CCS Securities will be determined pursuant to an auction process. On April 7, 2008 this auction process failed, thereby increasing the annualized rate on the CCS Securities to One-Month LIBOR plus 250 basis points. Distributions on the AGC Preferred Stock will be determined pursuant to the same process or, if the Company so elects upon the dissolution of the Custodial Trusts at a fixed rate equal to One-Month LIBOR plus 250 basis points (based on the then current 30-year swap rate).

Put Agreement

        Pursuant to the Put Agreement, AGC will pay a monthly put premium to each Custodial Trust except (1) during any period when the AGC Preferred Stock that has been put to a Custodial Trust is held by that Custodial Trust or (2) upon termination of the Put Agreement. The put premium will equal the product of (A) the applicable distribution rate on the CCS Securities for the respective distribution period less the excess of (i) the Custodial Trust's stated return on the Eligible Assets for such distribution period (including any fees and expenses of the Pass-Through Trust) (expressed as an annual rate) over (ii) the expenses of the Custodial Trust for such distribution period (expressed as an annual rate), (B) the aggregate face amount of the CCS Securities of the Custodial Trust outstanding on the date the put premium is calculated, and (C) a fraction, the numerator of which will be the actual number of days in such distribution period and the denominator of which will be 360. In addition, and as a condition to exercising the put option under a Put Agreement, AGC is required to enter into a Custodial Trust Expense Reimbursement Agreement with the respective Custodial Trust pursuant to which AGC agrees it will pay the fees and expenses of the Custodial Trust (which includes the fees and expenses of the Pass-Through Trust) during the period when such Custodial Trust holds AGC Preferred Stock.

        Upon exercise of the put option granted to AGC pursuant to the Put Agreement, a Custodial Trust will liquidate its portfolio of Eligible Assets and purchase the AGC Preferred Stock and will hold the AGC Preferred Stock until the earlier of (i) the redemption of such AGC Preferred Stock and (ii) the liquidation or dissolution of the Custodial Trust.

        Each Put Agreement has no scheduled termination date or maturity, however, it will terminate if (1) AGC fails to pay the put premium in accordance with the Put Agreement, and such failure continues for five business days, (2) AGC elects to have the AGC Preferred Stock bear a fixed rate dividend (a "Fixed Rate Distribution Event"), (3) AGC fails to pay (i) dividends on the AGC Preferred Stock, or (ii) the fees and expenses of the Custodial Trust, for the related dividend period, and such failure continues for five business days, (4) AGC fails to pay the redemption price of the AGC Preferred Stock and such failure continues for five business days, (5) the face amount of a Custodial Trust's CCS Securities is less than $20,000,000, (6) AGC elects to terminate the Put Agreement, or (7) a decree of judicial dissolution of the Custodial Trust is entered. If, as a result of AGC's failure to pay the put premium, the Custodial Trust is liquidated, AGC will be required to pay a termination payment which will be distributed to the holders of the Pass-Through Trust Securities. The termination payment will be at a rate equal to 1.10% per annum of the amount invested in Eligible Assets

140


Table of Contents


calculated from the date of the failure to pay the put premium through the end of the applicable period.

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the put option had not been exercised.

AGC Preferred Stock

        AGC Preferred Stock under the Put Agreement will be issued in one or more series, with each series in an aggregate liquidation preference amount equal to the aggregate face amount of a Custodial Trust's outstanding CCS Securities, net of fees and expenses, upon exercise of the put option. Unless redeemed by AGC, the AGC Preferred Stock will be perpetual.

        For each distribution period, holders of the outstanding AGC Preferred Stock of any series, in preference to the holders of common stock and of any other class of shares ranking junior to the AGC Preferred Stock, will be entitled to receive out of any funds legally available therefore when, as and if declared by the Board of Directors of AGC or a duly authorized committee thereof, cash dividends at a rate per share equal to the dividends rate for such series of AGC Preferred Stock for the respective distribution period. Prior to a Fixed Rate Distribution Event, the dividend rate on the AGC Preferred Stock will be equal to the distribution rate on the CCS Securities. The Custodial Trust's expenses (including any expenses of the Pass-Through Trust) for the period will be paid separately by AGC pursuant to the Custodial Trust Expense Reimbursement Agreement.

        Upon a Fixed Rate Distribution Event, the distribution rate on the AGC Preferred Stock will equal the fixed rate equivalent of one-month LIBOR plus 2.50%. A "Fixed Rate Distribution Event" will be deemed to have occurred when AGC Preferred Stock is outstanding, if: (1) AGC elects to have the AGC Preferred Stock bear dividends at a fixed rate, (2) AGC fails to pay dividends on the AGC Preferred Stock for the related distribution period and such failure continues for five business days or (3) AGC fails to pay the fees and expenses of the Custodial Trust for the related distribution period pursuant to the Custodial Trust Expense Reimbursement Agreement and such failure continues for five business days.

        During the period in which AGC Preferred Stock is held by a Custodial Trust and unless a Fixed Rate Distribution Event has occurred, dividends will be paid every 49 days. Following a Fixed Rate Distribution Event, dividends will be paid every 90 days.

        Following exercise of the put option during any Flexed Rate Period, AGC may redeem the AGC Preferred Stock held by a Custodial Trust in whole and not in part on any distribution payment date by paying a redemption price to such Custodial Trust in an amount equal to the liquidation preference amount of the AGC Preferred Stock (plus any accrued but unpaid dividends on the AGC Preferred Stock for the then current distribution period). If AGC redeems the AGC Preferred Stock held by a Custodial Trust, the Custodial Trust will reinvest the redemption proceeds in Eligible Assets and, in accordance with the Put Agreement, AGC will pay the put premium to the Custodial Trust. If the AGC Preferred Stock was distributed to holders of CCS Securities during any Flexed Rate Period then AGC may not redeem the AGC Preferred Stock until the end of such period.

        Following exercise of the put option AGC Preferred Stock held by a Custodial Trust in whole or in part on any distribution payment date by paying a redemption price to the Custodial Trust in an amount equal to the liquidation preference amount of the AGC Preferred Stock to be redeemed (plus any accrued but unpaid dividends on such AGC Preferred Stock for the then current distribution period). If AGC partially redeems the AGC Preferred Stock held by a Custodial Trust, the redemption proceeds will be distributed pro rata to the holders of the CCS Securities (and a corresponding reduction in the aggregate face amount of CCS Securities); provided that AGC must redeem all of the AGC Preferred Stock if after giving effect to a partial redemption, the aggregate liquidation preference amount of the AGC Preferred Stock held by such Custodial Trust immediately following such

141


Table of Contents


redemption would be less than $20,000,000. If a Fixed Rate Distribution Event occurs, AGC may not redeem the AGC Preferred Stock for a period of two years from the date of such Fixed Rate Distribution Event.

Investment Portfolio

        Our investment portfolio consisted of $3,154.1 million of fixed maturity securities, $477.2 million of short-term investments and a duration of 4.1 years as of December 31, 2008, compared with $2,587.0 million of fixed maturity securities, $552.9 million of short-term investments and a duration of 3.9 years as of December 31, 2007. Our fixed maturity securities are designated as available-for-sale in accordance with FAS No. 115 "Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities" ("FAS 115"). Fixed maturity securities are reported at their fair value in accordance with FAS 115, and the change in fair value is reported as part of accumulated other comprehensive income. If we believe the decline in fair value is "other than temporary," we write down the carrying value of the investment and record a realized loss in our statement of operations.

        The following table summarizes our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2008:

 
  Amortized Cost   Gross Unrealized Gain   Gross Unrealized Loss   Estimated Fair Value  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

U.S. government and agencies

  $ 426.6   $ 49.4   $   $ 475.9  

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

    1,235.9     33.2     (51.4 )   1,217.7  

Corporate securities

    274.2     5.8     (11.8 )   268.2  

Mortgage-backed securities

    1,081.9     21.8     (51.8 )   1,051.8  

Asset-backed securities

    80.7         (7.1 )   73.6  

Foreign government securities

    50.3     4.2         54.5  

Preferred stock

    12.6         (0.3 )   12.4  
                   
 

Total fixed maturity securities

    3,162.3     114.3     (122.5 )   3,154.1  

Short-term investments

    477.2             477.2  
                   
 

Total investments(1)

  $ 3,639.5   $ 114.3   $ (122.5 ) $ 3,631.3  
                   

        The following table summarizes our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2007:

 
  Amortized Cost   Gross Unrealized Gain   Gross Unrealized Loss   Estimated Fair Value  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

U.S. government and agencies

  $ 297.4   $ 13.5   $   $ 311.0  

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

    1,043.0     38.6     (2.8 )   1,078.8  

Corporate securities

    179.4     4.8     (1.4 )   182.8  

Mortgage-backed securities

    859.7     9.9     (4.6 )   864.9  

Asset-backed securities

    68.1     0.3     (0.1 )   68.4  

Foreign government securities

    71.4     1.7         73.1  

Preferred stock

    7.9     0.2         8.1  
                   
 

Total fixed maturity securities

    2,526.9     69.1     (8.9 )   2,587.0  

Short-term investments

    552.9             552.9  
                   
 

Total investments(1)

  $ 3,079.8   $ 69.1   $ (8.9 ) $ 3,139.9  
                   

(1)
Totals may not add across and down due to rounding.

142


Table of Contents

        The amortized cost and estimated fair value of our available-for-sale fixed maturity securities as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

        See Note 9 "Investments" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K for more information on our available-for-sale fixed maturity securities as of December 31, 2008 and 2007.

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007  
($ in millions)
  Amortized Cost   Estimated Fair Value   Amortized Cost   Estimated Fair Value  

Due within one year

  $ 29.0   $ 29.5   $ 11.7   $ 11.7  

Due after one year through five years

    357.1     373.2     357.6     364.8  

Due after five years through ten years

    564.7     584.8     382.5     396.9  

Due after ten years

    1,117.0     1,101.4     907.6     940.6  

Mortgage-backed securities

    1,081.9     1,051.8     859.7     864.9  

Preferred stock

    12.6     12.4     7.9     8.1  
                   

Total(1)

  $ 3,162.3   $ 3,153.1   $ 2,526.9   $ 2,587.0  
                   

(1)
Total may not add due to rounding.

        Fair value of the fixed maturity securities is based upon market prices provided by either independent pricing services or, when such prices are not available, by reference to broker or underwriter bid indications. Our investment portfolio does not include any non-publicly traded securities. For a detailed description of our valuation of investments see "—Critical Accounting Estimates."

        We review our investment portfolio for possible impairment losses. For additional information, see "—Critical Accounting Estimates."

143


Table of Contents

        The following table summarizes the ratings distributions of our investment portfolio as of December 31, 2007 and 2006. Ratings are represented by the lower of the Moody's and S&P classifications.

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007  

AAA or equivalent

    59.0 %   79.9 %

AA

    23.8 %   15.6 %

A

    15.5 %   4.5 %

BBB

    1.7 %    

Below investment grade(1)

         
           

Total

    100.0 %   100.0 %
           

        As of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007, our investment portfolio contained three securities that were not rated or rated below investment grade. The change in the rating distributions reflected above is mainly the result of downgrades of certain financial guaranty insurance companies during the Second Quarter 2008. As of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007, the weighted average credit quality of our entire investment portfolio was AA+ and AAA, respectively.

        As of December 31, 2008, $641.1 million of the Company's $3,154.1 million of fixed maturity securities were guaranteed by third parties. The following table presents the credit rating of these $641.1 million of securities without the third-party guaranty:

Rating
  Amount (in millions)  

AAA

  $ 14.4  

AA

    357.5  

A

    240.0  

BBB

    7.9  

Not Available

    21.3  
       
 

Total(1)

  $ 641.1  
       

        As of December 31, 2008, the distribution by third-party guarantor of the $641.1 million is presented in the following table:

Guarantor
  Amount (in millions)  

MBIA

  $ 198.4  

Ambac

    190.8  

FSA

    150.1  

FGIC

    101.8  
       
 

Total(1)

  $ 641.1  
       

144


Table of Contents

        As of December 31, 2008 and to date, the Company has had no investments in or asset positions with any of these guarantors.

        Short-term investments include securities with maturity dates equal to or less than one year from the original issue date. Our short-term investments are composed of money market funds, discounted notes and certain time deposits for foreign cash portfolios. Short-term investments are reported at cost, which approximates the fair value of these securities due to the short maturity of these investments.

        Under agreements with our cedants and in accordance with statutory requirements, we maintain fixed maturity securities in trust accounts for the benefit of reinsured companies and for the protection of policyholders, generally in states where we or our subsidiaries, as applicable, are not licensed or accredited. The carrying value of such restricted balances as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 was $1,233.4 million and $936.0 million, respectively.

        Under certain derivative contracts, the Company is required to post eligible securities as collateral, generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities. The need to post collateral under these transactions is generally based on mark-to-market valuation in excess of contractual thresholds. The fair market value of the Company's pledged securities totaled $157.7 million and $0.4 million as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

Credit Risk

        The recent credit crisis and related turmoil in the global financial system has had and may continue to have an impact on our business. On September 15, 2008, Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. filed for protection under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code in the United States Bankruptcy Court in the Southern District of New York. As of December 31, 2008, we had CDS contracts outstanding with Lehman Brothers International (Europe), a subsidiary of Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc., with future installment payments totaling $44.7 million ($38.5 million present value). We have not received payment since September 15, 2008, and are currently reviewing our rights under the CDS contracts.

        As of December 31, 2008, the present value of future installments ("PVI") of our CDS contracts with counterparties in the financial services industry is approximately $495.1 million. The largest counterparties are:

Counterparty
  PVI Amount (in millions)  

Deutsche Bank AG

  $ 144.8  

RBS/ABN AMRO

    45.2  

Barclays Capital

    44.1  

Lehman Brothers International

    38.5  

Others(1)

    222.5  
       
 

Total

  $ 495.1  
       

Market Risk

        Market risk represents the potential for losses that may result from changes in the value of a financial instrument as a result of changes in market conditions. The primary market risks that impact the value of our financial instruments are interest rate risk, basis risk, such as taxable interest rates relative to tax-exempt interest rates, and credit spread risk. Each of these risks and the specific types of financial instruments impacted are described below. Senior managers in our surveillance department

145


Table of Contents


are responsible for monitoring risk limits and applying risk measurement methodologies. The estimation of potential losses arising from adverse changes in market conditions is a key element in managing market risk. We use various systems, models and stress test scenarios to monitor and manage market risk. These models include estimates made by management that use current and historic market information. The valuation results from these models could differ materially from amounts that actually are realized in the market. See "—Critical Accounting Estimates—Valuation of Investments."

        Financial instruments that may be adversely affected by changes in interest rates consist primarily of investment securities. The primary objective in managing our investment portfolio is generation of an optimal level of after-tax investment income while preserving capital and maintaining adequate liquidity. Investment strategies are based on many factors, including our tax position, fluctuation in interest rates, regulatory and rating agency criteria and other market factors. As of January 1, 2005 we have retained BlackRock Financial Management, Inc. to manage our investment portfolio. These investment managers manage our fixed maturity investment portfolio in accordance with investment guidelines approved by our Board of Directors.

        Financial instruments that may be adversely affected by changes in credit spreads consist primarily of Assured Guaranty's outstanding credit derivative contracts. We enter into credit derivative contracts which require us to make payments upon the occurrence of certain defined credit events relating to an underlying obligation (generally a fixed income obligation). The Company's credit derivative exposures are substantially similar to its financial guaranty insurance contracts and provide for credit protection against payment default, and are generally not subject to collateral calls due to changes in market value. In general, the Company structures credit derivative transactions such that the circumstances giving rise to our obligation to make loss payments is similar to that for financial guaranty insurance policies and only occurs as losses are realized on the underlying reference obligation. Nonetheless, credit derivative transactions are governed by International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. ("ISDA") documentation and operate differently from financial guaranty insurance policies. For example, our control rights with respect to a reference obligation under a credit derivative may be more limited than when we issue a financial guaranty policy on a direct primary basis. In addition, while our exposure under credit derivatives, like our exposure under financial guaranty policies, has been generally for as long as the reference obligation remains outstanding, unlike financial guaranty insurance policies, a credit derivative may be terminated for a breach of the ISDA documentation or other specific events. In some older credit derivative transactions, one such specified event is the failure of AGC to maintain specified financial strength ratings ranging from AA- to BBB-.

        If a credit derivative is terminated we could be required to make a mark-to-market payment as determined under the ISDA documentation. For example, if AGC's rating were downgraded to A+, under market conditions at December 31, 2008, if the counterparties exercised their right to terminate their credit derivatives, AGC would have been required make payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $261 million. Further, if AGC's rating was downgraded to levels between "BBB+" and "BB+" it would have been required to make additional payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $620 million at December 31, 2008.

        Under a limited number of credit derivative contracts, the Company is required to post eligible securities as collateral, generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities. The need to post collateral under these transactions is generally based on mark-to-market valuation in excess of contractual thresholds. The particular thresholds decline if the Company ratings decline. As of December 31, 2008 the Company had pre-IPO transactions with approximately $1.9 billion of par subject to collateral posting due to changes in market value. Of this amount, as of December 31, 2008, the Company posted collateral totaling approximately $157.7 million (including $134.2 million for AGC) based on the unrealized mark-to-market loss position for transactions with two of its counterparties. Any amounts required to be posted as collateral in the future will depend on changes in the market values of these transactions. Additionally, in the event AGC were downgraded below A-, contractual

146


Table of Contents


thresholds would be eliminated and the amount of par that could be subject to collateral posting requirements would be $2.4 billion. Based on market values as of December 31, 2008, such a downgrade would have resulted in AGC posting an additional $88.7 million of collateral. Currently no additional collateral posting is required or anticipated for any other transactions.

        Unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives are a function of changes in the estimated fair value of our credit derivative contracts. If credit spreads of the underlying obligations change, the fair value of the related credit derivative changes. Market liquidity could also impact valuations of the underlying obligations. As such, Assured Guaranty experiences mark-to-market gains or losses. We consider the impact of our own credit risk, in collaboration with credit spreads on risk that we assume through CDS contracts, in determining the fair value of our credit derivatives. We determine our own credit risk based on quoted CDS prices traded on the Company at each balance sheet date. The quoted price of CDS contracts traded on AGC at December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 was 1,775 basis points and 180 basis points, respectively. The price of CDS traded on the Company generally moves directionally the same as general market spreads. A widening of the CDS prices traded on the Company has an effect of offsetting unrealized losses that result from widening general market credit spreads. Thus, as the Company's credit spreads widen, the value of our CDS decreases. Conversely, as our own credit spread narrows, the value of our unrealized losses widens. However, an overall narrowing of spreads generally results in an unrealized gain on credit derivatives for us and a widening of spreads generally results in an unrealized loss for us.

        The impact of changes in credit spreads will vary based upon the volume, tenor, interest rates, and other market conditions at the time these fair values are determined. In addition, since each transaction has unique collateral and structure terms, the underlying change in fair value of each transaction may vary considerably. The fair value of credit derivatives also reflects the change in our own credit cost based on the price to purchase credit protection on AGC. During the year ended December 31, 2008, we incurred net pre-tax unrealized gains on credit derivative contracts of $38.0 million. The 2008 gain includes a gain of $4,147.6 million associated with the change in AGC's credit spread, which widened substantially from 180 basis points at December 31, 2007 to 1,775 basis points at December 31, 2008. Management believes that the widening of AGC's credit spread is due to the correlation between AGC's risk profile and that experienced currently by the broader financial markets. Offsetting the gain attributable to the significant increase in AGC's credit spread were declines in fixed income security market prices primarily attributable to widening spreads in certain markets as a result of the continued deterioration in credit markets and some credit rating downgrades, rather than from delinquencies or defaults on securities guaranteed by the Company. The higher credit spreads in the fixed income security market are due to the recent lack of liquidity in the high yield collateralized debt obligation and collateralized loan obligation markets as well as continuing market concerns over the most recent vintages of subprime residential mortgage backed securities.

        The total notional amount of credit derivative exposure outstanding as of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 and included in our financial guaranty exposure was $75.1 billion and $71.6 billion, respectively.

        We generally hold these credit derivative contracts to maturity. The unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives will reduce to zero as the exposure approaches its maturity date, unless there is a payment default on the exposure.

147


Table of Contents

        The following table summarizes the estimated change in fair values on the net balance of Assured Guaranty's credit derivative positions assuming immediate parallel shifts in credit spreads at December 31, 2008:

        (Dollars in millions)

Credit Spreads(1)
  Estimated Net Fair Value (Pre-Tax)   Estimated Pre-Tax Change in Gain/(Loss)  

December 31, 2008:

             

100% widening in spreads

  $ (1,538.3 ) $ (999.1 )

50% widening in spreads

    (1,044.0 )   (504.8 )

25% widening in spreads

    (793.5 )   (254.3 )

10% widening in spreads

    (642.2 )   (103.0 )

Base Scenario

    (539.2 )    

10% narrowing in spreads

    (454.4 )   84.8  

25% narrowing in spreads

    (326.7 )   212.5  

50% narrowing in spreads

    (118.4 )   420.8  

        See Item 7A, "Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk" for more information.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

        In September 2006, the FASB issued FAS No. 157, "Fair Value Measurement" ("FAS 157"). FAS 157 defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. FAS 157 applies to other accounting pronouncements that require or permit fair value measurements, since the FASB had previously concluded in those accounting pronouncements that fair value is the relevant measure. Accordingly, FAS 157 does not require any new fair value measurements. FAS 157 is effective for the measurement of financial assets and liabilities in financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, and interim periods within those fiscal years. FASB Staff Position ("FSP") No. 157-2 extended the effective date of FAS 157 for non-financial assets and liabilities for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008. We adopted FAS 157 for financial assets and liabilities effective January 1, 2008 and will adopt FAS 157 for non-financial assets and liabilities effective January 1, 2009. FAS 157 did not have a material impact on our results of operations or financial position.

        In February 2007, the FASB issued FAS No. 159, "The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Liabilities" ("FAS 159"). FAS 159 allows entities to voluntarily choose, at specified election dates, to measure many financial assets and financial liabilities (as well as certain nonfinancial instruments that are similar to financial instruments) at fair value (the "fair value option"). The election is made on an instrument-by-instrument basis and is irrevocable. If the fair value option is elected for an instrument, FAS 159 specifies that all subsequent changes in fair value for that instrument shall be reported in the Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income. FAS 159 is effective as of the beginning of an entity's first fiscal year that begins after November 15, 2007. We adopted FAS 159 effective January 1, 2008. We did not apply the fair value option to any eligible items on our adoption date.

        In April 2007, the FASB Staff issued FASB Staff Position No. FIN 39-1, "Amendment of FASB Interpretation No. 39" ("FSP FIN 39-1"), which permits companies to offset cash collateral receivables or payables with net derivative positions under certain circumstances. FSP FIN 39-1 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, with early adoption permitted. FSP FIN 39-1 did not affect the Company's results of operations or financial position.

148


Table of Contents

        In December 2007, the FASB issued FAS No. 141 (revised), "Business Combinations" ("FAS 141R"). FAS 141R establishes principles and requirements for how the acquirer of a business recognizes and measures in its financial statements the identifiable assets acquired, the liabilities assumed, and any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree. FAS 141R also provides guidance for recognizing and measuring the goodwill acquired in the business combination and determines what information to disclose to enable users of the financial statement to evaluate the nature and financial effects of the business combination. FAS 141R is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and interim statements within those fiscal years. Early adoption is not permitted. Since FAS 141R applies prospectively to business combinations whose acquisition date is subsequent to the statement's adoption. The Company plans to apply the provisions of FAS 141R to account for its pending acquisition of FSAH. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had paid $2.7 million of expenses related to the Company's pending acquisition of FSAH that the Company plans to expense in the first quarter 2009.

        In December 2007, the FASB issued FAS No. 160, "Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements—an amendment of ARB No. 51" ("FAS 160"). FAS 160 establishes accounting and reporting standards for the noncontrolling interest in a subsidiary for the deconsolidation of a subsidiary. FAS 160 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and interim statements within those fiscal years. The Company is currently evaluating the impact, if any, FAS 160 will have on its consolidated financial statements.

        In March 2008, the FASB issued FAS No. 161, "Disclosures About Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities—An Amendment of FASB Statement No. 133" ("FAS 161"). FAS 161 establishes the disclosure requirements for derivative instruments and for hedging activities. FAS 161 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after November 15, 2008. Early application is encouraged. FAS 161 did not have an impact on the Company's current results of operations or financial position.

        In May 2008, the FASB issued FAS 163. FAS 163 requires that an insurance enterprise recognize a claim liability prior to an event of default (insured event) when there is evidence that credit deterioration has occurred in an insured financial obligation. FAS 163 also clarifies the methodology to be used for financial guaranty premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement, as well as requiring expanded disclosures about the insurance enterprise's risk management activities. The provisions of FAS 163 related to premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement are effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and all interim periods within those fiscal years. Earlier application of these provisions is not permitted. The expanded risk management activity disclosure provisions of FAS 163 were effective for the third quarter of 2008 and are included in Note 11 "Significant Risk Management Activities" to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of this Form 10-K. FAS 163 will be applied to all existing and future financial guaranty insurance contracts written by the Company. The cumulative effect of initially applying FAS 163 will be recorded as an adjustment to retained earnings as of January 1, 2009. The adoption of FAS 163 is expected to have a material effect on the Company's financial statements. The Company is in the process of estimating the impact of its adoption of FAS 163. The Company will continue to follow its existing accounting policies in regards to premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement until it completes its first quarter 2009 financial statements.

        In June 2008, the FASB issued FSP EITF 03-6-1, "Participating Securities and the Two-Class Method under FASB Statement No. 128" ("FSP"). The FSP addresses whether instruments granted in share-based payment transactions are participating securities prior to vesting and therefore need to be included in the earnings allocation in calculating earnings per share ("EPS") under the two-class method described in FAS No. 128, "Earnings per Share." The FSP requires companies to treat unvested share-based payment awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividend or dividend equivalents as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. The FSP is effective for

149


Table of Contents


fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008; earlier application is not permitted. This FSP also requires that all prior period EPS data be adjusted retrospectively. The Company does not expect adoption of the FSP to have a material effect on its results of operations or earnings per share.

        In October 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position No. 157-3, "Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset Is Not Active" ("FSP 157-3"). FSP 157-3 clarified the application of FAS 157, "Fair Value Measurements", in a market that is not active. FSP 157-3 was effective when issued. It did not have an impact on the Company's current results of operations or financial position.

        The FASB adopted FSP FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4, "Disclosures About Credit Derivatives and Certain Guarantees" and FAS 161, "Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" to address concerns that current derivative disclosure requirements did not adequately address the potential adverse effects that these instruments can have on the financial performance and operations of an entity. Companies will be required to provide enhanced disclosures about their derivative activities to enable users to better understand: (1) how and why a company uses derivatives, (2) how it accounts for derivatives and related hedged items, and (3) how derivatives affect its financial statements. These should include the terms of the derivatives, collateral posting requirements and triggers, and other significant provisions that could be detrimental to earnings or liquidity. Disclosures specific to credit derivatives must be included in the December 31, 2008 financial statements. Certain other derivative and hedging disclosures must be included in the Company's March 31, 2009 Form 10-Q. Management believes that the Company's current derivatives disclosures are in compliance with the items required by FSP 133-1 and FAS 161.

        In December 2008, the FASB adopted FSP FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8, "Disclosures by Public Entities (Enterprises) about Transfers of Financial Assets and Interests in Variable Interest Entities" to require public entities to provide, among other things, additional disclosures about transfers of financial assets and their involvement with variable interest entities. FSP FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8 was effective when issues. It did not have an impact on the Company's current results of operations or financial position.

ITEM 7A.    QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

        Information concerning quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk appears in Part II, Item 7, "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" under the headings "—Critical Accounting Estimates—Valuation of Investments" and "Market Risk."

150


Table of Contents

ITEM 8.    FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA


INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.

 
  Page

Management's Responsibility for Financial Statements and Internal Controls Over Financial Reporting

  152

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  153

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2008 and 2007

  154

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

  155

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders' Equity for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

  156

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

  157

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

  158

151


Table of Contents


Management's Responsibility for Financial Statements and Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

Financial Statements

        The consolidated financial statements of Assured Guaranty Ltd. were prepared by management, who are responsible for their reliability and objectivity. The statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and, as such, include amounts based on informed estimates and judgments of management. Financial information elsewhere in this annual report is consistent with that in the consolidated financial statements.

        The Board of Directors, operating through its Audit Committee, which is composed entirely of directors who are not officers or employees of the Company, provides oversight of the financial reporting process and safeguarding of assets against unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition. The Audit Committee annually recommends the appointment of an independent registered public accounting firm and submits its recommendation to the Board of Directors for approval.

        The Audit Committee meets with management, the independent registered public accounting firm and the outside firm engaged to perform internal audit functions for the Company; approves the overall scope of audit work and related fee arrangements; and reviews audit reports and findings. In addition, the independent registered public accounting firm and the outside firm engaged to perform internal audit functions for the Company meet separately with the Audit Committee, without management representatives present, to discuss the results of their audits; the adequacy of the Company's internal control; the quality of its financial reporting; and the safeguarding of assets against unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition.

        The consolidated financial statements have been audited by an independent registered public accounting firm, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, who were given unrestricted access to all financial records and related data, including minutes of all meetings of the Board of Directors and committees of the Board. The Company believes that all representations made to our independent registered public accounting firm during their audits were valid and appropriate.

Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

        The management of Assured Guaranty Ltd. is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of our consolidated financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

        As of December 31, 2008, management has evaluated the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on the criteria established in "Internal Control—Integrated Framework," issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on this evaluation, we have concluded that Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2007.

        The effectiveness of the Company's internal controls over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008 has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report included in this Item under the heading "Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm."

  /s/ DOMINIC J. FREDERICO

Dominic J. Frederico
President and Chief Executive Officer
  /s/ ROBERT B. MILLS

Robert B. Mills
Chief Financial Officer

152


Table of Contents


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Assured Guaranty Ltd.:

        In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, of shareholders' equity and of cash flows, present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Assured Guaranty Ltd. and its subsidiaries (the "Company") at December 31, 2008 and 2007, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2008 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2008, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company's management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management's Responsibility for Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 8. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

        A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

        Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
New York, New York
February 25, 2009

153


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands of U.S. dollars except per share and share amounts)

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007  

Assets

             

Fixed maturity securities, at fair value (amortized cost: $3,162,308 in 2008 and $2,526,889 in 2007)

  $ 3,154,137   $ 2,586,954  

Short-term investments, at cost which approximates fair value

    477,197     552,938  
           
 

Total investments

    3,631,334     3,139,892  

Cash and cash equivalents

    12,305     8,048  

Accrued investment income

    32,846     26,503  

Deferred acquisition costs

    288,616     259,298  

Prepaid reinsurance premiums

    18,856     13,530  

Reinsurance recoverable on ceded losses

    6,528     8,849  

Premiums receivable

    15,743     27,802  

Goodwill

    85,417     85,417  

Credit derivative assets

    146,959     5,474  

Deferred income taxes

    129,118     147,563  

Current income taxes receivable

    21,427      

Salvage recoverable

    80,207     8,540  

Committed capital securities, at fair value

    51,062     8,316  

Other assets

    35,289     23,702  
           
 

Total assets

  $ 4,555,707   $ 3,762,934  
           

Liabilities and shareholders' equity

             

Liabilities

             

Unearned premium reserves

  $ 1,233,714   $ 887,171  

Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses

    196,798     125,550  

Profit commissions payable

    8,584     22,332  

Reinsurance balances payable

    17,957     3,276  

Current income taxes payable

        635  

Funds held by Company under reinsurance contracts

    30,683     25,354  

Credit derivative liabilities

    733,766     623,118  

Senior Notes

    197,443     197,408  

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

    149,767     149,738  

Other liabilities

    60,773     61,782  
           
 

Total liabilities

    2,629,485     2,096,364  
           

Commitments and contingencies

             

Shareholders' equity

             

Common stock ($0.01 par value, 500,000,000 shares authorized; 90,955,703 and 79,948,979 shares issued and outstanding in 2008 and 2007)

    910     799  

Additional paid-in capital

    1,284,370     1,023,886  

Retained earnings

    638,055     585,256  

Accumulated other comprehensive income

    2,887     56,629  
           
 

Total shareholders' equity

    1,926,222     1,666,570  
           
 

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 4,555,707   $ 3,762,934  
           

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

154


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income

(in thousands of U.S. dollars except per share amounts)

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  

Revenues

                   

Gross written premiums

  $ 618,270   $ 424,546   $ 261,272  

Ceded premiums

    (13,714 )   (16,576 )   (5,452 )
               

Net written premiums

    604,556     407,970     255,820  

Increase in net unearned premium reserves

    (343,158 )   (248,711 )   (111,017 )
               
 

Net earned premiums

    261,398     159,259     144,803  

Net investment income

    162,558     128,092     111,455  

Net realized investment losses

    (69,801 )   (1,344 )   (1,994 )

Change in fair value of credit derivatives

                   

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

    117,589     73,992     73,861  

Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives

    38,034     (670,403 )   11,827  
               
   

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

    155,623     (596,411 )   85,688  

Other income

    43,410     8,801     419  
               
 

Total revenues

    553,188     (301,603 )   340,371  
               

Expenses

                   

Loss and loss adjustment expenses

    265,762     5,778     11,323  

Profit commission expense

    1,336     6,476     9,528  

Acquisition costs

    61,249     43,150     45,208  

Other operating expenses

    83,493     79,866     68,019  

Interest expense

    23,283     23,529     13,772  

Other expense

    5,734     2,623     2,547  
               
 

Total expenses

    440,857     161,422     150,397  
               

Income before provision (benefit) for income taxes

    112,331     (463,025 )   189,974  

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

                   

Current

    332     12,383     18,644  

Deferred

    43,116     (172,136 )   11,596  
               

Total provision (benefit) for income taxes

    43,448     (159,753 )   30,240  
               
 

Net income (loss)

    68,883     (303,272 )   159,734  
               

Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of taxes

                   

Unrealized holding (losses) gains on fixed maturity securities arising during the year

    (109,408 )   13,638     (7,533 )

Reclassification adjustment for realized losses included in net income (loss)

    62,695     1,327     1,458  
               

Change in net unrealized (losses) gains on fixed maturity securities

    (46,713 )   14,965     (6,075 )

Change in cumulative translation adjustment

    (6,611 )   199     2,544  

Change in cash flow hedge

    (418 )   (418 )   (418 )
               
 

Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of taxes

    (53,742 )   14,746     (3,949 )
               
 

Comprehensive income (loss)

  $ 15,141   $ (288,526 ) $ 155,785  
               

Earnings (loss) per share:

                   
 

Basic

  $ 0.78   $ (4.46 ) $ 2.18  
 

Diluted

  $ 0.77   $ (4.46 ) $ 2.15  

Dividends per share

  $ 0.18   $ 0.16   $ 0.14  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

155


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders' Equity

For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

(in thousands of U.S. dollars)

 
  Common
Stock
  Additional
Paid-in
Capital
  Unearned
Stock Grant
Compensation
  Retained
Earnings
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income
  Total
Shareholders'
Equity
 

Balance, December 31, 2005

  $ 748   $ 881,998   $ (14,756 ) $ 747,691   $ 45,832   $ 1,661,513  

Net income

                159,734         159,734  

Dividends ($0.14 per share)

                (10,478 )       (10,478 )

Common stock repurchases

    (65 )   (170,998 )               (171,063 )

Shares cancelled to pay withholding taxes

    (1 )   (2,914 )               (2,915 )

Stock options exercises

    1     2,544                 2,545  

Tax benefit for stock options exercised

        170                 170  

Shares issued under Employee Stock Purchase Plan

        501                 501  

Reclassification due to adoption of FAS 123R

    (10 )   (14,746 )   14,756              

Share-based compensation and other

    2     14,701                 14,703  

Change in cash flow hedge, net of tax of $(225)

                    (418 )   (418 )

Change in cumulative translation adjustment

                    2,544     2,544  

Unrealized loss on fixed maturity securities, net of tax of $(861)

                    (6,075 )   (6,075 )
                           

Balance, December 31, 2006

  $ 675   $ 711,256   $   $ 896,947   $ 41,883   $ 1,650,761  

Cumulative effect of FIN 48 adoption

                2,629         2,629  

Net loss

                (303,272 )       (303,272 )

Dividends ($0.16 per share)

                (11,048 )       (11,048 )

Common stock issuance, net of offering costs

    125     303,696                 303,821  

Common stock repurchases

    (4 )   (9,345 )               (9,349 )

Shares cancelled to pay withholding taxes

    (2 )   (4,086 )               (4,088 )

Stock options exercises

    1     1,501                 1,502  

Tax benefit for stock options exercised

        183                 183  

Shares issued under Employee Stock Purchase Plan

        627                 627  

Share-based compensation and other

    4     20,054                 20,058  

Change in cash flow hedge, net of tax of $(225)

                    (418 )   (418 )

Change in cumulative translation adjustment

                    199     199  

Unrealized gain on fixed maturity securities, net of tax of $402

                    14,965     14,965  
                           

Balance, December 31, 2007

  $ 799   $ 1,023,886   $   $ 585,256   $ 56,629   $ 1,666,570  

Net income

                68,883         68,883  

Dividends ($0.18 per share)

                (16,015 )       (16,015 )

Dividends on restricted stock units

        69         (69 )        

Common stock issuance, net of offering costs

    107     248,948                 249,055  

Shares cancelled to pay withholding taxes

    (2 )   (4,449 )               (4,451 )

Stock options exercises

        342                 342  

Tax benefit for stock options exercised

        16                 16  

Shares issued under Employee Stock Purchase Plan

        425                 425  

Share-based compensation and other

    6     15,133                 15,139  

Change in cash flow hedge, net of tax of $(225)

                    (418 )   (418 )

Change in cumulative translation adjustment

                    (6,611 )   (6,611 )

Unrealized loss on fixed maturity securities, net of tax of $(21,523)

                    (46,713 )   (46,713 )
                           

Balance, December 31, 2008

  $ 910   $ 1,284,370   $   $ 638,055   $ 2,887   $ 1,926,222  
                           

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

156


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(in thousands of U.S. dollars)

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  

Operating activities

                   

Net income (loss)

  $ 68,883   $ (303,272 ) $ 159,734  

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash flows provided by operating activities:

                   
 

Non-cash interest and operating expenses

    16,328     21,354     15,455  
 

Net amortization of premium on fixed maturity securities

    2,397     2,649     6,075  
 

Provision (benefit) for deferred income taxes

    43,116     (172,136 )   11,596  
 

Net realized investment losses

    69,801     1,344     1,994  
 

Unrealized (gains) losses on credit derivatives

    (38,034 )   670,403     (11,827 )
 

Fair value gain on committed capital securities

    (42,746 )   (8,316 )    
 

Change in deferred acquisition costs

    (29,318 )   (42,269 )   (23,587 )
 

Change in accrued investment income

    (6,343 )   (2,308 )   (1,519 )
 

Change in premiums receivable

    12,059     (5,029 )   (5,961 )
 

Change in prepaid reinsurance premiums

    (5,326 )   (8,994 )   4,937  
 

Change in unearned premium reserves

    346,543     257,705     106,387  
 

Change in reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses, net

    16,583     8,391     379  
 

Change in profit commissions payable

    (13,748 )   (13,662 )   (16,999 )
 

Change in funds held by Company under reinsurance contracts

    5,329     3,942     2,226  
 

Change in current income taxes

    (22,046 )   (6,346 )   10,371  
 

Tax benefit for stock options exercised

    (16 )   (183 )   (170 )
 

Other changes in credit derivatives assets and liabilities, net

    7,197     (6,744 )   1,405  
 

Other

    (3,670 )   (10,679 )   1,078  
               

Net cash flows provided by operating activities

    426,989     385,850     261,574  
               

Investing activities

                   
 

Fixed maturity securities:

                   
   

Purchases

    (1,272,024 )   (1,054,591 )   (883,221 )
   

Sales

    532,144     786,590     656,958  
   

Maturities

    11,730     24,724     16,495  
 

Sales (purchases) of short-term investments, net

    78,535     (421,112 )   (18,693 )
               

Net cash flows used in investing activities

    (649,615 )   (664,389 )   (228,461 )
               

Financing activities

                   
 

Net proceeds from common stock issuance

    248,967     304,016      
 

Repurchases of common stock

        (9,349 )   (171,063 )
 

Dividends paid

    (16,015 )   (11,032 )   (10,458 )
 

Proceeds from employee stock purchase plan

    425     627     501  
 

Share activity under option and incentive plans

    (4,057 )   (2,584 )   (424 )
 

Tax benefit for stock options exercised

    16     183     170  
 

Net proceeds from issuance of Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

            149,708  
 

Debt issue costs

        (425 )   (1,500 )
 

Repayment of notes assumed during formation transactions

            (2,000 )
               

Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities

    229,336     281,436     (35,066 )

Effect of exchange rate changes

    (2,453 )   366     548  
               

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    4,257     3,263     (1,405 )

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

    8,048     4,785     6,190  
               

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

  $ 12,305   $ 8,048   $ 4,785  
               

Supplemental cash flow information

                   

Cash paid during the year for:

                   
 

Income taxes

  $ 18,743   $ 28,917   $ 9,386  
 

Interest

  $ 23,600   $ 23,677   $ 14,081  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

157


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

1. Business and Organization

        On April 28, 2004, subsidiaries of ACE Limited ("ACE"), completed an initial public offering ("IPO") of 49,000,000 of their 75,000,000 common shares, par value $0.01 per share, of Assured Guaranty Ltd. (the "Company"), formerly AGC Holdings Ltd. Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s common shares are traded on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol "AGO". The IPO raised approximately $840.1 million in net proceeds, all of which went to the selling shareholders.

        On December 20, 2006, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., a subsidiary of the Company, completed the issuance of $150.0 million Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures and used the proceeds to repurchase 5,692,599 of the Company's common shares from a subsidiary of ACE. As of December 31, 2008 ACE owns approximately 21% of the Company's outstanding common shares.

        On December 21, 2007, the Company completed the sale of 12,483,960 of its common shares at a price of $25.50 per share. The net proceeds of the sale totaled approximately $303.8 million. The Company has contributed the net proceeds of the offering to its reinsurance subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. ("AG Re"). AG Re has used the proceeds to provide capital support in the form of a reinsurance portfolio transaction with Ambac Assurance Corp. for approximately $29 billion of net par outstanding, as well as to support the growth of Assured Guaranty Corp. ("AGC"), the Company's direct financial guaranty subsidiary, by providing reinsurance. AG Re is AGC's principal financial guaranty reinsurer.

        Assured Guaranty Ltd. is a Bermuda based holding company which provides, through its operating subsidiaries, credit enhancement products to the public finance, structured finance and mortgage markets. Credit enhancement products are financial guarantees or other types of support, including credit derivatives, that improve the credit of underlying debt obligations. The Company issues policies in both financial guaranty and credit derivative form. Assured Guaranty Ltd. applies its credit expertise, risk management skills and capital markets experience to develop insurance, reinsurance and derivative products that meet the credit enhancement needs of its customers. Under a reinsurance agreement, the reinsurer, in consideration of a premium paid to it, agrees to indemnify another insurer, called the ceding company, for part or all of the liability of the ceding company under one or more insurance policies that the ceding company has issued. A derivative is a financial instrument whose characteristics and value depend upon the characteristics and value of an underlying security. Assured Guaranty Ltd. markets its products directly to and through financial institutions, serving the U.S. and international markets. Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s financial results include four principal business segments: financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty reinsurance, mortgage guaranty and other. These segments are further discussed in Note 23.

        Financial guaranty insurance provides an unconditional and irrevocable guaranty that protects the holder of a financial obligation against non-payment of principal and interest when due. Financial guaranty insurance may be issued to the holders of the insured obligations at the time of issuance of those obligations, or may be issued in the secondary market to holders of public bonds and structured securities. A loss event occurs upon existing or anticipated credit deterioration, while a payment under a policy occurs when the insured obligation defaults. This requires the Company to pay the required principal and interest when due in accordance with the underlying contract. The principal types of obligations covered by the Company's financial guaranty direct and financial guaranty assumed reinsurance businesses are structured finance obligations and public finance obligations. Because both businesses involve similar risks, the Company analyzes and monitors its financial guaranty direct

158


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

1. Business and Organization (Continued)


portfolio and financial guaranty assumed reinsurance portfolio on a unified process and procedure basis.

        Mortgage guaranty insurance is a specialized class of credit insurance that provides protection to mortgage lending institutions against the default of borrowers on mortgage loans that, at the time of the advance, had a loan to value in excess of a specified ratio. Reinsurance in the mortgage guaranty insurance industry is used to increase the insurance capacity of the ceding company, to assist the ceding company in meeting applicable regulatory and rating agency requirements, to augment the financial strength of the ceding company, and to manage the ceding company's risk profile. The Company provides mortgage guaranty protection on an excess of loss basis.

        The Company has participated in several lines of business that are reflected in its historical financial statements but that the Company exited in connection with its 2004 initial public offering ("IPO"). The results from these lines of business make up the Company's Other segment discussed in Note 23.

        On April 8, 2008, investment funds managed by WL Ross & Co. LLC ("WL Ross") purchased 10,651,896 shares of the Company's common equity at a price of $23.47 per share, resulting in proceeds to the Company of $250.0 million. The Company contributed $150.0 million of these proceeds to its Bermuda domiciled reinsurance subsidiary, AG Re. In addition, the Company contributed $100.0 million of these proceeds to its subsidiary, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., which in turn contributed the same amount to its Maryland domiciled insurance subsidiary, AGC. The commitment to purchase these shares was previously announced on February 29, 2008. In addition, Wilbur L. Ross, Jr., President and Chief Executive Officer of WL Ross, was appointed to the Board of Directors of the Company to serve a term expiring at the Company's 2009 annual general meeting of shareholders. Mr. Ross's appointment became effective immediately following the Company's 2008 annual general meeting of shareholders, which was held on May 8, 2008. WL Ross has a remaining commitment through April 8, 2009 to purchase up to $750.0 million of the Company's common equity, at the Company's option, subject to the terms and conditions of the investment agreement with the Company dated February 28, 2008. In accordance with the investment agreement, the Company may exercise this option in one or more drawdowns, subject to a minimum drawdown of $50 million, provided that the purchase price per common share for the subsequent shares is not greater than $27.57 or less than $19.37. The Company must also be rated triple-A (Stable) by Moody's, Standard & Poor's and Fitch to drawdown on the commitment. The purchase price per common share for such shares will be equal to 97% of the volume weighted average price of a common share on the NYSE for the 15 NYSE trading days prior to the applicable drawdown notice. As of December 31, 2008, and as of the date of this filing, the purchase price per common share is outside of this range and therefore the Company may not, at this time, exercise its option for WL Ross to purchase additional shares.

        On September 16, 2008, the Company agreed to waive the standstill provisions of the investment agreement to permit investment funds managed by WL Ross (the "WLR Funds") to purchase up to 5,000,000 additional common shares of the Company in open market transactions from time to time. The timing and amount of any such purchases are in the sole discretion of WL Ross and they are not obligated to purchase any such shares. The additional shares purchased by the WLR Funds, if any, will be purchased from current shareholders and therefore will not result in an increase in shareholders' equity at the Company or its subsidiaries. If all 5,000,000 additional shares were purchased, the WLR

159


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

1. Business and Organization (Continued)


Funds would beneficially own 17,166,396 shares or approximately 18.9% of the Company's outstanding common shares based on shares outstanding as of December 31, 2008. As of the date of this filing, the Company has not been notified that WLR Funds purchased any additional shares of the Company.

        The Company's subsidiaries have been assigned the following insurance financial strength ratings:

 
  Moody's   S&P   Fitch

Assured Guaranty Corp. 

  Aa2(Excellent)   AAA(Extremely Strong)   AAA(Extremely Strong)

Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. 

  Aa3(Excellent)   AA(Very Strong)   AA(Very Strong)

Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. 

  Aa3(Excellent)   AA(Very Strong)   AA(Very Strong)

Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company

  Aa3(Excellent)   AA(Very Strong)   AA(Very Strong)

Assured Guaranty (UK) Ltd. 

  Aa2(Excellent)   AAA(Extremely Strong)   AAA(Extremely Strong)

        On November 21, 2008, Moody's downgraded the insurance financial strength ratings of AGC and its wholly owned subsidiary, AGUK, to Aa2 from Aaa and also downgraded the insurance financial strength ratings of AG Re and its affiliated insurance operating companies to Aa3 from Aa2. In the same rating action, Moody's downgraded the senior unsecured rating of AGUS and the issuer rating of the ultimate holding company, Assured Guaranty Ltd to A2 from Aa3. Commensurate with these downgrades, Moody's also announced that its ratings outlook for all of Assured's ratings was "stable." As of the date of this filing, the Company's rating outlook is categorized as stable from Moody's, Standard & Poor's Rating Service, a division of McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. ("S&P") and Fitch Ratings ("Fitch").

Acquisition of Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd.

        On November 14, 2008, Assured Guaranty Ltd. announced that it had entered into a definitive agreement ("the Purchase Agreement") with Dexia Holdings, Inc. ("Dexia") to purchase Financial Security Assurance Holdings Ltd. ("FSAH") and, indirectly, all of its subsidiaries, including the financial guaranty insurance company, Financial Security Assurance, Inc. The definitive agreement provides that the Company will be indemnified against exposure to FSAH's Financial Products segment, which includes its guaranteed investment contract business. Pursuant to the Purchase Agreement, the Company agreed to buy 33,296,733 issued and outstanding shares of common stock of FSAH, representing as of the date thereof approximately 99.8524% of the issued and outstanding shares of common stock of FSAH. The remaining shares of FSAH are currently held by current or former directors of FSAH. Assured expects that it will acquire the remaining shares of FSAH common stock concurrent with the closing of the acquisition of shares of FSAH common stock from Dexia or shortly thereafter at the same price paid to Dexia. The closing of this transaction is expected to occur in either the first or second quarter of 2009.

        The purchase price is $722 million (based upon the closing price of the Company's common shares on the NYSE on November 13, 2008 of $8.10), consisting of $361 million in cash and up to 44,567,901 of the Company's common shares. Under the Purchase Agreement, the Company may elect to pay $8.10 per share in cash in lieu of up to 22,283,951 of the Company's common shares that it would otherwise deliver as part of the purchase price.

        The Company expects to finance the cash portion of the acquisition with the proceeds of a public equity offering. The Company has received a backstop commitment ("the WLR Backstop

160


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

1. Business and Organization (Continued)

Commitment") from the WLR Funds, a related party, to fund the cash portion of the purchase price with the purchase of newly issued common shares. The Company entered into the WLR Backstop Commitment on November 13, 2008 with the WLR Funds. The WLR Backstop Commitment amended the Investment Agreement between the Company and the WLR Funds and provided to the Company the option to cause the WLR Funds to purchase from Assured Guaranty Ltd. or Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. a number of the Company's common shares equal to the quotient of (i) the aggregate dollar amount not to exceed $361 million specified by the Company divided by (ii) the volume weighted average price of the Company's common share on the NYSE for the 20 NYSE trading days ending with the last NYSE trading day immediately preceding the date of the closing under the stock purchase agreement, with a floor of $6.00 and a cap of $8.50. Should the Company cause WLR Funds to purchase the Company's common shares at the floor amount of $6.00, WLR Funds would own approximately 39% of the Company's common shares.

        The WLR Funds have no obligation to purchase these common shares pursuant to the WLR Backstop Commitment until the closing under the stock purchase agreement occurs. The Company may use the proceeds from the sale of the Company's common shares pursuant to the WLR Backstop Commitment solely to pay a portion of the purchase price under the stock purchase agreement. The WLR Funds' obligations under the WLR Backstop Commitment have been secured by letters of credit issued for the benefit of the Company by Bank of America, N.A. and RBS Citizens Bank, N.A., each in the amount of $180.5 million.

        The Company has paid the WLR Funds a nonrefundable commitment fee of $10,830,000 in connection with the option granted by the WLR Backstop Commitment and has agreed to pay the WLR Funds' expenses in connection with the transactions contemplated thereby. The Company has agreed to reimburse the WLR Funds for the $4.1 million cost of obtaining the letters of credit referred to above.

2. Significant Accounting Policies

Basis of Presentation

        The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("GAAP"), which requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. (See Notes 4 and 11 for discussion of significant estimates of derivatives and losses.)

        The volatility and disruption in the global financial markets have reached unprecedented levels. The availability and cost of credit has been materially affected. These factors, combined with volatile oil prices, depressed home prices and increasing foreclosures, falling equity market values, declining business and consumer confidence and the risks of increased inflation and unemployment, have precipitated an economic slowdown and fears of a severe recession. These conditions may adversely affect our profitability, financial position, investment portfolio, cash flow, statutory capital, financial strength ratings and stock price. Additionally, future legislative, regulatory or judicial changes in the

161


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


jurisdictions regulating our Company may adversely affect our ability to pursue our current mix of business, materially impacting our financial results.

        All intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated.

Reclassifications

        Certain prior year items have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

        Effective with the quarter ended March 31, 2008, the Company reclassified the revenues, expenses and balance sheet items associated with financial guaranty contracts that the Company's financial guaranty subsidiaries write in the form of credit default swap ("CDS") contracts. The reclassification does not change the Company's net income (loss) or shareholders' equity. This reclassification is being adopted by the Company after agreement with member companies of the Association of Financial Guaranty Insurers in consultation with the staffs of the Office of the Chief Accountant and the Division of Corporate Finance of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The reclassification is being implemented in order to increase comparability of the Company's financial statements with other financial guaranty companies that have CDS contracts.

        In general, the Company structures credit derivative transactions such that circumstances giving rise to our obligation to make payments is similar to that for financial guaranty policies and generally occurs as losses are realized on the underlying reference obligation. Nonetheless, credit derivative transactions are governed by International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. ("ISDA") documentation and operates differently from financial guaranty insurance policies. Under GAAP CDS contracts are subject to derivative accounting rules and financial guaranty policies are subject to insurance accounting rules.

        In the accompanying consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, the Company has reclassified previously reported CDS revenues from "net earned premiums" to "realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives." Loss and loss adjustment expenses and recoveries that were previously included in "loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)" have been reclassified to "realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives," as well. Portfolio and case loss and loss adjustment expenses have been reclassified from "loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)" and are included in "unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives," which previously included only unrealized mark to market gains or losses on the Company's contracts written in CDS form. In the consolidated balance sheet, the Company reclassified all CDS-related balances previously included in "unearned premium reserves," "reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses," "prepaid reinsurance premiums," "premiums receivable" and "reinsurance balances payable" to either "credit derivative liabilities" or "credit derivative assets," depending on the net position of the CDS contract at each balance sheet date.

162


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        The effects of these reclassifications on the Company's consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2007 and related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income and cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006 are as follows (dollars in thousands):

 
  As of December 31, 2007  
 
  As previously reported   As reclassified  

ASSETS:

             

Prepaid reinsurance premiums

  $ 17,049   $ 13,530  

Premiums receivable

    57,914     27,802  

Unrealized gains on derivative financial instruments(1)

    17,584      

Credit derivative assets

        5,474  

Committed capital securities, at fair value(1)

        8,316  

Total assets

    3,800,359     3,762,934  

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY:

             

Unearned premium reserves

  $ 908,349   $ 887,171  

Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses

    133,845     125,550  

Reinsurance balances payable

    4,136     3,276  

Unrealized losses on derivative financial instruments

    630,210      

Credit derivative liabilities

        623,118  

Total liabilities

    2,133,789     2,096,364  

Total shareholders' equity

    1,666,570     1,666,570  

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

    3,800,359     3,762,934  

163


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 
  Year Ended December 31, 2007   Year Ended December 31, 2006  
 
  As previously
reported
  As reclassified   As previously
reported
  As reclassified  

Gross written premiums

  $ 505,899   $ 424,546   $ 325,670   $ 261,272  

Ceded premiums

    (19,615 )   (16,576 )   (6,998 )   (5,452 )

Net written premiums

    486,284     407,970     318,672     255,820  

Increase in net unearned premium reserves

    (254,304 )   (248,711 )   (112,018 )   (111,017 )

Net earned premiums

    231,980     159,259     206,654     144,803  

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

        73,992         73,861  

Unrealized (losses) gains on derivative financial instruments(1)

    (658,535 )       5,524      

Unrealized (losses) gains on credit derivatives

        (670,403 )       11,827  

Other income(1)

    485     8,801     419     419  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    7,965     5,778     (6,756 )   11,323  

Acquisition costs

    43,244     43,150     44,974     45,208  

Net (loss) income

    (303,272 )   (303,272 )   159,734     159,734  

(1)
A fair value gain of $8.3 million related to Assured Guaranty Corp.'s committed capital securities, which was included in "Unrealized (losses) gains on derivative financial instruments" for the year ended December 31, 2007 has been reclassified to "Other income" to conform with the 2008 presentation.
 
  Year Ended December 31, 2007   Year Ended December 31, 2006  
 
  As previously
reported
  As reclassified   As previously
reported
  As reclassified  

CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

                         

Change in unrealized losses (gains) on derivative financial instruments(1)

  $ 658,535   $   $ (5,524 ) $  

Fair value gain on committed capital securities(1)

        (8,316 )        

Unrealized losses (gains) on credit derivatives

        670,403         (11,827 )

Change in premiums receivable

    (16,349 )   (5,029 )   (8,554 )   (5,961 )

Change in prepaid reinsurance premiums

    (9,549 )   (8,994 )   4,978     4,937  

Change in unearned premium reserves

    263,853     257,705     107,347     106,387  

Change in reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses, net

    10,926     8,391     (2,927 )   379  

Other changes in credit derivative assets and liabilities, net

        (6,744 )       1,405  

Net cash provided by operating activities

    385,850     385,850     261,574     261,574  

(1)
A fair value gain of $8.3 million related to Assured Guaranty Corp.'s committed capital securities, which was included in "Change in unrealized (losses) gains on derivative financial instruments" for the year ended December 31, 2007 has been reclassified to "Fair value gain on committed capital securities" to conform with the 2008 presentation.

        These adjustments had no impact on net income (loss), comprehensive income (loss), earnings (loss) per share, cash flows or total shareholders' equity.

Premium Revenue Recognition

        Premiums are received either upfront or in installments. Upfront premiums are earned in proportion to the expiration of the amount at risk. Each installment premium is earned ratably over its

164


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


installment period, generally one year or less. Premium earnings under both the upfront and installment revenue recognition methods are based upon and are in proportion to the principal amount guaranteed and therefore result in higher premium earnings during periods where guaranteed principal is higher. For insured bonds for which the par value outstanding is declining during the insurance period, upfront premium earnings are greater in the earlier periods thus matching revenue recognition with the underlying risk. The premiums are allocated in accordance with the principal amortization schedule of the related bond issue and are earned ratably over the amortization period. When an insured issue is retired early, is called by the issuer, or is in substance paid in advance through a refunding accomplished by placing U.S. Government securities in escrow, the remaining unearned premium reserves are earned at that time. Unearned premium reserves represent the portion of premiums written that is applicable to the unexpired amount at risk of insured bonds.

        In the Company's reinsurance businesses, the Company estimates the ultimate written and earned premiums to be received from a ceding company at the end of each quarter and the end of each year because some of the Company's ceding companies report premium data anywhere from 30 to 90 days after the end of the relevant period. Written premiums reported in the Company's statement of operations are based upon reports received from ceding companies supplemented by the Company's own estimates of premium for which ceding company reports have not yet been received. Differences between such estimates and actual amounts are recorded in the period in which the actual amounts are determined.

Investments

        The Company accounts for its investments in fixed maturity securities in accordance with the Financial Accounting Standards Board's ("FASB") Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ("FAS") No. 115, "Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities" ("FAS 115"). Management determines the appropriate classification of securities at the time of purchase. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, all investments in fixed maturity securities were designated as available-for-sale and are carried at fair value with a corresponding adjustment to accumulated other comprehensive income. The fair values of all the Company's investments are calculated from independent market valuations. The fair values of the Company's U.S. Treasury securities are primarily determined based upon broker dealer quotes obtained from several independent active market makers. The fair values of the Company's portfolio other than U.S. Treasury securities are determined primarily using matrix pricing models. The matrix pricing models incorporate factors such as tranche type, collateral coupons, average life, payment speeds, and spreads, in order to calculate the fair values of specific securities owned by the Company.

        The amortized cost of fixed maturity securities is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts computed using the effective interest method. That amortization or accretion is included in net investment income. For mortgage-backed securities, and any other holdings for which there is prepayment risk, prepayment assumptions are evaluated and revised as necessary. Any necessary adjustments required due to the resulting change in effective yields and maturities are recognized in current income.

        Realized gains and losses on sales of investments are determined using the specific identification method. Unrealized gains and losses on investments, net of applicable deferred income taxes, are

165


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


included in accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholders' equity. The Company has a formal review process for all securities in its investment portfolio, including a review for impairment losses. Factors considered when assessing impairment include:

        If the Company believes a decline in the value of a particular investment is temporary, the decline is recorded as an unrealized loss on the balance sheet in "accumulated other comprehensive income" in shareholders' equity. If the Company believes the decline is "other than temporary," the Company will write down the carrying value of the investment and record a realized loss in its consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. In periods subsequent to the recognition of an other-than-temporary impairment, the impaired security is accounted for as if it had been purchased on the measurement date of the impairment. Accordingly, the discount (or reduced premium) based on the new cost basis is accreted into net investment income in future periods based upon the amount and timing of expected future cash flows of the security, if the recoverable value of the investment based upon those cash flows is greater than the carrying value of the investment after the impairment.

        The Company's assessment of a decline in value includes management's current assessment of the factors noted above. The Company also seeks advice from its outside investment managers. If that assessment changes in the future, the Company may ultimately record a loss after having originally concluded that the decline in value was temporary.

        As part of its other than temporary impairment review process, management considers the nature of the investment, the cause for the impairment (interest or credit related), the severity (both as a percentage of book value and absolute dollars) and duration of the impairment, the severity of the impairment regardless of duration, and any other available evidence, such as discussions with investment advisors, volatility of the securities fair value and recent news reports when performing its assessment.

        Short-term investments are recorded at cost, which approximates fair value. Short-term investments are those with original maturities of greater than three months but less than one year from date of purchase.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

        The Company classifies demand deposits as cash. Cash equivalents are short-term, highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less.

166


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Deferred Acquisition Costs

        Acquisition costs incurred, other than those associated with credit derivative products, that vary with and are directly related to the production of new business are deferred and amortized in relation to earned premiums. These costs include direct and indirect expenses such as ceding commissions, brokerage expenses and the cost of underwriting and marketing personnel. Management uses its judgment in determining what types of costs should be deferred, as well as what percentage of these costs should be deferred. The Company annually conducts a study to determine which operating costs vary with, and are directly related to, the acquisition of new business and qualify for deferral. Ceding commissions received on premiums the Company cedes to other reinsurers reduce acquisition costs. Anticipated losses, loss adjustment expenses and the remaining costs of servicing the insured or reinsured business are considered in determining the recoverability of acquisition costs. Acquisition costs associated with credit derivative products are expensed as incurred. When an insured issue is retired early, as discussed above in the Premium Revenue Recognition section, the remaining related deferred acquisition cost is expensed at that time.

Reserves for Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses

        Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses for non-derivative transactions in the Company's financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty assumed reinsurance and mortgage guaranty business include case reserves and portfolio reserves. See Note 4. Credit Derivatives, for more information on the Company's derivative transactions. Case reserves are established when there is significant credit deterioration on specific insured obligations and the obligations are in default or default is probable, not necessarily upon non-payment of principal or interest by an insured. Case reserves represent the present value of expected future loss payments and loss adjustment expenses ("LAE"), net of estimated recoveries, but before considering ceded reinsurance. This reserving method is different from case reserves established by traditional property and casualty insurance companies, which establish case reserves upon notification of a claim and establish incurred but not reported ("IBNR") reserves for the difference between actuarially estimated ultimate losses and recorded case reserves. Financial guaranty insurance and assumed reinsurance case reserves and related salvage and subrogation, if any, are discounted at the taxable equivalent yield on the Company's investment portfolio, which is approximately 6%, in all periods presented. When the Company becomes entitled to the underlying collateral of an insured credit under salvage and subrogation rights as a result of a claim payment, it reduces the corresponding loss reserve for a particular financial guaranty insurance policy for the estimated salvage and subrogation, in accordance with FAS No. 60, "Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises". If the expected salvage and subrogation exceeds the estimated loss reserve for a policy, such amounts are recorded as a salvage recoverable asset in the Company's balance sheets.

        The Company records portfolio reserves in its financial guaranty direct, financial guaranty assumed reinsurance and mortgage guaranty business. Portfolio reserves are established with respect to the portion of the Company's business for which case reserves have not been established.

        Portfolio reserves are not established based on a specific event, rather they are calculated by aggregating the portfolio reserve calculated for each individual transaction. Individual transaction reserves are calculated on a quarterly basis by multiplying the par in-force by the product of the ultimate loss and earning factors without regard to discounting. The ultimate loss factor is defined as

167


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


the frequency of loss multiplied by the severity of loss, where the frequency is defined as the probability of default for each individual issue. The earning factor is inception to date earned premium divided by the estimated ultimate written premium for each transaction. The probability of default is estimated from rating agency data and is based on the transaction's credit rating, industry sector and time until maturity. The severity is defined as the complement of recovery/salvage rates gathered by the rating agencies of defaulting issues and is based on the industry sector.

        Portfolio reserves are recorded gross of reinsurance. The Company has not ceded any amounts under these reinsurance contracts, as the Company's recorded portfolio reserves have not exceeded the Company's contractual retentions, required by said contracts.

        The Company records an incurred loss that is reflected in the statement of operations upon the establishment of portfolio reserves. When the Company initially records a case reserve, the Company reclassifies the corresponding portfolio reserve already recorded for that credit within the balance sheet. The difference between the initially recorded case reserve and the reclassified portfolio reserve is recorded as a charge in the Company's statement of operations. Any subsequent change in portfolio reserves or the initial case reserves are recorded quarterly as a charge or credit in the Company's statement of operations in the period such estimates change. Due to the inherent uncertainties of estimating loss and LAE reserves, actual experience may differ from the estimates reflected in the Company's consolidated financial statements, and the differences may be material.

        The Company also records IBNR reserves for its other segment. IBNR is an estimate of losses for which the insured event has occurred but the claim has not yet been reported to the Company. In establishing IBNR, the Company uses traditional actuarial methods to estimate the reporting lag of such claims based on historical experience, claim reviews and information reported by ceding companies. The Company records IBNR for trade credit reinsurance within its other segment, which is 100% reinsured. The other segment represents lines of business that the Company exited or sold as part of the Company's IPO.

        For mortgage guaranty transactions the Company records portfolio reserves in a manner consistent with its financial guaranty business. While other mortgage guaranty insurance companies do not record portfolio reserves, rather just case and IBNR reserves, the Company records portfolio reserves because the Company writes business on an excess of loss basis, while other industry participants write quota share or first layer loss business. The Company manages and underwrites this business in the same manner as its financial guaranty insurance and reinsurance business because they have similar characteristics as insured obligations of mortgage-backed securities.

        FAS No. 60 is the authoritative guidance for an insurance enterprise. FAS 60 prescribes differing reserving methodologies depending on whether a contract fits within its definition of a short-duration contract or a long-duration contract. Financial guaranty contracts have elements of long-duration insurance contracts in that they are irrevocable and extend over a period that may exceed 30 years or more, but for regulatory purposes are reported as property and liability insurance, which are normally considered short-duration contracts. The short-duration and long-duration classifications have different methods of accounting for premium revenue and contract liability recognition. Additionally, the accounting for deferred acquisition costs ("DAC") could be different under the two methods.

168


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        The Company believes the guidance of FAS 60 does not expressly address the distinctive characteristics of financial guaranty insurance, so the Company also applies the analogous guidance of Emerging Issues Task Force ("EITF") Issue No. 85-20, "Recognition of Fees for Guaranteeing a Loan" ("EITF 85-20"), which provides guidance relating to the recognition of fees for guaranteeing a loan, which has similarities to financial guaranty insurance contracts. Under the guidance in EITF 85-20, the guarantor should assess the probability of loss on an ongoing basis to determine if a liability should be recognized under FAS No. 5, "Accounting for Contingencies" ("FAS 5"). FAS 5 requires that a loss be recognized where it is probable that one or more future events will occur confirming that a liability has been incurred at the date of the financial statements and the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated.

        The Company is aware that there are certain differences regarding the measurement of portfolio loss liabilities among companies in the financial guaranty industry. In January and February 2005, the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") staff had discussions concerning these differences with a number of industry participants. Based on those discussions, in June 2005, the FASB staff decided additional guidance is necessary regarding financial guaranty contracts. In May 2008, the FASB issued FAS No. 163, "Accounting for Financial Guarantee Insurance Contracts—An Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 60" ("FAS 163"). See Note 3 for more information.

Profit Commissions

        Under the terms of certain of the Company's reinsurance contracts, the Company is obligated to pay the ceding company at predetermined future dates a contingent commission based upon a specified percentage of the net underwriting profits. The Company's liability for the present value of expected future payments is shown on the balance sheet under the caption, "Profit commissions payable". The unamortized discount on this liability was $0 as of both December 31, 2008 and 2007.

Reinsurance

        In the ordinary course of business, the Company's insurance subsidiaries assume and retrocede business with other insurance and reinsurance companies. These agreements provide greater diversification of business and may minimize the net potential loss from large risks. Retrocessional contracts do not relieve the Company of its obligation to the reinsured. Reinsurance recoverable on ceded losses includes balances due from reinsurance companies for paid and unpaid losses and LAE that will be recovered from reinsurers, based on contracts in force, and is presented net of any provision for estimated uncollectible reinsurance. Any change in the provision for uncollectible reinsurance is included in loss and loss adjustment expenses. Prepaid reinsurance premiums represent the portion of premiums ceded to reinsurers relating to the unexpired terms of the reinsurance contracts in force.

        Certain of the Company's assumed and ceded reinsurance contracts are funds held arrangements. In a funds held arrangement, the ceding company retains the premiums instead of paying them to the reinsurer and losses are offset against these funds in an experience account. Because the reinsurer is not in receipt of the funds, the reinsurer earns interest on the experience account balance at a predetermined credited rate of interest. The Company generally earns interest at fixed rates of between 4% and 6% on its assumed funds held arrangements and generally pays interest at fixed rates of between 4% and 6% on its ceded funds held arrangements. The interest earned or credited on funds

169


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

held arrangements is included in net investment income. In addition, interest on funds held arrangements will continue to be earned or credited until the experience account is fully depleted, which can extend many years beyond the expiration of the coverage period.

Goodwill

        In connection with FAS No. 142, "Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets", the Company does not amortize goodwill, but instead is required to perform an impairment test annually or more frequently should circumstances warrant. The impairment test evaluates goodwill for recoverability by comparing the fair value of the Company's direct and reinsurance lines of business to their carrying value. If fair value is greater than carrying value then goodwill is deemed to be recoverable and there is no impairment. If fair value is less than carrying value then goodwill is deemed to be impaired and written down an amount such that the fair value of the reporting unit is equal to the carrying value, but not less than $0. No such impairment to goodwill was recognized in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 or 2006.

        As part of the impairment test of goodwill, there are inherent assumptions and estimates used by management in developing discounted future cash flows related to our direct and reinsurance lines of business that are subject to change based on future events. Management's estimates include projecting earned premium, incurred losses, expenses, interest rates, cost of capital and tax rates. Many of the factors used in assessing fair value are outside the control of management and it is reasonably likely that assumptions and estimates will change in future periods. These changes can result in future impairments.

        The Company has concluded that it is reasonably likely that the goodwill associated with our reinsurance line of business could become impaired in future periods if the volume of new business in the financial guaranty reinsurance market does not return to historical levels experienced prior to 2008 or if the Company is not able to continue to execute portfolio based reinsurance contracts on blocks of business for other financial guarantors in financial distress. Also, the pending FSAH transaction may cause a triggering event that will cause management to reassess its goodwill amounts related to its reinsurance line of business. See Note 22. Goodwill, for more information.

Income Taxes

        Certain of the Company's subsidiaries are subject to U.S. income tax. In accordance with FAS No. 109, "Accounting for Income Taxes", deferred income taxes are provided for with respect to the temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities, using enacted rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. Such temporary differences relate principally to deferred acquisition costs, reserves for losses and LAE, unearned premium reserves, unrealized gains and losses on investments, unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives and statutory contingency reserves. A valuation allowance is recorded to reduce the deferred tax asset to that amount that is more likely than not to be realized.

Earnings Per Share

        Basic earnings per share is calculated using the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the year. In calculating diluted earnings per share, the shares issued are increased to

170


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


include all potentially dilutive securities. All potentially dilutive securities, including nonvested restricted stock and stock options, are excluded from the basic earnings per share calculation. Basic and diluted earnings per share are calculated by dividing net income by the applicable number of shares as described above. See Note 21. Earnings (Loss) Per Share, for more information.

Share-Based Compensation

        Prior to January 1, 2006, the Company accounted for its share-based employee compensation plans under the measurement and recognition provisions of Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, "Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees" ("APB 25") and related Interpretations, as permitted by FAS No. 123, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation" ("FAS 123"). In accordance with FAS 123 and FAS No. 148, "Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation—Transition and Disclosure" ("FAS 148") the Company disclosed its net income and earnings per share in the notes to consolidated financial statements as if the Company had applied the fair value-based method in measuring compensation expense for its share-based incentive programs.

        Effective January 1, 2006, the Company adopted the fair value recognition provisions of FAS No. 123 (revised), "Share-Based Payment" ("FAS 123R") using the modified prospective transition method. Under that transition method, compensation expense includes: (a) compensation expense for all share-based payments granted prior to, but not yet vested as of January 1, 2006, based on the grant date fair value estimated in accordance with the original provisions of FAS 123, and (b) compensation expense for all share-based payments granted on or after January 1, 2006, based on the grant date fair value estimated in accordance with the provisions of FAS 123R. See Note 20 for further discussion regarding the methodology utilized in recognizing share-based compensation expense.

Variable Interest Entities and Special Purpose Entities

        The Company provides financial guarantees with respect to debt obligations of special purpose entities, including variable interest entities ("VIEs"). The Company's variable interest exists through this financial guaranty insurance or credit derivative contract. The transaction structure generally provides certain financial protections to the Company. This financial protection can take several forms, the most common are over-collateralization, first loss protection (or subordination) and excess spread. In the case of over-collateralization (i.e. the principal amount of the securitized assets exceeds the principal amount of the structured finance obligations guaranteed by the Company), the structure allows defaults of the securitized assets before a default is experienced on the structured finance obligation guaranteed by the Company. In the case of first loss, the financial guaranty insurance policy only covers a senior layer of losses of multiple obligations issued by special purpose entities, including VIEs. The first loss exposure with respect to the assets is either retained by the seller or sold off in the form of equity or mezzanine debt to other investors. In the case of excess spread, the financial assets contributed to special purpose entities, including VIEs, generate interest cash flows that are in excess of the interest payments on the debt issued by the special purpose entity. Such excess spread is typically distributed through the transaction's cash flow waterfall and may be used to create additional credit enhancement, applied to redeem debt issued by the special purpose entity (thereby creating additional over-collateralization), or distributed to equity or other investors in the transaction.

        There are two different accounting frameworks applicable to special purpose entities ("SPE"); the qualifying SPE ("QSPE") framework under FAS 140; and the VIE framework under Financial

171


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


Interpretation ("FIN") 46R "Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities". The applicable framework depends on the nature of the entity and the Company's relation to that entity. The QSPE framework is applicable when an entity transfers (sells) financial assets to a SPE meeting certain criteria as defined in FAS 140. These criteria are designed to ensure that the activities of the entity are essentially predetermined in their entirety at the inception of the vehicle; decision making is limited and restricted to certain events, and that the transferor of the financial assets cannot exercise control over the entity and the assets therein. Entities meeting these criteria are not consolidated by the transferor or other counterparty, as long as the entity does not have the unilateral ability to liquidate or to cause it to no longer meet the QSPE criteria. SPEs meeting all of FAS 140's criteria for a QSPE are not within the scope of FIN 46 and as such, need not be assessed for consolidation. When the SPE does not meet the QSPE criteria, consolidation is assessed pursuant to FIN 46R. Under FIN 46R, a VIE is defined as an entity that is not assessed for consolidation by determining which party maintains a controlling financial interest. As such, a VIE (i) lacks enough equity investment at risk to permit the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support from other parties, (ii) its equity owners lack the right to make significant decisions affecting the entity's operations, and (iii) its equity owners do not have an obligation to absorb or the right to receive the entity's losses or returns. FIN 46R requires a variable interest holder (e.g., an investor in the entity or a financial guarantor) to consolidate that VIE if that holder will absorb a majority of the expected losses of the VIE, receive a majority of the residual returns of the VIE, or both. The Company determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE by first performing a qualitative analysis of the VIE that includes, among other factors, its capital structure, contractual terms, which variable interests create or absorb variability, related party relationships and the design of the VIE. When qualitative analysis is not conclusive the Company performs a quantitative analysis. To date the results of the qualitative and quantitative analyses have indicated that the Company does not have a majority of the variability in any of these VIEs and as a result none of these VIEs are consolidated in the Company's financial statements. The Company's exposure provided through its financial guarantees with respect to debt obligations of special purpose entities is included within net par in force in Note 7. Insurance In Force.

Qualifying Special Purpose Entities:

        During 2006, the Company issued a financial guaranty on financial assets that were transferred into a special purpose entity for which the business purpose of that entity was to provide a financial guarantee client with funding for their debt obligation. This entity met the characteristics of a QSPE in accordance with FAS 140. QSPEs are not subject to the requirements of FIN 46R and accordingly are not consolidated in the Company's financial statements. QSPEs are legal entities that are demonstrably distinct from the Company, and neither the Company, nor its affiliates or its agents can unilaterally dissolve the QSPE. The QSPE's permitted activities are contractually limited to purchasing assets, issuing notes to fund such purchases, and related administrative services. Pursuant to the terms of the Company's insurance policy, insurance premiums are paid to the Company by the QSPE and are earned in a manner consistent with other insurance policies, over the risk period. Any losses incurred would be included in the Company's consolidated statements of operations.

        There were no such transactions during 2008 or 2007.

172


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

3. Recent Accounting Pronouncements

        In September 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued FAS No. 157, "Fair Value Measurements" ("FAS 157"). FAS 157 defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. FAS 157 applies to other accounting pronouncements that require or permit fair value measurements, since the FASB had previously concluded in those accounting pronouncements that fair value is the relevant measure. Accordingly, FAS 157 does not require any new fair value measurements. FAS 157 is effective for the measurement of financial assets and liabilities in financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, and interim periods within those fiscal years. FASB Staff Position,("FSP") No. 157-2 extended the effective date of FAS 157 for non-financial assets and liabilities for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008. The Company adopted FAS 157 for financial assets and liabilities effective January 1, 2008 and will adopt FAS 157 for non-financial assets and liabilities effective January 1, 2009. See Note 5.

        In February 2007, the FASB issued FAS No. 159, "The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Liabilities" ("FAS 159"). FAS 159 allows entities to voluntarily choose, at specified election dates, to measure many financial assets and financial liabilities (as well as certain nonfinancial instruments that are similar to financial instruments) at fair value (the "fair value option"). The election is made on an instrument-by-instrument basis and is irrevocable. If the fair value option is elected for an instrument, FAS 159 specifies that all subsequent changes in fair value for that instrument shall be reported in the Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income. FAS 159 is effective as of the beginning of an entity's first fiscal year that begins after November 15, 2007. The Company adopted FAS 159 effective January 1, 2008. The Company did not apply the fair value option to any eligible items on the adoption date.

        In April 2007, the FASB Staff issued FASB Staff Position No. FIN 39-1, "Amendment of FASB Interpretation No. 39" ("FSP FIN 39-1"), which permits companies to offset cash collateral receivables or payables with net derivative positions under certain circumstances. FSP FIN 39-1 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, with early adoption permitted. FSP FIN 39-1 did not affect the Company's results of operations or financial position.

        In December 2007, the FASB issued FAS No. 141 (revised), "Business Combinations" ("FAS 141R"). FAS 141R establishes principles and requirements for how the acquirer of a business recognizes and measures in its financial statements the identifiable assets acquired, the liabilities assumed, and any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree. FAS 141R also provides guidance for recognizing and measuring the goodwill acquired in the business combination and determines what information to disclose to enable users of the financial statement to evaluate the nature and financial effects of the business combination. FAS 141R is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and interim statements within those fiscal years. Early adoption is not permitted. Since FAS 141R applies prospectively to business combinations whose acquisition date is subsequent to the statement's adoption. The Company plans to apply the provisions of FAS 141R to account for its pending acquisition of FSAH. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had paid $2.7 million of expenses related to the Company's pending acquisition of FSAH that the Company plans to expense in the first quarter 2009.

        In December 2007, the FASB issued FAS No. 160, "Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements—an amendment of ARB No. 51" ("FAS 160"). FAS 160 establishes accounting and reporting standards for the noncontrolling interest in a subsidiary for the deconsolidation of a

173


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

3. Recent Accounting Pronouncements (Continued)


subsidiary. FAS 160 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and interim statements within those fiscal years. The Company is currently evaluating the impact, if any, FAS 160 will have on its consolidated financial statements.

        In March 2008, the FASB issued FAS No. 161, "Disclosures About Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities—An Amendment of FASB Statement No. 133" ("FAS 161"). FAS 161 establishes the disclosure requirements for derivative instruments and for hedging activities. FAS 161 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after November 15, 2008. Early application is encouraged. FAS 161 is not expected to have an impact on the Company's current results of operations or financial position.

        In May 2008, the FASB issued FAS No. 163, "Accounting for Financial Guarantee Insurance Contracts" ("FAS 163"). FAS 163 requires that an insurance enterprise recognize a claim liability prior to an event of default (insured event) when there is evidence that credit deterioration has occurred in an insured financial obligation. FAS 163 also clarifies the methodology to be used for financial guaranty premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement, as well as requiring expanded disclosures about the insurance enterprise's risk management activities. The provisions of FAS 163 related to premium revenue recognition and claim liability measurement are effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008, and all interim periods within those fiscal years. Earlier application of these provisions is not permitted. The expanded risk management activity disclosure provisions of FAS 163 were effective for the third quarter of 2008 and are included in Note 11 of the these financial statements. FAS 163 will be applied to all existing and future financial guaranty insurance contracts written by the Company. The cumulative effect of initially applying FAS 163 will be recorded as an adjustment to retained earnings as of January 1, 2009. The Company expects the effect of FAS 163 to be material to premiums receivable and unearned premium reserve on its balance sheet as of January 1, 2009 for the recording of future installment premiums. The Company is in the process of finalizing the impact of the adoption of FAS 163 on retained earnings for revisions to the Company's premium revenue recognition and claims liability methodologies. The Company will disclose the impact of the adoption of FAS 163 in its 10-Q for the period ended March 31, 2009.

        In June 2008, the FASB issued FSP EITF 03-6-1, "Participating Securities and the Two-Class Method under FASB Statement No. 128" ("FSP"). The FSP addresses whether instruments granted in share-based payment transactions are participating securities prior to vesting and therefore need to be included in the earnings allocation in calculating earnings per share ("EPS") under the two-class method described in FAS No. 128, "Earnings per Share." The FSP requires companies to treat unvested share-based payment awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividend or dividend equivalents as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. The FSP is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008; earlier application is not permitted. This FSP also requires that all prior period EPS data be adjusted retrospectively. The Company does not expect adoption of the FSP to have a material effect on its results of operations or earnings per share.

        In October 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position No. 157-3, "Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset Is Not Active" ("FSP 157-3"). FSP 157-3 clarified the application of FAS 157, "Fair Value Measurements", in a market that is not active. FSP 157-3 was effective when issued. It did not have an impact on the Company's current results of operations or financial position.

174


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

3. Recent Accounting Pronouncements (Continued)

        The FASB adopted FSP FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4, "Disclosures About Credit Derivatives and Certain Guarantees" and FAS 161, "Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" to address concerns that current derivative disclosure requirements did not adequately address the potential adverse effects that these instruments can have on the financial performance and operations of an entity. Companies will be required to provide enhanced disclosures about their derivative activities to enable users to better understand: (1) how and why a company uses derivatives, (2) how it accounts for derivatives and related hedged items, and (3) how derivatives affect its financial statements. These should include the terms of the derivatives, collateral posting requirements and triggers, and other significant provisions that could be detrimental to earnings or liquidity. Disclosures specific to credit derivatives must be included in the December 31, 2008 financial statements. Certain other derivative and hedging disclosures must be included in the Company's March 31, 2009 Form 10-Q. Management believes that the Company's current derivatives disclosures are in compliance with the items required by FSP 133-1 and FAS 161.

        In December 2008, the FASB adopted FSP FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8, "Disclosures by Public Entities (Enterprises) about Transfers of Financial Assets and Interests in Variable Interest Entities" to require public entities to provide, among other things, additional disclosures about transfers of financial assets and their involvement with variable interest entities. FSP FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8 was effective when issues. It did not have an impact on the Company's current results of operations or financial position.

4. Credit Derivatives

        Credit derivatives issued by the Company, principally in the form of insured CDS contracts, have been deemed to meet the definition of a derivative under FAS No. 133, "Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" ("FAS 133"), FAS No. 149, "Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" ("FAS 149") and FAS No. 155, "Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments" ("FAS 155"). FAS 133 and FAS 149 require that an entity recognize all derivatives as either assets or liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets and measure those instruments at fair value. If certain conditions are met, a derivative may be specifically designated as a fair value, cash flow or foreign currency hedge. FAS 155 requires companies to recognize freestanding or embedded derivatives relating to beneficial interests in securitized financial instruments. This recognition was not required prior to January 1, 2007. The accounting for changes in the fair value of a derivative depends on the intended use of the derivative and the resulting designation.

        Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives include credit derivative premiums received and receivable for credit protection the Company has sold under its insured CDS as well as any contractual claim losses paid and payable related to insured credit events under these contracts, ceding commissions (expense) income and realized gains or losses related to their early termination. The Company generally holds credit derivative contracts to maturity. However, in certain circumstances such as for risk management purposes or as a result of a decision to exit a line of business, the Company may decide to terminate a credit derivative contract prior to maturity.

175


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

4. Credit Derivatives (Continued)

        The following table disaggregates realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives into its component parts for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 (dollars in thousands):

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

                   

Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable

  $ 118,077   $ 72,721   $ 61,851  

Net credit derivative losses recovered and recoverable

    391     1,365     11,776  

Ceding commissions (paid/payable) received/receivable, net

    (879 )   (94 )   234  
               
 

Total realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

  $ 117,589   $ 73,992   $ 73,861  
               

        Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives represent the adjustments for changes in fair value that are recorded in each reporting period, under FAS 133. Changes in unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives are reflected in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income in unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives. Cumulative unrealized losses, determined on a contract by contract basis, are reflected as either net assets or net liabilities in the Company's balance sheets. Unrealized gains and losses resulting from changes in the fair value of credit derivatives occur because of changes in interest rates, credit spreads, the credit ratings of the referenced entities and the issuing Company's own credit rating and other market factors. The unrealized gains and losses on credit derivatives will reduce to zero as the exposure approaches its maturity date, unless there is a payment default on the exposure. Changes in the fair value of the Company's credit derivative contracts do not reflect actual claims or credit losses, and have no impact on the Company's claims paying resources, rating agency capital or regulatory capital positions.

        The Company determines fair value of its credit derivative contracts primarily through modeling that uses various inputs such as credit spreads, based on observable market indices and on recent pricing for similar contracts, and expected contractual life to derive an estimate of the value of our contracts in our principal market (see Note 5). Credit spreads capture the impact of recovery rates and performance of underlying assets, among other factors, on these contracts. The Company's pricing model takes into account not only how credit spreads on risks that it assumes affects pricing, but how the Company's own credit spread affects the pricing of its deals. If credit spreads of the underlying obligations change, the fair value of the related credit derivative changes. Market liquidity could also impact valuations of the underlying obligations.

        The impact of changes in credit spreads will vary based upon the volume, tenor, interest rates, and other market conditions at the time these fair values are determined. In addition, since each transaction has unique collateral and structure terms, the underlying change in fair value of each transaction may vary considerably. The fair value of credit derivative contracts also reflects the change in the Company's own credit cost based on the price to purchase credit protection on AGC. During 2008, the Company incurred net pre-tax unrealized gains on credit derivative contracts of $38.0 million. The 2008 gain includes an amount of $4,147.6 million associated with the change in AGC's credit spread, which widened substantially from 180 basis points at December 31, 2007 to 1,775 basis points at

176


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

4. Credit Derivatives (Continued)


December 31, 2008. Management believes that the widening of AGC's credit spread is due to the correlation between AGC's risk profile and that experienced currently by the broader financial markets and increased demand for credit protection against AGC as the result of its increased business volume. Offsetting the gain attributable to the significant increase in AGC's credit spread were declines in fixed income security market prices primarily attributable to widening spreads in certain markets as a result of the continued deterioration in credit markets and some credit rating downgrades, rather than from delinquencies or defaults on securities guaranteed by the Company. The higher credit spreads in the fixed income security market are due to the recent lack of liquidity in the high yield collateralized debt obligation and collateralized loan obligation markets as well as continuing market concerns over the most recent vintages of subprime residential mortgage backed securities and commercial mortgage backed securities. The 2007 loss of $670.4 million primarily related to spreads widening and includes no credit losses. For the year ended 2007, approximately 45% of the Company's unrealized loss on credit derivatives was due to a decline in the market value of high yield and investment grade corporate collateralized loan obligation transactions, with the balance generated by lower market values principally in the residential and commercial mortgage-backed securities markets. The 2006 gain of $11.8 million primarily related to the run-off of transactions and changes in credit spreads.

        The total notional amount of credit derivative exposure outstanding as of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 and included in the Company's financial guaranty exposure was $75.1 billion and $71.6 billion, respectively.

        The components of the Company's unrealized gain (loss) on credit derivatives as of December 31, 2008 are:

Asset Type
  Net Par
Outstanding
(in billions)
  Weighted
Average Credit
Rating(1)
  Full Year 2008
Unrealized Gain
(Loss)
(in millions)
 

Corporate collateralized loan obligations

  $ 26.3   AAA   $ 271.2  

Market value CDOs of corporates

    3.8   AAA     48.8  

Trust preferred securities

    6.2   AA+     7.5  
               

Total pooled corporate obligations

    36.3   AAA     327.4  

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    5.8   AAA     79.0  

Residential mortgage-backed securities

    20.3   AA     (1.5 )

Other

    9.7   AA     (339.2 )
               

Total

  $ 72.0   AA+   $ 65.7  

Reinsurance exposures written in CDS form

    3.2   AA+     (27.7 )
               

Grand Total

  $ 75.1   AA+   $ 38.0  
               

        Corporate collateralized loan obligations, market value CDO's, and trust preferred securities, which comprise the Company's pooled corporate exposures, include all U.S. structured finance pooled corporate obligations and international pooled corporate obligations. Commercial mortgage-backed securities are comprised of commercial U.S. structured finance and commercial international mortgage

177


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

4. Credit Derivatives (Continued)


backed securities. Residential mortgage-backed securities are comprised of prime and subprime U.S. mortgage-backed and home equity securities, international residential mortgage-backed and international home equity securities. Other includes all other U.S. and international asset classes, such as commercial receivables, and international infrastructure and pooled infrastructure securities.

        The Company's exposure to pooled corporate obligations is highly diversified in terms of obligors and industries. Most pooled corporate transactions are structured to limit exposure to any given obligor and industry. The majority of the Company's pooled corporate exposure in the direct segment consists of collateralized loan obligations ("CLOs"). Most of these direct CLOs have an average obligor size of less than 1% and typically restrict the maximum exposure to any one industry to approximately 10%. The Company's exposure also benefits from embedded credit enhancement in the transactions which allows a transaction to sustain a certain level of losses in the underlying collateral, further insulating the Company from industry specific concentrations of credit risk on these deals.

        The Company's $9.7 billion exposure to Other CDS contracts is also highly diversified. It includes $4.0 billion of exposure to four pooled infrastructure deals comprised of diversified pools of international infrastructure project transactions and loans to regulated utilities. These pools were all structured with underlying credit enhancement sufficient for the Company to attach at super senior AAA levels. The remaining $5.7 billion of exposure in Other CDS contracts is comprised of numerous deals typically structured with significant underlying credit enhancement and spread across various asset classes, such as commercial receivables, infrastructure, regulated utilities and consumer receivables. Substantially all of this $9.7 billion of exposure is rated investment grade and the weighted average credit rating is AA.

        The unrealized loss of $(339.2) million on Other CDS contracts for the year ended December 31, 2008 is primarily attributable to a change in the call date assumption and widening of spreads for a pooled infrastructure transaction during the Second Quarter 2008, that resulted in a unrealized loss of $(145.8) million, and the ratings downgrades on a wrapped film securitization transaction where the Company provided credit protection on a transaction insured by another financial guarantor. The ratings downgrade of that other financial guarantor caused the downgrade and credit spread widening of the film securitization transaction that resulted in an unrealized loss of $(104.6) million.

        With considerable volatility continuing in the market, unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives may fluctuate significantly in future periods.

        The Company's exposure to the mortgage industry is discussed in Note 11.

178


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

4. Credit Derivatives (Continued)

        The following table presents additional details about the Company's unrealized gain on pooled corporate obligation credit derivatives, which includes collateralized loan obligations, market value CDOs and trust preferred securities, by asset type as of December 31, 2008:

Asset Type
  Original
Subordination(2)
  Current
Subordination(2)
  Net Par
Outstanding
(in billions)
  Weighted
Average Credit
Rating(1)
  Full Year 2008
Unrealized Gain
(Loss)
(in millions)
 

High yield corporates

    36.2 %   32.3 % $ 23.1   AAA   $ 263.3  

Trust preferred

    46.3 %   42.6 %   6.2   AA+     7.5  

Market value CDOs of corporates

    39.2 %   26.0 %   3.8   AAA     48.8  

Investment grade corporates

    28.6 %   29.9 %   2.3   AAA     3.8  

Commercial real estate

    49.1 %   49.1 %   0.8   AAA     7.5  

CDO of CDOs (corporate)

    1.7 %   4.9 %   0.1   AAA     (3.4 )
                           

Total

    37.9 %   33.5 % $ 36.3   AAA   $ 327.4  
                           

(1)
Based on the Company's internal rating, which is on a comparable scale to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies.

(2)
Represents the sum of subordinate tranches and over-collateralization and does not include any benefit from excess interest collections that may be used to absorb losses.

        The following table presents additional details about the Company's unrealized gain on credit derivatives associated with commercial mortgage-backed securities by vintage as of December 31, 2008:

Vintage
  Original
Subordination(2)
  Current
Subordination(2)
  Net Par
Outstanding
(in billions)
  Weighted
Average Credit
Rating(1)
  Full Year 2008
Unrealized Gain
(Loss)
(in millions)
 

2004 and Prior

    19.7 %   21.4 % $ 0.3   AAA   $ 5.1  

2005

    27.8 %   28.9 %   3.4   AAA     50.7  

2006

    27.6 %   27.9 %   1.9   AAA     20.7  

2007

    35.8 %   35.9 %   0.2   AAA     2.4  

2008

                   
                           

Total

    27.6 %   28.5 % $ 5.8   AAA   $ 79.0  
                           

179


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

4. Credit Derivatives (Continued)

        The following tables present additional details about the Company's unrealized gain on credit derivatives associated with residential mortgage-backed securities by vintage and asset type as of December 31, 2008:

Vintage
  Original
Subordination(2)
  Current
Subordination(2)
  Net Par
Outstanding
(in billions)
  Weighted
Average Credit
Rating(1)
  Full Year 2008
Unrealized Gain
(Loss)
(in millions)
 

2004 and Prior

    5.2 %   12.9 % $ 0.5   A+   $ (37.0 )

2005

    24.4 %   50.4 %   5.0   AA     75.5  

2006

    16.4 %   23.3 %   5.8   AA+     129.7  

2007

    16.4 %   18.5 %   9.0   AA-     (169.7 )

2008

                   
                           

Total

    18.1 %   27.5 % $ 20.3   AA   $ (1.5 )
                           

 

Asset Type
  Original
Subordination(2)
  Current
Subordination(2)
  Net Par
Outstanding
(in billions)
  Weighted
Average Credit
Rating(1)
  Full Year 2008
Unrealized Gain
(Loss)
(in millions)
 

Alt-A loans

    20.3 %   23.3 % $ 6.4   A+   $ (194.9 )

Prime first lien

    10.3 %   12.2 %   8.2   AAA     7.7  

Subprime lien

    26.9 %   54.4 %   5.7   AA-     185.7  
                           

Total

    18.1 %   27.5 % $ 20.3   AA   $ (1.5 )
                           

        In general, the Company structures credit derivative transactions such that the circumstances giving rise to our obligation to make payments is similar to that for financial guaranty policies and generally occurs as losses are realized on the underlying reference obligation. Nonetheless, credit derivative transactions are governed by ISDA documentation and operate differently from financial guaranty insurance policies. For example, our control rights with respect to a reference obligation under a credit derivative may be more limited than when the Company issues a financial guaranty insurance policy on a direct primary basis. In addition, while the Company's exposure under credit derivatives, like the Company's exposure under financial guaranty insurance policies, is generally for as long as the reference obligation remains outstanding, unlike financial guaranty insurance policies, a credit derivative may be terminated for a breach of the ISDA documentation or other specific events. In some older credit derivative transactions, one such specified event is the failure of AGC to maintain specified financial strength ratings ranging from AA- to BBB-. If a credit derivative is terminated the Company could be required to make a mark-to-market payment as determined under the ISDA documentation. For example, if AGC's rating were downgraded to A+, under market conditions at December 31, 2008, if the counterparties exercised their right to terminate their credit derivatives, AGC would have been required to make payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $261 million. Further, if AGC's rating was downgraded to levels between "BBB+" and "BB+" it would have been required to make additional payments that the Company estimates to be approximately $620 million at December 31, 2008.

180


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

4. Credit Derivatives (Continued)

        Under a limited number of credit derivative contracts, the Company is required to post eligible securities as collateral, generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities. The need to post collateral under these transactions is generally based on mark-to-market valuation in excess of contractual thresholds. The particular thresholds decline if the Company's ratings decline. As of December 31, 2008 the Company had pre-IPO transactions with approximately $1.9 billion of par subject to collateral posting due to changes in market value. Of this amount, as of December 31, 2008, the Company posted collateral totaling approximately $157.7 million (including $134.2 million for AGC) based on the unrealized mark-to-market loss position for transactions with two of its counterparties. Any amounts required to be posted as collateral in the future will depend on changes in the market values of these transactions. Additionally, in the event AGC were downgraded below A-, contractual thresholds would be eliminated and the amount of par that could be subject to collateral posting requirements would be $2.4 billion. Based on market values as of December 31, 2008, such a downgrade would have resulted in AGC posting an additional $88.7 million of collateral. Currently no additional collateral posting is required or anticipated for any other transactions.

        As of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007, the Company considered the impact of its own credit risk, in combination with credit spreads on risk that it assumes through CDS contracts, in determining the fair value of its credit derivatives. The Company determines its own credit risk based on quoted CDS prices traded on the Company at each balance sheet date. The quoted price of CDS contracts traded on AGC at December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 was 1,775 basis points and 180 basis points, respectively. Historically, the price of CDS traded on AGC moves directionally the same as general market spreads. Generally, a widening of the CDS prices traded on AGC has an effect of offsetting unrealized losses that result from widening general market credit spreads, while a narrowing of the CDS prices traded on AGC has an effect of offsetting unrealized gains that result from narrowing general market credit spreads. An overall narrowing of spreads generally results in an unrealized gain on credit derivatives for the Company and an overall widening of spreads generally results in an unrealized loss for the Company. At December 31, 2008, the values of our CDS contracts before and after considering implications of our credit spreads were $(4,686.8) million and $(539.2) million, respectively. At December 31, 2007 the effect of our own credit was not significant. As noted above, our own credit spread widened from 180 basis points at December 31, 2007 to 1,775 basis points at December 31, 2008. As such, the impact of our own credit spread significantly affected the 2008 values but not the 2007 values.

181


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

4. Credit Derivatives (Continued)

        The following table summarizes the estimated change in fair values on the net balance of the Company's credit derivative positions assuming immediate parallel shifts in credit spreads at December 31, 2008:

        (Dollars in millions)

Credit Spreads(1)
  Estimated Net
Fair Value (Pre-Tax)
  Estimated Pre-Tax
Change in Gain / (Loss)
 

December 31, 2008:

             

100% widening in spreads

  $ (1,538.3 ) $ (999.1 )

50% widening in spreads

    (1,044.0 )   (504.8 )

25% widening in spreads

    (793.5 )   (254.3 )

10% widening in spreads

    (642.2 )   (103.0 )

Base Scenario

    (539.2 )    

10% narrowing in spreads

    (454.4 )   84.8  

25% narrowing in spreads

    (326.7 )   212.5  

50% narrowing in spreads

    (118.4 )   420.8  

        The Company had no derivatives that were designated as hedges, except as described in Note 18. Long-Term Debt, during 2008, 2007 and 2006.

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments

        The carrying amount and estimated fair value of financial instruments are presented in the following table:

 
  As of December 31, 2008   As of December 31, 2007  
 
  Carrying
Amount
  Estimated
Fair Value
  Carrying
Amount
  Estimated
Fair Value
 
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Assets:

                         
 

Fixed maturity securities

  $ 3,154,137   $ 3,154,137   $ 2,586,954   $ 2,586,954  
 

Cash and short-term investments

    489,502     489,502     560,986     560,986  
 

Credit derivative assets

    146,959     146,959     5,474     5,474  

Liabilities:

                         
 

Unearned premium reserves

    1,233,714     1,785,769     887,171     855,474  
 

Long-term debt:

                         
   

Senior Notes

    197,443     106,560     197,408     169,478  
   

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

    149,767     37,500     149,738     140,997  
 

Credit derivative liabilities

    733,766     733,766     623,118     623,118  

Off-Balance Sheet Instruments:

                         
 

Future installment premiums

        463,407         489,482  

182


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)

Background

        Effective January 1, 2008, the Company adopted FAS 157. FAS 157 defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value and expands disclosures about fair value measurements. FAS 157 applies to other accounting pronouncements that require or permit fair value measurements, but does not require any new fair value measurements.

        FAS 157 defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. The price shall represent that available in the principal market for the asset or liability. If there is no principal market, then the price is based on the market that maximizes the value received for an asset or minimizes the amount paid for a liability (i.e. the most advantageous market).

        FAS 157 specifies a fair value hierarchy based on whether the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect Company estimates of market assumptions. In accordance with FAS 157, the fair value hierarchy prioritizes model inputs into three broad levels as follows:

        An asset or liability's categorization within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of significant input to its valuation.

Effect on the Company's financial statements

        FAS 157 applies to both amounts recorded in the Company's financial statements and to disclosures. Amounts recorded at fair value in the Company's financial statements on a recurring basis are fixed maturity securities available for sale, short-term investments, credit derivative assets and

183


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)


liabilities relating to the Company's CDS contracts and CCS Securities. The fair value of these items as of December 31, 2008 is summarized in the following table.

 
   
  Fair Value Measurements Using  
(Dollars in millions)
  Fair Value   Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
  Significant Other
Observable Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 

Assets

                         

Fixed maturity securities

  $ 3,154.1   $   $ 3,154.1   $  

Short-term investments

    477.2     47.8     429.4      

Credit derivative assets

    147.0             147.0  

CCS Securities

    51.1         51.1      
                   
 

Total assets

  $ 3,829.4   $ 47.8   $ 3,634.6   $ 147.0  
                   

Liabilities

                         

Credit derivative liabilities

  $ 733.8   $   $   $ 733.8  
                   
 

Total liabilities

  $ 733.8   $   $   $ 733.8  
                   

Fixed Maturity Securities and Short-term Investments

        The fair value of fixed maturity securities and short-term investments is determined using one of three different pricing services: pricing vendors, index providers or broker-dealer quotations. Pricing services for each sector of the market are determined based upon the provider's expertise.

        Typical inputs used by these three pricing methods include, but are not limited to, reported trades, benchmark yields, issuer spreads, bids, offers, and/or estimated cash flows and prepayments speeds. Based on the typical trading volumes and the lack of quoted market prices for fixed maturities, third party pricing services will normally derive the security prices through recent reported trades for identical or similar securities making adjustments through the reporting date based upon available market observable information as outlined above. If there are no recent reported trades, the third party pricing services and brokers may use matrix or model processes to develop a security price where future cash flow expectations are developed based upon collateral performance and discounted at an estimated market rate. Included in the pricing of asset backed securities are estimates of the rate of future prepayments of principal over the remaining life of the securities. Such estimates are derived based on the characteristics of the underlying structure and prepayment speeds previously experienced at the interest rate levels projected for the underlying collateral. The Company does not make any internal adjustments to prices provided by its third party pricing service.

        The Company has analyzed the third party pricing services' valuation methodologies and related inputs, and has also evaluated the various types of securities in its investment portfolio to determine an appropriate FAS 157 fair value hierarchy level based upon trading activity and observability of market inputs. Based on this evaluation, each price was classified as Level 1, 2 or 3. Prices provided by third party pricing services with market observable inputs are classified as Level 2. Prices on the money fund

184


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)


portion of short-term investments are classified as Level 1. No investments were classified as Level 3 as of or for the year ended December 31, 2008.

Committed Capital Securities ("CCS Securities")

        The fair value of CCS Securities represents the present value of remaining expected put option premium payments under the CCS Securities agreements and the value of such estimated payments based upon the quoted price for such premium payments as of December 31, 2008 (see Note 18). The $51.1 million fair value asset for CCS Securities is included in the consolidated balance sheet. Changes in fair value of this asset are included in other income in the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income. The significant market inputs used are observable, therefore, the Company classified this fair value measurement as Level 2.

Level 3 Valuation Techniques

        Financial instruments are considered Level 3 when their values are determined using pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies or similar techniques and at least one significant model assumption or input is unobservable. Level 3 financial instruments also include those for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation. A brief description of the valuation techniques used for Level 3 assets and liabilities is provided below.

Credit Derivatives

        The Company's credit derivatives consist of insured CDS contracts (see Note 4). As discussed in Note 4, the Company does not typically exit its credit derivative contracts, and there are no quoted prices for its instruments or for similar instruments. Observable inputs other than quoted market prices exist, however, these inputs reflect contracts that do not contain terms and conditions similar to the credit derivative contracts issued by the Company. Therefore, the valuation of credit derivative contracts requires the use of models that contain significant, unobservable inputs. Thus, we believe the credit derivative valuations are in Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy discussed above.

        The fair value of the Company's credit derivative contracts represents the difference between the present value of remaining expected premiums the Company receives for the credit protection and the estimated present value of premiums that a comparable financial guarantor would hypothetically charge the Company for the same protection at the balance sheet date. The fair value of the Company's credit derivatives depends on a number of factors including notional amount of the contract, expected term, credit spreads, changes in interest rates, the credit ratings of referenced entities, the Company's own credit risk and remaining contractual cash flows. Contractual cash flows, which are included in the "Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives" fair value component of credit derivatives, are the most readily observable variables of the fair value of credit derivative contracts since they are based on contractual terms. These variables include (i) net premiums received and receivable on written credit derivative contracts, (ii) net premiums paid and payable on purchased contracts, (iii) losses paid and payable to credit derivative contract counterparties and (iv) losses recovered and recoverable on purchased contracts. The remaining key variables described above impact "Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives".

185


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        Market conditions at December 31, 2008 were such that market prices of the Company's CDS contracts were not generally available. Where market prices were not available, the Company used a combination of observable market data and valuation models, using various market indices, credit spreads, the Company's own credit risk, and estimated contractual payments to estimate the "Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives" portion of the fair value of its credit derivatives. These models are primarily developed internally based on market conventions for similar transactions.

        Management considers the non-standard terms of its credit derivative contracts in determining the fair value of these contracts. These terms differ from credit derivatives sold by companies outside the financial guaranty industry. The non-standard terms include the absence of collateral support agreements or immediate settlement provisions, relatively high attachment points and the fact that the Company does not exit derivatives it sells for credit protection purposes, except under specific circumstances such as exiting a line of business. Because of these terms and conditions, the fair value of the Company's credit derivatives may not reflect the same prices observed in an actively traded market of credit derivatives that do not contain terms and conditions similar to those observed in the financial guaranty market. These models and the related assumptions are continuously reevaluated by management and enhanced, as appropriate, based upon improvements in modeling techniques and availability of more timely market information.

        Valuation models include the use of management estimates and current market information. Management is also required to make assumptions on how the fair value of credit derivative instruments is affected by current market conditions. Management considers factors such as current prices charged for similar agreements, performance of underlying assets, life of the instrument, and the extent of credit derivative exposure the Company ceded under reinsurance agreements, and the nature and extent of activity in the financial guaranty credit derivative marketplace. The assumptions that management uses to determine its fair value may change in the future due to market conditions. Due to the inherent uncertainties of the assumptions used in the valuation models to determine the fair value of these credit derivative products, actual experience may differ from the estimates reflected in the Company's consolidated financial statements and the differences may be material.

        Listed below are various inputs and assumptions that are key to the establishment of our fair value for CDS contracts.

        The key assumptions of our internally developed model include:

186


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The specific model inputs are listed below, including how we derive inputs for market credit spreads on the underlying transaction collateral.

187


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The following is an example of how changes in gross spreads, the Company's own credit spread and the cost to buy protection on the Company affect the amount of premium the Company can demand for its credit protection. Scenario 1 represents the market conditions in effect on the transaction date and Scenario 2 represents market conditions at a subsequent reporting date.

 
  Scenario 1   Scenario 2  
 
  bps   % of Total   bps   % of Total  

Original Gross Spread / Cash Bond Price (in Bps)

    185.0           500.0        

Bask Profit (in Bps)

    115.0     62 %   50.0     10 %

Hedge Cost (in Bps)

    30.0     16 %   440.0     88 %

AGC Premium Received Per Annum (in Bps)

    40.0     22 %   10.0     2 %

        In Scenario 1, the gross spread is 185bps. The bank or deal originator captures 115bps of the original gross spread and hedges 10% of its exposure to AGC, when the CDS spread on AGC was 300bps (300bps × 10% = 30bps). Under this scenario AGC received premium of 40bps, or 22% of the gross spread.

        In Scenario 2, the gross spread is 500bps. The bank or deal originator captures 50bps of the original gross spread and hedges 25% of its exposure to AGC, when the CDS spread on AGC was 1,760bps (1,760bps × 25% = 440bps). Under this scenario AGC would receive premium of 10bps, or 2% of the gross spread.

        In this example, the contractual cash flows exceed the amount a market participant would require AGC to pay in today's market to accept its obligations under the credit default swap contract, thus resulting in an asset. This credit derivative asset is equal to the difference in premium rate discounted at a risk adjusted rate over the weighted average remaining life of the contract. The expected future cash flows for the Company's credit derivatives were discounted at rates ranging from 1.0% to 17.0% over LIBOR at December 31, 2008, with over 97% of the transactions ranging from 1.0% to 6.0% over LIBOR.

        The Company corroborates the assumptions in its fair value model, including the amount of exposure to the Company hedged by its counterparties, with independent third parties each reporting period. Recent increases in the CDS spread on AGC have resulted in the bank or deal originator

188


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)


hedging a greater portion of its exposure to AGC. This has the effect of reducing the amount of contractual cash flows AGC can capture for selling our protection.

        The amount of premium a financial guaranty insurance market participant can demand is inversely related to the cost of credit protection on the insurance company as measured by market credit spreads. This is because the buyers of credit protection typically hedge a portion of their risk to the financial guarantor, due to the fact that contractual terms of financial guaranty insurance contracts typically do not require the posting of collateral by the guarantor. The widening of a financial guarantor's own credit spread increases the cost to buy credit protection on the guarantor, thereby, reducing the amount of premium the guarantor can capture out of the gross spread on the deal. The extent of the hedge depends on the types of instruments insured and the current market conditions.

        A credit derivative asset under FAS 157 is the result of contractual cash flows on in-force deals in excess of what a hypothetical financial guarantor could receive if it sold protection on the same risk as of the current reporting date. If the Company were able to freely exchange these contracts (i.e., assuming its contracts did not contain proscriptions on transfer and there was a viable exchange market), it would be able to realize an asset representing the difference between the higher contractual premiums to which it's entitled and the current market premiums for a similar contract.

        To clarify, management does not believe there is an established market where financial guaranty insured credit derivatives are actively traded. The terms of the protection under an insured financial guaranty credit derivative do not, except for certain rare circumstances, allow the Company to exit its contracts. Management has determined that the exit market for the Company's credit derivatives is a hypothetical one based on its entry market. Management has tracked the historical pricing of the Company's deals to establish historical price points in the hypothetical market that are used in the fair value calculation.

        The following spread hierarchy is utilized in determining which source of spread to use, with the rule being to use CDS spreads where available. If not available, the Company either interpolates or extrapolates CDS spreads based on similar transactions or market indices.

        Over time the data inputs can change as new sources become available or existing sources are discontinued or are no longer considered to be the most appropriate. It is the Company's objective to move to higher levels on the hierarchy whenever possible, but it is sometimes necessary to move to lower priority inputs because of discontinued data sources or assessments that the higher priority inputs are no longer considered to be representative of market spreads for a given type of collateral. This can

189


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)


happen, for example, if transaction volume changes such that a previously used spread index is no longer viewed as being reflective of current market levels.

        As of December 31, 2008, the Company obtained approximately 8% of its credit spread information, based on notional par outstanding, from actual collateral specific credit spreads, while 78% was based on market indices and 14% was based on spreads provided by the CDS counterparty. The Company interpolates a curve based on the historical relationship between premium the Company receives when a financial guarantee written in CDS form closes to the daily closing price of the market index related to the specific asset class and rating of the deal. This curve indicates expected credit spreads at each indicative level on the related market index. For specific transactions where no price quotes are available and credit spreads need to be extrapolated, an alternative transaction for which the Company has received a spread quote from one of the first three sources within the Company's spread hierarchy is chosen. This alternative transaction will be within the same asset class, have similar underlying assets, similar credit ratings, and similar time to maturity. The Company then calculates the percentage of relative spread change quarter over quarter for the alternative transaction. This percentage change is then applied to the historical credit spread of the transaction for which no price quote was received in order to calculate the transactions current spread. Counterparties determine credit spreads by reviewing new issuance pricing for specific asset classes and receiving price quotes from their trading desks for the specific asset in question. These quotes are validated by cross-referencing quotes received from one market source with those quotes received from another market source to ensure reasonableness. In addition, management compares the relative change experienced on published market indices for a specific asset class for reasonableness and accuracy.

        The Company's credit derivative valuation model, like any financial model, has certain strengths and weaknesses

        The primary strengths of the Company's CDS modeling techniques are:

        The primary weaknesses of the Company's CDS modeling techniques are:

190


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        As discussed above, the Company does not trade or exit its credit derivative contracts in the normal course of business. As such, the ability to test modeled results is limited by the absence of actual exit transactions. However, management does compare modeled results to actual data that is available. Management first attempts to compare modeled values to premiums on deals the Company received on new deals written within the reporting period. If no new transactions were written for a particular asset type in the period or if the number of transactions is not reflective of a representative sample, management compares modeled results to premium bids offered by the Company to provide credit protection on new transactions within the reporting period, the premium the Company has received on historical transactions to provide credit protection in net tight and wide credit environments and/or the premium on transactions closed by other financial guaranty insurance companies during the reporting period.

        The net par outstanding of the Company's credit derivative contracts was $75.1 billion and $71.6 billion at December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007, respectively. The estimated remaining average life of these contracts at December 31, 2008 was 7.0 years.

        As required by FAS 157, financial assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement. As of December 31, 2008, these contracts are classified as Level 3 in the FAS 157 hierarchy since there is reliance on at least one unobservable input deemed significant to the valuation model, most significantly the Company's estimate of the value of the non-standard terms and conditions of its credit derivative contracts and of the Company's current credit standing.

191


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The table below presents a reconciliation of the Company's credit derivatives whose fair value included significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) during the year ended December 31, 2008.

 
  Year Ended
December 31, 2008
 
 
  Fair Value
Measurements Using
Significant
Unobservable Inputs
(Level 3)
 
(Dollars in millions)
  Credit Derivative
Liability (Asset), net
 

Beginning Balance

  $ 617,644  
 

Total gains or losses realized and unrealized

       
   

Unrealized gains on credit derivatives

    (38,034 )
   

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

    (117,589 )
   

Current period net effect of purchases, settlements and other activity included in unrealized portion of beginning balance

    124,786  
 

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3

     
       

Ending Balance

  $ 586,807  
       

Gains and losses (realized and unrealized) included in earnings for the period are reported as follows:

       
   

Total realized and unrealized gains included in earnings for the period

  $ (155,623 )
       
   

Change in unrealized gains on credit derivatives still held at the reporting date

  $ (57,492 )
       

        Items in the Company's financial statements measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis and for disclosure purposes only are unearned premiums reserve, senior notes, Series A enhanced junior subordinated debentures and future installment premiums. The fair value of these items as of December 31, 2008 is summarized in the following table.

 
  Fair Value Measurements Using  
(Dollars in millions)
  Fair Value   Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
  Significant Other
Observable Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
  Total Gains
(Losses)
 

Liabilities

                               

Unearned premium reserves

  $ 1,785.8   $   $   $ 1,785.8   $ (552.1 )

Senior Notes

    106.6         106.6         90.9  

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

    37.5         37.5         112.3  
                       
 

Total liabilities

  $ 1,929.9   $   $ 144.1   $ 1,785.8   $ (348.9 )
                       

Off-Balance Sheet Instruments

                               

Future installment premiums

  $ 463.4   $   $ 463.4   $   $  
                       

Unearned Premium Reserves

        The fair value of the Company's unearned premium reserves is based on the estimated cost of entering into a cession of entire financial guaranty insurance portfolio with third party reinsurers under current market conditions. This figure is based on management's estimate of what a similarly rated financial guaranty insurance company would demand to assume the Company's in-force book of financial guaranty insurance business. This amount is based on the pricing assumptions we have

192


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

5. Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Continued)


observed in recent portfolio transfers that have occurred in the financial guaranty market and includes adjustments to the carrying value of unearned premiums reserves for stressed losses and ceding commissions. The significant inputs for stressed losses and ceding commissions are not readily observable inputs, therefore, the Company classified this fair value measurement as Level 3.

Senior Notes and Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

        The fair value of the Company's $200.0 million of Senior Notes and $150.0 million of Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures are determined by calculating the midpoint of quoted bid/ask prices over the U.S. Treasury yield at the year-end date and the appropriate credit spread for similar debt instruments. The significant market inputs used are observable, therefore, the Company classified this fair value measurement as Level 2.

Future Installment Premiums

        The fair value of the Company's installment premiums is derived by calculating the present value of the estimated future cash flow stream for financial guaranty installment premiums discounted at 6.0%. The significant inputs used to fair value this item are observable, therefore, the Company classified this fair value measurement as Level 2.

6. Statutory Accounting Practices

        These consolidated financial statements are prepared on a GAAP basis, which differs in certain respects from accounting practices prescribed or permitted by the insurance regulatory authorities, including the Maryland Insurance Administration, the New York State Insurance Department as well as the statutory requirements of the Bermuda Monetary Authority.

        The Company's U.S. domiciled insurance companies prepare statutory financial statements in accordance with accounting practices prescribed or permitted by the National Association of Insurance Commissioners ("NAIC") and their respective Insurance Departments. Prescribed statutory accounting practices are set forth in the NAIC Accounting Practices and Procedures Manual. There are no permitted accounting practices on a statutory basis. The combined capital and statutory surplus of the Company's U.S. domiciled insurance companies was $408.7 million and $430.5 million as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. The statutory combined net income of the Company's U.S. domiciled insurance companies was $27.6 million, $73.2 million and $66.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

        AG Re, a Bermuda regulated Class 3 insurer and Long-Term insurer, prepares its statutory financial statements in conformity with the accounting principles set forth in The Insurance Act 1978, amendments thereto and Related Regulations. The statutory capital and surplus of AG Re was $1,169.7 million and $1,059.3 million as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. The statutory net income of AG Re was $2.4 million, $78.9 million and $91.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

7. Insurance In Force

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, net financial guaranty par in force, including insured CDS, was approximately $222.7 billion and $200.3 billion, respectively. The portfolio was broadly diversified by payment source, geographic location and maturity schedule, with no single risk representing more than 0.7% and 0.8% of the total net par in force as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

193


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

7. Insurance In Force (Continued)

        The composition of net par in force by bond type was as follows:

 
  As of
December 31,
 
 
  2008   2007  
 
  (in billions of U.S. dollars)
 

U.S. public finance:

             
 

General obligation

  $ 27.0   $ 20.3  
 

Tax-backed

    25.9     17.8  
 

Municipal utilities

    15.6     11.7  
 

Transportation

    12.6     10.0  
 

Healthcare

    11.7     10.4  
 

Higher education

    5.3     3.7  
 

Investor-owned utilities

    2.2     2.3  
 

Housing

    2.0     2.0  
 

Other public finance

    5.0     3.8  
           
   

Total U.S. public finance

    107.3     81.9  
           

U.S. structured finance:

             
 

Pooled corporate obligations

    34.7     33.8  
 

Residential mortgage-backed and home equity

    18.4     18.2  
 

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    5.9     6.0  
 

Consumer receivables

    5.2     6.6  
 

Commercial receivables

    4.9     5.2  
 

Structured credit

    3.3     1.6  
 

Insurance securitizations

    1.6     1.2  
 

Other structured finance

    0.5     1.2  
           
   

Total U.S. structured finance

    74.4     73.8  
           

International:

             
 

Infrastructure and pooled infrastructure

    9.3     11.6  
 

Pooled corporate obligations

    8.4     8.5  
 

Residential mortgage-backed and home equity

    8.2     7.3  
 

Regulated utilities

    7.5     8.3  
 

Commercial receivables

    1.7     1.9  
 

Public finance

    1.7     2.0  
 

Future flow

    1.2     1.1  
 

Insurance securitizations

    1.0     0.9  
 

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    0.8     1.2  
 

Structured credit

    0.4     0.6  
 

Consumer receivables

    0.1     0.4  
 

Other international structured finance

    0.6     0.8  
           
   

Total international

    41.0     44.5  
           
     

Total exposures(1)

  $ 222.7   $ 200.3  
           

(1)
Totals may not add due to rounding.

194


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

7. Insurance In Force (Continued)

        Maturities for U.S. public finance obligations range from 1 to 44 years, with a weighted average life of 16 years. U.S. structured finance transactions have legal maturities that range from 1 to 39 years with a weighted average life of 7 years. International finance transactions have legal maturities that range from 1 to 59 years with a weighted average life of 13 years. CDS transactions are included in all structured finance categories and tax-backed and investor owned utilities categories in public finance.

        The portfolio contained exposures in each of the 50 states and abroad. The distribution of net financial guaranty par outstanding by geographic location is set forth in the following table:

 
  As of December 31, 2008   As of December 31, 2007  
 
  Net par
outstanding
  % of Net par
outstanding
  Net par
outstanding
  % of Net par
outstanding
 
 
  (in billions of U.S. dollars)
 

Domestic:

                         
 

California

  $ 16.2     7.3 % $ 13.1     6.5 %
 

New York

    9.5     4.3 %   7.4     3.7 %
 

Florida

    8.4     3.8 %   6.4     3.2 %
 

Texas

    7.3     3.3 %   4.7     2.4 %
 

Illinois

    5.9     2.7 %   4.2     2.1 %
 

Pennsylvania

    4.6     2.1 %   3.5     1.8 %
 

Massachusetts

    4.4     2.0 %   3.8     1.9 %
 

New Jersey

    4.2     1.9 %   2.6     1.3 %
 

Michigan

    3.1     1.4 %   2.3     1.1 %
 

Washington

    2.9     1.3 %   2.5     1.3 %
 

Other states

    40.8     18.3 %   31.4     15.7 %
 

Mortgage and structured (multiple states)

    74.4     33.4 %   73.8     36.9 %
                   
   

Total domestic exposures

    181.7     81.6 %   155.7     77.8 %
                   

International:

                         
 

United Kingdom

    23.7     10.7 %   25.1     12.5 %
 

Germany

    3.3     1.5 %   4.4     2.2 %
 

Australia

    2.6     1.2 %   3.1     1.5 %
 

Ireland

    0.9     0.4 %   0.8     0.4 %
 

Turkey

    0.8     0.4 %   0.8     0.4 %
 

Other

    9.6     4.3 %   10.3     5.2 %
                   
   

Total international exposures

    41.0     18.4 %   44.5     22.2 %
                   
     

Total exposures(1)

  $ 222.7     100.0 % $ 200.3     100.0 %
                   

(1)
Totals may not add due to rounding.

195


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

7. Insurance In Force (Continued)

        The following table sets forth the net financial guaranty par outstanding by underwriting rating:

 
  As of December 31, 2008   As of December 31, 2007  
Ratings(1)
  Net par outstanding   % of Net par outstanding   Net par outstanding   % of Net par outstanding  
 
  (in billions of U.S. dollars)
 

Super senior

  $ 32.4     14.5 % $ 36.4     18.2 %

AAA

    40.7     18.3 %   47.3     23.6 %

AA

    47.7     21.4 %   38.4     19.2 %

A

    66.0     29.6 %   49.2     24.6 %

BBB

    29.4     13.2 %   26.9     13.4 %

Below investment grade

    6.6     3.0 %   2.1     1.1 %
                   
 

Total exposures(2)

  $ 222.7     100.0 % $ 200.3     100.0 %
                   

(1)
The Company's internal rating. The Company's scale is comparable to that of the nationally recognized rating agencies. The super senior category, which is not generally used by rating agencies, is used by the Company in instances where the Company's AAA-rated exposure has additional credit enhancement due to either (1) the existence of another security rated AAA that is subordinated to the Company's exposure or (2) the Company's exposure benefits from a different form of credit enhancement that would pay any claims first in the event that any of the exposures incurs a loss, and such credit enhancement, in management's opinion, causes the Company's attachment point to be materially above the AAA attachment point.

(2)
Totals may not add due to rounding.

        As part of its financial guaranty business, the Company enters into CDS transactions whereby one party pays a periodic fee in fixed basis points on a notional amount in return for a contingent payment by the other party in the event one or more defined credit events occurs with respect to one or more third party referenced securities or loans. A credit event may be a nonpayment event such as a failure to pay, bankruptcy, or restructuring, as negotiated by the parties to the CDS transaction. The total notional amount of insured CDS exposure outstanding as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 and included in the Company's financial guaranty exposure was $75.1 billion and $71.6 billion, respectively.

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the Company's net mortgage guaranty insurance in force (representing the current principal balance of all mortgage loans currently reinsured) was approximately $0.4 billion and $1.1 billion, respectively, and net risk in force was approximately $0.4 billion and $1.1 billion, respectively. These amounts are not included in the above table.

8. Premiums Earned from Refunded and Called Bonds

        Net earned premiums include $61.9 million, $17.6 million and $11.2 million for 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, related to refunded and called bonds, which reflect the unscheduled pre-payment or refundings of underlying municipal bonds. The increase in 2008 compared to 2007 is primarily a result of greater refundings of municipal auction rate and variable rate debt as reported by the Company's ceding companies. The 2008 year included $1.3 million of public finance refundings in the financial

196


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

8. Premiums Earned from Refunded and Called Bonds (Continued)


guaranty direct segment and $60.6 million of refundings in the financial guaranty reinsurance segment. The 2007 year included $2.8 million of public finance refundings in the financial guaranty direct segment and $14.8 million of refundings in the financial guaranty reinsurance segment. There were no unscheduled refundings in the financial guaranty direct segment in 2006. The unscheduled refundings included in net earned premiums for 2008 and 2006 related to financial guaranty reinsurance segment. These unscheduled refundings are sensitive to market interest rates and other market factors.

9. Investments

        The following table summarizes the Company's aggregate investment portfolio as of December 31, 2008:

 
  Amortized Cost   Gross Unrealized Gains   Gross Unrealized Losses   Estimated Fair Value  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Fixed maturity securities

                         

U.S. government and agencies

  $ 426,592   $ 49,370   $ (36 ) $ 475,926  

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

    1,235,942     33,196     (51,427 )   1,217,711  

Corporate securities

    274,237     5,793     (11,793 )   268,237  

Mortgage-backed securities

    1,081,879     21,772     (51,817 )   1,051,834  

Asset-backed securities

    80,710         (7,144 )   73,566  

Foreign government securities

    50,323     4,173         54,496  

Preferred stock

    12,625         (258 )   12,367  
                   

Total fixed maturity securities

    3,162,308     114,304     (122,475 )   3,154,137  

Short-term investments

    477,197             477,197  
                   

Total investments

  $ 3,639,505   $ 114,304   $ (122,475 ) $ 3,631,334  
                   

197


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

9. Investments (Continued)

        The following table summarizes the Company's aggregate investment portfolio as of December 31, 2007:

 
  Amortized
Cost
  Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Estimated
Fair Value
 
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Fixed maturity securities

                         

U.S. government and agencies

  $ 297,445   $ 13,524   $ (17 ) $ 310,952  

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

    1,043,000     38,612     (2,773 )   1,078,839  

Corporate securities

    179,369     4,759     (1,368 )   182,760  

Mortgage-backed securities

    859,666     9,882     (4,686 )   864,862  

Asset-backed securities

    68,148     341     (82 )   68,407  

Foreign government securities

    71,386     1,694     (18 )   73,062  

Preferred stock

    7,875     197         8,072  
                   

Total fixed maturity securities

    2,526,889     69,009     (8,944 )   2,586,954  

Short-term investments

    552,938             552,938  
                   

Total investments

  $ 3,079,827   $ 69,009   $ (8,944 ) $ 3,139,892  
                   

        Approximately 29% and 28% of the Company's total investment portfolio as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, was composed of mortgage-backed securities, including collateralized mortgage obligations and commercial mortgage-backed securities. As of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007, respectively, approximately 69% and 55% of the Company's total mortgage-backed securities were government agency obligations. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the weighted average credit quality of the Company's entire investment portfolio was AA+ and AAA, respectively. The Company's portfolio is comprised primarily of high-quality, liquid instruments. The Company continues to receive sufficient information to value its investments and has not had to modify its approach due to the current market conditions.

        The amortized cost and estimated fair value of available-for-sale fixed maturity securities as of December 31, 2008, by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.

 
  Amortized
Cost
  Estimated
Fair Value
 
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Due within one year

  $ 28,996   $ 29,473  

Due after one year through five years

    357,054     373,214  

Due after five years through ten years

    564,707     584,828  

Due after ten years

    1,117,047     1,101,421  

Mortgage-backed securities

    1,081,879     1,051,834  

Preferred stock

    12,625     12,367  
           

Total

  $ 3,162,308   $ 3,153,137  
           

198


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

9. Investments (Continued)

        Proceeds from the sale of available-for-sale fixed maturity securities were $532.1 million, $786.6 million and $657.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

        Net realized investment gains (losses) consisted of the following:

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Gains

  $ 5,656   $ 1,984   $ 2,467  

Losses

    (4,189 )   (3,328 )   (4,461 )

Other than temporary impairments

    (71,268 )        
               
 

Net realized investment (losses) gains

  $ (69,801 ) $ (1,344 ) $ (1,994 )
               

        The change in net unrealized gains (losses) of available-for-sale fixed maturity securities consists of:

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Fixed maturity securities

  $ (68,236 ) $ 15,367   $ (6,936 )

Less: Deferred income tax (benefit) expense

    (21,523 )   402     (861 )
               

Change in net unrealized (losses) gains on fixed maturity securities

  $ (46,713 ) $ 14,965   $ (6,075 )
               

        The following tables summarize, for all securities in an unrealized loss position as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, the aggregate fair value and gross unrealized loss by length of time the amounts have continuously been in an unrealized loss position.

 
  As of December 31, 2008  
 
  Less than 12 months   12 months or more   Total  
 
  Fair
value
  Unrealized
loss
  Fair
value
  Unrealized
loss
  Fair
value
  Unrealized
loss
 
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

U.S. government and agencies

  $ 8.0   $   $   $   $ 8.0   $  

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

    479.4     (28.7 )   137.9     (22.7 )   617.3     (51.4 )

Corporate securities

    105.6     (10.2 )   14.2     (1.6 )   119.8     (11.8 )

Mortgage-backed securities

    181.4     (44.5 )   74.4     (7.3 )   255.8     (51.8 )

Asset-backed securities

    73.2     (7.2 )           73.2     (7.2 )

Foreign government securities

                         

Preferred stock

    12.4     (0.3 )           12.4     (0.3 )
                           

Total

  $ 860.0   $ (90.9 ) $ 226.5   $ (31.6 ) $ 1,086.5   $ (122.5 )
                           

199


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

9. Investments (Continued)


 
  As of December 31, 2007  
 
  Less than 12 months   12 months or more   Total  
 
  Fair
value
  Unrealized
loss
  Fair
value
  Unrealized
loss
  Fair
value
  Unrealized
loss
 
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

U.S. government and agencies

  $ 25.4   $   $   $   $ 25.4   $  

Obligations of state and political subdivisions

    190.2     (2.5 )   8.6     (0.3 )   198.8     (2.8 )

Corporate securities

    33.2     (1.1 )   12.8     (0.3 )   46.0     (1.4 )

Mortgage-backed securities

    64.6     (0.7 )   234.3     (3.9 )   298.9     (4.6 )

Asset-backed securities

    5.1         20.1     (0.1 )   25.2     (0.1 )

Foreign government securities

    2.6                 2.6      

Preferred stock

                         
                           

Total

  $ 321.1   $ (4.3 ) $ 275.8   $ (4.6 ) $ 596.9   $ (8.9 )
                           

        The above unrealized loss balances are comprised of 218 and 161 fixed maturity securities as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. The Company has considered factors such as sector credit ratings and industry analyst reports in evaluating the above securities for impairment. As of December 31, 2008, the Company's gross unrealized loss position stood at $122.5 million compared to $8.9 million at December 31, 2007. The $113.6 million increase in gross unrealized losses was primarily attributable to mortgage and asset-backed securities, $54.3 million, municipal securities, $48.6 million, and corporate securities, $10.4 million. The increase in these unrealized losses during the year ended December 31, 2008 was related to the overall illiquidity in the financial markets and resulted in a sudden and severe depressed demand for non-cash investments.

        As of December 31, 2008, the Company had 58 securities in an unrealized loss position for greater than 12 months, representing a gross unrealized loss of $31.6 million. Of these securities, 20 securities had unrealized losses greater than 10% of book value. The total unrealized loss for these securities as of December 31, 2008 was $24.1 million. This unrealized loss is primarily attributable to the market illiquidity and volatility in the U.S. economy mentioned above and not specific to individual issuer credit. Except as noted below, the Company has recognized no other than temporary impairment losses and has the ability and intent to hold these securities until a recovery in value.

        The Company recognized $71.3 million of other than temporary impairment losses substantially related to mortgage-backed and corporate securities for the year ended December 31, 2008 primarily due to the fact that it does not have the intent to hold these securities until there is a recovery in their value. The Company continues to monitor the value of these investments. Future events may result in further impairment of the Company's investments. The Company had no write downs of investments for other than temporary impairment losses for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006.

200


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

9. Investments (Continued)

        Net investment income is derived from the following sources:

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Income from fixed maturity securities

  $ 154,467   $ 123,426   $ 105,886  

Income from short-term investments

    11,578     7,266     7,927  
               

Gross investment income

    166,045     130,692     113,813  

Less: investment expenses

    (3,487 )   (2,600 )   (2,358 )
               

Net investment income

  $ 162,558   $ 128,092   $ 111,455  
               

        Under agreements with its cedants and in accordance with statutory requirements, the Company maintains fixed maturity securities in trust accounts of $1,233.4 million and $936.0 million as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, for the benefit of reinsured companies and for the protection of policyholders, generally in states in which the Company or its subsidiaries, as applicable, are not licensed or accredited.

        Under certain derivative contracts, the Company is required to post eligible securities as collateral, generally cash or U.S. government or agency securities. The need to post collateral under these transactions is generally based on mark-to-market valuation in excess of contractual thresholds. The fair market value of the Company's pledged securities totaled $157.7 million and $0.4 million as of December 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

        The Company is not exposed to significant concentrations of credit risk within its investment portfolio.

        No material investments of the Company were non-income producing for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006.

201


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

10. Reserves for Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses

        The following table provides a reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances of reserves for losses and LAE (certain 2007 and 2006 amounts have been reclassified as discussed in Note 2):

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Balance as of January 1

  $ 125,550   $ 115,857   $ 117,376  

Less reinsurance recoverable

    (8,849 )   (10,889 )   (12,350 )
               

Net balance as of January 1

    116,701     104,968     105,026  

Transfers to case reserves from portfolio reserves

    69,360     10,363     9  

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses pertaining to case and IBNR reserves:

                   
 

Current year

    163,197     8,056     (228 )
 

Prior years

    111,194     (17,716 )   3,248  
               

    274,391     (9,660 )   3,020  

Transfers to case reserves from portfolio reserves

    (69,360 )   (10,363 )   (9 )

Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses pertaining to portfolio reserves

    (8,629 )   15,438     8,303  
               

Total losses and loss adjustment expenses

    265,762     5,778     11,323  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (paid) and recovered pertaining to:

                   
 

Current year

    (90,339 )   (2,637 )   (20 )
 

Prior years

    (169,061 )   7,330     (11,422 )
               

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (paid) recovered

    (259,400 )   4,693     (11,442 )

Change in salvage recoverable, net

    67,420     1,295     42  

Foreign exchange (gain) loss on reserves

    (213 )   (33 )   19  
               

Net balance as of December 31

    190,270     116,701     104,968  

Plus reinsurance recoverable

    6,528     8,849     10,889  
               

Balance as of December 31

  $ 196,798   $ 125,550   $ 115,857  
               

        The difference between the portfolio reserve transferred to case reserves and the ultimate case reserve recorded is included in current year incurred amounts.

        The financial guaranty case basis reserves have been discounted using the taxable equivalent yield on our investment portfolio, which approximated 6% in 2008, 2007 and 2006, resulting in a discount of $(8.7) million, $3.9 million and $9.6 million, respectively.

        The unfavorable current and prior year development in 2008 of is primarily due to incurred losses related to our U.S. RMBS exposures as well as other real estate related exposures. Additionally, during 2008 case reserves were established for two public finance transactions (see "Significant Risk Management Activities" note for further detail).

202


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

10. Reserves for Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses (Continued)

        The favorable prior year development in 2007 of $17.7 million is primarily due to $8.6 million of loss recoveries, $5.0 million reduction in case reserves and $4.3 million increase in salvage reserves for aircraft related transactions, reported to us by our cedant. These losses were incurred in 2002 and 2006.

        Losses and loss adjustment expenses paid (received), were $259.4 million, $(4.7) million and $11.4 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006. The loss payments of $259.4 million in 2008 are related to several HELOC and Closed-End Second transactions, as these transactions have experienced significant deterioration during the year. The loss recovery of $4.7 million in 2007 was mainly a result of loss recoveries of $8.6 million from two aircraft related transactions in which claims were paid in 2002 and 2006. These recoveries were partially offset by loss payments related to assumed U.S. home equity line of credit exposures. The loss payments of $11.4 million in 2006 were related to a U.S. Infrastructure transaction and a European Infrastructure transaction.

11. Significant Risk Management Activities

        The Risk Oversight and Audit Committees of the Board of Directors oversees our risk management policies and procedures. Within the limits established by the board committees, specific risk policies and limits are set by the Portfolio Risk Management Committee, which includes members of senior management and senior Credit and Surveillance officers. As part of its risk management strategy, the Company may seek to obtain third party reinsurance or retrocessions and may also periodically enter into other arrangements to alleviate all or a portion of this risk.

        Risk Management and Surveillance personnel are responsible for monitoring and reporting on all transactions in the insured portfolio, including exposures in both the Direct and Reinsurance segments. The primary objective of the surveillance process is to monitor trends and changes in transaction credit quality, detect any deterioration in credit quality, and take such remedial actions as may be necessary or appropriate. All transactions in the insured portfolio are risk rated, and surveillance personnel are responsible for adjusting those ratings to reflect changes in transaction credit quality. Surveillance personnel are also responsible for managing work-out and loss situations when necessary. For transactions where a loss is considered probable, surveillance personnel make recommendations on case loss reserves to a Reserve Committee. The Reserve Committee is made up of the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Surveillance Officer, General Counsel and Chief Accounting Officer. The Reserve Committee considers the recommendations of the surveillance personnel when reviewing reserve recommendations of our operating subsidiaries.

Direct Businesses

        We conduct surveillance procedures to track risk aggregations and monitor performance of each risk. The review cycle and scope vary based upon transaction type and credit quality. In general, the review process includes the collection and analysis of information from various sources, including trustee and servicer reports, financial statements and reports, general industry or sector news and analyses, and rating agency reports. For Public Finance risks, the surveillance process includes monitoring general economic trends, developments with respect to state and municipal finances, and the financial situation of the issuers. For Structured Finance transactions, the surveillance process can include monitoring transaction performance data and cash flows, compliance with transaction terms and

203


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

11. Significant Risk Management Activities (Continued)


conditions, and evaluation of servicer or collateral manager performance and financial condition. Additionally, the Company uses various quantitative tools and models to assess transaction performance and identify situations where there may have been a change in credit quality. For all transactions, surveillance activities may include discussions with or site visits to issuers, servicers or other parties to a transaction.

Reinsurance Businesses

        For transactions in the Company's Reinsurance segment, the primary insurers are responsible for conducting ongoing surveillance, and our surveillance personnel monitor the activities of the primary insurers through a variety of means, such as review of surveillance reports provided by the primary insurers, and meetings and discussions with their analysts. Our surveillance personnel take steps to ensure that the primary insurer is managing risk pursuant to the terms of the applicable reinsurance agreement. To this end, we conduct periodic reviews of ceding companies' surveillance activities and capabilities. That process may include the review of the primary insurer's underwriting, surveillance, and claim files for certain transactions. In the event of credit deterioration of a particular exposure, more frequent reviews of the ceding company's risk mitigation activities are conducted. Our surveillance personnel also monitor general news and information, industry trends, and rating agency reports to help focus surveillance activities on sectors or credits of particular concern. For certain exposures, we also will undertake an independent analysis and remodeling of the transaction.

Closely Monitored Credits

        The Company's surveillance department is responsible for monitoring our portfolio of credits and maintains a list of closely monitored credits ("CMC"). The closely monitored credits are divided into four categories:

        The closely monitored credits include all below investment grade ("BIG") exposures where there is a material amount of exposure (generally greater than $10.0 million) or a material risk of the Company incurring a loss greater than $0.5 million. The closely monitored credits also include investment grade ("IG") risks where credit quality is deteriorating and where, in the view of the Company, there is significant potential that the risk quality will fall below investment grade. As of December 31, 2008, the closely monitored credits include approximately 99% of our BIG exposure, and the remaining BIG exposure of $92.3 million is distributed across 89 different credits. Other than those excluded BIG credits, credits that are not included in the closely monitored credit list are categorized as fundamentally sound risks.

204


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

11. Significant Risk Management Activities (Continued)

        The following table provides financial guaranty net par outstanding by credit monitoring category as of December 31, 2008 (dollars in millions):

 
  Closely Monitored Credit categories    
 
 
  Category 1   Category 2   Category 3   Category 4   Total  

Number of policies

    53     33     107     4     197  

Remaining weighted-average contract period (in years)

    15.8     17.3     12.7     8.2     14.1  

Insured contractual payments outstanding:

                               
 

Principal

  $ 1,101.9   $ 670.9   $ 2,832.1   $ 19.7   $ 4,624.6  
 

Interest

    836.5     308.7     976.5     5.7     2,127.4  
                       
   

Total

  $ 1,938.4   $ 979.6   $ 3,808.6   $ 25.4   $ 6,752.0  
                       

Gross reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses

  $ 0.2   $ 1.2   $ 162.5   $ 24.6   $ 188.5  

Less:

                               
 

Gross potential recoveries

            (0.9 )       (0.9 )
 

Discount, net

            65.3     4.2     69.5  
                       

Net reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses

  $ 0.2   $ 1.2   $ 98.1   $ 20.4   $ 119.9  
                       

Reinsurance recoverable

  $   $   $   $   $  
                       

        The Company's loss adjustment expenses for mitigating claim liabilities were $1.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2008.

        In accordance with FAS 163, the above table includes financial guaranty contracts written in insurance form. It does not include financial guaranty contracts written in CDS form, mortgage guaranty insurance or the Company's other lines of insurance.

        The Company insures various types of residential mortgage-backed securitizations ("RMBS"). Such transactions may include obligations backed by closed-end first mortgage loans and closed and open-end second mortgage loans or home equity loans on one-to-four family residential properties, including condominiums and cooperative apartments. An RMBS transaction where the underlying collateral is comprised of revolving home equity lines of credit is generally referred to as a "HELOC" transaction. In general, the collateral supporting HELOC securitizations are second lien loans made to prime borrowers. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had net par outstanding of $1.7 billion related to HELOC securitizations, of which $1.2 billion were written in the Company's financial guaranty direct segment. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had net par outstanding of $1.5 billion for transactions with Countrywide, of which $1.1 billion were written in the Company's financial guaranty direct segment ("direct Countrywide transactions" or "Countrywide 2005-J" and "Countrywide 2007-D"). As of December 31, 2007, the Company had net par outstanding of $2.4 billion related to HELOC securitizations, of which $2.1 billion were transactions with Countrywide.

        The performance of our HELOC exposures deteriorated during 2007 and 2008 and transactions, particularly those originated in the period from 2005 through 2007, continue to perform below our

205


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

11. Significant Risk Management Activities (Continued)


original underwriting expectations. In accordance with its standard practice, during the year ended December 31, 2008, we evaluated the most currently available information, including trends in delinquencies and charge-offs on the underlying loans, draw rates on the lines of credit, and the servicer's ability to fulfill its contractual obligations including its obligation to fund additional draws. The key assumptions used in our analysis of potential case loss reserves on the direct Countrywide transactions are presented in the following table:

Key Variables
   

Constant payment rate (CPR)

  3-month average, 7–8% as of December 31, 2008

Constant default rate (CDR)

 

6-month average CDR of approximately 19–21% during months 1-9, declining to 1.0% at the end of month 15. From months 16 onward, a 1.0% CDR is assumed.

Draw rate

 

3-month average, 1–2% as of December 31, 2008

Excess spread

 

250 bps per annum

Repurchases of Ineligible loans by Countrywide

 

$49.3 million; or approximately 2.1% of original pool balance of $2.4 billion

Loss Severity

 

100%

        In recent periods, CDR, CPR, Draw Rates and delinquency percentages have fluctuated within ranges that we believe make it appropriate to use rolling averages to project future performance. Accordingly, the Company is using modeling assumptions that are based upon or which approximate recent actual historical performance to project future performance and potential losses. During 2008, the Company extended the time frame during which it expects the CDR to remain elevated. The Company also revised its assumptions with respect to the overall shape of the default and loss curves. Among other things, these changes assume that a higher proportion of projected defaults will occur over the near term. This revision was based upon management's judgment that a variety of factors including the deterioration of U.S. economic conditions could lead to a longer period in which default rates remain high. The Company continues to model sensitivities around the results booked using a variety of CDR rates and stress periods as well as other modeling approaches including roll rates and hybrid roll rate/CDR methods.

        As a result of this modeling and analysis, the Company incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses of $111.0 million for its direct Countrywide transactions during 2008. The Company's cumulative incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses on the direct Countrywide transactions as of December 31, 2008 were $111.0 million ($87.2 million after-tax). During 2008, the Company paid losses and loss adjustment expenses for its direct Countrywide transactions of $170.0 million, of which we expect to recover $59.0 million from the receipt of excess spread from future cash flows as well as funding of future draws. This amount of $59.0 million is included in "salvage recoverable" on the balance sheet.

206


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

11. Significant Risk Management Activities (Continued)


There were no incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses or salvage recoverable amounts on these transactions in 2007.

        For the year ended December 31, 2008, the Company incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses of $168.1 million for its HELOC exposures. Of this amount, $130.0 million related to the Company's financial guaranty direct segment, including $111.0 million of incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses for the direct Countrywide transactions. The remaining $38.1 million of incurred loss and loss adjustment expenses related to the Company's assumed HELOC exposures in its financial guaranty reinsurance segment.

        The ultimate performance of the Company's HELOC transactions will depend on many factors, such as the level and timing of loan defaults, interest proceeds generated by the securitized loans, repayment speeds and changes in home prices, as well as the levels of credit support built into each transaction. Other factors also may have a material impact upon the ultimate performance of each transaction, including the ability of the seller and servicer to fulfill all of their contractual obligations including its obligation to fund future draws on lines of credit, as well as the amount of benefit received from repurchases of ineligible loans by Countrywide. The variables affecting transaction performance are interrelated, difficult to predict and subject to considerable volatility. If actual results differ materially from any of our assumptions, the losses incurred could be materially different from our estimate. We continue to update our evaluation of these exposures as new information becomes available.

        A summary of the Company's exposure to these two deals and their actual performance statistics through December 31, 2008 are as follows:

($ in millions)
  Countrywide 2005J   Countrywide 2007D  

Original principal balance

  $ 1,500   $ 900  

Remaining principal balance

  $ 520.3   $ 621.3  

Cumulative losses (% of original principal balance)(1)

    10.6 %   14.3 %

Total delinquencies (% of current balance)(2)

    16.9 %   13.9 %

Average initial FICO score of borrowers(3)

    709     712  

Interest margin over prime(4)

    2.0 %   1.8 %

Revolving period(5)

    10     10  

Repayment period(6)

    15     15  

Average draw rate(7)

    1.6 %   1.8 %

Average constant payment rate(8)

    7.2 %   7.5 %

Excess spread(9)

    329   bps   324   bps

(1)
Cumulative collateral losses expressed as a percentage of the original deal balance.

(2)
Total delinquencies (loans >30 days past due) as a percentage of the current deal balance.

(3)
Fair Isaacs and Company score is a measurement designed to indicate the credit quality of a borrower.

(4)
Floating rate charged to borrowers above the prime rate.

207


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

11. Significant Risk Management Activities (Continued)

(5)
Time period (usually 5–10 years) in which the borrower may draw funds from their HELOC.

(6)
Time period (usually 10–20 years) in which the borrower must repay the funds withdrawn from the HELOC.

(7)
Represents the three-month average draw rate as of December 2008.

(8)
Represents the three-month average constant payment rate as of December 2008.

(9)
Excess spread during December 2008.

        Another type of RMBS transaction is generally referred to as "Subprime RMBS". The collateral supporting such transactions is comprised of first-lien residential mortgage loans made to subprime borrowers. A "subprime borrower" is one considered to be a higher risk credit based on credit scores or other risk characteristics. As of December 31, 2008, we had net par outstanding of $6.6 billion related to Subprime RMBS securitizations, of which $483 million is classified by us as Below Investment Grade risk. Of the total U.S. Subprime RMBS exposure of $6.6 billion, $6.1 billion is from transactions issued in the period from 2005 through 2007 and written in our direct financial guaranty segment. As of December 31, 2008, we had portfolio reserves of $8.8 million and case reserves of $7.8 million related to our $6.6 billion U.S. Subprime RMBS exposure, of which $6.9 million were portfolio reserves related to our $6.1 billion exposure in the direct financial guaranty segment for transactions issued from 2005 through 2007.

        The problems affecting the subprime mortgage market have been widely reported, with rising delinquencies, defaults and foreclosures negatively impacting the performance of Subprime RMBS transactions. Those concerns relate primarily to Subprime RMBS issued in the period from 2005 through 2007. The $6.1 billion exposure that we have to such transactions in our direct financial guaranty segment benefits from various structural protections, including credit enhancement that on average currently equals approximately 54.3% of the remaining principal balance of the transactions.

        We also have exposure of $433.1 million to Closed-End Second ("CES") RMBS transactions, of which $424.2 million is in the direct segment. As with other types of RMBS, we have seen significant deterioration in the performance of our CES transactions. On two transactions, which had exposure of $185.0 million, during 2008 we have seen a significant increase in delinquencies and collateral losses, which resulted in erosion of the Company's credit enhancement and the payment of claims totaling $16.2 million. Based on the Company's analysis of these transaction and their projected collateral losses, the Company had case reserves of $37.7 million as of December 31, 2008. Additionally, as of December 31, 2008, the Company had portfolio reserves of $0.1 million in its financial guaranty direct segment and no case or portfolio reserves in its financial guaranty reinsurance segment related to its U.S. Closed-End Second RMBS exposure.

        Another type of RMBS transaction is generally referred to as "Alt-A RMBS". The collateral supporting such transactions is comprised of first-lien residential mortgage loans made to prime quality borrowers that lack certain ancillary characteristics that would make them prime. Included in this category is Alt-A Option ARMs, which include transactions where 66% or more of the collateral is comprised of mortgage loans that have the potential to negatively amortize. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had net par outstanding of $7.6 billion related to Alt-A RMBS securitizations. Of that amount, $7.5 billion is from transactions issued in the period from 2005 through 2007 and written in

208


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

11. Significant Risk Management Activities (Continued)


the Company's financial guaranty direct segment. As of December 31, 2008, the Company had portfolio reserves of $6.5 million and case reserves of $1.5 million related to its $7.6 billion Alt-A RMBS exposure, in the financial guaranty direct and reinsurance segments, respectively.

        The ultimate performance of the Company's RMBS transactions remains highly uncertain and may be subject to considerable volatility due to the influence of many factors, including the level and timing of loan defaults, changes in housing prices and other variables. The Company will continue to monitor the performance of its RMBS exposures and will adjust the risk ratings of those transactions based on actual performance and management's estimates of future performance.

        The Company has exposure on two life insurance reserve securitization transactions based on two discrete blocks of individual life insurance business reinsured by Scottish Re (U.S.) Inc. ("Scottish Re"). The two transactions relate to Ballantyne Re p.l.c. ("Ballantyne") (gross exposure of $500 million) and Orkney Re II, p.l.c. ("Orkney II") (gross exposure of $423 million). Under both transactions, monies raised through the issuance of the insured notes support present and future U.S. statutory life insurance reserve requirements. The monies were invested at inception of each transaction in accounts managed by a large, well-known investment manager. However, those investment accounts have incurred substantial mark-to-market losses since mid-year 2007, principally as a result of their exposure to subprime and Alt-A RMBS transactions. Largely as a result of these mark-to-market losses both we and the rating agencies have downgraded our exposure to both Ballantyne and Orkney II to below investment grade. As regards the Ballantyne transaction, the Company is working with the directing guarantor, who has insured exposure of $900 million, to remediate the risk. On the Orkney Re II transaction, the Company, as directing financial guarantor, is taking remedial action.

        Some credit losses have been realized on the securities in the Ballantyne and Orkney Re II portfolios and significant additional credit losses are expected to occur. Performance of the underlying blocks of life insurance business thus far generally has been in accordance with expectations. The combination of cash flows from the investment accounts and the treaty settlements currently is sufficient to cover interest payments due on the notes that we insure. Adverse treaty performance and/or a rise in credit losses on the invested assets are expected to lead to interest shortfalls. Additionally, the transactions also contain features linked to the market values of the invested assets, reserve funding requirements on the underlying blocks of life insurance business, and minimum capital requirements for the transactions themselves that may trigger a shut off of interest payments to the insured notes and thereby result in claim payments by the Company.

        Another key risk is that the occurrence of certain events may result in a situation where either Ballantyne and/or Orkney Re II are required to sell assets and potentially realize substantial investment losses and for Assured Guaranty Ltd. to incur corresponding insured losses ahead of the scheduled final maturity date. For example, cedants to Scottish Re may have the right to recapture blocks of life insurance business which Scottish Re has ceded to Orkney Re II. Such recaptures could require Orkney Re II to sell assets and realize investment losses. In the Ballantyne transaction, further declines in the market value of the invested assets and/or an increase in the reserve funding requirements could lead to a similar mandatory realization of investment losses and for Assured Guaranty Ltd. to incur corresponding insured losses ahead of the scheduled final maturity date.

209


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

11. Significant Risk Management Activities (Continued)

        In order for the Company to incur an ultimate net loss on these transactions, adverse experience on the underlying block of life insurance policies and/or credit losses in the investment portfolio would need to exceed the level of credit enhancement built into the transaction structures. Based on its analysis of the information currently available, including estimates of future investment performance, projected credit impairments on the invested assets and performance of the blocks of life insurance business, at December 31, 2008, the Company established a case reserve of $17.2 million for the Ballantyne transaction. The Company has not established a case loss reserve for the Orkney Re II transaction.

        On December 19, 2008, the Company sued J.P. Morgan Investment Management Inc. ("JPMIM"), the investment manager in the Orkney II transaction, in New York Supreme Court alleging that JPMIM engaged in breaches of fiduciary duty, gross negligence and breaches of contract based upon its handling of the investments of Orkney Re II. JPMIM requested and was given an extension of time to answer until the end of February.

        The Company has exposure to a public finance transaction for sewer service in Jefferson County, Alabama through several reinsurance treaties. The Company's total exposure to this transaction is approximately $456 million as of December 31, 2008. The Company has made debt service payments during the year and expects to make additional payments in the near term. Through our cedants, the Company is currently in discussions with the bond issuer to structure a solution, which may result in some or all of these payments being recoverable. A case reserve of $6.0 million has been established as of December 31, 2008.

12. Income Taxes

        The Company and its Bermuda Subsidiaries are not subject to any income, withholding or capital gains taxes under current Bermuda law. The Company has received an assurance from the Minister of Finance in Bermuda that, in the event of any taxes being imposed, the Company and its Bermuda Subsidiaries will be exempt from taxation in Bermuda until March 28, 2016.

        The Company's U.S. subsidiaries are subject to income taxes imposed by U.S. authorities and file U.S. tax returns.

        Prior to the IPO in April 2004, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. ("AGUS"), Assured Guaranty Corp. ("AGC"), Assured Value Insurance Company ("AVIC"), an AGC subsidiary prior to its merger into AGC in December 2006, AG Financial Products Inc. ("AGFP") and AFP Transferor Inc. ("AFP") had historically filed their U.S. income tax returns in the consolidated U.S. tax return of its former shareholder. For periods after April 2004, AGUS and its subsidiaries, AGC, AVIC (prior to merger into AGC in December 2006), AGFP and AFP (for the period ended May 18, 2005) file a consolidated federal income tax return. Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. ("AGOUS") and its subsidiaries, Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. ("AGRO"), Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company and AG Intermediary Inc., have historically filed a consolidated federal income tax return. AGRO, a Bermuda domiciled company, has elected under Section 953(d) of the Internal Revenue Code to be taxed as a U.S. domestic corporation. Each company, as a member of its respective consolidated tax return group, has paid its proportionate share of the consolidated federal tax burden

210


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

12. Income Taxes (Continued)


for its group as if each company filed on a separate return basis with current period credit for net losses.

        The following table provides the Company's income tax (benefit) provision and effective tax rates:

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Current tax (benefit) provision

  $ 332   $ 12,383   $ 18,644  

Deferred tax provision (benefit)

    43,116     (172,136 )   11,596  
               

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

  $ 43,448   $ (159,753 ) $ 30,240  
               

Effective tax rate

    38.7 %   34.5 %   15.9 %

        The change in the effective tax rate from year to year is primarily due changes in the proportion of pre tax income earned in different tax jurisdictions at varying statutory rates.

        Reconciliation of the difference between the provision for income taxes and the expected tax provision at statutory rates in taxable jurisdictions was as follows:

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Expected tax provision at statutory rates in taxable jurisdictions

  $ 59,961   $ (135,905 ) $ 42,494  

Tax-exempt interest

    (16,272 )   (13,362 )   (11,642 )

Change in FIN 48 liability

    2,306     (10,150 )    

Other

    (2,547 )   (336 )   (612 )
               

Total provision for income taxes

  $ 43,448   $ (159,753 ) $ 30,240  
               

211


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

12. Income Taxes (Continued)

        The deferred income tax asset (liability) reflects the tax effect of the following temporary differences:

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Deferred tax assets:

             
 

Unrealized losses on derivative financial instruments

  $ 116,537   $ 168,920  
 

Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses

    15,787     15,759  
 

Tax and loss bonds

    23,857     18,857  
 

Net operating loss carry forward

    17,070     19,189  
 

Alternative minimum tax credit

    727     727  
 

Tax basis step-up

    8,401     9,148  
 

Unrealized depreciation on investments

    4,263      
 

Credit derivative assets/liabilities

    16,558     6,376  
 

Other

    17,859     7,990  
           

Total deferred income tax assets

    221,059     246,966  
           

Deferred tax liabilities:

             
 

Deferred acquisition costs

    36,495     39,975  
 

Unearned premium reserves

    3,965     11,700  
 

Contingency reserves

    24,358     17,697  
 

Unrealized appreciation on investments

        17,320  
 

Unrealized gains on committed capital securities

    17,872     2,911  
 

Other

    2,251     2,800  
           

Total deferred income tax liabilities

    84,941     92,403  
           
   

Valuation allowance

    7,000     7,000  
           

Net deferred income tax asset

  $ 129,118   $ 147,563  
           

        As of December 31, 2008, AGRO had a standalone net operating loss carry forward ("NOL") of $47.9 million, compared with $54.8 million as of December 31, 2007, which is available to offset its future U.S. taxable income. The Company has $27.2 million of this NOL available through 2017 and $20.7 million available through 2023. AGRO's stand alone NOL is not permitted to offset the income of any other members of AGRO's consolidated group. Under applicable accounting rules, we are required to establish a valuation allowance for NOLs that we believe are more likely than not to expire before being utilized. Management has assessed the likelihood of realization of all of its deferred tax assets. Based on this analysis, management believes it is more likely than not that $20.0 million of AGRO's $47.9 million NOL will not be utilized before it expires and has established a $7.0 million valuation allowance related to the NOL deferred tax asset. Management believes that all other deferred income taxes are more-likely-than-not to be realized. The valuation allowance is subject to considerable judgment, is reviewed quarterly and will be adjusted to the extent actual taxable income differs from estimates of future taxable income that may be used to realize NOLs or capital losses.

212


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

12. Income Taxes (Continued)

Taxation of Subsidiaries

        The Company's Bermuda subsidiaries are not subject to any income, withholding or capital gains taxes under current Bermuda law. The Company's U.S. and U.K. subsidiaries are subject to income taxes imposed by U.S. and U.K. authorities and file applicable tax returns. In addition, AGRO, a Bermuda domiciled company, has elected under Section 953(d) of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code to be taxed as a U.S. domestic corporation.

        The U.S. Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") has completed audits of all of the Company's U.S. subsidiaries' federal income tax returns for taxable years through 2001. In September 2007, the IRS completed its audit of tax years 2002 through 2004 for Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries, which includes Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc., AGRO, Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company and AG Intermediary Inc. As a result of the audit there were no significant findings and no cash settlements with the IRS. In addition the IRS is reviewing AGUS for tax years 2002 through the date of the IPO. AGUS includes Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., AGC and AG Financial Products and were part of the consolidated tax return of a subsidiary of ACE, for years prior to the IPO. The Company is indemnified by ACE for any potential tax liability associated with the tax examination of AGUS as it relates to years prior to the IPO. In addition, tax years 2005 and subsequent remain open.

Uncertain Tax Positions

        The Company adopted the provisions of FASB Interpretation No. 48, "Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes—an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109" ("FIN 48"), on January 1, 2007. As a result of the adoption of FIN 48, the Company reduced its liability for unrecognized tax benefits and increased retained earnings by $2.6 million. The total liability for unrecognized tax benefits as of January 1, 2007 was $12.9 million. This entire amount, if recognized, would affect the effective tax rate.

        Subsequent to the adoption of FIN 48, the IRS published final regulations on the treatment of consolidated losses. As a result of these regulations the utilization of certain capital losses is no longer at a level that would require recording an associated liability for an uncertain tax position. As such, the Company decreased its liability for unrecognized tax benefits and its provision for income taxes $4.1 million during the period ended March 31, 2007. In September 2007, upon completion of the IRS audit of Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries, the liability for unrecognized tax benefits was reduced by approximately $6.0 million. The total liability for unrecognized tax benefits as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 was $5.1 million and $2.8 million, respectively, and are included in other liabilities on the balance sheet. During the year ended December 31, 2008 the net liability of $2.8 million as of December 31, 2007 increased by approximately $2.3 million due to a position management intends to take on the Company's 2008 tax return. The Company does not believe it is reasonably possible that this amount will change significantly in the next twelve months.

        The Company's policy is to recognize interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions in income tax expense. As of the date of adoption, the Company has accrued $0.9 million in interest and penalties.

213


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

12. Income Taxes (Continued)

        The following table provides a reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances of the total liability for unrecognized tax benefits recorded under FIN 48:

(in thousands of U.S. dollars)
   
 

Balance as of January 1, 2008

  $ 2,795  

Increase in unrecognized tax benefits as a result of position taken during the current period

    2,306  
       

Balance as of December 31, 2008

  $ 5,101  
       

Liability For Tax Basis Step-Up Adjustment

        In connection with the IPO, the Company and ACE Financial Services Inc. ("AFS"), a subsidiary of ACE, entered into a tax allocation agreement, whereby the Company and AFS made a "Section 338 (h)(10)" election that has the effect of increasing the tax basis of certain affected subsidiaries' tangible and intangible assets to fair value. Future tax benefits that the Company derives from the election will be payable to AFS when realized by the Company.

        As a result of the election, the Company has adjusted its net deferred tax liability, to reflect the new tax basis of the Company's affected assets. The additional basis is expected to result in increased future income tax deductions and, accordingly, may reduce income taxes otherwise payable by the Company. Any tax benefit realized by the Company will be paid to AFS. Such tax benefits will generally be calculated by comparing the Company's affected subsidiaries' actual taxes to the taxes that would have been owed by those subsidiaries had the increase in basis not occurred. After a 15 year period, to the extent there remains an unrealized tax benefit, the Company and AFS will negotiate a settlement of the unrealized benefit based on the expected realization at that time.

        The Company initially recorded a $49.0 million reduction of its existing deferred tax liability, based on an estimate of the ultimate resolution of the Section 338(h)(10) election. Under the tax allocation agreement, the Company estimated that, as of the IPO date, it was obligated to pay $20.9 million to AFS and accordingly established this amount as a liability. The initial difference, which is attributable to the change in the tax basis of certain liabilities for which there is no associated step-up in the tax basis of its assets and no amounts due to AFS, resulted in an increase to additional paid-in capital of $28.1 million. As of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007, the liability for tax basis step-up adjustment, which is included in the Company's balance sheets in "Other liabilities," was $9.1 million and $9.9 million, respectively. The Company has paid ACE and correspondingly reduced its liability by $0.7 million and $5.1 million in 2008 and 2007, respectively.

Tax Treatment of CDS

        The Company treats the guaranty it provides on CDS as insurance contracts for tax purposes and as such a taxable loss does not occur until the Company expects to make a loss payment to the buyer of credit protection based upon the occurrence of one or more specified credit events with respect to the contractually referenced obligation or entity. The Company holds its CDS to maturity, at which time any unrealized mark to market loss would revert to zero absent any credit related losses. As of

214


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

12. Income Taxes (Continued)


December 31, 2008, the Company did not anticipate any significant credit related losses on its credit default swaps and, therefore, no resultant tax deductions.

        The tax treatment of CDS is an unsettled area of the law. The uncertainty relates to the IRS's determination of the income or potential loss associated with CDS as either subject to capital gain (loss) or ordinary income (loss) treatment. In treating CDS as insurance contracts the Company treats both the receipt of premium and payment of losses as ordinary income and believes it is more likely than not that any CDS credit related losses will be treated as ordinary by the IRS. To the extent the IRS takes the view that the losses are capital losses in the future and the Company incurred actual losses associated with the CDS the Company would need sufficient taxable income of the same character within the carryback and carryforward period available under the tax law.

        As of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 the deferred tax assets associated with CDS were $116.5 million and $168.9 million, respectively. The Company came to the conclusion that it is more likely than not that its deferred tax asset related to CDS will be fully realized after weighing all positive and negative evidence available as required under FAS 109. The evidence that was considered included the following:

        Positive Evidence

215


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

12. Income Taxes (Continued)

        After examining all of the available positive and negative evidence, the Company believes that no valuation allowance is necessary in connection with the deferred tax asset. The Company will continue to analyze the need for a valuation allowance on a quarter to quarter basis.

13. Analysis of Premiums Written, Premiums Earned And Loss And Loss Adjustment Expenses

        The Company enters into reinsurance agreements with non-affiliated companies to limit its exposure to risk on an on-going basis. In the event that any or all of the reinsurers are unable to meet their obligations, the Company would be liable for such defaulted amounts. Direct, assumed, and ceded premium and loss and loss adjustment expense amounts for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 were as follows (2007 and 2006 amounts have been reclassified as discussed in Note 2):

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Premiums Written

                   
 

Direct

  $ 484,727   $ 167,228   $ 124,864  
 

Assumed

    133,543     257,318     136,408  
 

Ceded

    (13,714 )   (16,576 )   (5,452 )
               
 

Net

  $ 604,556   $ 407,970   $ 255,820  
               

Premiums Earned

                   
 

Direct

  $ 93,406   $ 54,958   $ 28,523  
 

Assumed

    176,332     111,925     126,666  
 

Ceded

    (8,340 )   (7,624 )   (10,386 )
               
 

Net

  $ 261,398   $ 159,259   $ 144,803  
               

216


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

13. Analysis of Premiums Written, Premiums Earned And Loss And Loss Adjustment Expenses (Continued)

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

                   
 

Direct

  $ 199,027   $ 29,206   $ 2,603  
 

Assumed

    64,890     (24,615 )   9,660  
 

Ceded

    1,845     1,187     (940 )
               
 

Net

  $ 265,762   $ 5,778   $ 11,323  
               

        Reinsurance recoverable on ceded losses and LAE as of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007 were $6.5 million and $8.8 million, respectively, and are mainly related to the Company's other segment. In the event that any or all of the reinsurers are unable to meet their obligations, the Company would be liable for such defaulted amounts. Of these amounts, $4.8 million and $8.8 million, respectively, relate to reinsurance agreements with ACE.

Agreement with CIFG Assurance North America, Inc.

        AGC entered into an agreement with CIFG Assurance North America, Inc. ("CIFG") to assume a diversified portfolio of financial guaranty contracts totaling approximately $13.3 billion of net par outstanding. The Company closed the transaction in January 2009 and received $75.6 million, which included $85.7 million of upfront premiums net of ceding commissions, and approximately $12.2 million of future installments related to this transaction.

XLFA Commutation

        Effective July 25, 2008, AG Re commuted its $2.1 billion portfolio of business assumed from XLFA for a payment of $18.0 million, which included returning $14.6 million of unearned premium, net of ceding commissions, and loss reserves of $5.2 million, resulting in a net gain to the Company of $1.8 million.

Agreement with Ambac Assurance Corporation

        On December 13, 2007, AG Re reinsured a diversified portfolio of financial guaranty contracts totaling approximately $29 billion of net par outstanding from Ambac Assurance Corporation ("Ambac"), a subsidiary of Ambac Financial Group, Inc. The ceded contracts are entirely in financial guaranty form and contain no CDS contracts. The portfolio was reinsured under AG Re's existing master facultative reinsurance agreement with Ambac. In addition, effective November 15, 2007 AG Re agreed to provide reinsurance under the terms of Ambac's current surplus share treaty program that expires March 31, 2008. Ambac has also agreed to offer AG Re the opportunity to provide reinsurance under the terms of Ambac's surplus share treaty programs that commence April 1, 2008, 2009 and 2010, if Ambac maintains its reinsurance program in those periods.

217


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

14. Insurance Regulations

        AGC is a Maryland domiciled insurance company and a subsidiary of the Company. Under Maryland's 1993 revised insurance law, the amount of surplus available for distribution as dividends is subject to certain statutory provisions, which generally prohibit the payment of dividends in any twelve-month period in an aggregate amount exceeding the lesser of 10% of surplus or net investment income (at the preceding December 31) without prior approval of the Maryland Commissioner of Insurance. The amount available for distribution from the Company during 2009 with notice to, but without prior approval of, the Maryland Commissioner of Insurance under the Maryland insurance law is approximately $37.8 million. During the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, AGC declared and paid $16.5 million, $12.1 million and $13.8 million, respectively, in dividends to AGUS. Under Maryland insurance regulations, AGC is required at all times to maintain a minimum surplus of $750,000.

        AG Re's and AGRO's dividend distribution are governed by Bermuda law. Under Bermuda law, dividends may only be paid if there are reasonable grounds for believing that the Company is, or would after the payment be, able to pay its liabilities as they become due and if the realizable value of its assets would thereby not be less than the aggregate of its liabilities and issued share capital and share premium accounts. Distributions to shareholders may also be paid out of statutory capital, but are subject to a 15% limitation without prior approval of the Bermuda Monetary Authority. Dividends are limited by requirements that the subject company must at all times (i) maintain the minimum solvency margin required under the Insurance Act of 1978 and (ii) have relevant assets in an amount at least equal to 75% of relevant liabilities, both as defined under the Insurance Act of 1978. The amount available at AG Re to pay dividends in 2009 in compliance with Bermuda law is $1,125.0 million. However, any distribution which results in a reduction of 15% of more of AG Re's total statutory capital, as set out in its previous year's financial statements, would require the prior approval of the Bermuda Monetary Authority. During 2008, AG Re declared and paid dividends of $31.3 million to its parent, Assured Guaranty Ltd. During 2007 and 2006, AG Re declared dividends of $36.0 million and paid $35.3 million, and $46.5 million and paid $42.6 million, respectively.

218


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

15. Related Party Transactions

        In 2004 the Company entered into reinsurance transactions with ACE subsidiaries as part of the IPO. The business ceded was part of the Company's other segment, and is no longer written. The following table summarizes the activity with ACE subsidiaries ("affiliated") and non-affiliated entities for each line item where applicable in the income statements (certain 2007 and 2006 amounts have been reclassified as discussed in Note 2). The affiliated amounts relate primarily to these legacy reinsurance transactions.

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Net earned premiums

                   

Non-affiliated:

                   

Gross written premiums

  $ 618,270   $ 424,546   $ 261,448  

Ceded written premiums

    (10,168 )   (13,011 )   (1,326 )
               

Net written premiums

    608,102     411,535     260,122  

Increase in net unearned premium reserves

    (343,210 )   (248,682 )   (108,762 )
               

Non-affiliated net earned premiums

    264,892     162,853     151,360  
               

Affiliated:

                   

Gross written premiums

            (176 )

Ceded written premiums

    (3,546 )   (3,565 )   (4,126 )
               

Net written premiums

    (3,546 )   (3,565 )   (4,302 )

Decrease (increase) in net unearned premium reserves

    52     (29 )   (2,255 )
               

Affiliated net earned premiums

    (3,494 )   (3,594 )   (6,557 )
               
   

Total

    261,398     159,259     144,803  
               

Net investment income

   
162,558
   
128,092
   
111,455
 

Net realized investment losses

    (69,801 )   (1,344 )   (1,994 )

Change in fair value of credit derivatives

                   
 

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

    117,589     73,992     73,861  
 

Unrealized (losses) gains on credit derivatives

    38,034     (670,403 )   11,827  
               
   

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

    155,623     (596,411 )   85,688  

Other income

    43,410     8,801     419  
               
   

Total revenues

  $ 553,188   $ (301,603 ) $ 340,371  
               

219


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

15. Related Party Transactions (Continued)


 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

                   

Non-affiliated

  $ 265,763   $ 1,128   $ 12,321  

Affiliated

    (1 )   4,650     (998 )
               

Total

    265,762     5,778     11,323  
               

Profit commission expense

                   

Non-affiliated

    1,336     6,476     9,684  

Affiliated

            (156 )
               

Total

    1,336     6,476     9,528  
               

Acquisition costs

                   

Non-affiliated

    61,246     43,129     45,924  

Affiliated

    3     21     (716 )
               

Total

    61,249     43,150     45,208  
               

Other operating expenses

   
83,493
   
79,866
   
68,019
 

Interest expense

    23,283     23,529     13,772  

Other expense

    5,734     2,623     2,547  
               
 

Total expenses

    440,857     161,422     150,397  
               

Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes

    112,331     (463,025 )   189,974  

Total provision (benefit) for income taxes

    43,448     (159,753 )   30,240  
               
 

Net income (loss)

  $ 68,883   $ (303,272 ) $ 159,734  
               

220


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

15. Related Party Transactions (Continued)

        The following table summarizes the affiliated components of each balance sheet item, where applicable:

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Assets

             

Prepaid reinsurance premiums

  $ 114   $ 155  

Reinsurance recoverable on ceded losses

    4,824     8,752  

Other assets

    11,031     90  
           
 

Total affiliate assets

    15,969     8,997  
 

Non-affiliate assets

    4,539,738     3,753,937  
           
 

Total assets

  $ 4,555,707   $ 3,762,934  
           

Liabilities and shareholders' equity

             

Liabilities

             

Unearned premium reserves

  $ 1,484   $ 1,576  

Reserves for loss and loss adjustment expenses

    4,589     4,650  

Funds held by Company under reinsurance agreements

    30,683     25,274  

Other liabilities

    9,147     9,893  
           
 

Total affiliate liabilities

    45,903     41,393  
 

Non-affiliate liabilities

    2,583,582     2,054,971  
           
 

Total liabilities

    2,629,485     2,096,364  

Total shareholders' equity

    1,926,222     1,666,570  
           

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 4,555,707   $ 3,762,934  
           

221


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

15. Related Party Transactions (Continued)

        The following table summarizes the non-affiliated and affiliated components of cash flows from operations:

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
 

Affiliated

  $ (5,958 ) $ (2,826 ) $ (4,551 )

Non-affiliated

    432,947     388,676     266,125  
               

Net cash flows provided by operating activities

  $ 426,989   $ 385,850   $ 261,574  
               

Affiliated

 
$

 
$

 
$

 

Non-affiliated

    (649,615 )   (664,389 )   (228,461 )
               

Net cash flows used in investing activities

  $ (649,615 ) $ (664,389 ) $ (228,461 )
               

Affiliated(1)(2)

 
$

250,000
 
$

 
$

(152,000

)

Non-affiliated

    (20,664 )   281,436     116,934  
               

Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities

  $ 229,336   $ 281,436   $ (35,066 )
               

(1)
2008 amount represents net proceeds from common stock issued to WL Ross. See Note 1.

(2)
2006 amount represents $150.0 million share repurchase from ACE and $2.0 million repayment of notes issued in connection with IPO.

Transactions and Agreements with ACE

        During 2008, 2007 and 2006, ACE provided certain general and administrative services to some of the Company's subsidiaries, including AGC, AG Re and AGRO. In 2008 and 2007 those services were information technology related services and in 2006 also included tax consulting and preparation services. Expenses included in the Company's consolidated financial statements related to these services were $0.1 million, $0.1 million and $0.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Effective January 1, 2007, the tax consulting and preparation services arrangement was terminated.

16. Commitments and Contingencies

Litigation

        Effective January 1, 2004, Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company ("AGMIC") reinsured a private mortgage insurer (the "Reinsured") under a Mortgage Insurance Stop Loss Excess of Loss Reinsurance Agreement (the "Agreement"). Under the Agreement, AGMIC agreed to cover the Reinsured's aggregate mortgage guaranty insurance losses in excess of a $25 million retention and subject to a $95 million limit. Coverage under the Agreement was triggered only when the Reinsured's: (1) combined loss ratio exceeded 100%; and (2) risk to capital ratio exceeded 25 to 1, according to insurance statutory accounting. In April 2008, AGMIC notified the Reinsured it was terminating the Agreement because of the Reinsured's breach of the terms of the Agreement. The Reinsured notified

222


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

16. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)


AGMIC that it considers the Agreement to remain in effect and that the two coverage triggers under the Agreement apply as of April 1, 2008. By letter dated May 5, 2008, the Reinsured demanded arbitration against AGMIC seeking a declaration that the Agreement remains in effect and alleged compensatory and other damages. The arbitration hearing took place before a three person panel in December 2008 and January 2009. Post hearing briefing and oral arguments will be completed on February 26, 2009, and the arbitration panel could render its decision at any time thereafter.

        It is the opinion of the Company's management, based upon the information available, that the expected outcome of litigation against the Company, individually or in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's financial position or liquidity, although an adverse resolution of litigation against the Company could have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations in a particular quarter or fiscal year.

Real Estate Leases

        The Company and its subsidiaries are party to various lease agreements. In June 2008, the Company's subsidiary, Assured Guaranty Corp., entered into a new five-year lease agreement for New York office space. Future minimum annual payments of $5.3 million for the first twelve month period and $5.7 million for subsequent twelve month periods commenced October 1, 2008 and are subject to escalation in building operating costs and real estate taxes. As of December 31, 2008, future minimum rental payments under the terms of these operating leases for office space are $7.1 million in 2009, $6.3 million in 2010, $6.1 million in 2011and 2012, $5.1 million in 2013 and $1.1 million thereafter. These payments are subject to escalations in building operating costs and real estate taxes. Rent expense for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 was approximately $5.7 million, $3.5 million and $3.0 million, respectively.

Reinsurance

        In the ordinary course of their respective businesses, certain of the Company's subsidiaries assert claims in legal proceedings against third parties to recover losses paid in prior periods. The amounts, if any, the Company will recover in these proceedings are uncertain, although recoveries in any one or more of these proceedings during any quarter or fiscal year could be material to the Company's results of operations in that particular quarter or fiscal year.

        During 2006, the Company's wholly owned subsidiary, AGRO, and a number of other parties, completed various settlements with defendants in the In re: National Century Financial Enterprises Inc. Investment Litigation now pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of Ohio—Eastern District. AGRO received approximately $0.4 million (pre-tax) in 2008, $1.3 million (pre-tax) in 2007 and $13.5 million (pre-tax) in 2006 from the settlements. AGRO originally paid claims in 2003 of approximately $41.7 million (pre-tax) related to National Century Financial Enterprises Inc. To date, including the settlements described above, the Company has recovered $20.5 million (pre-tax), representing a partial settlement of the litigation. The litigation will continue against other parties.

        The Company is party to reinsurance agreements with most of the major monoline primary financial guaranty insurance companies. The Company's facultative and treaty agreements are generally subject to termination (i) upon written notice (ranging from 90 to 120 days) prior to the specified

223


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

16. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)


deadline for renewal, (ii) at the option of the primary insurer if the Company fails to maintain certain financial, regulatory and rating agency criteria which are equivalent to or more stringent than those the Company is otherwise required to maintain for its own compliance with state mandated insurance laws and to maintain a specified financial strength rating for the particular insurance subsidiary or (iii) upon certain changes of control of the Company. Upon termination under the conditions set forth in (ii) and (iii) above, the Company may be required (under some of its reinsurance agreements) to return to the primary insurer all statutory unearned premiums, less ceding commissions, attributable to reinsurance ceded pursuant to such agreements after which the Company would be released from liability with respect to the ceded business. Upon the occurrence of the conditions set forth in (ii) above, whether or not an agreement is terminated, the Company may be required to obtain a letter of credit or alternative form of security to collateralize its obligation to perform under such agreement or it may be obligated to increase the level of ceding commission paid.

17. Concentrations

        The Company's client base includes all of the major monoline primary financial guaranty insurance companies, many banks and several European insurance and reinsurance companies. Of the Company's total non-CDS gross premiums written for the year ended December 31, 2008, 15.3% came from FSA, a primary financial guaranty insurance company. Of the Company's total non-derivative gross premiums written for the year ended December 31, 2007, 37.0% and 13.8% came from Ambac and FSA, respectively, both of which are primary financial guaranty insurance companies. Of the Company's total non-CDS gross premiums written for the year ended December 31, 2006, 22.0% came from FSA. No other client represented more than 10% of the Company's total non-CDS gross premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006.

18. Long-Term Debt

        The Company's consolidated financial statements include long-term debt used to fund the Company's insurance operations, and related interest expense, as described below.

Senior Notes

        On May 18, 2004, AGUS, a subsidiary of the Company, issued $200.0 million of 7.0% Senior Notes due 2034 for net proceeds of $197.3 million. The proceeds of the offering were used to repay substantially all of a $200.0 million promissory note issued to a subsidiary of ACE in April 2004 as part of the IPO related formation transactions. The coupon on the Senior Notes is 7.0%, however, the effective rate is approximately 6.4%, taking into account the effect of a cash flow hedge executed by the Company in March 2004, the term of which matches that of the Senior Notes. The Company recorded interest expense of $13.4 million, including $0.6 million of amortized gain on the cash flow hedge, for each of the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. These Senior Notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

        On December 20, 2006, AGUS issued $150.0 million of Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures (the "Debentures") due 2066 for net proceeds of $149.7 million. The proceeds of the

224


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

18. Long-Term Debt (Continued)


offering were used to repurchase 5,692,599 of Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s common shares from ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd., a subsidiary of ACE. The Debentures pay a fixed 6.40% rate of interest until December 15, 2016, and thereafter pay a floating rate of interest, reset quarterly, at a rate equal to 3 month LIBOR plus a margin equal to 2.38%. AGUS may elect at one or more times to defer payment of interest for one or more consecutive periods for up to ten years. Any unpaid interest bears interest at the then applicable rate. AGUS may not defer interest past the maturity date. The Company recorded interest expense of $9.8 million, $9.8 million and $0.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. These Debentures are guaranteed on a junior subordinated basis by Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Credit Facilities

2006 Credit Facility

        On November 6, 2006, Assured Guaranty Ltd. and certain of its subsidiaries entered into a $300.0 million five-year unsecured revolving credit facility (the "2006 credit facility") with a syndicate of banks. Under the 2006 credit facility, each of AGC, AG (UK), AG Re, AGRO and Assured Guaranty Ltd. are entitled to request the banks to make loans to such borrower or to request that letters of credit be issued for the account of such borrower.

        Of the $300.0 million available to be borrowed, no more than $100.0 million may be borrowed by Assured Guaranty Ltd., AG Re or AGRO, individually or in the aggregate, and no more than $20.0 million may be borrowed by AG (UK). The stated amount of all outstanding letters of credit and the amount of all unpaid drawings in respect of all letters of credit cannot, in the aggregate, exceed $100.0 million.

        The 2006 credit facility also provides that Assured Guaranty Ltd. may request that the commitment of the banks be increased an additional $100.0 million up to a maximum aggregate amount of $400.0 million. Any such incremental commitment increase is subject to certain conditions provided in the agreement and must be for at least $25.0 million.

        The proceeds of the loans and letters of credit are to be used for the working capital and other general corporate purposes of the borrowers and to support reinsurance transactions.

        At the closing of the 2006 credit facility, (i) AGC guaranteed the obligations of AG (UK) under such facility, (ii) Assured Guaranty Ltd. guaranteed the obligations of AG Re and AGRO under such facility and agreed that, if the Company Consolidated Assets (as defined in the related credit agreement) of AGC and its subsidiaries were to fall below $1.2 billion, it would, within 15 days, guarantee the obligations of AGC and AG (UK) under such facility, (iii) Assured Guaranty Overseas US Holdings Inc. guaranteed the obligations of Assured Guaranty Ltd., AG Re and AGRO under such facility and (iv) Each of AG Re and AGRO guarantees the other as well as Assured Guaranty Ltd.

        The 2006 credit facility's financial covenants require that Assured Guaranty Ltd. (a) maintain a minimum net worth of seventy-five percent (75%) of the Consolidated Net Worth of Assured Guaranty Ltd. as of the most recent fiscal quarter of Assured Guaranty Ltd. prior to November 6, 2006 and (b) maintain a maximum debt-to-capital ratio of 30%. In addition, the 2006 credit facility requires that AGC maintain qualified statutory capital of at least 75% of its statutory capital as of the fiscal

225


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

18. Long-Term Debt (Continued)


quarter prior to November 6, 2006. Furthermore, the 2006 credit facility contains restrictions on Assured Guaranty Ltd. and its subsidiaries, including, among other things, in respect of their ability to incur debt, permit liens, become liable in respect of guaranties, make loans or investments, pay dividends or make distributions, dissolve or become party to a merger, consolidation or acquisition, dispose of assets or enter into affiliate transactions. Most of these restrictions are subject to certain minimum thresholds and exceptions. The 2006 credit facility has customary events of default, including (subject to certain materiality thresholds and grace periods) payment default, failure to comply with covenants, material inaccuracy of representation or warranty, bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings, change of control and cross-default to other debt agreements. A default by one borrower will give rise to a right of the lenders to terminate the facility and accelerate all amounts then outstanding. As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, Assured Guaranty was in compliance with all of those financial covenants.

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, no amounts were outstanding under this facility nor have there been any borrowings under this facility.

        The 2006 credit facility replaced a $300.0 million three-year credit facility. Letters of credit for totaling approximately $2.9 million remained outstanding as of December 31, 2008 discussed in Note 16. No letters of credit were outstanding as of December 31, 2007.

Non-Recourse Credit Facilities

AG Re Credit Facility

        On July 31, 2007 AG Re entered into a non-recourse credit facility ("AG Re Credit Facility") with a syndicate of banks which provides up to $200.0 million to satisfy certain reinsurance agreements and obligations. The AG Re Credit Facility expires in July 2014.

        The AG Re Credit Facility does not contain any financial covenants. The AG Re Credit Facility has customary events of default , including (subject to certain materiality thresholds and grace periods) payment default, failure to comply with covenants, material inaccuracy of representation or warranty, bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings, change of control and cross-default to other debt agreements. If any such event of default were triggered, AG Re could be required to repay potential outstanding borrowings in an accelerated manner.

        AG Re's obligations to make payments of principal and interest on loans under the AG Re Credit Facility, whether at maturity, upon acceleration or otherwise, are limited recourse obligations of AG Re and are payable solely from the collateral securing the AG Re Credit Facility, including recoveries with respect to certain insured obligations in a designated portfolio, premiums with respect to defaulted insured obligations in that portfolio, certain designated reserves and other designated collateral.

        As of December 31, 2008 and 2007, no amounts were outstanding under this facility nor have there been any borrowings under the life of this facility.

Committed Capital Securities

        On April 8, 2005, AGC entered into four separate agreements with four different unaffiliated custodial trusts pursuant to which AGC may, at its option, cause each of the custodial trusts to

226


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

18. Long-Term Debt (Continued)


purchase up to $50.0 million of perpetual preferred stock of AGC. The custodial trusts were created as a vehicle for providing capital support to AGC by allowing AGC to obtain immediate access to new capital at its sole discretion at any time through the exercise of the put option. If the put options were exercised, AGC would receive $200.0 million in return for the issuance of its own perpetual preferred stock, the proceeds of which may be used for any purpose including the payment of claims. The put options were not exercised during 2008, 2007 or 2006. Initially, all of committed capital securities of the custodial trusts (the "CCS Securities") were issued to a special purpose pass-through trust (the "Pass-Through Trust"). The Pass-Through Trust was dissolved in April 2008 and the committed capital securities were distributed to the holders of the Pass-Through Trust's securities. Neither the Pass-Through Trust nor the Custodial Trusts are consolidated in Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s financial statements.

        Income distributions on the Pass-Through Trust Securities and CCS Securities were equal to an annualized rate of One-Month LIBOR plus 110 basis points for all periods ending on or prior to April 8, 2008. Following dissolution of the Pass-Through Trust, distributions on the CCS Securities are determined pursuant to an auction process. On April 7, 2008 this auction process failed, thereby increasing the annualized rate on the CCS Securities to One-Month LIBOR plus 250 basis points. Distributions on the AGC Preferred Stock will be determined pursuant to the same process.

        For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, the Company has incurred $5.7 million, $2.6 million and $2.5 million, respectively, of put option premiums which are an on-going expense. The increase in 2008 compared with 2007 was due to the increase in annualized rates from One-Month LIBOR plus 110 basis points to One-Month LIBOR plus 250 basis points as a result of the failed auction process in April 2008. These expenses are presented in the Company's consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income under other expense.

        The CCS securities had a fair value of $51.1 million (see Note 5) and $8.3 million as of December 31, 2008 and December 31, 2007, respectively, and a change in fair value during 2008 and 2007 of $42.7 million and $8.3 million, respectively. The change in fair value is recorded in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income in other income. The change in fair value of CCS securities was $0 during 2006, as the fair value was $0 at December 31, 2006 or 2005.

227


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

19. Shareholders' Equity

General

        The Company has an authorized share capital of $5.0 million divided into 500,000,000 shares, par value $0.01 per share. Except as described below, the Company's common shares have no preemptive rights or other rights to subscribe for additional common shares, no rights of redemption, conversion or exchange and no sinking fund rights. In the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding-up, the holders of the Company's common shares are entitled to share equally, in proportion to the number of common shares held by such holder, in the Company's assets, if any remain after the payment of all the Company's debts and liabilities and the liquidation preference of any outstanding preferred shares. Under certain circumstances, the Company has the right to purchase all or a portion of the shares held by a shareholder at fair market value. All of the common shares are fully paid and non assessable. Holders of the Company's common shares are entitled to receive such dividends as lawfully may be declared from time to time by the Company's Board of Directors.

        The following table presents changes in the Company's common stock issued and outstanding for each of the three years ended December 31, 2008.

 
  2008   2007   2006  

Beginning balance

    79,948,979     67,534,024     74,761,577  

Common stock issuance(1)

    11,176,726     12,917,897     309,065  

Reclassification to remove nonvested restricted stock due to adoption of FAS 123R(2)

            (1,021,124 )

Share activity under option and incentive plans, net(3)

    (170,002 )   (69,882 )   26,645  

Common stock repurchases(4)

        (433,060 )   (6,542,139 )
               

Ending balance

    90,955,703     79,948,979     67,534,024  
               

(1)
Includes public offering, vesting of restricted stock and shares issued under ESPP.

(2)
Prior to the adoption of FAS 123R, the Company reported restricted stock awards as issued common stock. In accordance with the provisions of FAS 123R, on January 1, 2006, the Company reclassified any unvested restricted stock awards as nonvested restricted stock and as such it is no longer considered issued.

(3)
Includes shares issued from exercises of stock options and shares repurchased from employees in connection with the payment of withholding taxes due in connection with the vesting of restricted stock awards.

(4)
2006 amount includes 5,692,599 shares of the Company's common stock purchased by Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. from ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd., a subsidiary of ACE. See Note 18. Long-Term Debt, for more information.

228


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

19. Shareholders' Equity (Continued)

Acquisition of Common Shares

        Under the Company's Bye-Laws and subject to Bermuda law, if the Company's Board of Directors determines that any ownership of the Company's shares may result in adverse tax, legal or regulatory consequences to us, any of the Company's subsidiaries or any of its shareholders or indirect holders of shares or its Affiliates (other than such as the Company's Board of Directors considers de minimis), the Company has the option, but not the obligation, to require such shareholder to sell to the Company or to a third party to whom the Company assigns the repurchase right the minimum number of common shares necessary to avoid or cure any such adverse consequences at a price determined in the discretion of the Board of Directors to represent the shares' fair market value (as defined in the Company's Bye-Laws).

        At the time of the IPO, ACE beneficially owned 26,000,000 common shares of Assured Guaranty Ltd. In December 2006, Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. repurchased 5,692,599 of the Company's common shares from a subsidiary of ACE. In addition, in December 2006 ACE sold 1,150,000 shares of the Company's common shares to Banc of America Securities LLC. Assured Guaranty did not receive any proceeds from this transaction. Following the closing of these two transactions, ACE's ownership in Assured Guaranty Ltd. was reduced to approximately 19.2 million of Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s outstanding common shares.

Stock Repurchase Programs

        On November 8, 2007, the Company's Board of Directors approved a new share repurchase program for up to 2.0 million common shares. Share repurchases will take place at management's discretion depending on market conditions. During 2007, the Company paid $5.6 million to repurchase 0.3 million shares of its Common Stock at an average price of $19.82. No shares were repurchased during 2008.

        In May 2006, the Company's Board of Directors approved a share repurchase program for 1.0 million common shares. Share repurchases took place at management's discretion depending on market conditions. In August 2007 the Company completed this share repurchase program. During 2007 and 2006, the Company paid $3.7 million and $21.1 million, respectively, to repurchase 1.0 million shares of its Common Stock at an average price of $24.81.

Dividend Policy

        During 2008, 2007 and 2006 the Company paid dividends of $16.0 million, or $0.18 per common share, $11.0 million, or $0.16 per common share, and $10.5 million, or $0.14 per common share, respectively. Any determination to pay cash dividends will be at the discretion of the Company's Board of Directors, and will depend upon the Company's results of operations and operating cash flows, its financial position and capital requirements, general business conditions, legal, tax, regulatory, rating agency and any contractual restrictions on the payment of dividends and any other factors the Company's Board of Directors deems relevant. For more information concerning regulatory constraints that will affect the Company's ability to pay dividends, see Note 14.

229


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans

Share-Based Compensation

Accounting for Share-Based Compensation

        Effective January 1, 2006, the Company adopted FAS 123R, which replaces FAS 123 and supersedes APB 25. FAS 123R requires all share-based compensation transactions with employees, including grants of employee stock options, to be recognized as compensation expense over the requisite service period based on their relative fair values.

        Prior to the adoption of FAS 123R, the Company followed the guidance of APB 25 and did not record share-based compensation expense related to employee stock options in the statement of operations, since for all grants the exercise price was equal to the market value of the common stock on the grant date.

        The Company elected to use the modified prospective transition method for implementing FAS 123R. Under this transition method, compensation expense includes: (a) compensation expense for all share-based payments granted prior to, but not yet vested as of, January 1, 2006, based on the grant date fair value estimated in accordance with the original provisions of FAS 123, and (b) compensation expense for all share-based payments granted on or after January 1, 2006, based on the grant date fair value estimated in accordance with the provisions of FAS 123R. Because the Company elected to use the modified prospective transition method, results for prior periods have not been restated and new awards are valued and accounted for prospectively upon adoption.

        Effective January 1, 2006, upon adoption of FAS 123R, the Company began recording share-based compensation for the cost of stock options, restricted stock and the Company sponsored employee stock purchase plan. Also, the Company began recording the cost associated with the accelerated vesting of retirement-eligible employees.

        Share-based compensation expense in 2008, 2007 and 2006 was $11.9 million ($9.6 million after tax), $17.3 million ($14.3 million after tax) and $12.1 million ($10.0 million after tax), respectively. The effect on both basic and diluted earnings per share for 2008 was $0.11. The effect on both basic and diluted earnings per share for 2007 was $0.21. The effect on basic and diluted earnings per share for 2006 was $0.14 and $0.13, respectively. Included in 2008, 2007 and 2006 expense were $3.3 million ($2.9 million after tax), $5.9 million ($5.1 million after tax) and $2.2 million ($1.8 million after tax), respectively, related to accelerated vesting for stock award grants to retirement-eligible employees. FAS 123R requires these awards be expensed over the period through the date the employee first becomes eligible to retire and is no longer required to provide service to earn part or all of the award, regardless of the employee's intent of retirement. The amount of share-based compensation capitalized in 2008, 2007 and 2006 as DAC was $3.3 million, $2.7 million and $2.6 million, respectively.

230


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)

        The following table presents pre-DAC and pre-tax, share-based compensation cost by share-based type:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)
  2008   2007   2006  

Share-Based Employee Cost

                   

Restricted Stock

                   
 

Recurring amortization

  $ 6,075   $ 9,371   $ 7,676  
 

Accelerated amortization for retirement eligible employees

    125     4,074     1,534  
               
   

Subtotal

    6,200     13,445     9,210  
               

Restricted Stock Units

                   
 

Recurring amortization

    1,174          
 

Accelerated amortization for retirement eligible employees

    1,632          
               
   

Subtotal

    2,806          
               

Stock Options

                   
 

Recurring amortization

    3,373     3,632     3,581  
 

Accelerated amortization for retirement eligible employees

    1,498     1,782     655  
               
   

Subtotal

    4,871     5,414     4,236  
               

ESPP

    125     154     125  
               

Total Share-Based Employee Cost

    14,002     19,013     13,571  
               

Share-Based Directors Cost

                   

Restricted Stock

    441     219     289  

Restricted Stock Units

    677     804     843  
               

Total Share-Based Directors Cost

    1,118     1,023     1,132  
               

Total Share-Based Cost

  $ 15,120   $ 20,036   $ 14,703  
               

Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan

        As of April 27, 2004, the Company adopted the Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (the "Incentive Plan"). The number of common shares that may be delivered under the Incentive Plan may not exceed 7,500,000. In the event of certain transactions affecting the Company's common shares, the number or type of shares subject to the Incentive Plan, the number and type of shares subject to outstanding awards under the Incentive Plan, and the exercise price of awards under the Incentive Plan, may be adjusted.

        The Incentive Plan authorizes the grant of incentive stock options, non-qualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, and full value awards that are based on the Company's common shares. The grant of full value awards may be in return for a participant's previously performed services, or in

231


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)

return for the participant surrendering other compensation that may be due, or may be contingent on the achievement of performance or other objectives during a specified period, or may be subject to a risk of forfeiture or other restrictions that will lapse upon the achievement of one or more goals relating to completion of service by the participant, or achievement of performance or other objectives. Awards under the Incentive Plan may accelerate and become vested upon a change in control of the Company.

        The Incentive Plan is administered by a committee of the Board of Directors. The Compensation Committee of the Board serves as this committee except as otherwise determined by the Board. The Board may amend or terminate the Incentive Plan. As of December 31, 2008, 1,041,161 common shares were available for grant under the Incentive Plan.

Stock Options

        Nonqualified or incentive stock options may be granted to employees and directors of the Company. Stock options are generally granted once a year with exercise prices equal to the closing price on the date of grant. To date, the Company has only issued nonqualified stock options. All stock options granted to employees vest in equal annual installments over a three-year period and expire 10 years from the date of grant. None of the Company's options have a performance or market condition. Following is a summary of the Company's options issued and outstanding for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006:

 
  Year of Expiration   Weighted Average Exercise Price   Options for Common Shares  

Balance as of December 31, 2005

        $ 18.05     2,457,302  

Options granted

    2016   $ 25.49     797,067  

Options exercised

        $ 17.96     (141,715 )

Options forfeited

        $ 20.73     (102,494 )
                   

Balance as of December 31, 2006

        $ 19.92     3,010,160  

Options granted

    2017   $ 26.74     862,667  

Options exercised

        $ 19.10     (78,651 )

Options forfeited

        $ 23.96     (90,945 )
                   

Balance as of December 31, 2007

        $ 21.44     3,703,231  

Options granted

    2018   $ 23.13     608,800  

Options exercised

        $ 18.01     (19,000 )

Options forfeited

        $ 24.41     (66,528 )
                   

Balance as of December 31, 2008

        $ 21.65     4,226,503  
                   

Exercisable as of December 31, 2006

        $ 18.00     1,272,211  
                   

Exercisable as of December 31, 2007

        $ 18.85     2,186,761  
                   

Exercisable as of December 31, 2008

        $ 20.10     2,872,199  
                   

232


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)

        As of December 31, 2008, the aggregate intrinsic value and weighted average remaining contractual term of options outstanding were $4 thousand and 6.8 years, respectively. As of December 31, 2008, the aggregate intrinsic value and weighted average remaining contractual term of options exercisable were $0 and 6.1 years, respectively.

        The Company recorded $4.9 million ($3.7 million after tax) in share based compensation related to stock options during the year ended December 31, 2008. As of December 31, 2008 the total unrecognized compensation expense related to outstanding nonvested stock options was $3.0 million, which will be adjusted in the future for the difference between estimated and actual forfeitures. The Company expects to recognize that expense over the weighted average remaining service period of 1.3 years.

        The weighted average grant-date fair value of options granted were $7.59, $6.83 and $6.71 for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The fair value of options issued is estimated on the date of grant using the Black Scholes option pricing model, with the following weighted average assumptions used for grants in 2008, 2007 and 2006:

 
  2008   2007   2006  

Dividend yield

    0.8 %   0.6 %   0.5 %

Expected volatility

    35.10 %   19.03 %   20.43 %

Risk free interest rate

    2.8 %   4.7 %   4.6 %

Expected life

    5 years     5 years     5 years  

Forfeiture rate

    6.0 %   6.0 %   6.0 %

        These assumptions were based on the following:

        For options granted before January 1, 2006, the Company amortizes the fair value on an accelerated basis. For options granted on or after January 1, 2006, the Company amortizes the fair value on a straight-line basis. All options are amortized over the requisite service periods of the awards, which are generally the vesting periods, with the exception of retirement-eligible employees. For retirement-eligible employees, options are amortized over the period through the date the employee

233


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)


first becomes eligible to retire and is no longer required to provide service to earn part or all of the award. The Company may elect to use different assumptions under the Black-Scholes option valuation model in the future, which could materially affect the Company's net income or earnings per share.

        The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 was $45 thousand, $0.7 million and $1.2 million, respectively. During the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, $0.3 million, $1.5 million and $2.5 million, respectively, was received from the exercise of stock options and $16 thousand, $0.2 million and $0.2 million, respectively, related tax benefit was recorded and included in the financing section in the statement of cash flows. In order to satisfy stock option exercises, the Company will either issue new shares or reissue shares held at AGUS due to the repurchase of 5,692,599 of the Company's common shares from ACE Bermuda. See Note 19 for further information.

Restricted Stock Awards

        Under the Company's Incentive Plan 20,443, 487,437 and 460,083 restricted common shares were awarded during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, to employees and non-employee directors of the Company. These shares vest at various dates through 2012.

        The Company has granted restricted stock awards to employees and directors of the Company. Restricted stock awards generally vest in equal annual installments over a four-year period. Restricted stock awards are amortized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service periods of the awards, which are generally the vesting periods, with the exception of retirement-eligible employees, discussed above. Prior to the adoption of FAS 123R, the Company presented restricted stock issuances on the balance sheet in common stock and additional paid-in capital with an offset in unearned stock grant compensation as a separate component of shareholders' equity. In accordance with the provisions of FAS 123R, on January 1, 2006, the Company reclassified the balance in unearned stock grant compensation to common stock and additional paid-in capital in shareholders' equity. The following table summarizes restricted stock award activity for the year ended December 31, 2008:

Nonvested Shares
  Number of Shares   Weighted Average
Grant-Date
Fair Value
 

Nonvested at December 31, 2007

    1,163,674   $ 23.75  

Granted

    20,443   $ 24.40  

Vested

    (478,443 ) $ 21.53  

Forfeited

    (19,349 ) $ 25.40  
             

Nonvested at December 31, 2008

    686,325   $ 25.28  
           

        The Company recorded $6.6 million ($4.9 million after tax) in share-based compensation, related to restricted stock awards, during the year ended December 31, 2008.

234


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)

        The following table includes a roll-forward of unearned stock grant compensation:

 
  Unearned stock
grant
compensation
 
 
  (in thousands of
U.S. dollars)

 

Balance, December 31, 2005

  $ 14,756  
 

Reclassification due to adoption of FAS 123R

    (14,756 )
       

Balance, December 31, 2006

  $  
       

        As of December 31, 2008 the total unrecognized compensation cost related to outstanding nonvested restricted stock awards was $6.5 million, which the Company expects to recognize over the weighted-average remaining service period of 1.5 years. The total fair value of shares vested during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 was $10.3 million, $8.0 million and $5.2 million, respectively.

Restricted Stock Units

        Under the Company's Incentive Plan 275,493, 28,988 and 34,030 restricted stock units were awarded during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, to employees and non-employee directors of the Company. Restricted stock units are valued based on the closing price of the underlying shares at the date of grant. The 2008 amount included 251,270 restricted stock units which the Company granted to employees beginning February 2008. These restricted stock units have vesting terms similar to those of the restricted common shares and are delivered on the vesting date. The Company has granted restricted stock units to directors of the Company. These restricted stock units vest over a one-year period and are delivered after directors leave.

        The following table summarizes restricted stock unit activity (excluding dividend equivalents) for the year ended December 31, 2008:

Nonvested Stock Units
  Number of
Stock Units
  Weighted Average
Grant-Date
Fair Value
 

Nonvested at December 31, 2007(1)

    129,319   $ 22.46  

Granted(2)

    275,493   $ 23.34  

Delivered(1)

    (16,543 ) $ 21.76  

Forfeited

    (6,750 ) $ 23.27  
             

Nonvested at December 31, 2008

    381,519   $ 23.11  
           

235


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)

        The Company recorded $3.5 million ($3.0 million after tax) in share-based compensation during the year ended December 31, 2008. The compensation for restricted stock units is expensed on a straight-line basis over the vesting period. As of December 31, 2008, the total unrecognized compensation cost related to outstanding nonvested restricted stock units was $2.8 million, which the Company expects to recognize over the weighted-average remaining service period of 1.8 years. The total fair value of restricted stock units delivered during the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 was $0.4 million, $0 and $0, respectively.

Employee Stock Purchase Plan

        In January 2005, the Company established the Assured Guaranty Ltd. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the "Stock Purchase Plan") in accordance with Internal Revenue Code Section 423. The Stock Purchase Plan was approved by shareholders at the 2005 Annual General Meeting. Participation in the Stock Purchase Plan is available to all eligible employees. Maximum annual purchases by participants are limited to the number of whole shares that can be purchased by an amount equal to 10 percent of the participant's compensation or, if less, shares having a value of $25,000. Participants may purchase shares at a purchase price equal to 85 percent of the lesser of the fair market value of the stock on the first day or the last day of the subscription period. The Company reserved for issuance and purchases under the Stock Purchase Plan 100,000 shares of its common stock. Employees purchased the Company's shares for aggregate proceeds of $0.4 million, $0.6 million and $0.5 million in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006. The Company recorded $0.1 million ($0.1 million after tax) in share-based compensation under the Stock Purchase Plan during the year ended December 31, 2008.

Defined Contribution Plan

        The Company maintains savings incentive plans, which are qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code. The U.S. savings incentive plan is available to all full-time employees upon hire. Eligible participants may contribute a percentage of their salary subject to a maximum of $15,500 for 2008. Beginning January 1, 2006, the Company amended the U.S. savings incentive plan. The Company matches employee contributions up to 6%, subject to IRS limitations. Any amounts over the IRS limits, are contributed to and matched by the Company into a nonqualified supplemental executive retirement plan. The Company also makes a core contribution of 6% to the qualified plan and the nonqualified supplemental executive retirement plan, regardless of whether the employee contributes to the plan. In addition, employees become fully vested after 1 year of service, as defined in the plan. Plan eligibility is immediate upon hire.

        In Bermuda the savings incentive plan is available to all full-time employees upon their first date of employment. Eligible participants may contribute a percentage of their salary subject to a maximum of $15,500 for 2008. Contributions are matched by the Company at a rate of 100% up to 6% of the participant's compensation, subject to IRS limitations. Eligible participants also receive a Company core contribution equal to 6% of the participant's compensation, subject to IRS limitations, without requiring the participant to contribute to the plan. Participants generally vest in Company contributions upon the completion of one year of service. With respect to those employees who are Bermudian or spouses of Bermudians and who must participate in the Bermuda national pension scheme plan maintained by the Company, a portion of the foregoing contributions are made to the Bermuda

236


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)


national pension scheme plan. If employee or employer contributions in the Bermuda savings incentive plan are limited by the tax-qualification rules of Code section 401(a), then contributions in excess of those limits are allocated to a nonqualified plan. The Company may contribute an additional amount to eligible employees' Bermuda nonqualified plan accounts at the discretion of the Board of Directors. No such contribution was made for plan years 2008, 2007 or in 2006.

        The Company contributed approximately $2.3 million in 2008, $2.9 million in 2007 and $2.6 million in 2006 in nondiscretionary contributions under all these plans. Total discretionary expense under all these plans amounted to approximately $2.7 million in 2008, $2.3 million in 2007 and $2.4 million in 2006.

Cash-Based Compensation

Performance Retention Plan

        In February 2006, the Company established the Assured Guaranty Ltd. Performance Retention Plan which permits the grant of cash based awards to selected employees. Awards granted to participants before 2008 vest after four years of continued employment (or if earlier, on employment termination, if the participant's termination occurs as a result of death, disability, or retirement), and participants receive the designated award in a single lump sum when it vests, except that participants who vest as a result of retirement receive the bonus at the end of the four year period during which the award would have vested had the participant continued in employment. The value of the award paid is greater than the originally-designated amount only if actual company performance, as measured by an increase in the company's modified adjusted book value, improves during the four year performance period. For those participants who vest prior to the end of the four year period as a result of their termination of employment resulting from retirement, death or disability, the value of the award paid is greater than the originally-designated amount only if actual company performance, as measured by an increase in the company's modified adjusted book value, improves during the period ending on the last day of the calendar quarter prior to the date of the participant's termination of employment. Awards under the plan may be treated as nonqualified deferred compensation subject to the rules of Internal Revenue Code Section 409A, and the plan was revised to satisfy those rules for the first award granted under the Plan, which occurred in 2007.

        The plan was again revised in 2008 to be a sub-plan under our Long-Term Incentive Plan (enabling awards under the plan to be performance-based compensation exempt from the $1 million limit on tax deductible compensation). The revisions also give the Compensation Committee greater flexibility in establishing the terms of performance retention awards, including the ability to establish different performance periods and performance objectives.

        Two types of awards were granted in 2008. Under the first type, the award is divided into three installments, with 25% of the award allocated to a performance period that includes 2008 and 2009, 25% of the award allocated to a performance period that includes 2008 through 2010, and 50% of the award allocated to a performance period that includes 2008 through 2011. Each installment of an award vests if the participant remains employed through the end of the performance period for that installment (or vests on the date of the participant's death, disability, or retirement if that occurs during the performance period). Payment for each performance period is made at the end of that performance

237


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)


period. One half of each installment is increased or decreased in proportion to the increase or decrease of modified adjusted book value during the performance period, and one half of each installment is increased or decreased in proportion to the increase or decrease of operating return on equity during the performance period. (However, if, during the performance period, a participant dies or becomes disabled while employed, the amount is based on performance through the quarter ending before death or disability and is paid after the occurrence of death or disability.)

        Under the second type of award granted in 2008, the entire award is allocated to a performance period that includes 2008 through 2012. The award vests if the participant remains employed through the end of the performance period (or vests on the date of the participant's death, disability, or retirement if that occurs during the performance period). Payment is made at the end of the performance period. One half of the award is increased or decreased in proportion to the increase or decrease of modified adjusted book value during the performance period, and one half of the award is increased or decreased in proportion to the increase or decrease of operating return on equity during the performance period. (However, if, during the performance period, a participant dies or becomes disabled while employed, the amount is based on performance through the quarter ending before death or disability and is paid after the occurrence of death or disability.)

        Under both types of the 2008 awards, if a payment would otherwise be subject to the $1 million limit on tax deductible compensation, no payment will be made unless performance satisfies a minimum threshold.

        Modified adjusted book value as of any date is determined by the Compensation Committee and equals:

        Operating return on equity as of any date is determined by the Compensation Committee and equals:

        Operating income is net income (loss) excluding after-tax realized gains (losses) on investments and after-tax unrealized gains (losses) on derivative financial instruments.

        In the event of a corporate transaction involving the Company, including, without limitation, any share dividend, share split, extraordinary cash dividend, recapitalization, reorganization, merger, amalgamation, consolidation, split-up, spin-off, sale of assets or subsidiaries, combination or exchange of shares, the Compensation Committee may adjust the calculation of the Company's modified adjusted

238


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

20. Employee Benefit Plans (Continued)


book value and operating return on equity as the Compensation Committee deems necessary or desirable in order to preserve the benefits or potential benefits of Performance Retention Plan awards.

        The Company recognized approximately $5.7 million ($4.5 million after tax) and $0.2 million ($0.1 million after tax) of expense for performance retention awards in 2008 and 2007, respectively. Included in 2008 amounts were $3.3 million, respectively, of accelerated expense related to retirement-eligible employees. The Company's compensation expense for 2007 was in the form of performance retention awards and the awards that were made in 2007 vest over a four year period.

21. Earnings (Loss) Per Share

        Basic earnings (loss) per share is calculated by dividing net income (loss) by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings (loss) per share adjusts basic earnings (loss) per share for the effects of restricted stock, stock options and other potentially dilutive financial instruments, only in the periods in which such effect is dilutive.

        The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted earnings per share ("EPS"):

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in thousands of U.S. dollars except per share amounts)
 

Net income (loss)

  $ 68,883   $ (303,272 ) $ 159,734  
               

Basic shares

    87,976     68,029     73,260  

Effect of dilutive securities:

                   

Stock awards

    970         989  
               

Diluted shares(1)

    88,946     68,029     74,248  
               
 

Basic EPS

  $ 0.78   $ (4.46 ) $ 2.18  
 

Diluted EPS

  $ 0.77   $ (4.46 ) $ 2.15  

        Potentially dilutive securities representing approximately 2.4 million, 5.0 million and 0.8 million shares of common stock for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively, were excluded from the computation of diluted earnings per share for these periods because their effect would have been antidilutive.

22. Goodwill

        Goodwill of $94.6 million arose from ACE's acquisition of Capital Re Corporation, Assured's corporate predecessor, as of December 31, 1999 and was being amortized over a period of twenty-five years. On January 1, 2002, the Company ceased amortizing goodwill as part of its adoption of FAS 142 and now evaluates it for impairment at least annually in accordance with FAS 142. No such impairment was recognized in the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006.

239


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

22. Goodwill (Continued)

        The following table details goodwill by segment as of December 31, 2008 and 2007:

 
  As of December 31,  
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)
  2008   2007  

Financial guaranty direct

  $ 14,748   $ 14,748  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    70,669     70,669  

Mortgage guaranty

         

Other

         
           

Total

  $ 85,417   $ 85,417  
           

        The Company conducted its most recent impairment test as of December 31, 2008. Step 1 of a goodwill impairment test under FAS 142, is to compare the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. The market value of common stock typically serves as an indicator of fair value to assess goodwill impairment of a publicly traded company. Due to the recent and severe volatility experienced in the broader financial markets the market value of most entities as measured by quoted prices for their common stock has been severely negatively impacted during the second half of 2008. The market value of the Company's common stock in the fourth quarter of 2008 has been affected by these macro economic conditions as well and currently trades significantly below the Company's carrying value.

        The Company's Step 1 goodwill impairment test is based on determining the fair value of the Company's direct and reinsurance operations and then reconciling these fair values to the Company's consolidated fair value. The Company determined the current in-force values of our direct and reinsurance books of business on a discounted cash flow basis to assess goodwill for impairment. The inputs to our discounted cash flow model for both the direct and reinsurance lines of business were unearned premium at carrying value, future installment premiums discounted at 15%, a future expense load equal to 25% of premiums, recorded loss reserves and taxes. Management has determined that the discounted cash flows supported the Company's goodwill balances for both the direct and reinsurance lines of business as of December 31, 2008.

        The pending FSAH transaction may cause a triggering event that will cause management to reassess its goodwill amounts related to its reinsurance line of business. If management determines in a future reporting period that goodwill is impaired, the Company would recognize a non-cash impairment charge in its statement of operations and comprehensive income in an amount up to $85.4 million, the current carrying value of goodwill. This charge would not have any adverse effect on the Company's debt agreements or our overall compliance with the covenants of our debt agreements.

23. Segment Reporting

        The Company has four principal business segments: (1) financial guaranty direct, which includes transactions whereby the Company provides an unconditional and irrevocable guaranty that indemnifies the holder of a financial obligation against non-payment of principal and interest when due, and could take the form of a credit derivative; (2) financial guaranty reinsurance, which includes agreements whereby the Company is a reinsurer and agrees to indemnify a primary insurance company against part or all of the loss which the latter may sustain under a policy it has issued; (3) mortgage guaranty, which

240


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

23. Segment Reporting (Continued)


includes mortgage guaranty insurance and reinsurance whereby the Company provides protection against the default of borrowers on mortgage loans; and (4) other, which includes lines of business in which the Company is no longer active.

        The Company does not segregate assets and liabilities at a segment level since management reviews and controls these assets and liabilities on a consolidated basis. The Company allocates operating expenses to each segment based on a comprehensive cost study. During 2006, the Company implemented a new operating expense allocation methodology to more closely allocate expenses to the individual operating segments. This new methodology was based on a comprehensive study which was based on departmental time estimates and headcount.

        Management uses underwriting gains and losses as the primary measure of each segment's financial performance. Underwriting gain is calculated as net earned premiums plus realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives, less the sum of loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries) including incurred losses on credit derivatives, profit commission expense, acquisition costs and other operating expenses that are directly related to the operations of the Company's insurance businesses. This measure excludes certain revenue and expense items, such as net investment income, realized investment gains and losses, unrealized losses on credit derivatives, other income, and interest and other expenses, that are not directly related to the underwriting performance of the Company's insurance operations, but are included in net income.

        The following table summarizes the components of underwriting gain (loss) for each reporting segment:

 
  Year Ended December 31, 2008  
 
  Financial
Guaranty
Direct
  Financial
Guaranty
Reinsurance
  Mortgage
Guaranty
  Other   Total  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 484.7   $ 129.3   $ 0.7   $ 3.5   $ 618.3  

Net written premiums

    474.7     129.1     0.7         604.6  

Net earned premiums

    90.0     165.9     5.7         261.4  

Realized gain and other settlements on credit derivatives

    113.8     3.4         0.4     117.6  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    196.7     68.4     2.0     (1.5 )   265.8  

Incurred losses on credit derivatives

    38.4     5.4             43.7  
                       
 

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    235.1     73.8     2.0     (1.5 )   309.5  

Profit commission expense

        1.0     0.4         1.3  

Acquisition costs

    14.0     46.6     0.5         61.2  

Other operating expenses

    61.5     19.7     2.2         83.5  
                       

Underwriting (loss) gain

  $ (106.8 ) $ 28.1   $ 0.6   $ 1.9   $ (76.4 )
                       

241


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

23. Segment Reporting (Continued)


 
  Year Ended December 31, 2007  
 
  Financial
Guaranty
Direct
  Financial
Guaranty
Reinsurance
  Mortgage
Guaranty
  Other   Total  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 167.1   $ 251.0   $ 2.7   $ 3.5   $ 424.5  

Net written premiums

    154.5     250.8     2.7         408.0  

Net earned premiums

    52.8     88.9     17.5         159.3  

Realized gain and other settlements on credit derivatives

    72.7             1.3     74.0  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    29.2     (24.1 )   0.6         5.8  

Incurred losses on credit derivatives

    3.6                 3.6  
                       
 

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    32.7     (24.1 )   0.6         9.3  

Profit commission expense

        2.7     3.8         6.5  

Acquisition costs

    10.2     31.3     1.6         43.2  

Other operating expenses

    60.5     17.3     2.0         79.9  
                       

Underwriting gain

  $ 22.1   $ 61.6   $ 9.4   $ 1.3   $ 94.5  
                       

 

 
  Year Ended December 31, 2006  
 
  Financial
Guaranty
Direct
  Financial
Guaranty
Reinsurance
  Mortgage
Guaranty
  Other   Total  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 124.8   $ 123.9   $ 8.4   $ 4.1   $ 261.3  

Net written premiums

    124.1     123.2     8.4         255.8  

Net earned premiums

    27.8     94.4     22.7         144.8  

Realized gain and other settlements on credit derivatives

    60.4             13.5     73.9  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    2.6     13.1     (4.4 )       11.3  

Incurred losses (gains) on credit derivatives

    (6.3 )               (6.3 )
                       
 

Total loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    (3.7 )   13.1     (4.4 )       5.0  

Profit commission expense

        2.7     6.8         9.5  

Acquisition costs

    8.7     34.1     2.3         45.2  

Other operating expenses

    52.3     14.5     1.3         68.0  
                       

Underwriting gain

  $ 30.8   $ 30.0   $ 16.7   $ 13.5   $ 91.0  
                       

242


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

23. Segment Reporting (Continued)

        The following is a reconciliation of total underwriting (loss) gain to income (loss) before provision for income taxes for the years ended:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

Total underwriting (loss) gain

  $ (76.4 ) $ 94.5   $ 91.0  

Net investment income

    162.6     128.1     111.5  

Net realized investment losses

    (69.8 )   (1.3 )   (2.0 )

Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives, excluding incurred losses on credit derivatives

    81.7     (666.9 )   5.5  

Other income

    43.4     8.8     0.4  

Interest expense

    (23.3 )   (23.5 )   (13.8 )

Other expense

    (5.7 )   (2.6 )   (2.5 )
               

Income (loss) before provision for income taxes

  $ 112.3   $ (463.0 ) $ 190.0  
               

        The following table provides the lines of businesses from which each of the Company's four reporting segments derive their net earned premiums:

 
  Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

Financial guaranty direct:

                   

Public finance

  $ 34.6   $ 13.0   $ 5.6  

Structured finance

    55.4     39.8     22.2  
               
 

Total

    90.0     52.8     27.8  
               

Financial guaranty reinsurance:

                   

Public finance

    123.1     62.8     61.2  

Structured finance

    42.8     26.1     33.2  
               
 

Total

    165.9     88.9     94.4  
               

Mortgage guaranty:

                   

Mortgage guaranty

    5.7     17.5     22.7  
               

Total net earned premiums

  $ 261.4   $ 159.3   $ 144.8  
               

Net credit derivative premiums received and receivable

  $ 118.1   $ 72.7   $ 61.9  
               
 

Total net earned premiums and credit derivative premiums received and receivable

  $ 379.5   $ 232.0   $ 206.7  
               

243


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

23. Segment Reporting (Continued)

        The other segment had an underwriting gain of $1.9 million, $1.3 million and $13.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The Company recorded net credit derivative loss recoveries of $0.4 million, $1.3 million and $13.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

        The following table summarizes the Company's gross written premiums by geographic region. Allocations have been made on the basis of location of risk.

 
  Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2008   2007   2006  
 
  (in millions of U.S. dollars)
 

North America

  $ 603.8     97.7 % $ 356.4     84.0 % $ 183.3     70.2 %

United Kingdom

    10.1     1.6 %   62.4     14.7 %   67.4     25.8 %

Europe

    3.6     0.6 %   3.7     0.9 %   5.2     2.0 %

Australia

    0.6     0.1 %   2.0     0.4 %   4.1     1.6 %

Other

    0.2                 1.3     0.4 %
                           

Total

  $ 618.3     100.0 % $ 424.5     100.0 % $ 261.3     100.0 %
                           

24. Subsidiary Information

        The following tables present the condensed consolidated financial information for Assured Guaranty Ltd., Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., of which AGC is a subsidiary and AG Re and other subsidiaries of Assured Guaranty Ltd. as of December 31, 2008 and 2007 and for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 (certain 2007 and 2006 amounts have been reclassified as discussed in Note 2).

244


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

24. Subsidiary Information (Continued)

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2008
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured Guaranty Ltd. (Parent Company)   Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc.   AG Re and Other Subsidiaries   Consolidating Adjustments   Assured Guaranty Ltd. (Consolidated)  

Assets

                               

Total investments and cash

  $ 188   $ 1,651,761   $ 1,991,690   $   $ 3,643,639  

Investment in subsidiaries

    1,901,108             (1,901,108 )    

Deferred acquisition costs

        78,987     209,629         288,616  

Reinsurance recoverable

        22,014     3,474     (18,960 )   6,528  

Goodwill

        85,417             85,417  

Credit derivative assets

        125,082     21,877         146,959  

Premiums receivable

        6,659     23,559     (14,475 )   15,743  

Deferred tax asset

        109,565     19,553         129,118  

Other

    29,427     383,272     49,502     (222,514 )   239,687  
                       
 

Total assets

  $ 1,930,723   $ 2,462,757   $ 2,319,284   $ (2,157,057 ) $ 4,555,707  
                       

Liabilities and shareholders' equity

                               

Liabilities

                               

Unearned premium reserves

  $   $ 707,957   $ 713,948   $ (188,191 ) $ 1,233,714  

Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses

        133,710     90,752     (27,664 )   196,798  

Profit commissions payable

        3,971     4,613         8,584  

Credit derivative liabilities

        481,253     252,513         733,766  

Senior Notes

        197,443             197,443  

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

        149,767             149,767  

Other

    4,501     82,024     62,982     (40,094 )   109,413  
                       
 

Total liabilities

    4,501     1,756,125     1,124,808     (255,949 )   2,629,485  
                       
 

Total shareholders' equity

    1,926,222     706,632     1,194,476     (1,901,108 )   1,926,222  
                       
 

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 1,930,723   $ 2,462,757   $ 2,319,284   $ (2,157,057 ) $ 4,555,707  
                       

245


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

24. Subsidiary Information (Continued)

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING BALANCE SHEET
AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2007
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent Company)
  Assured Guaranty
US Holdings Inc.
  AG Re and
Other
Subsidiaries
  Consolidating
Adjustments
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
 

Assets

                               

Total investments and cash

  $ 473   $ 1,370,865   $ 1,776,602   $   $ 3,147,940  

Investment in subsidiaries

    1,649,599             (1,649,599 )    

Deferred acquisition costs

        78,908     180,390         259,298  

Reinsurance recoverable

        20,478     3,526     (15,155 )   8,849  

Goodwill

        85,417             85,417  

Credit derivative assets

        4,552     922         5,474  

Premiums receivable

        11,596     26,972     (10,766 )   27,802  

Deferred tax asset

        131,449     16,114         147,563  

Other

    20,458     141,520     27,564     (108,951 )   80,591  
                       
 

Total assets

  $ 1,670,530   $ 1,844,785   $ 2,032,090   $ (1,784,471 ) $ 3,762,934  
                       

Liabilities and shareholders' equity

                               

Liabilities

                               

Unearned premium reserves

  $   $ 346,756   $ 624,840   $ (84,425 ) $ 887,171  

Reserves for losses and loss adjustment expenses

        70,411     70,198     (15,059 )   125,550  

Profit commissions payable

        3,628     18,704         22,332  

Credit derivative liabilities

        478,519     144,599         623,118  

Senior Notes

        197,408             197,408  

Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

        149,738             149,738  

Other

    3,960     73,241     49,234     (35,388 )   91,047  
                       
 

Total liabilities

    3,960     1,319,701     907,575     (134,872 )   2,096,364  
                       
 

Total shareholders' equity

    1,666,570     525,084     1,124,515     (1,649,599 )   1,666,570  
                       
 

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 1,670,530   $ 1,844,785   $ 2,032,090   $ (1,784,471 ) $ 3,762,934  
                       

246


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

24. Subsidiary Information (Continued)


CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2008
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent Company)
  Assured Guaranty
US Holdings Inc.
  AG Re and
Other
Subsidiaries
  Consolidating
Adjustments*
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
 

Revenues

                               

Net written premiums

  $   $ 345,912   $ 258,644   $   $ 604,556  

Net earned premiums

        91,998     169,400         261,398  

Net investment income

    543     73,576     88,438     1     162,558  

Net realized investment losses

        (14,661 )   (55,148 )   8     (69,801 )

Change in fair value of credit derivatives

                               
 

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

        93,435     24,154         117,589  
 

Unrealized gains (losses) on credit derivatives

        126,212     (88,178 )       38,034  
                       
   

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

        219,647     (64,024 )       155,623  

Equity in earnings of subsidiaries

    85,572             (85,572 )    

Other income

        44,358     16     (964 )   43,410  
                       
 

Total revenues

    86,115     414,918     138,682     (86,527 )   553,188  
                       

Expenses

                               

Loss and loss adjustment expenses

        149,479     116,283         265,762  

Acquisition costs and other operating expenses

    17,232     72,085     56,761         146,078  

Other

        29,017             29,017  
                       
 

Total expenses

    17,232     250,581     173,044         440,857  
                       

Income (loss) before provision for income taxes

    68,883     164,337     (34,362 )   (86,527 )   112,331  

Total provision for income taxes

        42,693     752     3     43,448  
                       

Net income (loss)

  $ 68,883   $ 121,644   $ (35,114 ) $ (86,530 ) $ 68,883  
                       

*
Due to the accounting for subsidiaries under common control, net income in the consolidating adjustment column does not equal parent company equity in earnings of subsidiaries, due to 1) recognition of income by Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. for dividends received from Assured Guaranty Ltd. and 2) the residual effects of the FSA agreement.

247


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

24. Subsidiary Information (Continued)

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2007
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent Company)
  Assured Guaranty
US Holdings Inc.
  AG Re and
Other
Subsidiaries
  Consolidating
Adjustments*
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
 

Revenues

                               

Net premiums written

  $   $ 123,554   $ 284,416   $   $ 407,970  

Net premiums earned

        58,717     100,542         159,259  

Net investment income

    2     63,611     64,482     (3 )   128,092  

Net realized investment (losses) gains

        (478 )   (897 )   31     (1,344 )

Change in fair value of credit derivatives

                               
 

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

        56,752     17,240         73,992  
 

Unrealized losses on credit derivatives

        (516,357 )   (154,046 )       (670,403 )
                       
   

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

        (459,605 )   (136,806 )       (596,411 )

Equity in earnings of subsidiaries

    (285,190 )           285,190      

Other income

        9,657     1     (857 )   8,801  
                       
 

Total revenues

    (285,188 )   (328,098 )   27,322     284,361     (301,603 )
                       

Expenses

                               

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

        (15,375 )   21,153         5,778  

Acquisition costs and other operating expenses

    18,084     64,179     47,229         129,492  

Other

        26,091     61         26,152  
                       
 

Total expenses

    18,084     74,895     68,443         161,422  
                       

(Loss) income before (benefit) provision for income taxes

    (303,272 )   (402,993 )   (41,121 )   284,361     (463,025 )

Total (benefit) provision for income taxes

        (153,896 )   (5,868 )   11     (159,753 )
                       

Net (loss) income

  $ (303,272 ) $ (249,097 ) $ (35,253 ) $ 284,350   $ (303,272 )
                       

*
Due to the accounting for subsidiaries under common control, net (loss) income in the consolidating adjustment column does not equal parent company equity in earnings of subsidiaries, due to 1) recognition of income by Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. for dividends received from Assured Guaranty Ltd. and 2) the residual effects of the FSA agreement.

248


Table of Contents

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2006
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent Company)
  Assured Guaranty
US Holdings Inc.
  AG Re and
Other
Subsidiaries
  Consolidating
Adjustments*
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
 

Revenues

                               

Net premiums written

  $   $ 79,246   $ 176,574   $   $ 255,820  

Net premiums earned

        56,781     88,022         144,803  

Net investment income

    2     55,710     55,782     (39 )   111,455  

Net realized investment losses

        (1,175 )   (819 )       (1,994 )

Change in fair value of credit derivatives

                               
 

Realized gains and other settlements on credit derivatives

        45,162     28,699         73,861  
 

Unrealized gains on credit derivatives

        5,186     6,641         11,827  
                       
   

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

        50,348     35,340         85,688  

Equity in earnings of subsidiaries

    176,060             (176,060 )    

Other income

    2     393     24         419  
                       
 

Total revenues

    176,064     162,057     178,349     (176,099 )   340,371  
                       

Expenses

                               

Loss and loss adjustment expenses

        8,143     3,180         11,323  

Acquisition costs and other operating expenses

    16,317     58,812     47,626         122,755  

Other

    13     16,304     2         16,319  
                       
 

Total expenses

    16,330     83,259     50,808         150,397  
                       

Income before provision for income taxes

    159,734     78,798     127,541     (176,099 )   189,974  

Total provision for income taxes

        16,508     13,712     20     30,240  
                       

Net income

  $ 159,734   $ 62,290   $ 113,829   $ (176,119 ) $ 159,734  
                       

*
Due to the accounting for subsidiaries under common control, net income in the consolidating adjustment column does not equal parent company equity in earnings of subsidiaries, due to the FSA agreement.

249


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

24. Subsidiary Information (Continued)

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2008
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent Company)
  Assured
Guaranty
US Holdings Inc.
  AG Re and
Other
Subsidiaries
  Consolidating
Adjustments
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
 

Dividends received

  $ 31,300   $ 964   $   $ (32,264 ) $  

Other operating activities

    (9,941 )   269,986     166,944         426,989  
                       

Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities

    21,359     270,950     166,944     (32,264 )   426,989  
                       

Cash flows from investing activities

                               

Fixed maturity securities:

                               
 

Purchases

        (495,798 )   (776,226 )       (1,272,024 )
 

Sales

        207,167     324,977         532,144  
 

Maturities

            11,730         11,730  

Sales (purchases) of short-term investments, net

    285     (76,158 )   154,408         78,535  

Capital contribution to subsidiary

    (250,000 )           250,000      
                       

Net cash flows used in investing activities

    (249,715 )   (364,789 )   (285,111 )   250,000     (649,615 )
                       

Cash flows from financing activities

                               

Net proceeds from common stock issuance

    248,967                 248,967  

Capital contribution from parent

          100,000     150,000     (250,000 )    

Dividends paid

    (16,979 )       (31,300 )   32,264     (16,015 )

Tax benefit from stock options exercised

        16             16  

Proceeds from employee stock purchase plan

    425                 425  

Share activity under option and incentive plans

    (4,057 )               (4,057 )
                       

Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities

    228,356     100,016     118,700     (217,736 )   229,336  

Effect of exchange rate changes

        (1,639 )   (814 )       (2,453 )
                       

Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

        4,538     (281 )       4,257  

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

        5,688     2,360         8,048  
                       

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  $   $ 10,226   $ 2,079   $   $ 12,305  
                       

250


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

24. Subsidiary Information (Continued)

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2007
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent Company)
  Assured
Guaranty
US Holdings Inc.
  AG Re and
Other
Subsidiaries
  Consolidating
Adjustments
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
 

Dividends received

  $ 35,349   $ 857   $   $ (36,206 ) $  

Other operating activities

    (13,204 )   113,837     285,217         385,850  
                       

Net cash flows provided by (used in) operating activities

    22,145     114,694     285,217     (36,206 )   385,850  
                       

Cash flows from investing activities

                               

Fixed maturity securities:

                               
 

Purchases

        (373,699 )   (680,892 )       (1,054,591 )
 

Sales

        256,066     530,524         786,590  
 

Maturities

        6,180     18,544         24,724  

Capital contribution to subsidiary

    (304,016 )           304,016      

Sales (purchases) of short-term investments, net

    1,050     (182 )   (421,980 )       (421,112 )
                       

Net cash flows (used in) provided by investing activities

    (302,966 )   (111,635 )   (553,804 )   304,016     (664,389 )
                       

Cash flows from financing activities

                               

Proceeds from issuance of common stock

    304,016                 304,016  

Capital contribution from parent

            304,016     (304,016 )    

Repurchases of common stock

    (9,349 )               (9,349 )

Dividends paid

    (11,889 )       (35,349 )   36,206     (11,032 )

Tax benefits from stock options exercised

        183             183  

Debt financing costs

        (425 )           (425 )

Proceeds from employee stock purchase plan

    627                 627  

Share activity under option and incentive plans

    (2,584 )               (2,584 )
                       

Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities

    280,821     (242 )   268,667     (267,810 )   281,436  

Effect of exchange rate changes

        95     271         366  
                       

Increase in cash and cash equivalents

        2,912     351         3,263  

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

        2,776     2,009         4,785  
                       

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

  $   $ 5,688   $ 2,360   $   $ 8,048  
                       

251


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

24. Subsidiary Information (Continued)

CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS
FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2006
(in thousands of U. S. dollars)

 
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Parent Company)
  Assured
Guaranty
US Holdings Inc.
  AG Re and
Other
Subsidiaries
  Consolidating
Adjustments
  Assured
Guaranty Ltd.
(Consolidated)
 

Dividends received

  $ 42,563   $   $   $ (42,563 ) $  

Other operating activities

    (7,759 )   148,982     120,351         261,574  
                       

Net cash flows provided by operating activities

    34,804     148,982     120,351     (42,563 )   261,574  
                       

Cash flows from investing activities

                               

Fixed maturity securities:

                               
 

Purchases

        (508,406 )   (374,815 )       (883,221 )
 

Sales

        341,373     315,585         656,958  
 

Maturities

        7,064     9,431         16,495  

(Purchases) sales of short-term investments, net

    (1,360 )   12,172     (29,505 )       (18,693 )
                       

Net cash flows used in investing activities

    (1,360 )   (147,797 )   (79,304 )       (228,461 )
                       

Cash flows from financing activities

                               

Repurchases of common stock

    (21,063 )   (150,000 )           (171,063 )

Dividends paid

    (10,458 )       (42,563 )   42,563     (10,458 )

Tax benefits from stock options exercised

        170             170  

Net proceeds from issuance of Series A Enhanced Junior Subordinated Debentures

        149,708             149,708  

Debt financing costs

        (1,500 )           (1,500 )

Repayment of note payable

    (2,000 )               (2,000 )

Proceeds from employee stock purchase plan

    501                 501  

Share activity under option and incentive plans

    (424 )               (424 )
                       

Net cash flows used in financing activities

    (33,444 )   (1,622 )   (42,563 )   42,563     (35,066 )

Effect of exchange rate changes

        290     258         548  
                       

Decrease in cash and cash equivalents

        (147 )   (1,258 )       (1,405 )

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

        2,923     3,267         6,190  
                       

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

  $   $ 2,776   $ 2,009   $   $ 4,785  
                       

252


Table of Contents


Assured Guaranty Ltd.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

25. Quarterly Financial Information (unaudited)

        A summary of selected quarterly statement of operations information follows (certain 2007 amounts have been reclassified as discussed in Note 2):

(in thousands, except per share data)
  First   Second   Third   Fourth  
2008
 

Gross written premiums

  $ 175,802   $ 245,776   $ 112,815   $ 83,877  

Net written premiums

    169,692     240,669     111,487     82,708  

Net earned premiums

    46,833     51,685     85,516     77,364  

Net investment income

    36,574     40,232     43,441     42,311  

Net realized investment gains (losses)

    627     1,453     (20,031 )   (51,850 )

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

    (232,004 )   740,295     (86,287 )   (266,381 )

Other income

    8,536     9,049     7,171     18,654  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    55,138     38,125     82,542     89,957  

(Loss) income before provision for income taxes

    (242,829 )   764,542     (99,538 )   (309,844 )

Net (loss) income

    (169,209 )   545,216     (63,340 )   (243,784 )

(Loss) earnings per share(1):

                         
 

Basic

  $ (2.11 ) $ 6.06   $ (0.70 ) $ (2.68 )
 

Diluted

  $ (2.11 ) $ 5.97   $ (0.70 ) $ (2.68 )

Dividends per share

  $ 0.045   $ 0.045   $ 0.045   $ 0.045  

 

2007
  First   Second   Third   Fourth  

Gross written premiums

  $ 55,167   $ 71,757   $ 68,487   $ 229,135  

Net written premiums

    51,365     68,490     60,418     227,697  

Net earned premiums

    37,047     37,987     38,608     45,617  

Net investment income

    31,482     30,860     31,846     33,904  

Net realized investment (losses) gains

    (279 )   (1,540 )   (119 )   594  

Net change in fair value of credit derivatives

    7,864     (1,690 )   (204,987 )   (397,598 )

Other income

            370     8,431  

Loss and loss adjustment expenses (recoveries)

    (4,023 )   (9,758 )   1,990     17,569  

Income (loss) before provision for income taxes

    40,327     38,338     (174,131 )   (367,559 )

Net income (loss)

    38,951     32,805     (114,958 )   (260,070 )

Earnings (loss) per share(1):

                         
 

Basic

  $ 0.58   $ 0.48   $ (1.70 ) $ (3.77 )
 

Diluted

  $ 0.57   $ 0.47   $ (1.70 ) $ (3.77 )

Dividends per share

  $ 0.04   $ 0.04   $ 0.04   $ 0.04  

(1)
Per share amounts for the quarters and the full years have each been calculated separately. Accordingly, quarterly amounts may not add to the annual amounts because of differences in the average common shares outstanding during each period and, with regard to diluted per share amounts only, because of the inclusion of the effect of potentially dilutive securities only in the periods in which such effect would have been dilutive.

        Gross and net written premiums in the fourth quarter of 2007 include the impact of the Ambac portfolio reinsured by AG Re, as discussed in Note 13.

        The net change in fair value of credit derivatives in the third and fourth quarters of 2007 reflected the decline in market values of the Company's credit derivative portfolio. These losses resulted from the significant widening of credit spreads observed in the third and fourth quarters of 2007. Derivatives are discussed further in Note 4.

253


Table of Contents

ITEM 9.    CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

        None.

ITEM 9A.    CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

        Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures.    Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s management, with the participation of Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s disclosure controls and procedures (as such term is defined in Rules 13a 15(e) and 15d 15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act")) as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based on this evaluation, Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that, as of the end of such period, Assured Guaranty Ltd.'s disclosure controls and procedures are effective in recording, processing, summarizing and reporting, on a timely basis, information required to be disclosed by Assured Guaranty Ltd. (including its consolidated subsidiaries) in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act. The Company's management report on internal control over financial reporting and PricewaterhouseCooper LLP's report of independent registered public accounting firm are included in Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.

        There has been no change in the Company's internal controls over financial reporting during the Company's quarter ended December 31, 2008, that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal controls over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B.    OTHER INFORMATION

NONE


PART III

ITEM 10.    DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

Code of Conduct

        The Company has adopted a Code of Conduct, which sets forth standards by which all Assured Guaranty Ltd. employees, officers and directors must abide as they work for the Company. The Company has posted this Code of Conduct on its internet site (www.assuredguaranty.com, under Investor Information/Corporate Governance/Code of Conduct). The Company intends to disclose on its internet site any amendments to, or waivers from, its Code of Conduct that are required to be publicly disclosed pursuant to the rules of the SEC or the NYSE. Information pertaining to this item is incorporated by reference to the sections entitled "Proposal No. 1: Election of Directors", "Corporate Governance—Did our insiders comply with Section 16(a) beneficial ownership reporting in 2008?", "Corporate Governance—How are Directors Nominated?" and "Corporate Governance—The committees of the Board—The Audit Committee" of the definitive proxy statement for the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, which involves the election of directors and will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to regulation 14A.

ITEM 11.    EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

        This item is incorporated by reference to the section entitled "Executive Compensation", "Corporate Governance—Compensation Committee interlocking and insider participation" and "Corporate Governance—Director Compensation" of the definitive proxy statement for the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, which will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to regulation 14A.

254


Table of Contents


ITEM 12.    SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

        This item is incorporated by reference to the sections entitled "Information about our Common Share Ownership" and "Equity Compensation Plans Information" of the definitive proxy statement for the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, which will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to regulation 14A.

ITEM 13.    CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

        This item is incorporated by reference to the sections entitled "Corporate Governance—What is our related person transactions approval policy and what procedures do we use to implement it?", "Corporate Governance—What related person transactions do we have?" and "Corporate Governance—Director independence" of the definitive proxy statement for the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, which will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to regulation 14A.

ITEM 14.    PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES

        This item is incorporated by reference to the section entitled "Proposal No. 4:Ratification of Appointment of Independent Auditors—Independent Auditor Fee Information" of the definitive proxy statement for the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders, which will be filed with the SEC not later than 120 days after the close of the fiscal year pursuant to regulation 14A.

255


Table of Contents


PART IV

ITEM 15.    EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

1.    Financial Statements

        The following financial statements of Assured Guaranty Ltd. have been included in Item 8 hereof:

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

    153  

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2008 and 2007

   
154
 

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

   
155
 

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders' Equity for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

   
156
 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006

   
157
 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   
158
 

2.    Financial Statement Schedules

        The following financial statement schedules are filed as part of this report:

Schedule
 
Title
   
 
II   Condensed Financial Information of Registrant (Parent Company Only)     266  

III

 

Supplementary Insurance Information

 

 

269

 

IV

 

Reinsurance

 

 

270

 

V

 

Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

 

 

271

 

        The report of the Registrant's independent registered public accounting firm with respect to the above listed financial statement schedules is included with the schedules.

        All other schedules are omitted because they are not applicable or the required information is shown in the consolidated financial statements or notes thereto.

3.    Exhibits

Exhibit
Number
  Description of Document
3.1   Certificate of Incorporation and Memorandum of Association of the Registrant (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 3.1 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
3.2   Bye-laws of the Registrant (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 3.2 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
4.1   Specimen Common Share Certificate (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 4.1 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
4.2   Certificate of Incorporation and Memorandum of Association of the Registrant (See exhibit 3.1)

256


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Number
  Description of Document
4.3   Bye-laws of the Registrant (See exhibit 3.2)
4.4   Indenture, dated as of May 1, 2004, among the Company, Assured Guaranty U.S. Holdings Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 4.1 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2004)
4.5   Indenture, dated as of December 1, 2006, entered into among Assured Guaranty Ltd., Assured Guaranty U.S. Holdings Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 4.1 to the current report on form 8-K filed on December 20, 2006)
4.6   First Supplemental Subordinated Indenture, dated as of December 20, 2006, entered into among Assured Guaranty Ltd., Assured Guaranty U.S. Holdings Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 4.2 to the current report on form 8-K filed on December 20, 2006)
4.7   Replacement Capital Covenant, dated as of December 20, 2006, between Assured Guaranty U.S. Holdings Inc. and Assured Guaranty Ltd., in favor of and for the benefit of each Covered Debtholder (as defined therein) (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 4.1 to the current report on form 8-K filed on December 20, 2006)
10.1   Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.6 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)*
10.2   Master Separation Agreement dated April 27, 2004, among the Company, ACE Limited, ACE Financial Services Inc. and ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.7 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.3   Transition Services Agreement, dated April 27, 2004, between the Company and ACE Limited (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.8 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.4   Registration Rights Agreement, dated April 27, 2004, among the Company, ACE Limited and ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.9 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.5   Tax Allocation Agreement, dated April 27, 2004, among the Company, ACE Financial Services Inc., ACE Prime Holdings, Inc., Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc., Assured Guaranty Corp., AGR Financial Products Inc. and ACE Risk Assurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.11 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.6   Credit Agreement with Deutsche Bank AG, as Agent, as amended (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.21 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.7   Retrocession Agreement between Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. and ACE American Insurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.29 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.8   Guaranty by Assured Guaranty Re International Ltd. in favor of Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.31 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.9   Guaranty by Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. in favor of Assured Guaranty Mortgage Insurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.32 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.10   Retrocessional Memorandum between ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. and Assured Guaranty Re International Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.34 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))

257


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Number
  Description of Document
10.11   Quota Share Reinsurance Agreement between Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. and JCJ Insurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.35 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.12   Quota Share Retrocession Agreement between Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. and ACE INA Overseas Insurance Company Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.37 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.13   Quota Share Retrocession Agreement between Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. and ACE American Insurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.38 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.14   Assignment and Indemnification Agreement between Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. and ACE INA Overseas Insurance Company Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.41 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.15   UK Title Quota Share Reinsurance Agreement between ACE European Markets Insurance Ltd. and Assured Guaranty Re International Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.45 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.16   Aggregate Loss Portfolio Reinsurance Agreement between Commercial Guaranty Assurance, Ltd. and Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.49 to Form S-1 of the Company (#333-111491))
10.17   Quota Share Retrocession Agreement, dated April 28, 2004, between Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. and ACE Tempest Re USA, Inc. for and on behalf of ACE American Insurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.13 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)
10.18   Quota Share Retrocession Agreement, dated April 28, 2004, between Assured Guaranty Corp. and ACE Tempest Re USA, Inc. for and on behalf of ACE American Insurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.14 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)
10.19   Quota Share Retrocession Agreement, dated April 28, 2004, between Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. and ACE INA Overseas Insurance Company Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.15 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)
10.20   Commutation and Release Agreement, dated April 28, 2004, between Westchester Fire Insurance Company and Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.16 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)
10.21   Assignment and Termination Agreement, dated April 28, 2004, among Assured Guaranty Re International Ltd., ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. and ACE Capital Title Reinsurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.18 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)
10.22   Assignment Agreement, dated April 28, 2004, among Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd., ACE European Markets Insurance Limited and ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.19 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)
10.23   Assignment Agreement, dated April 15, 2004, among Assured Guaranty Re Overseas Ltd., ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. and ACE Capital Title Reinsurance Company (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.20 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004)
10.24   Summary of Annual Compensation*

258


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Number
  Description of Document
10.25   Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.34 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005) *
10.26   Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.35 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005) *
10.27   Restricted Stock Agreement for Outside Directors under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.1 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2006)*
10.28   Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for Outside Directors under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.37 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005)*
10.29   Restricted Stock Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long Term Incentive Plan(Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.38 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005)*
10.30   Restricted Stock Unit Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long Term Incentive Plan(Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.39 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005)*
10.31   Assured Guaranty Ltd. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.40 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2004)*
10.32   Form of Indemnification Agreement between the Company and its executive officers and directors(Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.42 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2005)
10.33   Put Agreement between Assured Guaranty Corp. and Woodbourne Capital Trust [I][II][III][IV] (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.6 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2005)
10.34   Custodial Trust Expense Reimbursement Agreement (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.7 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2005)
10.35   Assured Guaranty Corp. Articles Supplementary Classifying and Designating Series of Preferred Stock as Series A Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series D Perpetual Preferred Stock (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.8 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2005)
10.36   Assured Guaranty Corp. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan Highlights Booklet 2006 Plan Year (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.1 of Form 8-K filed on December 28, 2005)*
10.37   Assured Guaranty Ltd. Supplemental Employee Retirement Plan, as amended through the second amendment (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.2 of Form 8-K filed on December 28, 2005)*
10.38   Assured Guaranty Ltd. Performance Retention Plan (As Amended and Restated as of February 14, 2008 for Awards Granted during 2007) (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.50 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.39   Five Year Cliff Vest Restricted Stock Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.1 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2006)*

259


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Number
  Description of Document
10.40   Employment agreement dated as of October 5, 2006, between Assured Guaranty Ltd., Assured Guaranty Corp. and Robert Bailenson (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.1 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended
September 30, 2006)*
10.41   Share Purchase Agreement, dated December 7, 2006, between Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. and ACE Bermuda Insurance Ltd. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 99.1 of Form 8-K filed on December 13, 2006)
10.42   $300,000,000 Revolving Credit Facility Credit Agreement (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 99.1 of Form 8-K filed on November 9, 2006)
10.43   Assured Guaranty Corp. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan—Amendment No. 1(Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.2 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2007)*
10.44   Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for Outside Directors under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.1 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2007)*
10.45   $200.0 million soft-capital credit facility (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.2 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2007)
10.46   Assured Guaranty Ltd. Performance Retention Plan (As Amended and Restated as of February 14, 2008) (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.58 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.47   Terms of Performance Retention Award Five Year Cliff Vest Granted on February 14, 2008 (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.59 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.48   Form of Award Letter for Performance Retention Award Five Year Cliff Vest Granted on February 14, 2008 (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.60 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.49   Terms of Performance Retention Award Four Year Installment Vesting Granted on February 14, 2008 (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.61 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007) *
10.50   Form of Award Letter for Performance Retention Award Four Year Installment Vesting Granted on February 14, 2008 (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.62 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.51   2007 Restricted Stock Agreement for Outside Directors under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.63 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.52   Restricted Stock Unit Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan to be used with employment agreement (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.64 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.53   Restricted Stock Unit Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.65 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*
10.54   Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan to be used with employment agreement (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.66 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)*

260


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Number
  Description of Document
10.55   Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.67 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007) *
10.56   Investment Agreement dated as of February 28, 2008 between Assured Guaranty Ltd. and WLR Recovery Fund IV, L.P. (Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.68 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)
10.57   Director Compensation Summary (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.1 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2008)*
10.58   Restricted Stock Unit Agreement for Outside Directors under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.1 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2008)*
10.59   Restricted Stock Agreement for Outside Directors under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.2 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2008)*
10.60   Form of amendment to Restricted Stock Unit Awards for Outside Directors (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.3 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2008)*
10.61   Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended August 5, 2008 (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 10.4 of Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2008)*
10.62   Assured Guaranty Ltd. Supplemental Employee Retirement Plan, as Amended and Restated Effective January 1, 2009*
10.63   Assured Guaranty Corp. Supplemental Employee Retirement Plan, as Amended and Restated Effective January 1, 2009*
10.64   Employment Agreement between Dominic J. Frederico and the Registrant*
10.65   Employment Agreement between Michael J. Schozer and the Registrant*
10.66   Employment Agreement between Robert B. Mills and the Registrant*
10.67   Employment Agreement between James M. Michener and the Registrant*
10.68   Employment Agreement between Robert A. Bailenson and the Registrant*
10.69   Assured Guaranty Ltd. Executive Officer Recoupment Policy*
10.70   Form of Acknowledgement of Assured Guaranty Ltd. Executive Officer Recoupment Policy*
10.71   Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan to be used with employment agreement*
10.72   Restricted Stock Unit Agreement under Assured Guaranty Ltd. 2004 Long-Term Incentive Plan to be used with employment agreement*
10.73   Terms of Performance Retention Award Four Year Installment Vesting Granted on February 5, 2009*
10.74   Approval dated September 16, 2008 pursuant to Investment Agreement dated as of February 28, 2008 with WLR Recovery Fund IV, L.P. Pursuant to the Investment Agreement, WLR Recovery Fund IV, L.P. and other funds affiliated with WL Ross & Co. LLC (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 99.1 of current report on Form 8-K filed on September 19, 2008)

261


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Number
  Description of Document
10.75   Purchase Agreement among Dexia Holdings Inc., Dexia Credit Local S.A. and the Company dated as of November 14, 2008 (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 99.1 of current report on Form 8-K filed on November 17, 2008)
10.76   Amendment to Investment Agreement dated as of November 13, 2008 between the Company and WLR Recovery Fund IV, L.P. (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 99.1 of current report on Form 8-K filed on November 17, 2008)
14.1   Code of Conduct (Incorporated by reference to exhibit 14.1 of Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2004)
21.1   Subsidiaries of the registrant
23.1   Accountants Consent
31.1   Certification of CEO Pursuant to Exchange Act Rules 13A-14 and 15D-14, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
31.2   Certification of CFO Pursuant to Exchange Act Rules 13A-14 and 15D-14, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
32.1   Certification of CEO Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
32.2   Certification of CFO Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
99.1   Assured Guaranty Corp. 2008 Consolidated Financial Statements

*
Management contract or compensatory plan

262


Table of Contents


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.


 

 

ASSURED GUARANTY LTD.

 

 

By:

 

/s/ DOMINIC J. FREDERICO

Name: Dominic J. Frederico
Title:  
President and Chief Executive Officer

Date: February 25, 2009

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Name
 
Position
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 
/s/ WALTER A. SCOTT

Walter A. Scott
  Chairman of the Board; Director   February 25, 2009

/s/ DOMINIC J. FREDERICO

Dominic J. Frederico

 

President and Chief Executive Officer; Director

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ ROBERT B. MILLS

Robert B. Mills

 

Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Duly Authorized Officer)

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ NEIL BARON

Neil Baron

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ G. LAWRENCE BUHL

G. Lawrence Buhl

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ STEPHEN A. COZEN

Stephen A. Cozen

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ FRANCISCO L. BORGES

Francisco L. Borges

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

263


Table of Contents

Name
 
Position
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 
/s/ PATRICK W. KENNY

Patrick W. Kenny
  Director   February 25, 2009

/s/ DONALD H. LAYTON

Donald H. Layton

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ ROBIN MONRO-DAVIES

Robin Monro-Davies

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ MICHAEL O'KANE

Michael O'Kane

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

/s/ WILBUR L. ROSS, JR.

Wilbur L. Ross, Jr.

 

Director

 

February 25, 2009

264


Table of Contents


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
on
Financial Statement Schedules

To the Board of Directors
of Assured Guaranty Ltd.:

        Our audits of the consolidated financial statements and of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting referred to in our report dated February 25, 2009 appearing in the 2008 Annual Report to Shareholders of Assured Guaranty Ltd. also included an audit of the financial statement schedules listed in Item 15(a)(2) of this Form 10K. In our opinion, these financial statement schedules present fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein when read in conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements.

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
New York, New York
February 25, 2009

265


Table of Contents


Schedule II

Assured Guaranty Ltd. (Parent Company)
Condensed Balance Sheets
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)

 
  As of December 31,  
 
  2008   2007  

Assets

             

Investments in subsidiaries and affiliates on equity basis

  $ 1,901,108   $ 1,649,599  

Short-term investments, at cost which approximates fair value

    188     473  

Other assets

    29,427     20,458  
           
 

Total assets

  $ 1,930,723   $ 1,670,530  
           

Liabilities and shareholders' equity

             

Liabilities

             

Other liabilities

  $ 4,501   $ 3,960  
           
 

Total liabilities

    4,501     3,960  
           

Shareholders' equity

             

Common stock

    967     856  

Additional paid-in capital

    1,284,313     1,023,829  

Retained earnings

    638,055     585,256  

Accumulated other comprehensive income

    2,887     56,629  
           
 

Total shareholders' equity

    1,926,222     1,666,570  
           
 

Total liabilities and shareholders' equity

  $ 1,930,723   $ 1,670,530  
           

266


Table of Contents


Schedule II

Assured Guaranty Ltd. (Parent Company)
Condensed Statements of Operations
For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)

 
  2008   2007   2006  

Revenues

                   

Equity in earnings of subsidiaries

  $ 85,572   $ (285,190 ) $ 176,060  

Net investment income

    543     2     2  

Other income

            2  
               
 

Total revenues

    86,115     (285,188 )   176,064  
               

Expenses

                   

Other operating expenses

    17,232     18,084     16,317  

Interest expense

            13  
               
 

Total expenses

    17,232     18,084     16,330  
               

Income (loss) before provision for income taxes

    68,883     (303,272 )   159,734  

Total provision for income taxes

             
               
 

Net income (loss)

  $ 68,883   $ (303,272 ) $ 159,734  
               

267


Table of Contents


Schedule II

Assured Guaranty Ltd. (Parent Company)
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
For the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006
(in thousands of U.S. dollars)

 
  2008   2007   2006  

Dividends received from Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. 

  $ 31,300   $ 35,349   $ 42,563  

Other operating activities

    (9,941 )   (13,204 )   (7,759 )
               

Net cash flows provided by operating activities

    21,359     22,145     34,804  
               

Cash flows from investing activities

                   
 

Capital contribution to Assured Guaranty Re Ltd. 

    (150,000 )   (304,016 )    
 

Capital contribution to Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc. 

    (100,000 )        
 

Sales (purchases) of short-term investments, net

    285     1,050     (1,360 )
               

Net cash flows used in investing activities

    (249,715 )   (302,966 )   (1,360 )
               

Financing activities

                   
 

Net proceeds from issuance of common shares

    248,967     304,016      
 

Repurchases of common stock

        (9,349 )   (21,063 )
 

Dividends paid(1)

    (16,979 )   (11,889 )   (10,458 )
 

Repayment of note payable

            (2,000 )
 

Proceeds from employee stock purchase plan

    425     627     501  
 

Share activity under option and incentive plans

    (4,057 )   (2,584 )   (424 )
               

Net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities

    228,356     280,821     (33,444 )

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

             
               

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  $   $   $  
               

(1)
2008 and 2007 include dividends of $964 thousand and $857 thousand, respectively, paid to Assured Guaranty US Holdings Inc.

268


Table of Contents


Schedule III

Supplementary Insurance Information
(in millions of U.S. dollars)(1)(2)

 
  DAC   UPR   Loss Reserves   Premiums Written   Premiums Earned   Loss and Loss Adjustment Expenses (Recoveries)   Net Investment Income   Acquisition Costs   Other Operating Expenses(3)  
 
  As of December 31, 2008   For the Year Ended December 31, 2008  

Financial guaranty direct

  $ 95.7   $ 626.7   $ 91.8   $ 484.7   $ 90.0   $ 196.7   $ 66.2   $ 14.0   $ 61.5  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    192.4     591.1     97.9     129.3     165.9     68.4     93.6     46.6     19.7  

Mortgage guaranty

    0.5     15.8     2.6     0.7     5.7     2.0     2.8     0.5     2.2  

Other

        0.1     4.5     3.5         (1.5 )            
                                       
 

Total

  $ 288.6   $ 1,233.7   $ 196.8   $ 618.3   $ 261.4   $ 265.8   $ 162.6   $ 61.2   $ 83.5  
                                       

 

 

As of December 31, 2007

 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2007

 

Financial guaranty direct

  $ 35.2   $ 237.4   $ 33.5   $ 167.1   $ 52.8   $ 29.2   $ 29.7   $ 10.2   $ 60.5  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    223.1     628.9     80.3     251.0     88.9     (24.1 )   93.9     31.3     17.3  

Mortgage guaranty

    1.0     20.7     2.9     2.7     17.5     0.6     4.5     1.6     2.0  

Other

        0.2     8.8     3.5                      
                                       
 

Total

  $ 259.3   $ 887.2   $ 125.6   $ 424.5   $ 159.3   $ 5.8   $ 128.1   $ 43.2   $ 79.9  
                                       

 

 

As of December 31, 2006

 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2006

 

Financial guaranty direct

  $ 34.3   $ 126.6   $ 4.6   $ 124.8   $ 27.8   $ 2.6   $ 13.4   $ 8.7   $ 52.3  

Financial guaranty reinsurance

    179.3     468.2     94.8     123.9     94.4     13.1     90.1     34.1     14.5  

Mortgage guaranty

    3.3     35.6     2.3     8.4     22.7     (4.4 )   8.0     2.3     1.3  

Other

    0.1     0.6     14.2     4.1                      
                                       
 

Total

  $ 217.0   $ 631.0   $ 115.9   $ 261.3   $ 144.8   $ 11.3   $ 111.5   $ 45.2   $ 68.0  
                                       

(1)
Certain 2007 and 2006 amounts have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

(2)
Some amounts may not add due to rounding.

(3)
During 2006, the Company implemented a new operating expense allocation methodology to more closely allocate expenses to the individual operating segments. This new methodology was based on a comprehensive study which was based on departmental time estimates and headcount.

269


Table of Contents


Schedule IV

Reinsurance
Net Earned Premiums
(in millions of U.S. dollars)(1)(2)

 
  For the Year Ended December 31, 2008  
Type of Business:
  Direct   Ceded   Assumed   Net   Percentage of assumed to net  

Financial guaranty

  $ 93.4   $ 4.7   $ 167.1   $ 255.8     65.3 %

Mortgage guaranty

            5.6     5.6     100.0 %

Other

        3.6     3.6         NM  
                       

Total

  $ 93.4   $ 8.3   $ 176.3   $ 261.4     67.45  

 

 
  For the Year Ended December 31, 2007  

Financial guaranty

  $ 55.0   $ 3.5   $ 90.3   $ 141.8     63.7 %

Mortgage guaranty

            17.5     17.5     100.0 %

Other

        4.1     4.1         NM  
                       

Total

  $ 55.0   $ 7.6   $ 111.9   $ 159.3     70.2 %

 

 
  For the Year Ended December 31, 2006  

Financial guaranty

  $ 28.5   $ 1.5   $ 95.2   $ 122.2     77.9 %

Mortgage guaranty

        2.3     24.9     22.7     109.7 %

Other

        6.6     6.6         NM  
                       

Total

  $ 28.5   $ 10.4   $ 126.7   $ 144.8     87.5 %

(1)
Certain 2007 and 2006 amounts have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

(2)
Some amounts may not add due to rounding.

NM = Not meaningful

270


Table of Contents


Schedule V

Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
(in millions of U.S. dollars)

        Valuation and qualifying accounts for the years ended December 31, 2008, 2007 and 2006 are as follows:

 
   
  Balance at
beginning of year
  Charged to
Expense/Deduction
  Balance at
end of year
 

2008

 

Tax valuation allowance

  $ 7.0   $   $ 7.0  

 

Allowance for Uncollectible Reinsurance

             
                   

 

Total

  $ 7.0   $   $ 7.0  
                   

2007

 

Tax valuation allowance

 
$

7.0
 
$

 
$

7.0
 

 

Allowance for Uncollectible Reinsurance

             
                   

 

Total

  $ 7.0   $   $ 7.0  
                   

2006

 

Tax valuation allowance

 
$

7.0
 
$

 
$

7.0
 

 

Allowance for Uncollectible Reinsurance

             
                   

 

Total

  $ 7.0   $   $ 7.0  
                   

271